now - Hartlepool Borough Council
Transcription
now - Hartlepool Borough Council
HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN Including Mineral and Waste Policies Director of Regeneration & Planning Services Hartlepool Borough Council Bryan Hanson House Hanson Square Hartlepool TS24 7BT Adopted Plan April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN INCLUDING MINERAL AND WASTE POLICIES CONTENTS 1 INTRODUCTION 2 OVERALL AIM STRATEGY AND OBJECTIVES Regeneration Local Plan Strategy Local Plan Objectives Indicators and Targets 7 7 10 12 12 3 GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINICPLES 15 Context for Policies General Principles Access For All Crime Prevention Pollution Environmental Impact Assessment Energy Efficiency Design along Main Approaches Advertisements Developers’ Contributions Art In Development Schemes Article 4 Directions Trees, Hedgerows and Development Protected Trees Trees on Highway Verges and Public Open Space Compulsory Purchase Potential Development Land Untidy Sites Derelict Land Contaminated Land 15 15 17 18 18 19 20 20 21 22 24 24 24 26 27 27 27 28 28 28 INDUSTRIAL AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT 31 Context for Policies Land for High Quality Industrial Development Land for General Industry, Business Use and Warehousing Bad Neighbour Uses The Port and Port Related Development Development Using Rail Facilities Improvements to Industrial Environment Land for Potentially Polluting or Hazardous Developments Underground Storage Hazardous Substances 31 35 41 42 44 45 46 46 48 48 RETAIL, COMMERCIAL AND MIXED USE DEVELOPMENT 51 Context for Policies The Town Centre The Primary Shopping Area Edge of Centre Areas Local Centres Commercial Improvement Areas Tees Bay Retail Park 51 54 57 59 64 65 66 4 5 1 i 6 7 8 ii Major Retail and Office Developments Retailing in Industrial Areas Petrol Filling Stations Food and Drink Commerical Uses within Residential Areas Working from Home Mixed Use Areas The North Docks/ Victoria Harbour Hartlepool Headland Land West of the A179 67 71 71 72 73 74 75 75 76 78 TOURISM 81 Context for Policies The Town Centre and the Marina The Headland Seaton Carew North Shelter Seaton Park Green Tourism Rural Tourism Tourist Accommodation Business Tourism and Conferencing 81 83 84 84 86 86 87 87 88 89 HOUSING 91 Context for Policies Improvements to Existing Housing Areas Housing Clearance Housing Market Restructuring Central Area Housing Housing Requirement Housing Supply Management of Housing Land Supply Affordable Housing Housing In Mixed Use Areas Conversions Low Density Housing New Residential Development: Design and Other Requirements House Extensions Residential Annexes for Relatives Homes and Hostels Mobile Homes Accommodation for Gypsies/ Travellers 91 97 97 98 100 100 103 105 109 110 111 112 114 115 116 117 117 118 TRANSPORT 119 Context for Policies Public Transport Bus Services Rail Services Rail Halts Durham Tees Valley Airport Integrated Public Transport The Cycle Network Provision for Pedestrians Improvements to the Pedestrian Environment Improvements to Pedestrian Linkages Pedestrian Routes within Housing Areas Traffic Management 119 121 121 122 122 123 123 124 126 126 126 127 127 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 9 10 11 Traffic Management in the Town Centre Improvements to Road Junctions Personal Mobility The Highway Network Strategic Road Schemes Other Road Improvements Road Schemes no Longer Required Access to Development Sites Restriction on Access to Major Roads Car Parking Freight Road Haulage Rail Freight Transport in the Countryside Provision for Transport in New Developments Travel Plans 128 128 128 129 129 129 130 131 131 132 135 135 135 136 136 137 PUBLIC UTILITIES AND COMMUNITY FACILITIES 139 Context for Policies Drainage Sewage Treatment Water Supplies Electricity Supplies Renewable Energy Wind Energy Other Renewable Energy Sources Telecommunications Community Facilities Health Services Education Community Centres Libraries 139 140 141 141 142 143 143 145 146 147 148 148 149 149 DEVELOPMENT CONSTRAINTS 151 Context for Policies Notifiable Installations The Nuclear Power Station Airports Landfill Sites Flood Risk Major Pipelines 151 151 151 153 153 156 158 RECREATION AND LEISURE 161 Context for Policies Coastal Recreation Play Facilities for Children Neighbourhood Parks Outdoor Playing Space Dual Use of School Facilities Outdoor Recreational Sites Informal Recreational Sites Recreational Routes Summerhill Noisy Outdoor Sports and Leisure Activities Indoor Sports and leisure Activities Late Night Uses Major Leisure Developments 161 163 164 165 166 168 168 169 169 170 170 171 172 173 iii 12 13 14 15 iv THE GREEN NETWORK 177 Context for policies The Green Network Green Wedges Key Green Space Areas Landscaping of Main Approaches Tree Planting Incidental Open Space 177 178 180 181 183 183 184 WILDLIFE AND NATURAL FEATURES 185 Context for Policies International Sites Nationally Important Sites Sites of Special Scientific Interest National Nature Reserves Enhancement of Sites of Special Scientific Interest Species Protected by Law Local Nature Reserves Sites of Nature Conservation Importance and Regionally Important Geological / Geomorphological Sites Ancient Woodlands Biodiversity 185 187 188 188 190 190 191 192 CONSERVATION OF THE HISTORIC ENVIRONMENT 197 Context for Policies Conservation Areas Protection and Enhancement of Conservation Areas Environmental Improvements in Conservation Areas Developments in the Vicinity of Conservation Areas Control of Demolition in Conservation Areas Additional Measures to Improve Design in Conservation Areas Review of Conservation Areas Historic Parks and Gardens Listed Buildings Control of Demolition of Listed Buildings Works to Listed Buildings Changes of Use of Listed buildings Development in the Vicinity of Listed Buildings Review of Listed Buildings Buildings of Local Interest Archaeological Sites Scheduled Monuments and Protected Wreck Sites Areas of Archaeological Interest Areas of Historic Landscape 197 198 198 201 201 201 202 202 202 204 204 205 206 206 206 207 208 208 208 210 THE RURAL AREA 211 Context for Policies Limits to Development The Urban Fence Development at Wynyard Village Envelopes Developments in the Villages Affordable Housing in the Rural Area Village Design Statements Development at Newton Bewley 211 213 213 213 214 214 214 214 215 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 193 194 195 Rural Services Development in the Countryside Agriculture Permitted Development Agricultural Land Intensive Livestock Units and Animal Waste Processing Changes in Farming Practices Farm Diversification Housing in the Rural Areas New Housing Residential Extensions Re-Use of Rural Buildings Recreation and Tourism Recreation Near the Urban Area The Tees Forest Gateway Sites Recreation and Tourism in the Open Countryside Access to the Countryside Recreational Routes Rights of Way Greenways Bridleways and Other Multi-User Routes Special Landscape Areas The Coast 215 215 217 217 218 218 220 220 221 221 222 222 224 224 224 225 225 226 226 227 228 228 228 229 MINERALS 231 Context for Policies Mineral Consultation Areas Primary and Secondary Aggregates Landbanks Mineral Extraction Transportation Restoration, After-Use and After-Care of Worked Mineral Sites 231 233 234 234 234 237 237 WASTE 239 Context for Policies Projected Levels of Waste Airports Large Scale Waste Producing Developments Waste Recovery Recycling Composting Waste Disposal Protection of Water Courses and Ground Water Supplies Civic Amenity Sites, Mineral Recovery Facilities and Waste Transfer Stations Incineration 239 241 241 241 242 242 243 244 245 245 246 IMPLEMENTATION AND RESOURCES 247 Development Control Site Specific Policies Proposals of Intent 247 247 248 19 MONITORING AND REVIEW 255 20 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL OF THE LOCAL PLAN 257 16 17 18 v DIAGRAMS Diagram 1.1 Diagram 1.2 Diagram 2.1 Diagram 4.1 Diagram 5.1 Diagram 5.2 Diagram 8.1 Diagram 8.2 Diagram 8.3 Diagram 10.1 Diagram 10.2 Diagram 10.3 Diagram 10.4 Diagram 10.5 Diagram 14.1 Diagram 15.1 The Regional Setting The Tees Valley Area Regeneration in Hartlepool Health & Safety Executive Consultation Zones Boundary of Town Centre Edge of Town Centre Areas Cycleway Network (Existing & Proposed) Town Centre Car Parking Area Seaton Carew Parking Area Hartlepool Nuclear Power Station Consultation Zones Durham Tees Valley Airport Safeguarding Zone Landfill Areas Environment Agency Flood Zones (2&3) Major Pipelines Conservation Areas Best & Most Versatile Agricultural Land Opp. Page 1 1 9 50 56 61 125 133 134 152 154 155 157 159 199 219 TABLES AND FIGURES Figure 7.1 Table H1 Table H2 Table H3 Table H4 Table H5 Figure 7.2 Table H6 Table 18.1 Table 20.1 Table 20.2 vi Housing Types Current Strategic Housing Requirement Committed Housing Provision Additional Dwellings Required 2002-2016 Proposed Strategic Housing Requirement Additional Dwellings Required 2004-2016 Brownfield Windfall Development 1995 – 2005 Potential Housing Supply Anticipated Responsibility for Implementation & Resourcing of Policies Appraisal Criteria Environmental Appraisal HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 91 101 101 102 102 102 104 105 249 258 261 APPENDICES Appendix 1 Appendix 2 Appendix 3 Appendix 4 Appendix 5 Appendix 6 Appendix 7 Appendix 8 The Town and Country Planning (Use Classes) (Amendment) (England) Order 2006 (As Amended) (Extract) Tees Forest Strategy Indicators and Targets Schedule 1 of Town & Country Planning (Environmental Assessment) (England & Wales) Regulations 1999 Undeveloped Industrial Land in Hartlepool (Hectares) – April 2005 Local Centres in Hartlepool Sites of Nature Conservation Importance (2003) List of Buildings of Special Architectural or Historic Interest (March 2006) 273 275 281 283 291 293 295 297 SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES Supplementary Note 1 Supplementary Note 2 Supplementary Note 3 Supplementary Note 4 Supplementary Note 5 Supplementary Note 6 Supplementary Note 7 Supplementary Note 8 Supplementary Note 9 Access Arrangements and Highway Considerations Design Requirements for Parking Trees and Development Guidelines Guidelines for House Extensions Design Guidance for Development in Conservation Areas and for Works to Listed Buildings Greatham Village Design Statement Crime Prevention by Planning and Design Developer Contributions Nature Conservation and Species Protected by Law 301 311 331 347 353 365 383 389 395 vii POLICIES GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINCIPLES GEP1 GEP2 GEP3 GEP4 GEP5 GEP6 GEP7 GEP8 GEP9 GEP10 GEP11 GEP12 GEP13 GEP14 GEP15 GEP16 GEP17 GEP18 General Environmental Principles Access for All Crime Prevention by Planning and Design Control of Pollution Environmental Impact Assessment Energy Efficiency Frontages of Main Approaches Advertisements Developers’ Contributions Provision of Public Art Article 4 Directions Trees, Hedgerows and Development Works to Protected Trees Review of Tree Preservation Orders Compulsory Purchase of Potential Development Sites Untidy Sites Derelict Land Reclamation Development on Contaminated Land 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 21 23 24 24 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 INDUSTRIAL AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT Ind1 Ind2 Ind3 Ind4 Ind5 Ind6 Ind7 Ind8 Ind9 Ind10 Ind11 Wynyard Business Park North Burn Electronics Components Park Queens Meadow Business Park Higher Quality Industrial Estates Industrial Areas Bad Neighbour Uses Port-Related Development Industrial Improvement Areas Potentially Polluting or Hazardous Developments Underground Storage Hazardous Substances 36 37 39 40 42 43 45 46 47 48 49 RETAIL, COMMERCIAL AND MIXED USE DEVELOPMENT Com1 Com2 Com3 Com4 Com5 Com6 Com7 Com8 Com9 Com10 Com11 Com12 Com13 Com14 Com15 Com16 Com17 viii Development of the Town Centre Primary Shopping Area Primary Shopping Area – Opportunity Site Edge of Town Centre Areas Local Centres Commercial Improvement Areas Tees Bay Mixed Use Site Shopping Development Main Town Centre Uses Retailing in Industrial Areas Petrol Filling Stations Food and Drink Commercial Uses in Residential Areas Business Uses in the Home Victoria Harbour/North Docks Mixed Use Site Headland – Mixed Use Land West of A179/ North of Middleton Road 55 57 58 62 65 66 67 69 70 71 72 73 74 74 76 78 79 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 TOURISM To1 To2 To3 To4 To5 To6 To7 To8 To9 To10 To11 Tourism Development in the Marina Tourism at the Headland Core Area of Seaton Carew Commercial Development Sites at Seaton Carew North Shelter Seaton Park Green Tourism Teesmouth National Nature Reserve Tourist Accommodation Touring Caravan Sites Business Tourism and Conferencing 84 84 85 86 86 87 87 87 88 89 89 Housing Improvements Selective Housing Clearance Housing market Renewal Central Area Housing Management of Housing Land Supply Mixed Use Areas Conversions for Residential Uses Residential Uses of Upper Floors New Residential Layout – Design and Other Requirements Residential Extensions Residential Annexes Homes and Hostels Residential Mobile Homes Gypsy Site 97 98 99 100 109 111 112 112 115 116 116 117 118 118 HOUSING Hsg1 Hsg2 Hsg3 Hsg4 Hsg5 Hsg6 Hsg7 Hsg8 Hsg9 Hsg10 Hsg11 Hsg12 Hsg13 Hsg14 TRANSPORT Tra1 Tra2 Tra3 Tra4 Tra5 Tra6 Tra7 Tra8 Tra9 Tra10 Tra11 Tra12 Tra13 Tra14 Tra15 Tra16 Tra17 Tra18 Tra19 Tra20 Bus Priority Routes Railway Line Extensions Rail Halts Public Transport Interchange Cycle Networks Cycle Facilities Pedestrian Linkages: Town Centre/ Headland/ Seaton Carew Pedestrian Routes- Residential Areas Traffic Management in the Town Centre Road Junction Improvements Strategic Road Schemes Road Scheme: North Graythorp Road Schemes: Development Sites Access to Development Sites Restriction on Access to Major Roads Car Parking Standards Railway Sidings Rail Freight Facilities Provision of Alternative Transport Travel Plans 121 122 123 124 126 126 127 127 128 128 129 130 130 131 131 132 135 135 136 137 ix PUBLIC UTILITY AND COMMUNITY FACILITIES PU1 PU2 PU3 PU4 PU5 PU6 PU7 PU8 PU9 PU10 PU11 Drainage Systems Industrial Sites Drainage Sewage Treatment Works Protection of the Aquifer Electricity Transmission, Distribution and Supply Nuclear Power Station Site Renewable Energy Developments Telecommunications Local Facilities Serving Residential Areas Primary School Location Primary School Site 140 141 141 141 142 142 145 147 148 148 149 DEVELOPMENT CONSTRAINTS Dco1 Dco2 Landfill Sites Flood Risk 153 158 RECREATION AND LEISURE Rec1 Rec2 Rec3 Rec4 Rec5 Rec6 Rec7 Rec8 Rec9 Rec10 Rec11 Rec12 Rec13 Rec14 Coastal Recreation Provision for Play in New Housing Areas Neighbourhood Parks Protection of Outdoor Playing Space Development of Sports Pitches Dual Use of School Facilities Outdoor Recreational Sites Areas of Quiet Recreation Recreational Routes Summerhill Noisy Outdoor Sports and Leisure Activities Land West of Brenda Road Late Night Uses Major Leisure Developments 163 165 165 167 167 168 168 169 170 170 171 171 173 175 THE GREEN NETWORK GN1 GN2 GN3 GN4 GN5 GN6 Enhancement of the Green Network Protection of Green Wedges Protection of Key Green Space Areas Landscaping of Main Approaches Tree Planting Protection of Incidental Open Space 180 181 182 183 183 184 Protection of International Nature Conservation Sites Protection of Nationally Important Nature Conservation Sites Enhancement of Sites of Special Scientific Interest Protected Species Protection of Local Nature Reserves New Local Nature Reserves Protection of SNCIs, RIGSs and Ancient Semi-Natural Woodland Protection of Biodiversity 188 190 191 192 193 193 194 195 WILDLIFE WL1 WL2 WL3 WL4 WL5 WL6 WL7 WL8 x HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 CONSERVATION OF THE HISTORIC ENVIRONMENT HE1 HE2 HE3 HE4 HE5 HE6 HE7 HE8 HE9 HE10 HE11 HE12 HE13 HE14 HE15 Protection and Enhancement of Conservation Areas Environmental Improvements in Conservation Areas Developments in the Vicinity of Conservation Areas Control of Demolition in Conservation Areas Review of Conservation Areas Protection and Enhancement of Registered Parks and Gardens Control of Demolition of Listed Buildings Works to Listed Buildings (Including Partial Demolition) Changes of Use of Listed Buildings Developments in the Vicinity of Listed Buildings Review of Listed Buildings Protection of Locally Important Buildings Scheduled Monuments Protection of Archaeological Sites Areas of Historic Landscape 200 201 201 201 202 203 204 205 206 206 206 207 208 209 210 THE RURAL AREA Rur1 Rur2 Rur3 Rur4 Rur5 Rur6 Rur7 Rur8 Rur9 Rur10 Rur11 Rur12 Rur13 Rur14 Rur15 Rur16 Rur17 Rur18 Rur19 Rur20 Urban Fence Wynyard Limits to Development Village Envelopes Village Design Statements Development At Newton Bewley Rural Services Development in the Countryside Prior Notification for Agricultural Development Protection of Agricultural Land Intensive Livestock Units Farm Diversification New Housing in the Countryside Re-Use of Rural Buildings The Tees Forest Small Gateway Sites Recreation in the Countryside Strategic Recreational Routes Rights of Way Summerhill- Newton Bewley Greenway Special Landscape Areas 213 213 214 214 215 215 216 217 218 220 221 222 223 224 225 226 227 227 228 228 MINERALS Min1 Min2 Min3 Min4 Min5 Safeguarding of Mineral Resources Use of Secondary Aggregates Mineral Extraction Transport of Minerals Restoration of Mineral Sites 233 234 236 237 238 Major Waste Producing Developments Provision of ‘Bring’ Recycling Facilities Composting Landfill Developments Landraising Incineration 242 242 243 244 245 246 WASTE Was1 Was2 Was3 Was4 Was5 Was6 xi xii HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 1. INTRODUCTION HARTLEPOOL 1.1. Hartlepool has over recent years seen substantial investment which has completely transformed its environment, overall prosperity and above all its image. 1.2. The town has a long history, the first recorded settlement being centred around the Saxon Monastery founded in 640AD. Its first charter was issued in 1145. The town as it is today has grown around the natural haven which became its commercial port and from which its heavy industrial base developed. Now, new high quality business facilities and exciting visitor attractions are being developed in the areas vacated by the heavy industries. 1.3. Hartlepool is a compact sustainable settlement with most of the needs of the residents in terms of housing, employment, shopping and leisure being able to be met within the town. SETTING 1.4. The Borough of Hartlepool covers an area of about 9400 hectares (over 36 square miles) and has a population of about 90,000. It is bounded to the east by the North Sea and encompasses the main urban area of the town of Hartlepool and a rural hinterland containing the five villages of Hart, Elwick, Dalton Piercy, Newton Bewley and Greatham. The Durham Coast railway line between Sunderland and Middlesbrough runs through the centre of the town, and the A19 trunk road which crosses north/south through the western rural part of the Borough is readily accessed via the A689 and the A179 roads which originate in the town centre. 1.5. The Borough comprises part of the Tees Valley area, formed by the five boroughs of Darlington, Hartlepool, Middlesbrough, Redcar and Cleveland and Stockton-on-Tees. Diagrams 1.1 and 1.2 show Hartlepool in its regional and local settings. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 1 A NEW LOCAL PLAN FOR HARTLEPOOL 1.6. In 1994, the first Borough-wide local plan for Hartlepool was adopted to guide and control development in Hartlepool and its environs. It was one of the earliest local plans to be completed in the Northern Region following the introduction of the planled system under the provisions of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990. 1.7. The planning system is now very firmly plan led and for the Hartlepool Local Plan to remain relevant and effective, it is necessary to review and update it. 1.8. The Borough Council has decided to undertake a full review of the plan because of the many new issues which have arisen and other developments which have occurred since the plan was first prepared. In particular: • local government reorganisation has resulted in Hartlepool Borough Council becoming responsible for waste and minerals planning. As the former Cleveland County Council did not prepare Waste or Minerals Local Plans, there is a lack of statutory local planning guidance on these matters; • central government policy and advice on the content of plans has changed considerably reflecting the much increased emphasis on sustainability; • issues arising from the operation of development control have highlighted the weaknesses as well as the strengths of the policies of the 1994 local plan; • many developments proposed in the 1994 plan have been completed and other changes such as new wildlife site designations need to be reflected in an updated document. 1.9. The new Hartlepool Local Plan (including mineral and waste policies) will cover the period up to 2016. THE DEVELOPMENT PLAN FOR HARTLEPOOL 1.10. The Hartlepool Local Plan comprises part of the Development Plan for Hartlepool, the other part being the Tees Valley Structure Plan adopted in February 2004. The structure plan provides the strategic framework for the detailed policies of the local plan. It provides guidance on the amount of new housing that will be required and identifies in general terms the locations for new employment uses and transportation developments in the area. A key diagram illustrates the proposals of the structure plan in diagrammatic form not related to precise areas of land. PURPOSES OF THIS LOCAL PLAN 1.11. 2 The Hartlepool Local Plan has four main functions: • as part of the development plan for Hartlepool, it shows precisely on a map base the areas of land indicated in the structure plan as locations for major development or subject to specific policies; • it provides guidance for the control of development by defining precise policies on land uses and on selected matters of design so that potential applicants for planning permission are aware of the planning requirements for the locality; • it promotes and provides guidance for regeneration and other investment opportunities and enables other ‘planning’ bodies to phase, service and market sites based on known criteria of land availability. Financial resources can then be targetted more effectively; and • it brings local and detailed issues to the attention of the public so that there is full involvement in the discussion, and input to, planning the future of the Borough. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 THE SCOPE OF THE LOCAL PLAN 1.12. The local plan has to confine itself to those actions and proposals which can be implemented through the Town and Country Planning legislative framework. Not all ‘development’ 1 requires planning permission. Certain developments are permitted by the Town and Country Planning (General Development) Order 1995 (and its amendments) including, for example, works to the interiors of buildings and changes of use of land or buildings from one use to another within the same class as defined in the Town and Country Planning (Use Classes) Order 1987 and subsequent amendments. (see Appendix 1). 1.13. The local plan is unable to address social and economic problems which are not directly influenced by changes in the use of land. It does, however, set the planning and land use context for programmes and strategies which have and will be developed to tackle these problems. Comments received from the public in connection with the consultation on the Issues Report 2 indicated many other problems such as litter and dog fouling. These also are matters which cannot be considered in the local plan, but they are recognised and being addressed as far as possible by the Borough Council under its other powers. 1.14. Whilst the local plan is detailed and provides guidance for developers, it does not incorporate specific policies and proposals for every site within the Borough. Rather, it concentrates on those issues, problems, opportunities and aims which can be incorporated into the land use planning framework. In particular it indicates those areas of land where changes are most likely to occur within the plan period. 1 ‘Development is defined in section 55 of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 as “the carrying out of building, engineering, mining or other operations in, on, over or under land, or the making of any material change in the use of buildings or other land”. 2 The Issues Report, published in January 1999, represented a first stage in the process of preparing the new Hartlepool Local Plan and outlined the main issues to be followed. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 3 PLANNING POLICY BACKGROUND 1.15. In drawing up the policies and proposals in the local plan, regard has to be had to national and regional planning polices and to the provisions of the structure plan. National Planning Policies 1.16. Central government advice and policy on different aspects of planning was formerly issued in the form of Planning Policy Guidance Notes (PPGs) and is now being issued in Planning Policy Statements (PPSs). These together with Circulars and Minerals Planning Guidance Notes (MPGs) are now the principal sources of national policy guidance on planning matters. In line with the government’s commitment to sustainable development set out in ‘Sustainable Development: The U.K. Strategy’ (1994), the guidance emphasises the need for development plans to make adequate provision for development whilst at the same time taking into account the need to protect the natural and built environment. 1.17. Reference to PPGs, PPSs, MPGs and other advice is made as appropriate within the individual chapters of this local plan, and in particular where local circumstances suggest that such advice is not relevant or applicable, full justification is given. Regional Planning Guidance 1.18 Regional Planning Guidance for the North East (RPG1) covering the period up to 2016 was issued by the Deputy Prime Minister in November 2002. The vision and strategy for the North East set out in this RPG is for the sustainable development of the region based on the four key themes of regeneration, opportunity, accessibility and conservation. The RPG’s locational strategy seeks to locate the majority of new development to the built up areas of the Tyne, Wear and Tees conurbations with significant, but smaller scale developments in Hartlepool, Darlington and the main towns serving other regeneration areas in the region, and to enhance the role of market towns and other main rural centres in serving their hinterland. 1.19 The new Local Plan will refer to relevant advice given in RPG1 as appropriate in the individual chapters of this local plan. A New Planning System 1.20 4 The Planning and Compulsory Purchase Act 2004 introduced a new development plan system whereby Local Plans are to be replaced by a series of Local Development Documents contained within a Local Development Framework and structure plans are to be replaced by Regional Spatial Strategies. RPG1 became the Regional Spatial Strategy on the commencement of the Act, but the Tees Valley Structure Plan, as it was adopted after RPG1, will provide the strategic context for the Local Plan. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Strategic Planning Policies 1.21 The policies in the Tees Valley Structure Plan comprise general policies for sustainable development and regeneration and set out the spatial strategy for development in the Tees Valley area. Specific policies cover the topics of: • Economy – including economic regeneration, office development and use, and the location of industrial land; • The natural and built environment – including the conservation and enhancement of designated landscape and wildlife areas and the built environment, and the control of urban development; • Housing - maximising the capacity of existing urban areas; • Transport – concentrating on improving alternatives to the private car and setting out the long term vision for a new crossing of the River Tees; • Town centres and shopping – seeking to maintain the vitality and viability of town centres; • Leisure, recreation and tourism – encouraging opportunities for leisure and the development of tourism facilities; • Energy – directing energy generating developments to the most appropriate locations and guiding renewable energy schemes; and • Waste and Minerals. 1.22 Reference is made to the relevant structure plan policies as appropriate throughout the local plan. FORM OF THE LOCAL PLAN 1.23 The Hartlepool Local Plan (including mineral and waste policies) comprises a written statement together with a proposals map. The written statement sets out the policies and general proposals for the future use of land and location of major development in written form together with explanations (the reasoned justification) as HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 5 to why the Borough Council thinks they are necessary. The policies and proposals are printed in upper case BOLD type and bounded by a black line; each is prefixed by “POLICY” to distinguish it from the accompanying text 3 . 1.24 The written statement is arranged into chapters on a topic basis. The context for the policies of each topic, including the strategic planning framework and the specific objectives of the local plan is set out at the beginning of each chapter. An overarching chapter on General Environmental Principles brings together a range of issues which apply generally to planning proposals and which seek to strengthen the principles of sustainability. 1.25 The proposals map is not a ‘zoning’ plan showing how all the land in the Borough is proposed to be used. It does show, however, on an Ordnance Survey base, precisely which areas of land are affected by particular proposals. Some parts of the Borough are shown in more detail on larger-scale ‘inset’ plans, including the Central Area, the Headland and the villages. 1.26 Some design guidance (including ‘Guidelines for House Extensions’ and ‘Design Guidance for Development in Conservation Areas and for Works to Listed Buildings’) is contained within the main plan document as Supplementary Notes. Also included is the Greatham Village Design Statement 4 which was adopted by the Borough Council as Supplementary Planning Guidance in September 1999. Relevant policies of the plan refer to the supplementary notes. 3 Although some policies remain essentially the same as in the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan, they will be given different policy number identifications in this new local plan. 4 The Greatham Village Design Statement was prepared by residents of the village in 1999. It identifies what the community thinks is important in terms of the character of the village and what it hopes to see preserved and protected. 6 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 2 OVERALL AIM, STRATEGY AND OBJECTIVES INTRODUCTION 2.1 Hartlepool possesses valuable assets in its coastal and maritime heritage, its historic identity and in the quality of some parts of its built environment. As mentioned in the introductory chapter, substantial investment over recent years has resulted in massive changes that have transformed the town and changed its image from that of a town dominated by heavy industrial development into an attractive tourism venue. 2.2 The overall aim of the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan was to ‘improve the quality of life in Hartlepool’ and the land use policies proposals of the plan have guided much of the change that has occurred, including for example: • tourism-related developments in the Marina and the Headland, • new shopping developments and improvements to Middleton Grange, • revitalisation of Church Street and older industrial and commercial areas, • re-use of some prominent derelict and under-used buildings (eg.Wesley), • reclamation of derelict and untidy land (eg, Clyde Place), • new executive housing developments in the Park area, • progress on the major new housing site at Middle Warren, • development of innovation centre at Queens Meadow, • improvements to older housing (Murray Street Renewal Area), • improvement of council housing areas (Owton Rossmere and North • Hartlepool), • provision of community sports and other facilities at Dyke House, Lynnfield and Stranton schools, • a new woodland recreational area at Summerhill, • environmental enhancement in Greatham Conservation Area, • environmental improvements along major transport corridors (A689 / A179), • new roads and cycleways, • first phases of coastal walkway, and • a local nature reserve at Seaton Dunes and Common. REGENERATION 2.3 The Hartlepool Community Strategy is a statutory plan required by the Local Government Act 2000 to promote the economic, social and environmental well-being of Hartlepool, and contribute to the achievement of sustainable development. The Strategy prepared by the Hartlepool Partnership, allows local communities to articulate their aspirations, needs and priorities; co-ordinates the actions of the Council, and of the public, private, voluntary and community organisations; focuses and shapes existing and future activity of those organisations; and contributes to the achievement of sustainable development. It provides an overall policy framework and an action plan. The local plan will provide a means of taking forward those elements of the Community Strategy that concern physical development and use of land. In some circumstances statements in the Community Strategy are capable of being material considerations in the determination of a planning application, if they relate to the development and use of land. 2.4 A Neighbourhood Renewal Strategy has been prepared to provide the framework for the regeneration of the most deprived neighbourhoods in the town which includes more than half of the population. This brings together local people and organisations to narrow the gap between the condition in these neighbourhoods and the national HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 7 situation. The strategy recognises that economic growth is fundamental to the regeneration of the town, but that it must proceed in parallel with environmental and social progress. 2.5 The Borough Council’s overall aim: ‘to take direct action and work in partnership with others, to continue the revitalisation of Hartlepool life and secure a better future for Hartlepool people’. The vision prepared by the Hartlepool Partnership for the Hartlepool Community Strategy is: ‘’that Hartlepool will be a prosperous, caring, confident and outward looking community, in an attractive environment, realising its potential’ Urban regeneration in its widest sense (economic, environmental and social) is still uppermost in the Council’s priorities. Investment in regeneration initiatives creating new development and reusing land and buildings in the urban area facilitates the creation of a more sustainable pattern of development. 2.6 Past regeneration initiatives, in particular City Challenge and the influence of the former Teesside Development Corporation have generated many of the improvements that have taken place in the central part of Hartlepool including the Marina. The emphasis of the town’s economy has shifted towards services and visitors. Currently the North Hartlepool Single Regeneration Budget (SRB) Partnerships and West Central Hartlepool New Deal for Communities (NDC) are seeking to address the high unemployment, poor housing and other social, environmental, educational and health problems of these deprived areas of Hartlepool. 2.7 The West Central NDC initiative extends the philosophy of investing in existing communities and seeking to involve people directly in the management of their own area. Key issues in the area include worklessness, crime, health and education, the condition of its older housing and industrial areas, the rapid social changes taking place and the relationship between the expanding town centre and surrounding residential neighbourhoods. Key strategies have been prepared to tackle low demand housing, commercial areas and the Longhill Industrial Estate. 2.8 Nevertheless, although there have been immense physical improvements in the town and many new jobs created, unemployment and other deprivation indicators remain well above the national averages. Further work is still required to help the economy grow, increase employment, bring land and buildings back into use, improve the quality of life in residential areas and empower local people. Further initiatives will seek to improve the image of Hartlepool even further than already achieved, and also to generate business confidence and stimulate investment in the town as a whole (see Diagram 2.1). 2.9 Key areas for future resource will be from the Regional Development Agency (ONE Northeast) and the North East Regional Housing Board who are facilitating regeneration through sub-regional partnerships, and the establishment of the Tees Valley City Region. The Tees Valley Partnership has established an Investment Framework supported by a rolling Action Plan which currently runs to 2008. 8 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 9 2.10 The Investment Framework includes a range of projects to be progressed under the Coastal Arc initiative including: • further development at Queens Meadow and the southern business zone; • the establishment of a business incubation system; • further enhancement around the town centre, Headland and Seaton Carew; • the implementation of the Victoria Harbour development (through Tees Valley Regeneration); enhancement of the town’s ‘education quarter’; and • a programme of housing market renewal. 2.11 The Tees Valley Partnership has developed a blue sky vision for the region – the Tees Valley Vision. The main priorities of this document have been incorporated within the Tees Valley City Region Development Plan which identifies key step change initiatives to regenerate the area as part of the Northern Way initiative. 2.12 Hartlepool has an economic strategy which accords with the revised Regional Economic Strategy. European Regional Development Funds are being accessed to encourage indigenous businesses and community based enterprises. Other policies and programmes for coordinating public expenditure, such as the Local Transport Plan, Education Development Plan, Health Action Zone, Housing Market renewal programme and Neighbourhood Renewal Strategy are also focusing resources into the deprived parts of the town. The strategy for the Tees Forest Plan seeks to bring multiple benefits especially in terms of regeneration, economic performance and the sustainable development of the area (see Appendix 2). LOCAL PLAN STRATEGY Overall Aim 2.13 The new overall aim for the Hartlepool Local Plan which takes account of the Borough Council’s overall aim, the Hartlepool Partnership’s vision (see paragraph 2.5 above) and the need for development to be sustainable, is as follows: To continue to regenerate Hartlepool securing a better future for its people by seeking to meet economic, environmental and social needs in a sustainable manner. Elements of the strategy 2.14 In the context of this aim, the strategy for the local plan covers the following four areas: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ 2.15 10 regeneration of Hartlepool provision of community needs conservation and improvement of the environment maximisation of accessibility These elements of the strategy are not set out in order of importance or priority and are interconnected in many respects, with the concept of sustainability common to them all. In view of the importance of social and economic as well as environmental concerns in the context of the future development of Hartlepool, the objectives and HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 policies of this local plan and its predecessor have been subject to a sustainability appraisal (see Chapter 20). Regeneration of Hartlepool 2.16 The Index of Multiple Deprivation (IMD), 2004, ranks Hartlepool the 14th most disadvantaged district in the country. Moreover, out of 58 Super Output Areas 1 (SOAs) in Hartlepool, 14 (or 24%) fall within the most disadvantaged 5% of SOAs in the country, 23 (40%) in the worst 10% and 32 (55%) in the worst 20%. There are multiple symptoms of social and economic decline – unemployment, poor housing, crime, major health issues and a degraded environment. These problems are being tackled in partnership with others through comprehensive regeneration initiatives that aim to address the considerable needs of the town, realise development and other opportunities and create a sustainable community in Hartlepool. Development opportunities still exist and the compact form of Hartlepool retains a human scale which optimises the potential for further development to be achieved in a sustainable manner. Investment in regeneration initiatives creating new development and reusing land in the urban area facilitates the creation of a more sustainable pattern of development. The local plan will provide the land use context for such initiatives by promoting and facilitating opportunities for economic, environmental and social regeneration. 2.17 To ensure that there is a sustainable community, out-migration of the economically active age groups needs to be reduced, and those employed in Hartlepool should be encouraged to live in the town. In this respect, the regeneration initiatives seek to increase employment prospects and improve the environment and image of the town, and the local plan will identify sites for the provision of housing of an appropriate quality. Provision of community needs 2.18 A sustainable community requires good quality housing, accessible not only to workplaces, but also to shopping, recreational, leisure, and other facilities. The local plan will therefore, through its policies and proposals, promote and facilitate the provision of housing and of appropriate and accessible facilities to meet the needs of the residents of the Borough. Conservation and improvement of the environment 2.19 1 Environmental issues range from global and national concerns (eg. controlling pollution, biodiversity and protecting important wildlife sites) to local level matters (eg. protecting specific aspects of the local landscape and townscape). The quality of the environment affects people who live and work in the area and can deter or attract potential visitors and investors. Much of the existing environment, including the internationally important wildlife areas along the coast, is of high quality and a significant asset in terms of promoting the image of the area. Opportunities exist to further promote the area through initiatives such as the Tees Forest. The local plan aims not only to conserve the natural and built environment, but also to enhance it where appropriate. Super output areas, of which there are about 32,500 nationally, comprise sub-divisions of wards, of about 1500 people. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 11 Maximisation of accessibility 2.20 Sustainable development is supported by a transport system that aims to provide choice and mobility for all in a way that is safe, efficient, clean and fair. The five year strategy for transport in Hartlepool is set out in the Local Transport Plan which seeks in its vision ‘a safe and effective transport system providing equal accessibility and maximum choice’. In planning terms, the strategy is to restrict the dispersal of development – to reduce the need to travel and provide better access to leisure and the countryside, jobs etc. The local plan will therefore, through its land allocation policies and proposals seek to minimise the need to travel and improve accessibility with safe, convenient and accessible alternatives to the private car. LOCAL PLAN OBJECTIVES 2.21 Specific objectives relating to the four elements of the strategy are set out on page 13. The policies and proposals in the plan have been developed from these objectives. Many policies relate to more than one objective. INDICATORS AND TARGETS 2.22 Regular monitoring will be carried out on a range of matters relating to development in the Borough (see Chapter 19). It is necessary to ensure that the local plan’s strategy is being successfully implemented and an important part of the monitoring process will therefore be to consider progress against indicators and targets. 2.23 The plan through its policies primarily seeks to enable and guide development by others rather than directly implemented by the Borough Council. It is not appropriate therefore to select indicators and targets (such as decreasing unemployment) which are subject to many influences other than planning. Also, whilst it is appropriate in terms of judging the continuing effectiveness of policies in controlling development, to monitor for example, the number of refusals of planning permission upheld on appeal for policy reasons, it is not generally meaningful to set targets in this respect. 2.24 Further, it is not practical to set out indicators and targets for all the plan’s policies and proposals. However, the local plan objectives, derived from the four elements of the local plan strategy, and providing the context for the plan’s policies and proposals, cover all the main policy areas of the plan. The key indicators and targets (set out in Appendix 3) have therefore been developed from these objectives. They will supplement the indicators and targets to be included in the Regional Planning Guidance for the North East and the Tees Valley Structure Plan. 12 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 A. REGENERATION OBJECTIVES A1 A2 A8 A9 to encourage the provision of more and higher quality job opportunities to ensure that sites are available for the full range of industrial and commercial activities so as to enable the diversification of employment opportunities to encourage the development of additional office, small business and light industrial uses to promote the growth of tourism to ensure that there is an adequate infrastructure to serve new and existing development to improve the viability and environment of older housing, commercial and industrial areas to promote development on previously used sites where appropriate, and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings to promote mixed use developments where appropriate to encourage the provision of high quality housing B. COMMUNITY NEEDS OBJECTIVES B1 to ensure that there is available throughout the plan period an adequate supply of suitable housing land which is capable of offering a range of house types to meet all needs to ensure that Hartlepool Town Centre continues to fulfil its role as a vibrant and viable amenity providing a wide range of attractions and services with convenient access for the whole community to encourage in accessible locations the provision of sport, recreational, leisure and cultural developments to cater for the whole community to protect and encourage the development of local shopping, leisure, sporting and recreational and other community facilities at locations convenient to main neighbourhoods A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 B2 B3 B4 C. ENVIRONMENT OBJECTIVES C1 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to retain the compact form of the main urban area by preventing urban development extending into the countryside to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest to encourage a high standard of design and the provision of high quality environment in all developments and particularly those on prominent sites, along the main road and rail corridors, and along the coast to seek to create a green network within the main urban area to direct the future protection, management and improvement of open space for people and wildlife to protect as far as possible existing open space, and to encourage further landscaping and tree planting where appropriate to protect and enhance the character of the existing villages to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas, and to make them more accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting or hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a damaging effect on the environment. to minimize the adverse environmental effects of mineral workings and waste disposal operations and ensure the appropriate restoration and after use of land C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 C9 C10 C11 C12 D TRANSPORT OBJECTIVES D1 D2 to ensure the provision of a safe, efficient and economic transport network, accessible to all to promote developments in locations which support existing transport infrastructure, which minimise the need to travel, and which are accessible by all modes of transport to ensure that developments attracting large numbers of people locate in existing centres which are highly accessible by means other than the private car to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport. D3 D4 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 13 14 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 3 GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINCIPLES CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 3.1 There are a range of concerns, some of a general nature, which apply to all planning proposals and others of a more specific nature, such as protection of trees and the control of advertisements, which need to be addressed in the determination of planning applications. The local plan seeks to ensure that all development, as far as possible, conforms to the principle of sustainability as set out in the Hartlepool Community Strategy. Where planning permission is required for development, certain underlying principles will be consistently applied in planning policy decisions. Development proposals will need to satisfy a set of general requirements which relate in varying degrees to the ultimate aim of improving the quality of life in Hartlepool. Structure Plan Policies 3.2 The Tees Valley Structure Plan, within its overall strategy and in policies SUS1 and SUS2, aims to ensure that the underlying pattern of development is sustainable in that development should meet the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. Local Plan Objectives 3.3 Most of the objectives listed on page 13 above, including all those relating to the conservation and improvement of the environment, are relevant in drawing up the general environmental principles policies set out below. POLICIES AND PROPOSALS GENERAL PRINCIPLES 3.4 The main environmental principles are embodied in a general policy (policy GEP1 below) which gives a basic framework of guidance over a complete range of planning issues. The policy does not refer to specific types of development or uses for which policies are set out in chapters 4 -17 below. It includes reference to the appearance of development, its effect on the area and the need to conform to a range of standards and requirements. 3.5 Encouragement will be given to maximising the development of sites in areas which can be easily accessed by the public, such as within the town centre, where these are highly accessible by public transport or close to a major transport interchange. 3.6 Most developments should be located within limits defined around the main built up area of the town (the urban fence) and the villages (village envelopes) and around the Wynyard development (limits to development). These limits have been drawn up to take account of future development needs, whilst respecting environmental and topographical features and infrastructure constraints (see policies Rur1, Rur2 and Rur3). Development within the urban fence and village envelopes should wherever possible reuse land which has previously been developed except where this would result in the loss of important urban green space. 3.7 Development should normally be of a scale and character in keeping with its surroundings and should not have a significant detrimental effect on the occupiers HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 15 of adjoining or nearby properties, or on the environment generally. In addition where appropriate, adequate access, servicing and car parking provision will need to be made (see Supplementary Notes 1 and 2). Where possible development should make use of secondary aggregates (see policy Min 2). Development within the Tees Forest should, where appropriate, provide for a range of environmental and community benefits (see policy Rur14 and Appendix 2). POLICY GEP1 GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINCIPLES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL, IN DETERMINING PLANNING APPLICATIONS FOR DEVELOPMENT, WILL HAVE DUE REGARD TO THE PROVISIONS OF THE DEVELOPMENT PLAN (THE TEES VALLEY STRUCTURE PLAN AND THE HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN) AND ALSO TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE FOLLOWING MATTERS: i. ii. iii. THE EXTERNAL APPEARANCE OF THE DEVELOPMENT, ITS RELATIONSHIPS WITH THE SURROUNDING AREA, THE EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES BY, FOR EXAMPLE: ♦ GENERAL DISTURBANCE, ♦ LOSS OF PRIVACY, ♦ VISUAL INTRUSION, ♦ NOISE, DUST, SMELL, VIBRATION, ♦ LIGHT POLLUTION, iv. THE EFFECT ON HIGHWAY SAFETY, v. THE EFFECT ON PUBLIC RIGHTS OF WAY, vi. THE ADEQUACY OF THE INFRASTRUCTURE, INCLUDING ROADS, THE WATER SUPPLY SYSTEM AND THE PROVISION OF SURFACE AND FOUL MAINS DRAINAGE, vii. THE EFFECT ON FLOOD RISK, viii. THE EFFECT ON AIR QUALITY, ix. THE EFFECT ON EXISTING TREES, HEDGEROWS AND OTHER LANDSCAPE FEATURES, x. THE EFFECT ON WILDLIFE, NATURAL HABITATS AND FEATURES AND SPECIES PROTECTED BY LAW, xi. THE NEED FOR A HIGH STANDARD OF DESIGN AND LANDSCAPING AND NATIVE SPECIES, xii. THE EFFECT ON ARCHAEOLOGICAL REMAINS AND THE HISTORIC ENVIRONMENT, AND xiii THE EFFECT ON AGRICULTURAL LAND. IN GENERAL, DEVELOPMENT SHOULD: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ BE LOCATED WITHIN THE LIMITS TO DEVELOPMENT AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, BE LOCATED OUTSIDE DESIGNATED GREEN WEDGES, BE LOCATED ON PREVIOUSLY DEVELOPED LAND, INCORPORATE ADEQUATE ACCESS AND SERVICING ARRANGEMENTS (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 1), INCORPORATE ADEQUATE CAR PARKING FACILITIES (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2), BE LOCATED SO AS TO BE ACCESSIBLE BY PUBLIC TRANSPORT, BY FOOT AND CYCLE, BE LOCATED SO AS NOT TO BE UNDULY AFFECTED BY POOR AIR QUALITY, NOISE OR SIMILAR EFFECTS EMANATING FROM ADJACENT USES OF LAND, RETAIN AREAS OF OPEN WATER, WATER COURSES AND THEIR MARGINS, MAKE USE OF SECONDARY AGGREGATES, AND SATISFY RELEVANT PLANNING REQUIREMENTS OF STATUTORY CONSULTEES INCLUDING AS APPROPRIATE: THE HEALTH AND SAFETY EXECUTIVE, THE NUCLEAR INSTALLATIONS INSPECTORATE, THE ENVIRONMENT AGENCY, ENGLISH NATURE (Natural England) SPORT ENGLAND, AND ENGLISH HERITAGE. PLANNING CONDITIONS WILL BE IMPOSED TO CONTROL DEVELOPMENT WHERE NECESSARY AND PLANNING AGREEMENTS MAY ALSO BE NEGOTIATED. 16 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 3.8 Appendix 1 sets out the classes of development in the Town & Country Planning (Use Classes) (Amendment) (England) Order 2005, many of which are referred to in specific policies of this local plan. However, not all uses fall within one of the designated classes and these are regarded as uses in their own right (“sui generis” uses). Policies in the plan cannot cover every eventuality and individual uses will be assessed in accordance with the principles embodied in policy GEP1 above. Some “sui generis” uses may be akin to uses in specific classes and, where appropriate, comparisons will be made and parallels drawn. ACCESS FOR ALL 3.9 Access for all, including people with disabilities of all types, the elderly and people with young children, should be a fundamental consideration in determining planning applications for developments that are used by the general public. Accessible buildings and public spaces generally provide a better environment for everyone. 3.10 Certain statutory requirements such as those contained in the Building Regulations are imposed on developers to secure reasonable access together with facilities for disabled people in respect of the building of new, and extensions to existing, non domestic properties. New housing should be designed to incorporate features reflecting homes for life under part M of the Building Regulations. 3.11 However, some matters lie outside the scope of such legislation but are still relevant in determining a planning application. These relate to the overall layout of developments, including the spaces between and around buildings, access to recreational and landscaped areas, parking provision and the design of roads and footpaths. 3.12 If permission is sought to alter an existing building, new or improved access, whichever is appropriate, should be incorporated into the new design of the building wherever possible. Alterations made to historic buildings to provide access for all should be in sympathy with the character of the building. It is more economical to incorporate access and special facilities at the design stage than having to adapt a development later. The Disability Discrimination Act (1995) requires service providers to have made reasonable adjustments to the physical features of premises by 2004 to overcome any barriers to access. Access provision for all should also be provided where practical in public transport provision. POLICY GEP2 ACCESS FOR ALL THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL REQUIRE PROVISION TO BE MADE TO ENABLE ACCESS FOR ALL (IN PARTICULAR FOR PEOPLE WITH DISABILITIES, THE ELDERLY AND PEOPLE WITH CHILDREN) IN RELATION TO: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ALL NEW DEVELOPMENTS WHERE PUBLIC ACCESS CAN BE EXPECTED, PLACES OF EMPLOYMENT, ALTERATIONS TO EXISTING DEVELOPMENTS (WHEREVER PRACTICAL), SCHEMES FOR PUBLIC TRANSPORT PROVISION, AND CAR PARKING AREAS. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 17 CRIME PREVENTION 3.13 The Crime and Disorder Act 1998 requires the Borough Council to exercise its various functions with due regard to the likely effect on crime and disorder and their prevention. The Borough Council acknowledges that the built environment can influence criminal behaviour and that environmental design and planning can play a part in crime prevention. It therefore seeks the creation of a physical environment conducive to the overall safety of the community by influencing the design and layout of new development so as to make it more difficult for crime and anti-social behaviour to be committed and/or to increase the detection of potential offenders. The Borough Council will seek to ensure, by negotiation, that developers take account of the need for crime prevention in their development proposals (see Supplementary Note 7). 3.14 The Borough Council will continue to consult Cleveland Constabulary on certain applications where there is potential to eliminate or reduce criminal activity through the adoption of appropriate measures at the design stage. Such applications will normally be those involving a large number of people or properties, for example, housing estates, industrial estates, shopping centres, leisure complexes and car parks. POLICY GEP3 CRIME PREVENTION BY PLANNING AND DESIGN THE BOROUGH COUNCIL, IN CONSIDERING APPLICATIONS FOR DEVELOPMENT, WILL HAVE REGARD TO THE GUIDANCE IN SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 7 AND THE NEED FOR THE DESIGN AND LAYOUT TO INCORPORATE FEATURES AND/OR MEASURES TO REDUCE CRIME AND THE FEAR OF CRIME INCLUDING: ♦ ♦ THE SITING OF CAR PARKS AND OPEN SPACE WHERE VISIBLE FROM THE SURROUNDING AREA, THE LOCATION OF WALLS, FENCES, FOOTPATHS AND LANDSCAPING TO ERADICATE BLIND SPOTS. POLLUTION 3.15 The Hartlepool Community Strategy seeks to minimise all forms of pollution – air, noise, land and water, and ensure that pollution is limited to levels which natural systems can cope with without damage. 3.16 Whilst the obvious visible pollutants have steadily declined over the last thirty years, there has been an increase in the less obvious sources of pollutants. It is essential that new developments do not add significantly to existing pollution levels. Generally developments should not be located where they would be directly affected by existing sources of pollution. 3.17 Localised problems of visual intrusion, dust, noise and smell arising from small businesses, such as coal and scrap yards, continue to cause concern. Planning controls need to be imposed to minimise the effects of those operations through such means as wheel washing, the control of stacking heights and measures to control dust nuisance. The Borough Council will seek to prevent pollution at source through controls imposed under the Environmental Protection Act 1990 (see policies Ind6, Ind9 and GEP1). 3.18 Under the Environment Act 1995 local authorities are required to review and assess air quality. Where the quality of air is found to be substandard a local authority could be required to define Air Quality Management Areas and to draw up 18 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 action plans to improve the air quality. No Air Quality Management Areas will be required in Hartlepool although this will be kept under review. However it is essential to maintain and improve air quality and therefore development which may affect air quality will be properly assessed as part of the consideration of any planning application (see also policy GEP1). 3.19 Under the Environmental Protection Act 1990 local authorities are required to compile an inspection strategy setting out how they intend to inspect all potentially contaminated areas of land within their area. In order to assist in this process it is the Government’s intention that, wherever possible, contaminated land is remediated through the development control process (see paragraph 3.53 and Policy GEP 18). 3.20 With respect to water pollution, Northumbrian Water is responsible for ensuring appropriate arrangements for the discharge of trade effluent to sewers whilst the Environment Agency should be consulted with regard to the control of surface water run off into water courses and the sea (see also policy PU4). POLICY GEP 4 CONTROL OF POLLUTION DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS RESULTING POLLUTION: i. ii. iii. iv. WILL NOT BE APPROVED WHERE WOULD HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE ENVIRONMENT OR ON THE AMENITIES OF LOCAL RESIDENTS AND/OR THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES, OR WOULD HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON WATER COURSES AND WETLANDS AND THEIR MARGINS, COASTAL WATERS, THE AQUIFER OR THE WATER SUPPLY SYSTEM, OR WOULD SIGNIFICANTLY AFFECT AIR QUALITY, OR WOULD UNNECESSARILY CONSTRAIN THE DEVELOPMENT OF NEIGHBOURING LAND. ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT 3.21 European Union Directive No 85/337 requires that projects which are likely to have significant effects on the environment by virtue of their nature, size or location shall be subject to an assessment of those effects. The Town and Country Planning (Environmental Impact Assessment) (England & Wales) Regulations 1999 implement these requirements on the assessment of the effects of some projects on the environment. 3.22 Certain types of developments (listed in Schedule 1 of the above regulations) including oil refineries, thermal power stations, steel works, integrated chemical installations and special roads require environmental assessment in every case. Other projects (listed in schedule 2 of the regulations) will require environmental assessment if they are likely to have significant effects on the environment, or are located in and around environmentally sensitive areas such as internationally or nationally designated nature conservation sites (see Appendix 4). The regulations list aspects of the environment which might be significantly affected by a project including population, fauna, flora; soil; water; air; climate; archaeological and architectural heritage, the landscape and the inter relationship between these factors. Consideration may also need to be given to the use of natural resources, the emission of pollutants, the creation of nuisance and the elimination of waste. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 19 Broad thresholds are identified in the regulations to give guidance on the requirements to undertake an Environmental Impact Assessment. POLICY GEP5 ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT OF PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT WILL BE REQUIRED WHERE DEVELOPMENT COMPRISES A SCHEDULE 1 PROJECT LISTED IN THE APPROPRIATE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT) (ENGLAND AND WALES) REGULATIONS. ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT WILL ALSO BE REQUIRED FOR SCHEDULE 2 PROJECTS WHERE THE DEVELOPMENT IS LIKELY TO HAVE A SIGNIFICANT EFFECT ON THE ENVIRONMENT BY VIRTUE OF ITS CHARACTER, ITS LOCATION AND ITS POTENTIAL IMPACT. IN ADDITION, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL MAY REQUIRE ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT WHERE THE PROPOSAL: i. ii. iii. iv. AN IS IN OR CLOSE TO AN INTERNATIONALLY OR NATIONALLY PROTECTED NATURE CONSERVATION SITE, OR MAY HAVE SIGNIFICANT EFFECTS ON CONCENTRATIONS OF POPULATION, OR GIVES RISE TO POTENTIALLY HAZARDOUS EMISSIONS OR DISCHARGES INTO THE RIVER SYSTEM, OR IS A MAJOR DEVELOPMENT OF MORE THAN LOCAL IMPORTANCE. ENERGY EFFICIENCY 3.23 POLICY GEP6 The careful use of design and materials in new development can increase energy efficiency thereby helping to reduce the amount of greenhouse gases such as carbon dioxide emitted into the atmosphere. The 1991 Building Regulations set standards of energy conservation in new buildings although some forms of development such as conversions are exempt. Where planning permission is required, the Borough Council will take into account opportunities to maximise energy efficiency. These may include design and layout of buildings and innovative methods of surface drainage. ENERGY EFFICIENCY DEVELOPERS SHOULD SEEK TO INCORPORATE ENERGY EFFICIENCY PRINCIPLES IN THE SITING, FORM, ORIENTATION AND LAYOUT OF BUILDINGS, IN ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURFACE DRAINAGE AND IN THE USE OF LANDSCAPING. DESIGN ALONG MAIN APPROACHES 3.24 20 The Borough Council seeks to ensure that, wherever possible, a quality urban design is achieved in the appearance of any proposed development and its relationship with its surroundings. Whilst the general principles of good design are embodied in Policy GEP1 above, there are circumstances where a particular standard of design is essential such as in Conservation Areas (see policy HE1), in the vicinity of Listed Buildings (policies HE8 and HE10), and along main approaches to the town. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 3.25 POLICY GEP7 It is important that a good first impression is given to potential investors and tourists and other visitors travelling along the main roads and the railway. As a consequence landscaping improvements have been carried out over recent years along the main approaches to the town and policy GN4 proposes a continuation of such schemes. It is important that this initiative is complemented by ensuring that careful attention is paid to the design of buildings and the provision of appropriate landscaping in developments adjacent to both major roads and the railway. FRONTAGES OF MAIN APPROACHES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL, WHEN CONSIDERING DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS ADJOINING THE MAJOR CORRIDORS LISTED BELOW, WILL REQUIRE THAT A PARTICULARLY HIGH STANDARD OF DESIGN, LANDSCAPING AND WOODLAND PLANTING ARE PROVIDED WHICH WILL IMPROVE THE VISUAL ENVIRONMENT ALONG: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ A1086 EASINGTON ROAD, A179 WEST VIEW ROAD / EASINGTON ROAD / POWLETT ROAD / MARINA WAY, A1048/1049 HEADLAND APPROACH, A178 CHURCH STREET / MAINSFORTH TERRACE / CORONATION DRIVE / TEES ROAD, A689 MARINA GATEWAY / STOCKTON STREET / STRANTON, BELLE VUE WAY / STOCKTON ROAD, B1277 BRENDA ROAD, B1276 SEATON LANE / STATION LANE, HART LANE, AND THE MIDDLESBROUGH - NEWCASTLE RAILWAY LINE. ADVERTISEMENTS 3.26 Advertisements and other large signs have long been a feature of the urban environment. In appropriate circumstances a hoarding can serve the function of screening unused or untidy land or premises, and to form the background to an attractive landscaped seating area. However some can be detrimental to the general surroundings, and can be visually obtrusive along main roads, within Conservation Areas, on or adjacent to Listed Buildings, in the open countryside, and in residential areas (see paragraph 80 of Supplementary Note 5 relating to advertisements within Conservation Areas). 3.27 In those areas which the Borough Council considers merit protection on amenity grounds, orders may be made defining them as Areas of Special Control wherein certain rights to display advertisements are withdrawn. The Council will keep under review the need for such orders. POLICY GEP8 ADVERTISEMENTS PROPOSALS FOR ADVERTISEMENTS WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE THEY DO NOT DETRACT FROM THE AMENITY OF THE AREA OR DO NOT REDUCE HIGHWAY SAFETY. ADVERTISEMENTS WHICH INTRODUCE FEATURES WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 VISUALLY OBTRUSIVE 21 DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS 3.28 A developer contribution is a mechanism which can enhance the quality of the development and enable proposals which in the absence of the policy may be refused planning permission. Government guidance requires the contribution to be fair, open and reasonable in order to enable development to go ahead (see Supplementary Note 8). 3.29 In certain circumstances specific policies in the local plan (including policies Rec2, Rec3, To4, Hsg5, Hsg9 and Tra19) require developers to provide additional works and facilities deemed necessary by the Borough Council as a direct result of a development. Highway works, including cycleways and pedestrian links, may be required off site as a direct result of increased traffic generated by a development. Where open space and landscaping are required on site the future maintenance of the land may, if appropriate, become the responsibility of the Borough Council. Contributions from the developers towards such ongoing maintenance costs will need to be secured through negotiation with the developer and set out by legal agreement. 3.30 Where it is not appropriate for a developer to provide areas for open space, play equipment, sporting or recreational facilities within a development site, the developer will be required to make a financial contribution to provide it elsewhere within the surrounding area. 3.31 Where planning permission is granted for late night uses or hot food takeaways the Borough Council may seek contributions from the developers to mitigate such effects on security or litter (sees policies Com12 and Rec13). 3.32 In order to ensure that the imbalance between housing supply and demand is tackled it will be necessary to relate new housing development to the level of clearance of surplus housing. Housing developers may be required to contribute towards acquisition, demolitions and improvements in the Housing Market Renewal Area being carried out under policy Hsg3. 3.33 In view of the limited capacity for new retail development generally within the Borough there may be scope to negotiate the relocation of existing less accessible shopping facilities to enable approval for the development of new shopping on more sustainable sites served by transport other than the private car (see Paragraph 5.46a). 3.34 General guidance on the provision of facilities or works and an indication of the level of contributions likely to be sought by the Borough Council are set out in Supplementary Note 8. 3.35 A Supplementary Planning Document will be prepared as part of the Local Development Framework during 2006/2007 . The document will set out guidance and standards on the use of developer contributions (commuted sums) through planning agreements including the circumstances when an agreement will be sought and its basis. 22 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY GEP9 DEVELOPERS’ CONTRIBUTIONS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK CONTRIBUTIONS FROM DEVELOPERS FOR THE PROVISION OF ADDITIONAL WORKS DEEMED TO BE REQUIRED AS A RESULT OF THE DEVELOPMENT. CONTRIBUTIONS MAY BE REQUIRED FOR: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ HIGHWAY AND INFRASTRUCTURE WORKS, IMPROVEMENTS TO PUBLIC TRANSPORT AND THE PEDESTRIAN AND CYCLEWAY NETWORK (SEE POLICY Tra19), THE LAYOUT AND MAINTENANCE OF LANDSCAPING AND WOODLAND PLANTING, THE LAYOUT AND MAINTENANCE OF OPEN SPACE AND PLAY FACILITIES (SEE POLICY Rec2), THE PROVISION OF NEIGHBOURHOOD PARKS (SEE POLICY Rec3), WORKS TO ENHANCE NATURE CONSERVATION FEATURES, ADDITIONAL MEASURES FOR STREET CLEANSING AND CRIME PREVENTION (SEE POLICIES Com12 and Rec13), THE ACQUISITION AND DEMOLITION OF SURPLUS HOUSING STOCK AND HOUSING IMPROVEMENTS IN LOW DEMAND HOUSING AREAS (SEE POLICIES Hsg6 AND Hsg5), THE RATIONALISATION OF RETAIL FACILITIES, AND ANY OTHER COMMUNITY FACILITITIES DEEMED NECESSARY BY THE LOCAL AUTHORITY AS A RESULT OF THE DEVELOPMENT. CONTRIBUTIONS MAY NECESSITATE DEVELOPERS ENTERING INTO LEGAL AGREEMENTS WITH THE BOROUGH COUNCIL (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 23 ART IN DEVELOPMENT SCHEMES 3.36 The Borough Council wishes to encourage the provision of art and craft through both the public and the private sector. Developers, in particular, will be encouraged to introduce good quality art and craftwork within large development sites and for this to be included in the initial design stage. 3.37 The North Hartlepool Partnership has prepared an environmental and arts strategy which seeks to establish a programme of arts features interpreting the Headland’s history. POLICY GEP10 PROVISION OF PUBLIC ART THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE THE PROVISION OF PUBLIC ART AND CRAFTWORK AS AN INTEGRAL FEATURE OF NEW DEVELOPMENT. ARTICLE 4 DIRECTIONS 3.38 POLICY GEP11 The Borough Council seeks to protect certain locations, such as Conservation Areas and other particularly sensitive sites from potentially unsympathetic development such as replacement windows, re-roofing, and boundary walls which are generally permitted development without the need for planning permission. Such protection can be given by making a Direction under Article 4 of the Town and Country Planning (General Permitted Development) Order 1995. This makes planning permission necessary for a wide range of works, such as those referred to above. There are presently such Article 4 Directions covering parts of Elwick, Greatham, the Headland and the Grange Conservation Area. ARTICLE 4 DIRECTIONS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL MAY, IN EXCEPTIONAL CIRCUMSTANCES, SEEK TO WITHDRAW PERMITTED DEVELOPMENT RIGHTS UNDER ARTICLE 4 OF THE TOWN & COUNTRY PLANNING (GENERAL PERMITTED DEVELOPMENT) ORDER (1995) (OR RELEVANT SUBSEQUENT LEGISLATION) WHERE IT CONSIDERS THAT THERE IS A THREAT TO LOCAL AMENITY AND FURTHER PROTECTION OF THE CHARACTER OF AN AREA IS REQUIRED. TREES, HEDGEROWS AND DEVELOPMENT 3.39 The local planning authority has a duty under Section 197 of the Town & Country Planning Act 1990 to ensure, whenever it is appropriate, that in granting planning permission for development, adequate provision is made for the preservation and planting of trees and to the making of Tree Preservation Orders as necessary. Controls on hedgerows in the countryside were introduced by the Hedgerows Regulations 1997 which require that planning permission is required for the removal of most types of countryside hedgerows. 3.40 The tree cover in Hartlepool is sparse, particularly within the urban area. As a consequence, those trees and groups of trees which do exist take on a particular 24 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 importance in the urban landscape, and should therefore, where practicable, be retained within development proposals. 3.41 In determining planning applications (or tree works or hedgerow applications) consideration will be given to the effect of the proposed development on any existing trees (or hedgerows), either on site or on adjacent sites, which do, or which when mature will, contribute significantly to any of the following: • visual amenity, • the setting of existing or proposed buildings, • the setting of a Listed Building, and • wildlife habitat. 3.42 Where trees are affected by development proposals, developers will, where appropriate, be required to submit landscaping schemes (see policy GEP1) including tree surveys to demonstrate how trees can be accommodated and sustained during and following construction. 3.43 Further advice and guidance is provided within Supplementary Note 3: Trees and Development Guidelines. POLICY GEP12 TREES, HEDGEROWS AND DEVELOPMENT THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK WITHIN DEVELOPMENT SITES, THE RETENTION OF EXISTING, AND THE PLANTING OF ADDITIONAL, TREES AND HEDGEROWS. WHERE TREES AND HEDGEROWS ON A SITE, OR ON AN ADJACENT SITE, ARE OF A SIGNIFICANT QUALITY IN TERMS OF SPECIES OR VISUAL AMENITY, PLANNING PERMISSION FOR DEVELOPMENT MAY BE REFUSED IF THE LOSS OR DAMAGE OF THOSE TREES WOULD HAVE A SIGNIFICANT IMPACT ON THE LOCAL ENVIRONMENT AND ITS ENJOYMENT BY THE PUBLIC. THIS WOULD BE PARTICULARLY THE CASE WHERE THERE ARE TREES PROTECTED BY A TREE PRESERVATION ORDER, OR HEDGEROWS PROTECTED BY THE 1997 HEDGEROW REGULATIONS, OR WHERE THEY CONTRIBUTE TO THE CHARACTER AND APPEARANCE OF A CONSERVATION AREA. IN CONSIDERING PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT OF SITES WHERE THERE ARE EXISTING TREES WORTHY OF PROTECTION WITHIN THE SITE OR ON ADJACENT SITES, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL HAVE REGARD TO THE NEED TO MAKE ADDITIONAL TREE PRESERVATION ORDERS. WHERE TREES AND HEDGEROWS WHICH CONTRIBUTE TO THE STREET SCENE ARE LOST THROUGH DEVELOPMENT, THEIR REPLACEMENT USING TREES AND HEDGEROWS OF AN APPROPRIATE SCALE AND SPECIES TO THE AREA WILL, WHERE PRACTICAL, BE REQUIRED AS A CONDITION OF PLANNING APPROVAL. PLANNING CONDITIONS WILL BE IMPOSED TO ENSURE THAT TREES AND HEDGEROWS TO BE RETAINED ON A DEVELOPMENT SITE OR WHICH COULD BE AFFECTED ON AN ADJACENT SITE WILL BE ADEQUATELY PROTECTED FROM DAMAGE DURING CONSTRUCTION. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL HAVE REGARD TO ITS POWERS OF PROSECUTION WHERE DAMAGE OR DESTRUCTION OF TREES WHICH ARE SUBJECT TO TREE PRESERVATION ORDERS OR PLANNING CONDITIONS HAS TAKEN PLACE. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 25 Protected Trees 3.44 As at March 2006, 176 Tree Preservation Orders had been made, covering individual trees and groups of trees together with larger areas of woodland. The purpose of such orders is to protect trees from felling, damage or unsympathetic tree works (pruning etc.) because of their particular amenity value. Such orders would not preclude the felling of trees which are dead, dying, diseased or dangerous. Permission can also be sought for undertaking of pruning works or the felling of healthy trees but such permission would normally only be granted where damage is proved to be caused to adjacent buildings. Further advice and guidance on the law and how to make Tree Works Applications is provided within Supplementary Note 3: Trees and Development Guidelines. 3.45 Trees are of key importance in most of the Conservation Areas where they provide a well-developed form to the quality of the area. Conservation Area designation empowers the local authority to control felling and other works to trees by the requirement to give notice to the Borough Council for works to any tree within a Conservation Area. This enables the Council to impose a Tree Preservation Order if thought necessary. The Council considers that proposals involving the removal of trees will only be permitted in exceptional circumstances and they should be replaced with suitable mature specimens such as heavy standard nursery stock or semi-mature trees. (For more general control on the trees and measures to protect and enhance woodland areas see policy GEP12). POLICY GEP13 WORKS TO PROTECTED TREES PERMISSION FOR THE FELLING OF ANY TREE INCLUDED IN A TREE PRESERVATION ORDER OR LOCATED WITHIN A CONSERVATION AREA WILL NOT BE GRANTED UNLESS: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. THE REMOVAL FORMS PART OF AN APPROVED DEVELOPMENT SCHEME, OR THE TREE OR TREES ARE PROVEN TO BE ADVERSELY AFFECTING THE STRUCTURAL CONDITION OR SAFETY OF BUILDINGS, OR THE TREES REPRESENT AN UNACCEPTABLE RISK TO THE SAFETY OF THE PUBLIC, OR IT IS IN THE INTEREST OF THE HEALTH OF THE TREE OR OTHER NEARBY TREES, OR THE FELLING IS REQUIRED AS PART OF AN AGREED MANAGEMENT SCHEME IN THE INTEREST OF AGE, STRUCTURE OR DIVERSITY, OR THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT IMPACT ON THE LOCAL ENVIRONMENT AND ITS ENJOYMENT BY THE PUBLIC. PERMISSION FOR TREE SURGERY WORKS TO PROTECTED TREES WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE: ♦ ♦ ♦ THE TREE IS A DANGER TO HUMAN LIFE, THE TREE IS CAUSING DAMAGE TO PROPERTY, OR IT IS IN THE INTERESTS OF THE WELL-BEING OF THE TREE. WHERE PERMISSION IS GIVEN TO FELL REPLACEMENT PLANTING WILL BE REQUIRED. 26 PROTECTED TREES, HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 3.46 POLICY GEP14 In addition to having regard to the need to make Tree Preservation Orders when considering planning applications, further areas of trees to be covered by new Preservation Orders will continually be assessed by the Borough Council as resources become available, and where there is a perceived risk to trees from future development. A standard survey procedure will be used to assess the quality and importance of trees within the Borough. REVIEW OF TREE PRESERVATION ORDERS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL KEEP UNDER REVIEW TREE PRESERVATION ORDERS TO ENSURE THAT THEY ARE ACCURATE AND LEGALLY VALID AND WILL MAKE FURTHER TREE PRESERVATION ORDERS. Trees on Highway Verges and Public Open Space 3.47 Over the years there has been substantial planting of trees on the frontage of strategic roads, such as the A689 approach to the town. At the same time there has been a loss of trees through disease and development, so it is important to ensure that those trees lost are, as far as possible, replaced with species appropriate to the area. 3.48 The Highways Act 1980 empowers the highway authority to plant and maintain trees on highway land and to ensure that privately owned trees do not cause a danger or nuisance to the use of the highway. The Council will therefore look to resource, maintain and replant highway trees particularly those on the frontages of main approach roads (see policy GN4). It will also look to resource the production of a strategy for planting, inspection, protection, management and maintenance of trees on the adopted highway, public open space and adjacent sites. 3.49 The Borough Council will use its powers under the Highways Act 1980 and the Local Government Miscellaneous Provisions Act 1976 to ensure the safety of the public with regard to dead, dying or dangerous trees on private property next to the adopted highway or public open space. COMPULSORY PURCHASE Potential Development Sites 3.50 POLICY GEP15 In certain circumstances the release of development land may have been held back by a landowner’s unwillingness to bring forward realistic development proposals. This may be detrimental to the economic growth of the town and may cause large unsightly vacant or derelict land to become an eyesore. Where, in the opinion of the Borough Council, it is necessary to achieve the proper planning of the area, the compulsory purchase of the land may be pursued. COMPULSORY PURCHASE OF POTENTIAL DEVELOPMENT SITES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL, IN ORDER TO ACHIEVE THE PROPER PLANNING OF AN AREA, WILL SEEK TO ACQUIRE SITES BY COMPULSORY PURCHASE IN THE INTERESTS OF IMPROVING THE LOCAL ECONOMY OR THE GENERAL ENVIRONMENT. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 27 Untidy Sites 3.51 POLICY GEP16 The Council has power under Section 215 of the Town & Country Planning Act 1990 to serve notice requiring steps to be taken to clean up land where the amenity of an area is affected In some areas, untidy or inappropriate operations and the unsatisfactory state of unused land may affect the surrounding environment to such a scale as to warrant the removal of certain activities altogether. The Council may, where finance is available, consider acquiring important untidy sites. It will also assist, where possible, the relocation of certain local firms considered to be bad neighbour uses, to alternative sites which are not visually prominent and which can be well screened from neighbouring uses and major roads (see policy Ind6). UNTIDY SITES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO ACQUIRE UNTIDY SITES AT PROMINENT LOCATIONS, WHETHER OPERATIONAL OR UNUSED, WHERE NECESSARY BY COMPULSORY PURCHASE, IN ORDER TO IMPROVE THE LOCAL ENVIRONMENT. DERELICT LAND 3.52 POLICY GEP17 Whilst considerable areas of derelict land have already been cleared and await redevelopment, there remain sites which still need treatment. Initial investigation works are being carried out at the former anhydrite mine at Central Park to ascertain what further information is needed on the extent of the workings and their stability and whether reclamation will be economically feasible. In due course other areas of land may become derelict and may need further work to bring them back into an appropriate use. The Borough Council will keep under review those areas of land which would benefit from clearance and redevelopment or landscaping and will seek funding for such work from appropriate sources. DERELICT LAND RECLAMATION THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL, SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY OF FINANCE, PURSUE THE RECLAMATION AND RE-USE OF DERELICT AND DISUSED LAND, INCLUDING THE AREA OF WORKING OF THE FORMER ANHYDRITE MINE AT CENTRAL PARK. RECLAMATION SCHEMES WILL INCLUDE LANDSCAPING AND TREE PLANTING AND SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF OPEN SPACE AND RECREATIONAL USES. ACCOUNT WILL BE TAKEN OF THE NATURE CONSERVATION VALUE OF SITES. CONTAMINATED LAND 3.53 28 Land contamination can be present on sites arising from previous uses long since abandoned. In some cases the storage or dumping of materials on a site can be a source of contamination. It is necessary for developers to establish at an early stage the nature and extent of any contamination likely on a particular site. The aim is to ensure that contamination is removed or reduced to a level which is not likely to cause significant harm, nor to cause pollution of controlled waters. Where HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 works, such as the removal off site of material, are to be carried out to secure remediation, these must not significantly increase the potential risk to the public. POLICY GEP18 DEVELOPMENT ON CONTAMINATED LAND PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT ON SITES WHICH ARE POTENTIALLY CONTAMINATED WILL BE ENCOURAGED WHERE THEY COMPLY WITH OTHER POLICIES IN THE PLAN AND WHERE: i. ii. iii. THE EXTENT OF THE CONTAMINATION HAS BEEN VERIFIED, REMEDIAL MEASURES APPROPRIATE TO THE PROPOSED AFTER USE HAVE BEEN IDENTIFIED, AND THE LAND DURING AND AFTER DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT POSE A SIGNIFICANT RISK TO OCCUPIERS OF ADJACENT PROPERTIES NOR RESULT IN A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE ENVIRONMENT GENERALLY. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 29 30 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 4 INDUSTRIAL AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 4.1 Hartlepool Borough Council is committed to supporting the development of the Hartlepool economy so that sustainable opportunities can be created for all the people of the town. Comprehensive regeneration initiatives in partnership with others aim to address the considerable needs of the town, realise development and other opportunities and create a sustainable community in Hartlepool. 4.2 The emphasis of the town’s economy is shifting towards services and visitors, although manufacturing still has a very important role to play. The lack of opportunity created by unemployment, and the wastage of skill and talents, remains the key issue facing the town. Unemployment is unsustainable and the local plan will provide the land-use context to help deal with the continued high unemployment in the town and this and the following two chapters cover various aspects of the economy including industrial, small business and office development, together with shopping and tourism. Industry and small business uses in the countryside are considered in Chapter 15 on The Rural Area. Unemployment 4.3 There were about 2,461 unemployed people in Hartlepool in March 2006 which represents an unemployment rate of 4.6%. This compared to a regional rate of 3.3% and a national figure of 2.7%. Hartlepool travel-to-work area, which covers the same area as the Borough, had the third highest unemployment rate in England having fallen from its previous position of worst. About 14.1% of the unemployed in Hartlepool had been without a job for over a year. Almost 32.5% were under 25 years of age and 17.3% over 50 years. Employment Structure 4.4 The main reason for the high unemployment in Hartlepool has been the area’s reliance on jobs in heavy manufacturing industries and on large firms that have subsequently closed. Manufacturing, which can be more vulnerable than other forms of employment to economic fluctuations, is still very important in the Hartlepool economy and needs to be encouraged. In 2004 manufacturing provided about 16% of all jobs compared to 12% nationally. By contrast only 76% of jobs in Hartlepool were in the service sector compared to about 82% nationally. Industrial Land Availability 4.5 The 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan made provision for almost 420 hectares of industrial land comprising: • • • • • • about 57 hectares at Wynyard Business Park, 59 hectares for prestige and high quality developments on sites within Hartlepool, 13 hectares at the Marina as part of a mixed use development, 154 hectares for other general industrial development, 56 hectares for port and port-related development, and 80 hectares for ‘special’ industry. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 31 4.6 Since then, planning approval has been given to a further 93 hectares at Wynyard comprising a small extension of the developable area of the business park together with a new site at North Burn for an electronic components park. This latter permission extended into the adjoining Stockton Borough where the first phase of the Samsung development has been constructed. In addition approval has been given to a small extension of the Sovereign Park high quality site in Brenda Road. 4.7 About 160 hectares of land have however been taken up or lost to development since 1994, although some of this comprised land which had been vacated since that date 1 . There is therefore still about 370 hectares of land potentially available for industrial and business development in the Borough, which is either identified in the 1994 Local Plan or has planning permission. However, only about 235 hectares of this land is located within the main urban area of Hartlepool, the remaining 135 hectares being at Wynyard. 4.8 The 235 hectares within the urban area of Hartlepool includes land for potentially polluting and hazardous industries (64 hectares) and land identified for port and portrelated uses (about 26 hectares). Only relatively small sites remain on some of the established industrial sites such as Oakesway, Park View West and Hunter House, the bulk of the remaining undeveloped land being on the three high quality sites at Queens Meadow, Sovereign Park and Golden Flatts. 4.9 Consideration has been given to the potential for re-allocating some of the industrial land identified in the 1994 Local Plan. The Borough Council is, however, concerned to ‘support and develop a vigorous and diverse local economy and to get Hartlepool people into jobs’ 2 and to reduce the jobs gap. In this respect it considers that there should be an appropriate allocation of land to provide a range of size, type, quality and location of sites to meet the needs of potential investors including developers moving into the area, and to enable the expansion of local businesses. 4.10 It is not, therefore, proposed to de-allocate any existing industrial sites except the site to the south of the Tees Bay Retail Park where industrial development has not proved viable primarily because of its ground conditions. The Issues Report did refer to the potential for a 4 hectare site to the south of Seaton Lane being reallocated, perhaps for housing purposes. However, there are concerns that existing industrial development in the area may be prejudiced by new housing on this site, and there is adequate housing land already available, particularly for low to medium cost housing. The site is therefore retained for industrial purposes. Change to Industrial Use Classification 4.11 Since the 1994 Local Plan was adopted, there have been changes to the Use Classes Order (see Appendix 1) and uses previously classified as ‘special industries’ (former use classes B4 to B7) have been included in use class B2 ‘general industry’. This means that it is possible for existing ‘general’ industrial premises to be occupied, without the need for planning permission, by developments falling within the former ‘special’ category or by other industrial processes which may give rise to amenity concerns in nearby residential areas or be significantly detrimental to the functioning of adjoining industries. 4.12 Sites which may be appropriate for general industrial uses as now defined are included in policy Ind5 below, but in some instances, it may be necessary to restrict planning permission to appropriate uses within the B2 classification in order to 1 This excludes land which has been developed in the Marina. 2 Mission Statement from Hartlepool Economic Development Strategy (1999/2000). 32 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 safeguard the amenity of the surrounding area. Those general industries, which may have a significant detrimental effect on the surrounding area, should be located on the sites identified in policy Ind9 below for potentially polluting or hazardous developments. Regional Planning Guidance 4.13 The Regional Planning Guidance for the North East (RPG1, published 2002) identifies Hartlepool as a regeneration area. It states that development plans should seek to improve the economic viability of previously used land to make it more attractive to developers and reduce the need for greenfield sites. A rigorous assessment of employment land should be undertaken to ensure that all current employment land meet the sequential approach and sustainability criteria. 4.14 The guidance further states that sites adjacent to ports and deep-water passages should be protected where they have potential for port-related purposes. Where there are internationally or nationally important sites for conservation adjoining, proposals for port development and expansion should take into account the need to protect these areas. In addition planning authorities should recognise the job creating potential of rail-based development sites and encourage their use by industries which are best placed to take advantage of the facilities available. Regional Economic Strategy 4.15 The Regional Economic Strategy for the North East ‘Realising our Potential’ (2002) sets out a vision which will harness and enhance the human, cultural and environmental resources of the region so that by 2010 the North East is vibrant, self reliant, ambitious and outward looking. The strategy recognises the region’s important role as part of Europe and seeks to create wealth in the region by raising productivity and establishing a new entrepreneurial culture . It seeks increased investment to educate train and develop new fields of knowledge and to improve transport and communications. Through a renaissance of urban and rural communities a more sustainable region will be ensured. Regional Spatial Strategy 4.16 The emerging Regional Spatial Strategy (RSS) seeks to strengthen the regional economy by continuing to encourage the focus of economic activity within and around the conurbations and main towns to maximise economic growth and regeneration potential. Policy 13 (Regional Brownfield mixed use developments) states that strategies, plans and programmes should continue to support and promote the Victoria Harbour mixed use regeneration project. The Local Development Framework (LDF) will make provision for the above regional Brownfield mixed use development. Policy 18 (Employment Land Portfolio) sets out the appropriate allocation of General Employment Land and Regional Brownfield Mixed Use, Prestige Employment sites for Hartlepool. Local Plan policies integrate and build on these emerging RSS policies. Structure Plan Policies 4.17 The Tees Valley Structure Plan requires that provision be made for about 380 hectares of land for employment purposes in Hartlepool (policy EMP5). About 210 hectares of this land (at Wynyard, and Queens Meadow) is for business parks or other prestige employment development (policy EMP6). In addition about 70 hectares of land in South Hartlepool should be provided for potentially polluting or HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 33 hazardous industrial development (policy EMP10). Policy EMP8 requires that priority be given to port related industrial development at Hartlepool Docks and North of Seaton Channel where there is direct waterside access. 4.18 The structure plan also states that priority will be given to the revitalisation of existing industrial estates and older industrial areas (policy EMP1). Priority will also be given to the development of business and industrial premises on brownfield sites which are capable of being well served by public transport and have good links with footpath and cycleway networks (policy EMP2). Local Plan Objectives 4.19 34 In line with the overall aim of the plan to continue to regenerate Hartlepool securing a better future for its people to meet economic, environmental and social needs in a sustainable manner, the following objectives are particularly relevant in drawing up the policies and general proposals relating to industrial and small business development: A1 to encourage the provision of more and higher quality job opportunities A2 to ensure that sites are available for the full range of industrial and commercial activities so as to enable the diversification of employment opportunities A3 to encourage the development of additional office, small business and light industrial uses A6 to improve the viability and environment of older housing, commercial and industrial areas A7 to promote development on previously used sites where appropriate, and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings C1 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool C3 to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest C4 to encourage a high standard of design and the provision of high quality environment in all developments and particularly those on prominent sites, along main road and rail corridors, and along the coast C6 to protect as far as possible existing open space, and to encourage further landscaping and tree planting where appropriate C9 to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources C10 to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings C11 to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting and hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a significant damaging effect on the environment D2 to promote developments in locations which support existing transport infrastructure, which minimise the need to travel, and which are accessible by all modes of transport D4 to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS LAND FOR HIGH QUALITY INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT 4.20 The Hartlepool Community Strategy seeks to encourage the development of flagship industrial developments including Queens Meadow Business Park and Wynyard. 4.21 Land at Wynyard is of regional significance for economic development. It is identified in the regional planning guidance as a ‘premier division’ strategic site where there are plots of land which can accommodate development requiring over 40 hectares of land. About 135 hectares of land is available in the Wynyard area comprising about 65 hectares at Wynyard business park and a further 70 hectares for an electronics components park at North Burn (Samsung site). 4.22 It is recognised that the development of such greenfield sites in the open countryside may give rise to negative impacts on the environment and could affect the efficiency of town centres and the compact urban form of development. However Wynyard and the North Burn area offer particularly high economic benefits to the region. They give rise to opportunities to encourage efficient transport infrastructure not dependent on the private car thereby strengthening principles of sustainability (see paragraph 20.8 - Environmental Appraisal of the Local Plan) 4.23 Wynyard and North Burn are located some 5 to 7 kilometres from the nearest housing areas of Hartlepool (although residential areas in Stockton Borough are closer) and therefore their development could lead to unsustainable travel patterns. The outline planning permissions for these sites contain conditions providing for the parking, safe setting down and picking up of passengers by public transport (including taxis and buses) and for the safe access within the sites for cyclists and for the satisfactory accommodation of cycles. Travel plans aimed at delivering sustainable transport objectives should be submitted with applications for large scale developments on these sites. Large scale developments are defined as B1 light industrial and office uses over 2,500 square metres gross floorspace, B2 industrial uses over 5,000 square metres gross floorspace, and B8 distribution and warehousing uses over 10,000 square metres gross floorspace. Development proposals may also need to demonstrate the impact on the A19 Trunk Road in accordance with the Highway Agency’s requirements. 4.24 Whilst the outline planning permissions for the development of these sites allows for the development of some B2 (general industry) uses, there is a need to ensure that these will not detrimentally affect the overall quality of the sites nor give rise to problems to neighbouring businesses or to the employees in the area. Such uses will therefore be subject to individual control. 4.25 Both the Wynyard Business Park and the North Burn site are remote from essential services such as banks, restaurants etc. and thus it may be appropriate to allow such uses where they specifically serve the business developments on the sites. In order to encourage principles of sustainability, facilities normally found in town centres should not be provided where they would principally serve the wider general public travelling into the site. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 35 POLICY Ind1 WYNYARD BUSINESS PARK LAND AT WYNYARD PARK, AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, IS RESERVED FOR DEVELOPMENT AS A BUSINESS PARK. PROPOSALS FOR BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT (FALLING WITHIN CLASS B1 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL BE PERMITTED IN THE WYNYARD BUSINESS PARK PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE IMPACT UPON AREAS OF NATURAL OR HISTORICAL INTEREST, HIGH QUALITY LANDSCAPING AND/OR WOODLAND PLANTING ARE PROVIDED AS APPROPRIATE TO THE SURROUNDING NATURAL ENVIRONMENT, THE BUILDINGS ARE PROVIDED WITH A HIGH QUALITY FINISH, THERE IS NO MORE THAN A 25% COVERAGE OF EACH PLOT BY BUILDINGS, CAR PARKING AREAS ARE LANDSCAPED, AND ANY OUTSIDE STORAGE IS WELL SITED AND SCREENED. PROPOSALS FOR GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT AND WAREHOUSING (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES B2 AND B8 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) MAY ALSO BE ALLOWED WHERE THEY MEET THE ABOVE CRITERIA AND PROVIDED THEY DO NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES OR PREJUDICE THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADJACENT SITES. IN THIS RESPECT, PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE IMPOSED TO RESTRICT GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS TO APPROPRIATE OPERATIONS WITHIN THE B2 USE CLASS. PROPOSALS FOR TOWN CENTRE USES SUCH AS BANKS OR FOOD ESTABLISHMENTS (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A2 AND A3 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL NOT BE APPROVED UNLESS IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THEY ARE PRIMARILY PROVIDING SUPPORT FACILITIES FOR PEOPLE WORKING IN THE BUSINESS PARK. TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). CONDITIONS WILL BE IMPOSED AND LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS SOUGHT TO SECURE OR CREATE AND MAINTAIN FEATURES OF NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST AND FOR LANDSCAPING AND WOODLAND PLANTING THE AMOUNT OF AVAILABLE LAND IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. 36 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Ind2 NORTH BURN ELECTRONICS COMPONENTS PARK LAND AT NORTH BURN COMPONENTS PARK. IS RESERVED AS AN ELECTRONICS PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENTS ASSOCIATED WITH THE ELECTRONICS INDUSTRY FALLING WITHIN CLASSES B1 (BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT), B2 (GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT) AND B8 (DISTRIBUTION AND WAREHOUSING) OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL BE PERMITTED PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. vii. viii. THEY DO NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES OR PREJUDICE THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADJACENT SITES. IN THIS RESPECT, PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE IMPOSED TO RESTRICT GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS TO APPROPRIATE OPERATIONS WITHIN THE B2 USE CLASS, THERE IS NO ADVERSE IMPACT UPON AREAS OF NATURAL OR HISTORICAL INTEREST OR THEIR SETTING, INCLUDING THE HIGH BURNTOFT SCHEDULED ANCIENT MONUMENT AND THE NORTH BURN VALLEY WHICH LIES WITHIN THE AREA, HIGH QUALITY LANDSCAPING AND WOODLAND PLANTING APPROPRIATE TO THE SURROUNDING NATURAL ENVIRONMENT ARE PROVIDED, PARTICULARLY ALONG THE MAIN ROAD FRONTAGES, THE BUILDINGS ARE PROVIDED WITH A HIGH QUALITY FINISH, THERE IS NO MORE THAN 30% COVERAGE OF EACH PLOT BY BUILDINGS, AND CAR PARKING AREAS ARE LANDSCAPED, ANY OUTSIDE STORAGE IS WELL SITED AND SCREENED, ADEQUATE HIGHWAY ACCESS IS PROVIDED (SEE POLICY Tra11). PROPOSALS FOR TOWN CENTRE USES SUCH AS BANKS OR FOOD ESTABLISHMENTS (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A2 AND A3 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL NOT BE APPROVED UNLESS IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THEY ARE PRIMARILY PROVIDING SUPPORT FACILITIES FOR PEOPLE WORKING IN THE BUSINESS PARK. TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICIES Tra20 AND Rur18). THE AMOUNT OF AVAILABLE LAND IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. 4.26 In the 1994 Local Plan, the high quality Queens Meadow site referred to in policies Ec2 and Ec3 comprised only the frontage area of the available land within and adjoining the Corus (former British Steel) South Works site. The Queens Meadow HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 37 designation in this plan is larger (about 65 hectares) and incorporates the area previously known as the ‘East Greatham’ industrial site. The larger area of Queens Meadow is identified as a strategic site in the English Partnership report ‘Locations for Strategic Economic Development in the North East’. 4.27 38 The Queens Meadow site is located adjacent to the A689 within the limit to development of Hartlepool. It is currently being comprehensively developed as a business, science and light industrial park, although some types of general industry may be appropriate in those parts of the site closest to the Corus operations provided they do not harm the overall amenity and quality of the site. This site is considered to be particularly important for the economic diversification of the town, and its proximity to some of the more disadvantaged areas of Hartlepool makes it an attractive location for the local workforce. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Ind3 QUEENS MEADOW BUSINESS PARK LAND AT QUEENS MEADOW IS RESERVED FOR DEVELOPMENT AS A BUSINESS PARK. PROPOSALS FOR BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT (FALLING WITHIN CLASS B1 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL BE PERMITTED IN THE QUEENS MEADOW BUSINESS PARK PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. v. THE BUILDINGS ARE PROVIDED WITH A HIGH QUALITY FINISH, THERE IS NO MORE THAN 30% COVERAGE OF EACH PLOT BY BUILDINGS, SUBSTANTIAL HIGH QUALITY LANDSCAPING AND WOODLAND PLANTING ARE PROVIDED, PARTICULARLY ON THE MAIN ROAD FRONTAGES AND ALONG THE BOUNDARY CLOSEST TO GREATHAM VILLAGE, CAR PARKING AREAS ARE LANDSCAPED, AND OUTSIDE STORAGE IS ADEQUATELY SITED AND SCREENED. PROPOSALS FOR GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT AND WAREHOUSING (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES B2 AND B8 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER AS AMENDED) WILL ONLY BE ALLOWED ON SITES AWAY FROM THE A689 AND GREATHAM VILLAGE FRONTAGES WHERE THEY MEET THE ABOVE CRITERIA AND DO NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES OR PREJUDICE THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADJOINING SITES. IN THIS RESPECT, PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE IMPOSED TO RESTRICT GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS TO APPROPRIATE OPERATIONS WITHIN THE B2 USE CLASS. PROPOSALS FOR TOWN CENTRE USES SUCH AS BANKS OR FOOD ESTABLISHMENTS (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A2 AND A3 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL NOT BE APPROVED UNLESS IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THEY ARE PRIMARILY PROVIDING SUPPORT FACILITIES FOR PEOPLE WORKING IN THE BUSINESS PARK. TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). THE AMOUNT OF AVAILABLE LAND IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. 4.28 The Borough Council seeks as part of its economic development strategy to provide a range of offers in terms of the type, size and quality of sites available for inward investment. Three other sites at Park View West, Sovereign Park (formerly Park View East) and Golden Flatts were thus identified for high quality industrial HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 39 development in the 1994 Local Plan. These sites are not considered to be so attractive as Wynyard or Queens Meadow for the highest quality developments primarily because they do not have high profile locations, although in the longer term the Golden Flatts site could be developed as an extension to the Queens Meadow Business Park. 4.29 POLICY Ind4 Only a small amount of land (under 3 hectares) remains available for development at Park View West and there are proposals to develop additional units at the Sovereign Park site. The Golden Flatts site provides a relatively large area, which could be developed by a major single user, and it is therefore identified as a strategic site by English Partnerships. HIGHER QUALITY INDUSTRIAL ESTATES THE FOLLOWING SITES ARE RESERVED FOR HIGHER QUALITY INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT: a. b. c. SOVEREIGN PARK, PARK VIEW WEST, AND GOLDEN FLATTS. PROPOSALS FOR BUSINESS DEVELOPMENTS (FALLING WITHIN CLASS B1 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL BE PERMITTED ON THESE SITES PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. THE BUILDINGS ARE PROVIDED WITH A HIGH QUALITY FINISH, SUBSTANTIAL LANDSCAPING IS PROVIDED, PARTICULARLY ON THE MAIN ROAD FRONTAGES, CAR PARKING AREAS ARE LANDSCAPED, AND OUTSIDE STORAGE IS ADEQUATELY SITED AND SCREENED. PROPOSALS FOR GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT AND WAREHOUSING (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES B2 AND B8 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL ONLY BE ALLOWED ON THE ABOVE SITES WHERE THEY MEET THE ABOVE CRITERIA AND PROVIDED THAT THEY DO NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES OR PREJUDICE THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADJACENT SITES. IN THIS RESPECT, PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE IMPOSED TO RESTRICT GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS TO APPROPRIATE OPERATIONS WITHIN THE B2 USE CLASS. TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND / OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). THE AMOUNT OF AVAILABLE LAND IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. 40 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 LAND FOR GENERAL INDUSTRY, BUSINESS USES AND WAREHOUSING 4.30 The prestige and high quality industrial sites identified in policies Ind1 to Ind4 above are generally restricted to business uses. The Borough Council wishes to be flexible and not unnecessarily inhibit new development by imposing undue restrictions on the mixture of industrial uses allowed on other industrial sites in the town, except where they will serve clear planning purposes. 4.31 Some types of general industry, however, may involve operations which could significantly impact upon neighbouring areas, and thus it may be necessary to impose controls to restrict development in some locations, especially those near housing areas, to certain types of industrial activity within the B2 (general industry) use class. In particular, uses which are potentially polluting or hazardous are not considered appropriate on any of the sites listed in policy Ind5 below, unless they are complementary to the predominant use of an existing or approved general industrial development. 4.32 A number of industrial areas lie within one or more of the Consultation Zones of the Health and Safety Executive (in respect of notifiable installations), the Nuclear Installations Inspectorate (in respect of the Nuclear Power Station), and/or of landfill sites. The areas currently affected by these zones are shown on Diagrams 4.1, 10.1 and 10.3 (see also policy GEP1 above). 4.33 The Graythorp Yard may be suitable for a range of industrial uses including marine and offshore activities. 4.34 Further development at the former Centura Foods site will require a traffic assessment to ensure that additional traffic generation does not have a significant effect on highway safety in Greatham Village. 4.35 The sites included in policy Ind5 are not considered appropriate for nonbusiness/industrial uses except certain retail uses, and cafes and other uses providing a service to the employees on the site. Retail uses which may be acceptable in these industrial areas include factory shops which are ancillary to the main use of the premises as manufacturing units, and forms of specialist retailing requiring large areas for showroom purposes (such as car dealerships which may have some industrial use attached), as well as plumbers and builders merchants which combine industrial and retail uses. 4.36 Where industrial sites have nature conservation interest value the temporary use of the land for nature conservation might be appropriate in the interim pending development for industrial purposes. In recent years planting of woodland has been carried out to the west of Brenda Road on land owned by Stadium pending industrial development. 4.37 Some of the older industrial areas create an untidy image of the town especially where they are close to main roads and the railway line and their overall appearance may deter inward investment. New development on these sites provides the opportunity to help improve the environment and policies GEP1 and GEP7 require, inter alia, that developments should be of a high standard of design and landscaping. In particular it is important that the main frontages of the industrial areas are enhanced through good design appropriate to the area and the provision of a high standard of landscaping. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 41 POLICY Ind5 INDUSTRIAL AREAS PROPOSALS FOR BUSINESS USES AND WAREHOUSING (INCLUDED WITHIN CLASSES B1 AND B8 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) WILL BE PERMITTED IN THE FOLLOWING INDUSTRIAL AREAS: a. b. c. d. e. f. g. h. i. j. k. OAKESWAY INDUSTRIAL ESTATE, LONGHILL/SANDGATE, USWORTH ROAD, BRENDA ROAD EAST, SOUTH WORKS, TOFTS FARM EAST/HUNTER HOUSE, BRENDA ROAD WEST, GRAYTHORP INDUSTRIAL ESTATE, GRAYTHORP YARD, ZINC WORKS ROAD, AND FORMER CENTURA FOODS SITE (PROVIDED THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON HIGHWAY SAFETY). PROPOSALS FOR GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT (INCLUDED WITHIN CLASS B2 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED) AND FOR OTHER USES WHICH ARE COMPLEMENTARY TO THE DOMINANT USE OF A DEVELOPMENT WILL BE APPROVED WHERE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL IS SATISFIED THAT THEY WILL NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES OR PREJUDICE THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADJACENT SITES. IN THIS RESPECT, PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE IMPOSED TO RESTRICT GENERAL INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS TO APPROPRIATE OPERATIONS WITHIN THE B2 USE CLASS. A PARTICULARLY HIGH QUALITY OF DESIGN AND LANDSCAPING WILL BE REQUIRED FOR DEVELOPMENT FRONTING THE MAIN APPROACH ROADS AND ESTATE ROADS. THE AMOUNT OF LAND AVAILABLE IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. BAD NEIGHBOUR USES 4.38 Some industrial activities such as coal and scrap yards and waste transfer stations can have a generally adverse effect upon their surrounding areas, particularly in terms of noise, smell and dust which can emanate from such concerns. Such ‘bad neighbours’ however comprise a necessary sector of the local economy, but there should be a strict control both on their location and on the effects of their activities on the surrounding area. 4.39 In most instances, ‘bad neighbour’ uses are unacceptable in newer industrial areas and in the vicinity of residential areas. The Borough Council considers that, in order to prevent the spread of untidy users into the more sensitive industrial areas, ‘bad neighbours’ should be concentrated in those parts of the Sandgate area which are not obviously visible from the main access roads, residential areas and the railway. The Arup Study of the Longhill/Sandgate area adopted by the Borough Council in 42 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 2002 3 recommended that bad neighbour uses should be more tightly contained and should not be allowed to spread into more visually prominent areas of Longhill. Consequently the area wherein bad neighbour uses should be concentrated has been identified on the Proposals Map and is restricted to the Sandgate Industrial Estate along the southern part of Mainsforth Terrace. Where untidy uses are proposed in Sandgate particular care will be needed to ensure that they can be adequately screened and do not have a detrimental effect on neighbouring properties. 4.40 The Environmental Protection Act 1990 gives some measure of control over such operations. However, planning conditions will need to be imposed, in the event of planning permission being granted, to control such matters as stacking heights, wheel washing facilities, measures to prevent dust nuisance and noise and the prohibition of burning materials. In view of the effects on neighbouring premises from inadequately operated sites the conditions imposed will be strictly enforced and activities monitored by the Borough Council. 4.41 Some existing untidy uses are close to important access roads and larger wellestablished firms. Environmental improvements are therefore important on the periphery of the Longhill/Sandgate area at Belle Vue Way, Burn Road and Mainsforth Terrace (see policies GEP16 relating to the acquisition of untidy sites and Ind8 relating to Improvement Areas). POLICY Ind6 BAD NEIGHBOUR USES PART OF THE SANDGATE AREA AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP IS IDENTIFIED FOR THE LOCATION OF BAD NEIGHBOUR USES. PROPOSALS FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OR EXTENSION OF SITES FOR BAD NEIGHBOUR USES (INCLUDING THE SORTING, COMPOSTING AND/OR STORAGE OF WASTE MATERIALS, SCRAPYARDS, CAR BREAKERS YARDS OR COAL YARDS) WILL BE PERMITTED ONLY IN THE SANDGATE AREA, PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. v. THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT NUISANCE TO ADJACENT PREMISES OR HIGHWAY USERS BY VIRTUE OF DUST, SMELL, VIBRATION, SMOKE, NOISE, MUD OR SLURRY, THE SITE IS NOT VISUALLY PROMINENT FROM A MAIN ACCESS ROAD OR FROM THE RAILWAY, THE SITE IS ADEQUATELY SCREENED, THE SITE IS OF A SUFFICIENT SIZE FOR THE OPERATIONS PROPOSED, AND THERE IS ADEQUATE CAR PARKING AND SERVICING FOR THE SITE (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES 1 AND 2). 3 Arup Study ‘Vision Formulation & Plan of Action for Longhill/Sandgate Industrial Estates’ 2002 commissioned by West Central Hartlepool New Deal for Communities. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 43 THE PORT AND PORT-RELATED DEVELOPMENT 4.42 The port fulfils an important role in the economy of Hartlepool. With the development of the former South Docks for mixed uses in connection with the Marina, port activities are concentrated in the area north of Middleton Road. Within this area, proposals directly related to the movement of goods through the port (e.g. storage sheds, roll-on/roll-off terminals) do not require planning permission. However, other developments, although making use of the port’s facilities (portrelated industries) do require permission. 4.43 The Tees Valley Structure Plan states in policy EMP8 that priority will be given to port-related industrial development in the areas with direct waterside access at Hartlepool Docks and North of Seaton Channel. The North Docks 4.44 The Tees & Hartlepool Port Authority currently owns and operates the North Docks which extends over about 155 hectares as a working port as part of its operations in the Tees area including Teesport. Whilst the operation of the North Docks continues in the short to medium term, the ongoing rationalisation of port infrastructure in the North East provides an opportunity to review port operation in Hartlepool over the local plan period and beyond 2016. 4.45 In the event of the port operations contracting in the North Docks area, the release of surplus land would create significant regeneration opportunities for the dock estate. Such a regeneration project would need to maximise the key waterside location and amenity area and recognise the important position of the area in relation to the town centre, the Marina and the Headland. 4.46 A master plan for the North Docks Estate was prepared to assess the long term development opportunities. For this reason the allocation of the area for industry and in particular port related development in the adopted 1994 Local Plan will not be continued. Consequently in recognition of the long term potential of the docks area it is proposed to identify the site for a range of uses as outlined in policy Com15. The area suitable for mixed use set out in policy Com15 will include: a) the core of the North Docks operational land, b) the Victoria Harbour and Kafiga Landing area, c) vacant land to the west of Greenland Road, and d) land at Middleton, North Seaton Channel 4.47 44 In the south-eastern part of Hartlepool, the North Seaton Channel site has been identified as a location having potential for further deep-water port facilities. Designated nature conservation sites, however, bound much of the site including areas designated as a Special Protection Area and as a Ramsar site. The construction of a deep-water frontage could involve direct habitat loss of internationally important inter-tidal flats. Port facilities should therefore only be considered on this site after the most rigorous examination of the environmental effects. In this respect a full environmental assessment will be required (see policy GEP5). If the development is to adversely affect the integrity of the Special Protection Area, planning permission may only be granted if there are imperative reasons of overriding public interest, including those of a social or economic nature. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 4.48 POLICY Ind7 Subject to this, only development making use of the potential deep-water frontage would be appropriately located on the site. In this respect care would need to be taken to ensure that such development does not prejudice the operation of the nuclear power station adjoining. The site is not therefore considered appropriate for the development of potentially polluting or hazardous industries. PORT-RELATED DEVELOPMENT LAND AT NORTH SEATON CHANNEL IS IDENTIFIED FOR DEVELOPMENT MAKING USE OF THE PORT FACILITIES. PROPOSALS FOR PORT AND FOR PORT-RELATED DEVELOPMENT AT NORTH SEATON CHANNEL WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. ii. THEY MEET THE CRITERIA SET OUT IN POLICIES WL1 (PROTECTION OF INTERNATIONAL NATURE CONSERVATION SITES) AND WL2 (PROTECTION OF SITES OF SPECIAL SCIENTIFIC INTEREST), AND THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE OPERATION OF THE POWER STATION OR ON EXISTING INDUSTRY IN THE VICINITY. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF POLICY Dco2 REGARDING FLOOD RISK. THE AMOUNT OF LAND AVAILABLE IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. DEVELOPMENT USING RAIL FACILITIES 4.49 The railway through Hartlepool bounds many of the sites identified for industrial development. Freight connections currently exist at Hartlepool Docks, Britmag Limited, the Corus (former British Steel) South Works, the nuclear power station and in the Newburn Bridge/Carr House area. Other industrial land, including sites in the Mainsforth Terrace / Sandgate area of Longhill, at Brenda Road West, North Graythorp, Graythorp Yard, North Seaton Channel and Centura Foods may offer the potential for new rail siding connections. 4.50 The Borough Council does not propose to identify any of these sites solely for developments making use of the land’s rail access potential as this may unduly HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 45 constrain their development. The Council is, however, concerned to encourage increased use of the railway for freight movement and policy Tra17 seeks to ensure that existing sidings are protected and encourages the provision of new sidings to serve industrial developments where appropriate. IMPROVEMENTS TO THE INDUSTRIAL ENVIRONMENT 4.51 The Borough Council will continue to seek ways to improve the environment of industrial areas. Local plan policies can assist in this by setting the land use context and requiring, where appropriate, landscaping works in association with developments (see policies Ind1 to Ind7). In addition, a number of Industrial Improvement Areas have been designated where grant assistance has been given to existing as well as new firms to improve the attractiveness and general efficiency of their premises. The Borough Council has carried out landscaping and infrastructure schemes in these areas to improve their overall environment and image. 4.52 Grants are available for improvement works at Longhill under the West Central New Deal for Communities programme. The local plan will seek to ensure that developments in all improvement areas contribute to the upgrading and enhancement of the environment. POLICY Ind8 INDUSTRIAL IMPROVEMENT AREAS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE ENVIRONMENTAL AND OTHER IMPROVEMENT AND ENHANCEMENT SCHEMES IN DESIGNATED INDUSTRIAL IMPROVEMENT AREAS. AS AT MARCH 2006, THE AREAS INCLUDED: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ OAKESWAY, LONGHILL, USWORTH ROAD, AND GRAYTHORP. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CARRY OUT ENVIRONMENTAL IMPROVEMENT SCHEMES WHERE POSSIBLE ON BOTH COUNCIL AND PRIVATELY OWNED LAND. LAND FOR POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS DEVELOPMENTS 4.53 Policy Ec8 of the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan identifies land west of Seaton Channel (Huntsman Tioxide site), at North Graythorp and Phillips Tank Farm for ‘special’ industrial development. However, most types of ‘special’ industrial uses were classed as general industry by an amendment to the Town and Country Planning (Use Classes) Order 1987. In order to distinguish those industrial developments that should be segregated from sensitive land uses, it is proposed to separately identify areas suitable for ‘potentially polluting or hazardous’ uses. Thus the areas previously identified for ‘special’ industry are now included in policy Ind9 below as sites suitable for potentially polluting or hazardous uses. 4.54 Much of this land is held by existing firms for their own longer-term expansion and is therefore not generally available for incoming developments. The remaining land at North Graythorp requires the provision of major infrastructure, including drainage, to 46 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 enable development. It was therefore suggested in the Issues Report 4 that additional land to the south of the Phillips Tank Farm could be identified for potentially polluting or hazardous development. Although development of this site could have resulted in some environmental gains including the diversion of the Centura Foods traffic from Greatham village direct to the A178 Tees Road, there are major constraints. These include the proximity of the site to areas of nature conservation importance and the fact that the site is low–lying and may be at risk from flooding. The Borough Council therefore considers that it would not be appropriate to allocate this land for development at this time. 4.55 Part of the Huntsman Tioxide site (West of Seaton Channel) was designated as the Tees and Hartlepool Foreshore and Wetlands Site of Special Scientific Interest (SSSI) in 1997 and included in the Teesmouth and Cleveland Coast Special Protection Area and Ramsar site (see paragraph 13.16 below). The area covered by the designations is therefore no longer identified for potentially polluting or hazardous industry. Proposed development on the balance of the industrial site will need to have regard to the effect on the adjoining internationally important wildlife site (see Policy WL1). In this respect a full environmental assessment may be required to be submitted with development proposals (see policy GEP5). 4.56 General industrial developments, business uses and warehousing will not normally be allowed on the North Graythorp and West of Seaton Channel sites unless they are (or are complementary to a predominant use which is) potentially polluting or hazardous. Sufficient sites are allocated for these non-polluting uses in policies Ind1 to Ind5 above and their development on these ‘special’ sites will preclude the further development of potentially polluting or hazardous uses on the only sites which are appropriate for them. POLICY Ind9 POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS DEVELOPMENTS LAND IN THE FOLLOWING AREAS IS RESERVED FOR DEVELOPMENTS WHICH ARE POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS: a. b. c. WEST OF SEATON CHANNEL (HUNTSMAN TIOXIDE SITE), NORTH GRAYTHORP, AND PHILLIPS TANK FARM. PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT WHICH IS POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS WILL BE PERMITTED ON THESE SITES PROVIDED THAT THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE ENVIRONMENT, OR ♦ ♦ ♦ ON DESIGNATED NATURE CONSERVATION SITES (SEE POLICIES WL1 AND WL2), OR ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES, OR ON THE DEVELOPMENT OF NEIGHBOURING LAND. IN CONSIDERING PROPOSALS, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL HAVE SPECIAL REGARD TO ADVICE RECEIVED FROM THE HEALTH AND SAFETY EXECUTIVE (INCLUDING THE NUCLEAR INSTALLATIONS INSPECTORATE), H.M. INSPECTOR OF POLLUTION, THE ENVIRONMENT AGENCY AND ENGLISH NATURE. THE AMOUNT OF LAND AVAILABLE IS GIVEN IN APPENDIX 5. 4 Hartlepool Local Plan Issues Report published in January 1999 for consultation purposes HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 47 UNDERGROUND STORAGE 4.57 POLICY Ind10 To the south-west of the West Seaton Channel site and east of Tees Road is an area of land which was used for the extraction of brine (ICI Brinefields). The brine was extracted in such a way that some of the cavities left following extraction have the potential for use for storage purposes of substances (such as oil) without the need for large above ground structures. In view of the internationally important wildlife interest in this area, only non-toxic substances should be considered for storage. Particular care will need to be taken to ensure that the aquifer and watercourses in the area are not affected and that potentially hazardous substances do not give rise to significant risks to people in the area or affect nearby industrial developments. UNDERGROUND STORAGE PROPOSALS FOR THE USE OF THE FORMER ICI BRINEFIELDS CAVITIES FOR UNDERGROUND STORAGE WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE: i. ii. iii. THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT INCREASE IN THE POTENTIAL RISK TO PEOPLE IN THE AREA, IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THERE WILL BE NO RESULTANT HARM TO THE AQUIFER OR TO WATERCOURSES, OR TO THE SURROUNDING AREA, AND IN PARTICULAR TO THE AREA’S NATURE CONSERVATION IMPORTANCE (SEE ALSO POLICIES WL1 AND WL2), AND ABOVE GROUND STRUCTURES ARE LIMITED AND ARE NOT VISUALLY PROMINENT. IN CONSIDERING PROPOSALS, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL PAY PARTICULAR REGARD TO ADVICE RECEIVED FROM THE HEALTH AND SAFETY EXECUTIVE (INCLUDING THE NUCLEAR INSTALLATIONS INSPECTORATE), THE ENVIRONMENT AGENCY, HARTLEPOOL WATER COMPANY AND ENGLISH NATURE. HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES 4.58 48 The Planning (Hazardous Substances) Act 1990 requires hazardous substances consent to be obtained for the introduction of a hazardous substance in an amount at or above its specified controlled quantity, whether on, over, or under the land. These controls enable the Borough Council, as the Hazardous Substance Authority, to consider whether the proposed storage or use of a significant quantity of a hazardous substance is appropriate in a particular location. In this respect, regard is had to the advice of the Health and Safety Executive, to the potential risks arising to people in the area, to the constraints likely to arise on further developments in the vicinity and to the effects on areas of particular natural sensitivity or interest. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 4.59 In general, therefore, the use or storage of hazardous substances should, as far as practicable, be confined to the sites identified in policy Ind9 above as suitable for potentially polluting or hazardous developments. However, there may be circumstances where, on the advice of the Health and Safety Executive, the introduction, or use, of hazardous substances elsewhere might be permitted if suitably sited. 4.60 There are a number of sites in Hartlepool which, in view of the processes carried out, or in view of the storage on site of hazardous materials, are designated Major Hazard Installations by the Health and Safety Executive. The Health and Safety Executive requires to be consulted on all applications relating to these installations together with most planning applications for sites within consultation zones established around them. The extent of these zones as at March 2003 is shown on Diagram 4.1. Developments such as intensive leisure uses attracting large numbers of people and ‘sensitive’ residential development including that specifically for the elderly or infirm should not be located within any part of these zones. In the areas closest to the installations the Health and Safety Executive has stated that it would prefer low employment density industrial use or warehousing. POLICY Ind11 HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES PROPOSALS INVOLVING THE INTRODUCTION OF HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES WILL BE PERMITTED ON SITES IDENTIFIED IN POLICY Ind9 FOR POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS DEVELOPMENTS PROVIDED THAT THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT INCREASE IN THE POTENTIAL RISK TO PEOPLE IN THE AREA AND THAT THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON DESIGNATED INTERNATIONAL AND NATIONAL NATURE CONSERVATION SITES IN THE VICINITY (SEE ALSO POLICIES WL1 AND WL2). PROPOSALS INVOLVING THE INTRODUCTION OF HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES ON SITES WHICH ARE NOT IDENTIFIED FOR POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL IS SATISFIED THAT: i. ii. iii. FROM THE HEALTH AND SAFETY VIEWPOINT, THERE WOULD BE NO SIGNIFICANT INCREASE IN THE POTENTIAL RISK TO PEOPLE IN THE SURROUNDING AREA AND TO EXISTING AND PROPOSED RESIDENTIAL AREAS, THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE ENVIRONMENT AND IN PARTICULAR ON AREAS OF IMPORTANCE FOR WILDLIFE IN THE AREA, AND THAT THE PRESENCE OF HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES, OR THE FURTHER EXTENSION OF SAFEGUARDING ZONES AROUND INSTALLATIONS WILL NOT INHIBIT THE FULL OPPORTUNITIES FOR DEVELOPMENT OF OTHER SITES IN THE VICINITY. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 49 50 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 5 RETAIL, COMMERCIAL AND MIXED USE DEVELOPMENT CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 5.1 This chapter is primarily concerned with retail, office and small business development particularly in relation to the town centre, local shopping areas (local centres) and mixed use areas (both within and outside the town centre). It sets out the retail strategy in relation to the hierarchy of centres, defines the extent of the overall town centre including the primary shopping area, edge of centre and fringe centre sites within it, where specific policies apply to each area. The plan seeks to ensure that the town centre remains the focus for the Hartlepool community and that it is further enhanced in line with the Hartlepool Community Strategy which seeks to improve the economic opportunities in the town centre, creating better job and investment prospects and ensuring that it retains its vitality and viability. 5.2 The plan also seeks to protect and enhance the shopping facilities provided in the local centres and policies are included setting out the consideration of major shopping and commercial developments attracting large numbers of visitors. Other policies relate to smaller scale convenience stores, petrol stations, food and drink premises, the restriction of retail uses in industrial areas and the control of commercial uses in primarily residential areas. Hartlepool Retail Study 5.3 The Borough Council commissioned a study 1 in 2002 (updated in March 2005) to review the amount and quality of shopping provision in Hartlepool and existing patterns of shopping. The study also assessed the demand for additional shopping in the future and the impact of proposed new shopping developments. 5.4 The study confirmed that, whilst Hartlepool is relatively self-contained for shopping, it also serves important areas in the southern part of Easington District. The town does however lose comparison shoppers to such centres as Middlesbrough and Teesside Park. 2 Overall, the vitality and viability of the town centre is quite healthy. The study found that the potential for growth in the retail market in Hartlepool is very largely taken up by committed developments. Thus it suggested that the Borough Council should be extremely cautious about allowing any further shopping developments on sites outside of the town centre other than the Marina as these which might weaken the position of the centre itself. It emphasised that the Middleton Grange Shopping Centre, the third largest covered mall in the North East is a major strength and, with the Marina, is performing well. 1 Hartlepool Retail Study Drivers Jonas (June 2002) Updated March 2005 Comparison goods include clothing, textiles, furniture , leisure goods and ‘White Goods’. The category excludes food retailing. 2 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 51 National Planning Guidance 5.5 National planning guidance is contained in various Planning Policy Statements. Generally Government policy is to promote and enhance existing town centres and encourage retail and leisure developments to locate within them where there is access by a choice of means of transport other than the car. A requirement is laid down for a sequential approach to be adopted for site location with a preference for town centres before any edge-of-centre locations that are or will be well-connected to the centre and lastly out-of-centre sites, with preference given to sites which are well served by a choice of means of transport. Regional Spatial Strategy 5.6 The submitted Regional Spatial Strategy for the North East ‘View, Shaping the North East’ states that development plans should ensure that town centres continue to be the focus for a wide range of activities which will maintain and enhance their vitality and viability, encourage investment and support sustainable development. Policies should be included in development plans which ensure that uses such as employment, shopping, offices, leisure, entertainment, hospitals and higher education which generate a large number of trips should be concentrated in town centres where they can be well served by public transport and therefore help reduce the need to travel. In this respect a sequential approach 3 to selecting sites for new development should be adopted. 5.7 The submitted strategy also states that development plans should include policies to retain and promote mixed use development in town centres taking into account the particular characteristics of individual town centres and their potential for incorporating schemes which will increase the range and quality of facilities. 5.8 Further the submitted strategy emphasises that new development within town centres should be based on the sequential approach and recognises that Hartlepool has an important role in serving a wide hinterland. Structure Plan Policies 5.9 The Tees Valley Structure Plan seeks to ensure that the vitality and viability of town centres are maintained and strengthened (policy TC1). It sets out the criteria to be considered in respect of large scale retail developments (policy TC5) and also requires that a sequential approach be adopted for large scale retail developments, major new office, leisure and entertainment uses (policies TC4 and TC6). Local Plan Objectives 5.10 The following objectives derived from all the elements of the local plan strategy are of relevance in drawing up the policies on retail, commercial and mixed use development: A1 A2 A3 to encourage the provision of more and higher quality job opportunities; to ensure that sites are available for the full range of industrial and commercial activities so as to enable the diversification of employment opportunities; to encourage the development of additional office, small business and light industrial uses; 3 The sequential approach means that first preference should be for town centre sites, followed by edge-of-centre sites, district and local centres and only then out-of-centre sites in locations accessible by a choice of transport. 52 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 A4 A6 A7 A8 B1 B2 B3 B4 C1 C2 C3 C4 C6 C10 D2 D3 D4 to promote the growth of tourism; to improve the viability and environment of older housing, commercial and industrial areas; to promote development on previously used sites where appropriate, and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings; to promote mixed use developments where appropriate; to ensure that there is available throughout the plan period an adequate supply of suitable housing land which is capable of offering a range of house types to meet all needs; to ensure that Hartlepool Town Centre continues to fulfil its role as a vibrant and viable amenity providing a wide range of attractions and services with convenient access for the whole community; to encourage in accessible locations the provision of sport, recreational, leisure and cultural developments to cater for all the whole community; to protect and encourage the development of local shopping, leisure, sporting and recreational and other community facilities at locations convenient to main neighbourhoods; to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool; to retain the compact form of the main urban area by preventing urban development extending into the countryside; to preserve the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest; to encourage a high standard of design and the provision of high quality environment in all developments and particularly those on prominent sites, along the main road and rail corridors, and along the coast; to protect as far as possible existing open space, and to encourage further landscaping and tree planting where appropriate; to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings; to promote developments in locations which support existing transport infrastructure, which minimise the need to travel, and which are accessible by all modes of transport; to ensure that developments attracting large numbers of people locate in existing centres which are highly accessible by means other than the private car; to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport. The Local Plan Strategy for Retail Development 5.11 The local plan objectives B2 and B4 above are particularly relevant to the following strategy for retail development. This strategy provides the context for the policies on retailing and seeks: ♦ the concentration of new retail developments in the town centre – in particular in the primary shopping area where land is identified for further development; ♦ the continued development of those parts of the marina area outside the town centre for specialist tourist related shopping facilities; ♦ the location of further small food stores in locations convenient by all modes of transport to the local market, but where they will not harm the viability of existing local shopping areas; ♦ the protection of the retailing function of the local shopping parades and other defined local shopping areas through the control on the proportion of development for non-retail uses; HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 53 ♦ resistance to most types of retail development in industrial areas. The Sequential Approach 5.12 Retail developments should accord with the sequential approach in site selection. The first preference is given to locations within the existing town centre where suitable sites or buildings for conversions are or are likely to become available within the plan period, taking account of an appropriate scale of development in relation to the role and function of the centre. The second area of search is at edge-of-centre locations, with preference given to sites that are or will be well-connected to the centre. The third area of search will cover out-of-centre sites which are or will be well served by a choice of means of transport and which are close to the centre and have a high likelihood of forming links with the centre. POLICIES AND PROPOSALS THE TOWN CENTRE 5.13 The town centre, as defined, is shown on the proposals map and on Diagram 5.1. It includes the primary shopping area around Middleton Grange and York Road together with parts of the Church Street area and limited parts of the Marina. In particular Hartlepool railway station, the proposed public transport interchange and, the two further education establishments, major leisure and recreation facilities (including the multi-screen cinema) are all located within the town centre. 5.14 The Borough Council wishes to continue to promote the town centre and ensure that it continues to provide the major focus for commercial investment and employment, by enabling the development of a wide range of attractions and amenities and creating and encouraging the provision of a high quality environment. Much has been achieved in improving the quality of the overall environment in recent years, through both private and public sector investment. The attractiveness and accessibility of the town centre could, however, be further enhanced by the creation of new high quality open spaces, improvements to the appearance of the area and extension and improvement of pedestrian links. 5.15 The Borough Council wishes to encourage a variety of uses in the town centre in order to increase its vitality and housing development can contribute to the vitality of the town centre and lead to increased activity, particularly after normal working hours. The Borough Council therefore wishes to encourage further residential development in the town centre particularly in converted buildings (policy Hsg7) and on the upper floors of commercial properties (policy Hsg8) where it will not constrain the further development of commercial facilities. 5.16 Proposals for restaurants, cafes, drinking establishments, hot food takeaways and night clubs which may be acceptable within in the town centre will be controlled to prevent any detrimental effect on nearby residential properties. In particular uses which stay open after midnight will be restricted to the late night entertainment area in the Church Street / South West Marina area provided for in Policy Rec13. 54 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Com1 DEVELOPMENT OF THE TOWN CENTRE THE TOWN CENTRE AS DEFINED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP WILL BE DEVELOPED AS THE MAIN SHOPPING, COMMERCIAL AND SOCIAL CENTRE OF HARTLEPOOL. THE TOWN CENTRE PRESENTS OPPORTUNITIES FOR A RANGE OF COMMERCIAL AND MIXED USE DEVELOPMENT SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF POLICIES Com2 (PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA) Com3 (PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA OPPORTUNITY SITE), Com8 (SHOPPING DEVELOPMENT), Com9 (MAIN TOWN CENTRE USES) AND Rec14 (MAJOR LESURE DEVELOPMENT). PROPOSALS FOR REVITALISATION AND REDEVELOPMENT WITHIN THE TOWN CENTRE SHOULD, WHERE POSSIBLE, PROVIDE FOR IMPROVEMENTS TO THE OVERALL APPEARANCE OF THE AREA, AND DEVELOPMENT OF IMPROVED PUBLIC TRANSPORT, PEDESTRIAN AND CYCLEWAY FACILITIES AND LINKAGES. IN ADDITION ENHANCEMENT OF EXISTING OR CREATION OF NEW OPEN SPACES WILL BE ENCOURAGED. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO SECURE THE RE-USE OF VACANT COMMERCIAL PROPERTIES INCLUDING THEIR USE FOR RESIDENTIAL PURPOSES (SEE POLICIES Hsg7 AND Hsg8). PROPOSALS FOR A3, A4 AND A5 USES WILL BE SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF POLICIES Rec13 (LATE NIGHT USES) AND Com12 (FOOD AND DRINK) AND WILL BE CONTROLLED BY THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 55 56 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 The Primary Shopping Area 5.17 At the heart of the town centre is the Primary Shopping Area encompassing the area generally bounded by Victoria Road, Stockton Street, Park Road and York Road, including both sides of the latter two streets. A large part of this area comprises the Middleton Grange centre, a purpose-built pedestrianised shopping facility initially developed in the late 1960s/early 1970s and considerably refurbished, enhanced and extended over recent years. 5.18 Whilst overall, retail uses predominate in the primary shopping area, other uses such as banks, building societies, estate agents, solicitors, cafes, restaurants, amusement centres, hotels and public houses providing services and activities for shoppers are also found within the area, primarily outside the Middleton Grange centre. The Borough Council wishes to control the level of development of non-retail uses within Middleton Grange in order to safeguard its existing character and function as the focus of town centre shopping activity. Non-retail uses are best located in the secondary retail frontages of the peripheral parts of the primary shopping area along York Road, Victoria Road and Park Road. 5.19 It will be important to maintain visual interest within the primary shopping area as a whole and therefore conditions may be attached to planning permissions for nonretail uses in the area requiring display windows to be provided. 5.20 In view of the availability of public car parking in the area and the accessibility of the area to public transport, there is no requirement for additional parking to be provided in association with developments in the primary shopping area. POLICY Com2 PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA PROPOSALS FOR RETAIL DEVELOPMENT (FALLING WITHIN CLASS A1 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) (AMENDMENT) ORDER 2005 WILL BE PERMITTED WITHIN THE PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA WHERE THE DEVELOPMENT IS OF AN APPROPRIATE DESIGN AND TO AN APPROPRIATE SCALE HAVING REGARD TO THE OVERALL APPEARANCE AND CHARACTER OF THE AREA. PROPOSALS FOR OFFICES, HOTELS AND FOR LEISURE AND ENTERTAINMENT USES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A2, A3, A4, A5, C1, D1 AND D2 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) (AMENDMENT) ORDER 2005 WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE: i. ii. iii. THEY DO NOT IMPACT ON THE RETAIL FUNCTION OF THE PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA, AND THEY DO NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE CHARACTER AND AMENITY OF THE SURROUNDING AREA, AND THEY ACCORD WITH POLICIES Rec13 AND Com12. PLANNING CONDITIONS WILL BE IMPOSED REQUIRING THE PROVISION OF DISPLAY WINDOW FRONTAGES. PROPOSALS FOR THE RESIDENTIAL USE OF UPPER FLOORS OF PROPERTIES WILL BE PERMITTED PROVIDED THAT THE FURTHER DEVELOPMENT OF COMMERCIAL ACTIVITIES IS NOT PREJUDICED AND SUBJECT TO THE INSTALLATION OF APPROPRIATE NOISE INSULATION (SEE ALSO POLICY Hsg8). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 57 5.21 POLICY Com3 Some of the land fronting Park Road currently used for surface car parking has outline planning permission for an extension to Middleton Grange and this together with land adjoining means that a site of about 1.9 hectares is available within the primary shopping area for further retail development. Replacement public car parking provision will need to be made and the current outline permission includes the provision of a multi-storey car park between York Road and the Middleton Grange centre. Existing commercial, leisure and community buildings lie adjacent to the main development site area and together they present an opportunity for a significant enhancement of the town centre. PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA OPPORTUNITY SITE AN AREA SOUTH AND WEST OF MIDDLETON GRANGE IS IDENTIFIED FOR FUTURE RETAIL DEVELOPMENT TO COMPLEMENT THE SHOPPING CENTRE SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF POLICIES Com1 AND Com2 ABOVE. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL IMPOSE PLANNING CONDITIONS AND WILL SEEK LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS AS APPROPRIATE TO ENSURE THE PROVISION OF REPLACEMENT CAR PARK FACILITIES TO COMPENSATE FOR THE LOSS OF EXISTING PUBLIC PARKING SPACES. The Town Centre Outside the Primary Shopping Area 5.22 Those parts of the town centre which lie outside the Primary Shopping Area are: • the Church Street Conservation Area • the Tower Street/ Whitby Street Area including the College of Further Education and a number of commercial buildings extending from the Albert Street car park to Lynn Street. • an area extending north of Victoria Road comprising the complex of public buildings at the Civic Centre, police station and the Town Hall. The area also includes the Morrison’s store opened in 2004. • a limited area of the south west part of the Marina where the Asda Superstore, the multiplex cinema and other leisure facilities attracting large numbers of visitors are located. • a very limited area of York Road extending south of Park Road to Waldon Street. Church Street Conservation Area 5.23 The Church Street Conservation Area comprises the former historic and commercial heart of West Hartlepool. It contains a mixture of uses, including hotels, Council and other offices, the Tourist Information Centre and Art Gallery, leisure facilities, shops and residential, much in the original mid-nineteenth century buildings. The area is included in a Commercial Improvement Area (see paragraph 5.38) and has been transformed through substantial investment under the auspices of Hartlepool City Challenge. Many of the buildings, previously semi-derelict, have been restored and re-used with grant assistance and considerable environmental improvements have been carried out to the streetscape. 5.24 In view of the variety of uses in this area, it is appropriate that this part of the town centre should continue to be identified as a mixed-use area. In this respect, regard 58 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 will need to be taken of the need for proposals to preserve or enhance the area (see Policy HE1 and Supplementary Note 5) and to ensure that the area retains its character and function as a mixed-use area. 5.25 The Church Street Conservation Area is a key location for a range of entertainment uses and together with parts of the South West Marina area has been identified for late night uses as set out in Policy Rec13. 5.26 Care will need to be taken in respect of proposals for residential development to ensure that they will not prejudice future commercial activities nearby, and that the amenities of the residents will not be adversely affected. In addition it is considered that developments, particularly for late night uses adjoining residential properties, should be controlled by the use of planning conditions. 5.27 Whilst non-operational car parking does not need to be provided as the area currently lies within the town centre car parking zone (see Diagram 8.2), proposals for development should allow for adequate servicing arrangements. Edge of Centre Areas 5.28 Immediately around the town centre are a number of areas suitable for a range of uses which could enhance the variety of facilities in the town centre. In determining applications for proposals within edge of town centre sites the effect on the amenities of occupiers of adjoining or nearby residential properties will be a material consideration (see Policy GEP1). The edge of centre locations are as follows:i) The York Road North / Avenue Road / Raby Road Area This area lies to the north of the primary shopping area. Further drinking establishments (A4 Uses) and hot food takeaways (A5) will not be permitted in this area owing to the proximity of residential premises (see Com12 and Rec13). ii) West Victoria Road This area lies to the north west of the town centre and is within the designated Grange Conservation Area. The south side of Victoria Road comprises a purpose built health centre with associated car parking whilst the north side comprises larger terraced properties providing an attractive and convenient area for office uses. In view of this, the Borough Council considers that the introduction of shops and leisure uses in this area would result in the loss of one of the most attractive areas for offices close to the main shopping area. Moreover, leisure uses including pubs and takeaways in particular those attracting evening and late-night customers, may be harmful to the amenities of the residents in the adjoining housing development. iii) The Park Road area This area extends from the south-western corner of the primary shopping area. Existing uses in the area comprise a mixture of retail, leisure and commercial activities. Further public houses and hot food takeaways will not be permitted. iv) York Road South HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 59 The southern stretch of York Road comprises a mixture of shops, offices, business and commercial activities together with some residential properties. Within this area there are some small unused or underused sites. It is important that development of these sites reflects the area’s character; Financial and professional services such as banking (Use class A2) will not be permitted as such uses are more appropriate nearer the town centre. Restaurants (Class A3), pubs (A4 Use) and hot food takeaways (A5 Use) will not be permitted. v) The Brewery and Stranton. The brewery has an access on to Park Road and extends through to the Stranton area. Whilst the long term operation is secured the possibility of commercial and other uses on the site is recognised provided that these do not affect the surrounding area. Certain types of industrial uses will be subject to planning conditions to prevent the change to more intensive activities detrimental to the area. vi) East of Stranton This site comprising the fire station, the Royal Mail Sorting office and areas of cleared vacant land lies to the east of the main dual carriage way at Stockton Street. Generally business uses, general industry and warehousing would be acceptable subject to conditions being imposed to control changes of uses within the same use class. Financial and professional services such as banking (Use class A2) will not be permitted as such uses are more appropriate within the town centre. vii) Lynn Street North / Mainsforth Terrace North The area is situated to the south east of the Church Street Conservation Area. Although some older properties remain, particularly in the vicinity of Lambton Street/Mainsforth Terrace area, the area has been substantially cleared and redeveloped over the last forty years to provide larger properties including office, industrial and specialist retail warehousing premises. There are several potential development sites remaining in the area including land in the Charles Street area. A range of uses might be acceptable including business and educational activities including crèches and nurseries. viii) South of Maritime Avenue A site fronting Maritime Avenue and comprising about 2.73 hectares (6.7 acres) currently has planning permission as a business park. It lies within that part of the marina area outside the defined town centre and is identified for mixed use development commensurate with its function as a major visitor attraction - see policy To1 below). Development for retail use (A1 Use) will not be permitted. ix) Mill House Existing developments in the Mill House area include the swimming baths and multi-purpose sports hall, a bowling club and the Hartlepool United FC Victoria Park ground. This is therefore an important focus for recreational and leisure activities complementing the overall attraction of the town centre and developments within the area should be for recreational or leisure use. Recreational and leisure uses will be encouraged. Other uses will not be permitted unless they are ancillary to the principal use of the area for recreational and leisure activities. 60 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 x) The Marina The main part of the Marina lies adjacent to the Town Centre. Over recent years it has been substantially re-developed for a wide range of uses. The Hartlepool Marina will continue to be developed for a mixture of uses which will enhance its value as a major attraction for both residents and visitors. The uses include tourist-related developments and other retail and leisure uses, together with offices and residential accommodation. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 61 POLICY Com4 Part1 EDGE OF TOWN CENTRE AREAS PROPOSALS FOR A RANGE OF USES WILL BE PERMITTED WITHIN EDGE OF TOWN CENTRE AREAS AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP PROVIDED THAT: • THEY DO NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE CHARACTER (APPEARANCE / FUNCTION) AND AMENITY OF THE AREA (SEE POLICY GEP1), AND • THEY ACCORD WITH POLICIES Com8, Com9. Com12, Rec13, Rec14, Tra16, GEP7, HE1, HE7, HE8 AND HE10. THE EDGE OF TOWN CENTRE AREAS AND THE RANGE OF USES OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) (AMENDMENT) ORDER 2005 WHICH ARE EITHER ACCEPTABLE OR UNACCEPTABLE IN THE INTERESTS OF AMENITIES ARE AS FOLLOWS: 1. AVENUE ROAD / RABY ROAD • RETAIL, OFFICES, RESIDENTIAL AND COMMERCIAL USES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A2, A3, B1 AND D1) WILL BE PERMITTED; • DRINKING ESTABLISHMENTS, HOT FOOD TAKEAWAYS OR GENERAL INDUSTRY (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A4, A5, B2 AND B8) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. 2. WEST VICTORIA ROAD • OFFICE AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENTS AND HEALTH CARE USES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A2, B1 AND D1) WILL BE PERMITTED; • SHOPS, DRINKING ESTABLISHMENTS, HOT FOOD TAKEAWAYS (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A4 AND A5) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. 3. PARK ROAD WEST • RETAIL, OFFICES, RESIDENTIAL AND COMMERCIAL USES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A2, A3 AND B1) WILL BE PERMITTED; • FURTHER DRINKING ESTABLISHMENTS AND HOT FOOD TAKEAWAYS (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A4 AND A5) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. 4. YORK ROAD SOUTH • RETAIL, OFFICES AND COMMERCIAL USES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1 and B1) WILL BE PERMITTED; • FINANCIAL AND PROFESSIONAL SERVICES, FURTHER RESTAURANTS, DRINKING ESTABLISHMENTS AND HOT FOOD TAKEAWAYS (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A2, A3, A4 AND A5) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. 5. THE BREWERY AND STRANTON • 62 RETAIL, OFFICES COMMERCIAL AND INDUSTRIAL USES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A3, B1, B2 AND B8) WILL BE PERMITTED. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Com4 part 2 6. EAST OF STRANTON • OFFICE AND BUSINESS AND INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS (FALLING WITHIN USE CLASSES B1, B2 AND B8) WILL BE PERMITTED; • A1 RETAIL DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT BE ALLOWED UNLESS IT IS DEMONSTRABLY SERVES THE LOCAL AREA; • FINANCIAL AND PROFESIONAL SERVICES WITHIN CLASS A2) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. (FALLING 7. LYNN STREET NORTH / MAINSFORTH TERRACE NORTH • OFFICE AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENTS, EDUCATIONAL AND LEISURE AND ENTERTAINMENT FACILITIES (FALLING WITHIN USE CLASSES B1, B2, B8 AND D1) WILL BE PERMITTED. 8. SOUTH OF MARITIME AVENUE • OFFICE AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENTS, LEISURE AND ENTERTAINMENT USES (FALLING WITHIN USE CLASSES A2, A3, B1 AND C1) WILL BE PERMITTED; • RETAIL USE (FALLING WITHIN CLASS A1) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. 9. MILL HOUSE • RECREATIONAL AND LEISURE USES (FALLING WITHIN USE CLASSES D1 & D2) WILL BE PERMITTED; • OTHER USES WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS THEY ARE ANCILLARY TO THE PRINCIPAL USE OF THE AREA FOR RECREATIONAL AND LEISURE ACTIVITIES. 10. MARINA • PROPOSALS FOR RETAIL, OFFICE, HOTEL, LEISURE AND RESIDENTIAL DEVELOPMENT (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A3, A4, A5, B1, C1, C2, C3, D1 AND D2) WILL BE PERMITTED WITHIN THOSE PARTS OF THE MARINA AREA LYING OUTSIDE THE TOWN CENTRE SUBJECT TO POLICIES Com8, Com9 & Rec14. CONDITIONS WILL BE ATTACHED TO PLANNING PERMISSIONS TO CONTROL CHANGES OF USE WITHIN THE SAME B2 USE CLASS IN THE INTERESTS OF AMENITY. ANY PROPOSED USES NOT SPECIFIED ABOVE WILL BE CONSIDERED ON THEIR MERITS TAKING ACCOUNT OF POLICY GEP1. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 63 LOCAL CENTRES 5.29 Hartlepool town centre is identified in policy TC3 of the 2004 Tees Valley Structure Plan as a major town centre. The Borough contains no other ‘town centres’ 4 , but has a number of small centres serving the local community. These centres are important in meeting the day to day shopping and other local needs of the community, particularly those who are less mobile. On the post-war estates these are provided in the form of small shopping parades. In the older areas of the town, however, local facilities are generally more scattered, primarily in the form of ‘corner shops’, but there are areas, such as along parts of Raby Road and Oxford Road, where there are concentrations of local shops and services. 5.30 Outline planning permission exists for a new local centre to be provided at Middle Warren on a site currently identified at the junction of Merlin Way with West View Road. The Section 106 Agreement 5 relating to the development of the Middle Warren area as a whole specifies that the retail element of the local centre should not exceed 1500sqm of gross floorspace. 5.31 The Borough Council wishes as far as practicable to encourage the retention of local shops and other local services particularly where these are grouped together. The local centres are shown on the proposals map and listed in Appendix 6 and include the site for a new local centre at Middle Warren. Certain office and institutional uses (such as building society branches and doctors’ surgeries) and in some circumstances food and drink premises and small amusement centres are appropriately located in these areas. However the Borough Council considers that such uses should not be allowed in the local centres to the extent that the characteristics and also the function of local centres in providing facilities to meet local shopping and service needs are prejudiced. They should not give rise to nuisance or disturbance to neighbours and where off-street parking is not available there is a need to ensure that developments do not affect highway safety (see also policy Com12 on food and drink premises). 5.32 A visually pleasing and safe shopping environment is important in ensuing that the local centres remain viable and attractive to shoppers. The Borough Council through various regeneration and crime prevention initiatives has sought to improve many of these areas (see paragraphs 5.33 and 5.34 below). New shop fronts should be appropriate to the street scene and security features such as shutters, lights, and cameras should also be carefully integrated with building design and frontage layout. 4 Town centres are defined in Planning Policy Statement 6 (PPS6) as a centre providing a broad range of facilities and services fulfilling a function as a focus for both the community and for public transport. 5 A Section 106 Agreement is a legal attached to the approval of a planning application through which the applicant and others with a legal interest in the land agrees to undertake or pay for additional works or adhere to restrictions which could not be dealt with by planning conditions alone. 64 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Com 5 LOCAL CENTRES PROPOSALS FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF SHOPS, LOCAL SERVICES AND FOOD AND DRINK PREMISES (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A2, A3, A4 A5 AND D1 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) (AMENDMENT) ORDER 2005 WILL BE APPROVED WITHIN THE LOCAL CENTRES WHERE: i. ii. THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEIGHBOURING PROPERTIES OR ON THE HIGHWAY NETWORK (SEE ALSO POLICIES GEP1, AND Com12), AND THE SCALE, FUNCTION, CHARACTER, AND APPEARANCE OF THE AREA IS MAINTAINED. THE LOCAL CENTRES ARE LISTED IN APPENDIX 6 AND SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP. COMMERCIAL IMPROVEMENT AREAS 5.33 Three of the larger local centres in the older parts of the town (Raby Road, Murray Street and the Headland Northgate) lie within designated Commercial Improvement Areas. Other currently designated Commercial Improvement Areas are in Church Street and at Seaton Carew. They were designated with a view to improving the environmental quality of the areas, securing the commercial performance of businesses, reducing the number of empty properties and unused upper floors of premises, and providing improved commercial facilities for residents. Considerable improvements have been carried out in these areas through City Challenge and, in the case of Seaton Carew, through Urban Programme initiatives and the Heritage Economic Regeneration Scheme (HERS) and in the Headland through the North Hartlepool Partnership SRB programme (see Diagram 2.1). 5.34 The Borough Council will encourage further improvements by the private sector and undertake environmental works on land in Commercial Improvement Areas where resources allow. In this respect, in West Central Hartlepool, the New Deal for Communities programme has included resources to provided grants and to undertake environmental improvements. 5.35 Further Commercial Improvement Areas will be considered to assist in the enhancement of areas and to give support and increase the vitality and viability of these commercial areas. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 65 POLICY Com 6 COMMERCIAL IMPROVEMENT AREAS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE ENVIRONMENTAL AND OTHER IMPROVEMENT AND ENHANCEMENT SCHEMES IN DESIGNATED COMMERCIAL IMPROVEMENT AREAS. AS AT MARCH 2006, THE AREAS DESIGNATED ARE: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ HEADLAND NORTHGATE RABY ROAD, MURRAY STREET, CHURCH STREET, AND SEATON CAREW. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CARRY OUT ENVIRONMENTAL AND IMPROVEMENT SCHEMES WHERE POSSIBLE ON BOTH COUNCIL AND PRIVATELY OWNED LAND. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO DECLARE COMMERCIAL IMPROVEMENT AREAS AS APPROPRIATE. FURTHER TEES BAY RETAIL PARK 5.36 The Tees Bay retail park was initially constructed in the mid to late 1980s under the terms of the Enterprise Zone scheme. The planning agreement attached to the permission enabled the development of certain leisure uses including a sports hall, cinema and fast food outlet, but restricted the type of goods sold from the retail units. Some of the units built on the site have never been occupied and others have for different reasons been vacated and never re-used. 5.37 The development is relatively remote from the residential areas of the town and not particularly convenient for shoppers in terms of encouraging travel by modes of transport other than the private car. Nevertheless the Borough Council has at times encouraged the occupation of the vacant units and agreed in principle to relaxing to a certain extent the restrictions on the uses. It is proposed to extend the site northwards towards Belle Vue Way where uses meeting the sequential approach and tests on need and accessibility might be located. 5.38 The existing units on the Tees Bay site are seen as appropriate for the sale of bulky goods in particular but not food and other convenience goods normally sold in the town centre. The site may be appropriate also for leisure uses provided that there is no significant adverse impact on the vitality and viability of the town centre. Proposals for shopping involving the change of use of the existing units or the erection of new units, however, would need to demonstrate need and that a sequential approach has been followed as would proposals for leisure and other commercial uses likely to attract a large number of visitors (see policies Com8 and Rec14). The legal agreement will be amended to accord with planning permissions granted. 5.39 The introduction of further uses into the enlarged area could help to stimulate further investment provided that they meet the sequential test and the need is justified. In this respect it is considered that additional leisure uses (including hotel accommodation) and business uses could be appropriately located on the site. 66 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Com 7 TEES BAY MIXED USE SITE TEES BAY IS IDENTIFIED FOR MIXED USES COMPRISING NON FOOD RETAIL, LEISURE AND BUSINESS USES PROVIDED THAT THEY ACCORD WITH POLICIES Com8, Com9 AND Rec14 RELATING TO SHOPPING AND MAIN TOWN CENTRE USES AND LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS AND POLICY Com12 RELATING TO FOOD AND DRINK. TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS WILL ALSO BE SOUGHT TO CONTROL THE TYPE OF GOODS SOLD FROM RETAIL PREMISES. MAJOR RETAIL AND OFFICE DEVELOPMENTS 5.40 As stated in paragraph 5.12 above a sequential approach should be adopted in the consideration of shopping and major traffic generating proposals such as major commercial and public office, entertainment and leisure developments. The approach means that first preference should be for town centre sites, followed by edge of centre sites with preference given to sites which are or will be well-connected to the centre and only then by out-of-centre sites in locations that are accessible by a choice of means of transport and which are close to the centre and have high likelihood of forming links with the centre. 5.41 The sequential approach for retail development to be adopted for Hartlepool in the context of the above is therefore as follows: 1. the primary shopping area where land is allocated for further retail development (see policies Com2 and Com3), 2. other sites within the town centre (subject to the provisions of policy Com1, 3. edge of centre locations readily accessible to the primary shopping area (see policy Com4), 4. Victoria Harbour, a regionally important regeneration area offering opportunities for increased accessibility and integration with the Marina edge of town centre area, then 5. other out-of-centre locations within the limits to development which are accessible by a choice of means of transport, particularly public transport, and which offer significant regeneration opportunities. Travel plans aimed at delivering sustainable transport objectives should be submitted for retail developments over 1000 sq.m. gross (see paragraph 8.71). Where appropriate the Borough Council may impose planning conditions or negotiate legally binding agreements to secure improvements to public transport, cycling and pedestrian accessibility to approved developments 5.42 The Hartlepool Retail Survey (updated 2005) found that there is currently no further capacity for new convenience floorspace and no capacity for convenience floorspace up to 2011 largely due to the opening in March 2004 of the WM Morrison’s store at Clarence Park. The town centre demonstrates a distinct lack of a large department HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 67 store and a deficiency of major national retailers. It is considered that the southern and western extension to the Middleton Grange Shopping centre could provide the opportunity for new comparison floorspace. This extension would absorb any capacity for comparison goods in the medium term. The study also recommended that stand alone retail warehouse stores should not be permitted unless the qualitative offer is considered exceptional. 5.43 The Retail Study emphasises that there has been a sporadic distribution of retail warehousing around the Borough and it would be preferable to form a better critical mass of such retailing. To encourage such a consolidation there may be opportunities, by means of planning agreements (see policy GEP9) to rationalise or relocate some existing facilities in the event of planning permission being granted for additional floorspace on sites meeting the sequential approach outlined in policy Com8 below. Such negotiated obligations could facilitate the relocation of existing less accessible shopping facilities to more sustainable sites served by transport other than the private car. Opportunities will be sought to secure the cessation of inappropriately located retail sites and any necessary clearance and after use treatment to achieve significant environmental improvements of such sites. 5.44 A retail impact assessment will need to be submitted with any proposal for major retail development outside the primary shopping area to ensure that it will not harm the vitality and viability of the town and local centres. 5.45 Although smaller scale convenience goods stores below 500 square metres are found in the primary shopping area of the town centre, very often they serve a more local function. In order to ensure that this type of store serves the local community they should as far as practical be located in or close to the local centres. Where such sites cannot be made available they should be located in areas well served by public transport and be easily accessible to customers travelling on foot or by cycle. In particular proposals for stores over 1000 sq.metres (10,750 sq.ft.) should be accompanied by travel plans aimed at delivering sustainable transport objectives and where appropriate the Borough Council may impose planning conditions or negotiate legally binding agreements to secure improvements to public transport, cycling and pedestrian accessibility to approved developments. 68 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Com8 SHOPPING DEVELOPMENT THE PREFERRED LOCATIONS FOR SHOPPING DEVELOPMENT ARE: WITHIN HARTLEPOOL TOWN CENTRE AS INDICATED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, EDGE-OF-CENTRE SITES (AS SET OUT IN POLICY Com4), THE OUT OF CENTRE VICTORIA HARBOUR REGENERATION AREA, THEN OTHER OUT OF CENTRE LOCATIONS ACCESSIBLE BY A CHOICE OF MEANS OF TRANSPORT AND WHICH OFFER SIGNIFICANT REGENERATION BENEFITS. ALL PROPOSALS FOR RETAIL DEVELOPMENT FOR 500 SQUARE METRES GROSS OR MORE AND LOCATED OUTSIDE THE PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA WILL BE REQUIRED TO DEMONSTATE NEED, TO JUSTIFY THAT THE SCALE IS APPROPRIATE TO THE AREA, AND TO DEMONSTRATE THAT THE SEQUENTIAL APPROACH ON LOCATION HAS BEEN FOLLOWED. FOR RETAIL PROPOSALS BETWEEN 500 SQUARE METRES GROSS AND 2499 SQUARE METRES GROSS THE APPLICANT SHOULD AGREE WITH THE BOROUGH COUNCIL PRIOR TO ANY SUBMISSION OF PLANNING APPLICATION WHETHER A RETAIL IMPACT ASSESSMENT WILL BE REQUIRED. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL IN DETERMINING WHETHER A RETAIL IMPACT ASSESSMENT IS REQUIRED WILL TAKE ACCOUNT OF:THE LIKELY EFFECT ON THE VITALITY AND VIABILITY OF THE TOWN CENTRE AND NEARBY CENTRES, THE LIKELY EFFECT ON LOCAL CENTRES, AND THE APPROPRIATENESS OF THE SCALE OF DEVELOPMENT. ALL RETAIL PROPOSALS OVER 2500 SQUARE METRES GROSS MUST BE ACCOMPANIED BY A RETAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENTS OVER 1000 SQUARE METRES AND CONSIDERATION MAY BE GIVEN, WHERE APPROPRIATE, TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE RATIONALISATION OF RETAIL PROVISION (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). CONDITIONS WILL BE ATTACHED TO PLANNING PERMISSIONS TO CONTROL HOURS OF OPERATIONS IN THE INTERESTS OF AMENITY. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 69 5.46 Offices attracting large numbers of visitors should also, as far as practicable, be located in the town centre. There is some vacant office accommodation in the town centre including 18,700sq.ft at Titan House. Other sites within the edge of town centre areas which could accommodate office uses (subject to the sequential approach in Com9) include the marina site fronting Maritime Avenue (see policies Com4 and Com8) and Lynn Street North / Mainsforth Terrace North (see paragraph 5.19a (viii) and Policies Com4 and Com7). 5.47 Office uses falling within Class B1 of the Use Classes Order could be located in the town centre, although they may also located on industrial sites. POLICY Com9 MAIN TOWN CENTRE USES RETAIL, OFFICE, BUSINESS, CULTURAL, TOURISM DEVELOPMENTS, LEISURE, ENTERTAINMENT AND OTHER MAIN TOWN CENTRE USES LIKELY TO ATTRACT LARGE NUMBER OF VISITORS SHOULD BE LOCATED IN THE TOWN CENTRE AS DEFINED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP. PROPOSALS FOR SUCH USES OUTSIDE THE TOWN CENTRE WILL ONLY BE ACCEPTABLE WHERE THE NEED FOR THE DEVELOPMENT HAS BEEN JUSTIFIED. WHERE A NEED HAS BEEN JUSTIFIED FOR THE DEVELOPMENT, PROPOSALS MUST ALSO DEMONSTRATE THAT THE SCALE AND NATURE OF THE DEVELOPMENT ARE APPROPRIATE TO THE CHARACTER OF THE AREA AND THAT THE VITALITY AND VIABILITY OF THE TOWN CENTRE AND OTHER CENTRES ARE NOT PREJUDICED. FOR PROPOSALS OUTSIDE THE TOWN CENTRE A SEQUENTIAL APPROACH FOR SITE SELECTION WILL BE APPLIED. SUCH LOCATIONS MUST BE ACCESSIBLE AND WELL SERVED BY A CHOICE OF MEANS OF TRANSPORT. THE PREFERRED SEQUENCE OF LOCATIONS IS AS FOLLOWS: 1. EDGE-OF-CENTRE SITES INCLUDING THE MARINA (AS SET OUT IN POLICY Com4), THEN 2. THE OUT OF CENTRE VICTORIA HARBOUR REGENERATION AREA (SEE POLICY Com15), THEN 3. OTHER OUT OF CENTRE LOCATIONS ACCESSIBLE BY A CHOICE OF MEANS OF TRANSPORT AND WHICH WILL BRING SIGNIFICANT REGENERATION OPPORTUNITIES. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS SHOULD ALSO ACCORD WHERE RELEVANT WITH POLICIES Com8 (SHOPPING DEVELOPMENT), To9 (TOURIST ACCOMMODATION) REC14 (MAJOR LEISURE USES) AND Com12 (FOOD & DRINK). TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). 5.48 70 Proposals for major leisure developments should accord with policy Rec14 below. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 RETAILING IN INDUSTRIAL AREAS 5.49 POLICY Com10 The Borough Council does not consider that new retail developments are appropriate on land identified for industrial purposes for a number of reasons. The Council wishes to concentrate shopping provision in the town centre and local centres, which are readily accessible to the public by means of transport other than the private car. Most industrial sites are either distant from or on the periphery of housing areas. Further, whilst there is likely to be adequate industrial land to meet foreseeable requirements, new retailing activity in industrial areas may prejudice the types of industrial developments that could be located in its vicinity. Certain retail uses, however, including those combining industrial and retail activities or serving the working population of the immediate area may be appropriately located in industrial areas. RETAILING IN INDUSTRIAL AREAS RETAIL DEVELOPMENT WHICH WOULD BE APPROPRIATELY LOCATED IN THE TOWN CENTRE WILL NOT BE PERMITTED IN IDENTIFIED INDUSTRIAL AREAS. SUBJECT TO POLICY Com8 TYPES OF RETAILING WHICH MAY BE ACCEPTABLE IN INDUSTRIAL AREAS INCLUDE THE FOLLOWING: ♦ ♦ ♦ RETAIL OUTLETS ANCILLARY TO THE MAIN USE OF PREMISES AS MANUFACTURING UNITS, MOTOR VEHICLE DEALERSHIPS, PETROL FILLING STATIONS AND CAR WASHES, AND PLUMBERS AND BUILDERS MERCHANTS PRIMARILY SERVING TRADE CUSTOMERS A3, A4, A5 (FOOD AND DRINK) USES PRIMARILY SERVING PEOPLE WORKING IN THE AREA MAY ALSO BE ACCEPTABLE. PETROL FILLING STATIONS 5.50 There is one petrol filling station complex in the Borough serving traffic travelling along on the A19. However there are service areas at Wolviston immediately to the south and at Easington to the north. Thus there is no need for new sites to provide additional facilities for through traffic on this road. Facilities alongside other roads in the Borough should be located within the main urban area of the town, to be available as a service both to motorists within and coming into the town. Owing to the nature of the developments they are best located away from residential areas, preferably either in or near local shopping areas or in industrial areas. 5.51 The primary function of petrol filling stations is selling fuels and related motoring accessories, but many also sell other convenience goods including tinned and frozen goods not directly related to the needs of the travelling motorist. In instances where this may undermine the viability of nearby local shops it may be appropriate to restrict the area permitted for retailing. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 71 POLICY Com11 PETROL FILLING STATIONS PETROL FILLING STATIONS WILL BE PERMITTED WITHIN THE URBAN AREA OF HARTLEPOOL PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY RESIDENTS OR ON THE CHARACTER AND APPEARANCE OF THE AREA, THEY WILL NOT LEAD TO TRAFFIC CONGESTION OR OTHERWISE ADVERSELY AFFECT HIGHWAY SAFETY, AND ASSOCIATED RETAIL PROVISION IS SUBJECT TO POLICY Com8. PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE ATTACHED TO APPROVALS RESTRICTING THE AREA ALLOWED FOR ASSOCIATED RETAILING IN ORDER TO PROTECT THE VITALITY AND VIABILITY OF NEARBY LOCAL SHOPPING AREAS. FOOD AND DRINK 5.52 The Use Classes (amendment) Order 2005 covers a variety of food and drink premises. Class A3 includes restaurants, snack bars and cafes whilst A4 covers pubs and restaurant. A separate A5 class relates to hot food take-aways. Planning permission is now required to change from one use class to another food and drink use class. These uses can give rise to different types of ‘nuisance’ not usually associated with other retail uses including noise, disturbance, litter, and smell, and in the case of hot food takeaways in particular, problems of highway safety associated with short term casual parking. Thus such uses are best located in parts of the town centre, some mixed use areas and in local centres away from residential properties and where they do not detract from the character, function and appearance of the area. They are not generally appropriate in predominantly residential areas. 5.53 Careful consideration therefore needs to be given to proposals for food and drink uses even those located in commercial areas where there may also be residential accommodation. Notwithstanding any requirement for licensing of premises under separate legislation (including the Licensing Act 2003), conditions can be attached to planning permissions for such uses to protect the amenity of the surrounding area. Such conditions can restrict opening hours where there are nearby residential properties. They can also require the provision of ventilation and sound insulation where necessary. In order to mitigate the effects of developments, contributions may be negotiated and legal agreements may be sought to cover such items as security and litter clearance. (see Policy GEP9 and Supplementary Note 8). 5.54 Where proposals for food and drink uses are likely to give rise to noise and disturbance nuisance, particularly during the night and early morning, they should accord with the provisions of policy Rec13 which seeks to direct uses operating at unsocial hours to limited areas within Church Street and parts of the Marina. 72 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Com 12 FOOD AND DRINK PROPOSALS FOR FOOD AND DRINK DEVELOPMENTS (FALLING WITHIN CLASS A3, A4 AND A5 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) (AMENDMENT) ORDER 2005 WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. ii. iii. iv. THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES BY REASON OF NOISE, DISTURBANCE, SMELL, OR LITTER, THEY WILL NOT LEAD TO TRAFFIC CONGESTION OR OTHERWISE ADVERSELY AFFECT HIGHWAY SAFETY, THERE IS NO ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE CHARACTER, APPEARANCE AND FUNCTION OF THE SURROUNDING AREA, AND WHERE LOCATED IN INDUSTRIAL AREAS, THEY ACCORD WITH POLICY Com10. IN ORDER TO PROTECT THE AMENITY OF THE AREA, PLANNING CONDITIONS WILL BE ATTACHED TO PERMISSIONS: ♦ ♦ ♦ TO RESTRICT THE HOURS OF OPENING, TO ENSURE THE PROVISION OF SATISFACTORY VENTILATION AND SOUND INSULATION, AND/OR TO EXCLUDE CHANGE TO OTHER USES WITHIN THE SAME CLASS. HOT FOOD TAKEAWAY USES (A5 USE CLASS) WILL NOT BE PERMITTED IN PREDOMINANTLY RESIDENTIAL AREAS WHERE THEY ADJOIN RESIDENTIAL PROPERTIES. PROPOSALS FOR FOOD AND DRINK USES SHOULD ALSO ACCORD WITH THE PROVISIONS OF POLICY Rec13. WHERE NECESSARY DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS WILL BE NEGOTIATED TO MITIGATE THE EFFECTS OF DEVELOPMENTS AND LEGAL AGREEMENTS WILL BE SOUGHT (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). COMMERCIAL USES WITHIN RESIDENTIAL AREAS 5.55 In the older areas of the town, there are pockets of small industrial, business, shopping or other commercial uses sometimes intermingled with other uses. These are not of a sufficient intensity to be included within the defined local centres and are generally located within larger areas where housing predominates. An intensification of non-residential uses, for example, by large extensions to existing premises or new use of dwellings, may cause difficulties relating to parking and servicing, and may harm the amenities of the occupiers of residential properties in particular. 5.56 Policy Com5 seeks to concentrate commercial development in the defined local centres. The Borough Council will therefore in general support proposals involving the redevelopment or conversion to residential use of commercial properties located in housing areas (see policy Hsg7) except where, as in the case of ‘corner shops’ for example, they provide an essential local service (see policy Rur6). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 73 5.57 POLICY Com13 Some larger non-residential properties located within their own grounds, however, could be appropriately retained for commercial uses (including offices and smallerscale leisure developments) subject to the potential impact on the amenities of the surrounding area and on its character. In this respect, such developments should be able to satisfactorily accommodate car parking and servicing requirements within the curtilage of the property. COMMERCIAL USES IN RESIDENTIAL AREAS PROPOSALS FOR INDUSTRIAL, BUSINESS, LEISURE AND OTHER COMMERCIAL DEVELOPMENT, OR FOR THEIR EXPANSION, WILL NOT BE PERMITTED IN PREDOMINANTLY RESIDENTIAL AREAS OUTSIDE THE DEFINED LOCAL CENTRES UNLESS: i. ii. iii. iv. THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PREMISES BY REASON OF NOISE, SMELL, DUST OR EXCESSIVE TRAFFIC GENERATION, THE DESIGN, SCALE AND IMPACT IS COMPATIBLE WITH THE CHARACTER AND AMENITY OF THE SITE AND THE SURROUNDING AREA, AND APPROPRIATE SERVICING AND PARKING PROVISION CAN BE MADE (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES 1 AND 2), AND THEY ACCORD WITH THE PROVISIONS OF Com8, Com9 AND Rec14. WORKING FROM HOME 5.58 Working from home can involve a range of activities from running a catalogue agency to repairing cars. Some may have little or no impact on surrounding properties. Others may cause significant problems. Planning permission is often not required provided that the main use of the dwelling remains as a family home, there are no employees at the house, and there is no nuisance caused to neighbouring properties. Nuisance can be caused by the nature of the activity itself giving rise to noise, dust, fumes etc., or by an increase in traffic generated by deliveries or callers. 5.59 Planning permission is required, however, where the business becomes dominant or intrusive and changes the overall character of a dwelling house as a residence. The Borough Council in such circumstance will not normally grant permission. POLICY Com14 BUSINESS USES IN THE HOME PROPOSALS FOR BUSINESS ACTIVITIES IN THE HOME WHICH REQUIRE PLANNING PERMISSION WILL NOT BE APPROVED UNLESS: i. ii. 74 THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES, OR ON THE CHARACTER OF THE PREMISES OR ITS AREA, BY REASON OF THE GENERATION OF VISITORS, TRAFFIC, NOISE, DUST, SMELL, VIBRATION OR FUMES, AND THE DOMESTIC APPEARANCE OF THE PROPERTY IS NOT SIGNIFICANTLY ALTERED. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 MIXED USE AREAS 5.60 The identification, in the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan, of parts of the central area of Hartlepool as locations for a wide range of uses has enabled their substantial regeneration as vibrant and viable amenities for both residents and visitors to the town. In particular, the Church Street and the Marina areas have been regenerated and now contain a wide range of uses including shopping, leisure facilities and residential accommodation. This plan includes the Church Street area and a small part of the Marina within the town centre, for a wide range of uses and also continues to identify the main part of the Marina area for mixed use development (see policy Com4). In addition it identifies several additional areas (Victoria Harbour /North Docks, Hartlepool Headland and land west of the A179 which are also appropriate for mixed development as part of regeneration and/or redevelopment initiatives (see policies Com15, Com16 and Com17 below). Victoria Harbour/ North Docks 5.61 The Victoria Harbour Master Plan proposes a substantial number of units of high quality housing together with commercial and office development. There will be scope for a major tourist-leisure focus which will capitalise on the assets of the site, attract visitors, and generate additional economic benefits to the town and the wider Tees Valley area. The proposals also include: • retail warehousing, convenience and speciality shopping; (subject to policy Com8); • construction of a new pedestrian/cycleway bridge linking Victoria Harbour with the Headland; • provision of open space and a coastal promenade; HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 75 • • • POLICY Com 15 improved accessibility and linkages through public and private transport to the Headland, Marina and town centre; provision of a range of community facilities and services; and appropriate community, health and education provision. VICTORIA HARBOUR/ NORTH DOCKS MIXED USE SITE PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT AT VICTORIA HARBOUR /THE NORTH DOCKS WILL BE PERMITTED FOR A MIXTURE OF USES WHERE THEY TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE SITE’S UNIQUE POTENTIAL INCLUDING ITS WATER FRONT LOCATION AND ITS LINKS TO THE MARINA AND THE HEADLAND. PROPOSALS FOR RETAIL, BUSINESS, OFFICE, HOTEL, TOURISM, LEISURE AND RESIDENTIAL DEVELOPMENT (FALLING WITHIN CLASSES A1, A3, A4, A5, B1, C1, C3, D1 AND D2 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) (AMENDMENT) ORDER 2005 WILL BE PERMITTED PROVIDED THAT THEY: i. DO NOT SIGNIFICANTLY ADVERSELY AFFECT THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES, ii. DO NOT UNDULY CONSTRAIN CONTINUING PORT AND PORT RELATED OPERATIONS, AND iii. SATISFY POLICIES Com8, Com9 AND Rec14. PROPOSALS FOR PORT, PORT RELATED DEVELOPMENT OR GENERAL INDUSTRY WILL BE APPROVED SUBJECT TO THE GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINCIPLES SET OUT IN POLICY GEP1. A HIGH QUALITY OF DESIGN WILL BE REQUIRED AND SUBSTANTIAL LANDSCAPING SHOULD BE PROVIDED WHERE DEVELOPMENTS BOUND THE A179 MARINA WAY AND A1048 HEADLAND APPROACH (see POLICY GEP7). DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE NEED FOR: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ FLOOD RISK ASSESSMENT (see POLICY Dco2), SAFE AND CONVENIENT PEDESTRIAN AND CYCLE ROUTES INCLUDING THE COASTAL WALKWAY (SEE POLICIES Rec9, Tra5 AND Tra8), APPROPRIATE PUBLIC ACCESS TO WATERFRONT AND COASTAL AREAS, AND APPROPRIATE DESIGN AND OTHER REQUIREMENTS AS SET OUT IN POLICIES Hsg6, Hsg9, GEP7, GEP9 AND HE3. Hartlepool Headland 5.62 The Headland is the original core of the town and has a long history with associations with St Hilda and with seafaring. Despite its historic importance, clearances and a lack of investment has resulted in a neglected asset and the area is now included within the North Hartlepool Partnership’s single regeneration budget programme. The vision for the Headland set out in the regeneration study for the Headland 6 ‘is to reclaim a bold and proud identity for the area and its people by promoting a 6 ‘Hartlepool Headland Regeneration Study’ prepared by the SQW/BBP Partnership for One North East and Hartlepool Borough Council – May 2000. 76 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 comprehensive programme of sustainable regeneration that will make the most of its exciting assets, develop a sound economic base and create an attractive environment for the community, visitors, businesses and investors’. 5.63 Investment in the Headland has been limited and the study considers that there is a need for substantial public investment to create the environment to encourage new private development. There are several key sites and buildings within the Headland which offer opportunities for mixed use development including tourism and community facilities, housing and some specialist retail and small workshop development. These sites include: ♦ the Nun Street area which may be included in a commercial improvement area; ♦ the Middlegate area, where housing together with commercial uses sensitive to the historic character of the area could be developed around a town square; and ♦ the Manor House / Friarage site, where there may be opportunities for tourism/community facilities and limited infill housing development. 5.64 Land bounding Victoria Harbour (Kafiga Landing and Heerema site) is an area with important water frontage within the Headland area. The site is included as part of the Victoria Harbour / North Docks mixed use site where development may include a major tourism attraction in association with visitor-oriented retail use, small craft workshops and quality housing (see policy Com15). 5.65 It will be important that developments in the Headland respect the maritime and Christian heritage of the area and those within or adjoining the conservation area will need to preserve or enhance its special character (see policies HE1 and HE3 below). The Headland also has important wildlife interests. Development proposals should seek to ensure that there is no significant adverse effect on the wildlife interest of the area. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 77 POLICY Com16 HEADLAND – MIXED USES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE DEVELOPMENT ON THE HEADLAND WHICH WILL: ♦ ♦ ♦ PROPOSALS FOR STRENGTHEN TOURISM AND ESTABLISHED ECONOMIC ACTIVITIES TO INCREASE LOCAL EMPLOYMENT AND PROSPERITY FOR THE AREA, OR WIDEN THE MIX OF HOUSING INVESTMENT TO MEET LOCAL NEEDS, AND CONSERVE AND RENEW THE ENVIRONMENTAL HERITAGE OF THE AREA TO PROTECT AND REINFORCE ITS HISTORIC IDENTITY. PROPOSALS FOR SMALL-SCALE RETAIL, OFFICES AND WORKSHOPS, LEISURE AND EDUCATIONAL USES AND HOUSING DEVELOPMENTS (INCLUDING A MIXTURE OF SUCH USES) WILL BE APPROVED IN THE FOLLOWING MIXED USE AREAS WHERE THEY MEET ANY OF THE ABOVE AIMS AND PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. THEY ARE OF AN APPROPRIATE SCALE AND COMPLEMENT THE HISTORIC AND CULTURAL CHARACTER OF THE AREA (SEE ALSO POLICIES HE1 AND HE3), THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE AMENITY OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING AND NEARBY PROPERTIES AND THE NEW DEVELOPMENT, THEY DO NOT UNDULY CONSTRAIN THE COMMERCIAL OPERATIONS OF NEARBY OCCUPIERS, AND THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE WILDLIFE INTEREST OF THE AREA. THE MIXED USE AREAS ARE: a. b. c. MIDDLEGATE, NUN STREET, AND THE MANOR HOUSE. WHERE APPROPRIATE, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ACQUIRE LAND, BY COMPULSORY PURCHASE WHERE NECESSARY, IN ORDER TO FACILITATE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY GEP15). Land West of the A179 5.66 78 The construction of the A179 dual carriageway northwards through the Greenland Road industrial area effectively segregated the land west of the new road from the main part of the docks and associated industrial land. The railway siding to the docks runs on an embankment through the northern part of this area. The land to the south of the siding closest to the mixed-use marina area is highly visible from the new road. It could therefore provide an attractive location to a range of developments including offices and other commercial developments such as drivethru restaurants, budget hotels or car sales showrooms seeking a main road frontage. The Borough Council considers the land should no longer be identified for HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 general industrial or port-related uses for which adequate land is identified in policies Ind5 and Ind7 above. 5.67 Convenience retailing is not considered appropriate on this land as it is not well located in relation to housing in the area. Shops selling comparison goods and requiring large areas of land for storage (bulky goods stores) will only be acceptable if the criteria set out in policy Com8 above are met. 5.68 Development on this land will have to be particularly well-designed and landscaped as the area is bounded by the main transport routes through the town (both road and rail) and is also overlooked by housing in Lancaster Road. POLICY Com17 LAND WEST OF A179 / NORTH OF MIDDLETON ROAD PROPOSALS FOR COMMERCIAL DEVELOPMENTS, EXCLUDING CONVENIENCE RETAILING, BUT INCLUDING OFFICES, LEISURE FACILITIES, AND OTHER USES WHICH BY THEIR NATURE WOULD BE APPROPRIATELY LOCATED ON A MAIN ROAD FRONTAGE, WILL BE APPROVED ON THE LAND WEST OF THE A179 (NORTH OF MIDDLETON ROAD) PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. THEY DO NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE VITALITY AND VIABILITY OF THE TOWN CENTRE AND LOCAL CENTRES, THEY ARE TO A PARTICULARLY HIGH STANDARD OF DESIGN AND LANDSCAPING, AND THEY COMFORM TO RELEVANT POLICIES Com8 (SHOPPING DEVELOPMENT) Com9 (MAIN TOWN CENTRE USES) AND Rec14 (MAJOR LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 79 80 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 6. TOURISM CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 6.1 The development of tourism is closely linked to the image of the town, its recreational, cultural and leisure facilities, and to its natural assets such as the beaches and dunes. As a result, leisure, recreation and the natural environment are all closely linked. Tourism has become an integral part of the economy – directly, in terms of providing jobs and indirectly, in terms of attracting visitors and spending into the town. In 2003, tourism expenditure was worth £30.19 million to the economy of Hartlepool. This was an increase of 18% from 1999. 6.2 Aspects of tourism, such as business tourism, short and specialist breaks and particularly day visits are likely to grow in importance. In recent years, much of the Marina has been developed (including the Historic Quay and Museum of Hartlepool together with Jackson’s Landing and other shopping attractions). In addition to this, Christ Church has been converted into an art gallery and tourist information centre and its tower used as a viewing point. These add to existing attractions such as St. Hilda's Church and the Headland, HMS Trincomalee, archaeological and nature conservation sites and the Scheduled Ancient Monuments. 6.3 The Hartlepool Community Strategy seeks to support and develop Hartlepool’s tourism industry especially in the Marina/Town Centre, Seaton Carew and the Headland. Tourism development in the built-up area of Hartlepool is thus being promoted on these three fronts: • town centre/marina as the main attraction catering for a range of visitor interests including specialist shopping, restaurants and museums, • the Headland, the historic core of Hartlepool, suitable for tourism-related projects of a potentially more modest scale, • Seaton Carew providing opportunities for the further development of seaside based recreational and leisure activities. The Victoria Harbour area is now seen as a key location for tourism development over the coming years. The site will build on the existing critical mass of tourism developments, providing crucial links between tourism areas at the Marina / town centre and the Headland. 6.4 Other visitor attractions in Hartlepool include Summerhill and the important nature conservation sites along much of the coast such as the Teesmouth Field Centre and the National Nature Reserve. 6.5 An increase in tourist interest could result in new jobs being created in the town in the service sector. This would help to balance the employment structure of the town as, in addition to the direct jobs supported at established tourist projects (attractions/hotels etc.), employment will also be created elsewhere in the economy as the projects use their income to buy in goods and services from the surrounding area. In addition to these primary effects, secondary employment effects would be generated as visitors, attracted to the town by the projects, spend money outside the projects in the surrounding businesses. 6.6 Tourism projects can have a positive impact on people’s image of an area and can lead to increased confidence and the likelihood of investment. Local residents have HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 81 a role to play in changing the perceptions of others, especially as a high proportion of tourists will be visiting friends and relatives rather than staying in commercial accommodation. Hartlepool has a higher proportion of visitors in this respect than the rest of the Northumbria Tourist Board area. It is equally important that tourism projects can change the attitude of developers towards investment in the area, if the correct image can be conveyed. 6.7 The Borough Council does not expect to solve the problems of unemployment in the town through tourism alone. Tourism and the economic benefits it generates can, however, play a role in complementing the continuing future of Hartlepool. This is reflected in the Tees Valley Partnership Single Programme Action Plan which includes a package of tourism related regeneration projects including HMS Trincomalee project, Hartlepool Events and the Tourism Strategy. The Borough Council will actively seek the development of major visitor attractions, which may attract lottery funding and further private investment. 6.8 Hartlepool has many valuable assets which can be utilised to attract tourists such as its historical and maritime heritage. Surveys show that more than a third of all visitors who come to the town do so because of its maritime heritage and connections with the sea. Its coastal areas offer great potential for the provision of those new leisure-based attractions which can complement wildlife interests such as nature reserves and nature conservation interpretative facilities. Emerging Regional Spatial Strategy 6.9 Policy 16 of the Submission Draft Regional Spatial Strategy sets out the framework for developing new and improving existing tourism developments within the region. It recognises that there has been considerable investment and growth in the sector and that this growth is expected to continue. It states that tourist facilities and services that will increase the international and national profile and attractiveness of the region should be supported and developed in both urban and rural areas. Structure Plan Policies 6.10 The Tees Valley Structure Plan addresses tourism through its policies L1, L9 and L10. Policy L1 sets out the broad framework for tourism development in the Tees Valley in terms of its most suitable location, accessibility and environmental impact. In policy L9, the structure plan identifies the need for an increased range and choice of tourist facilities and also the need to encourage the use of public transport serving them. Policy L10 highlights the need for a sustainable relationship between tourism and the environment. It states that tourism must not be allowed to have unacceptable impacts on its surrounding environment. 6.11 The Borough Council has taken these strategic policies relating to tourism into account and has developed tourism policies in the local plan to complement them. Local Plan Objectives 6.12 In conjunction with the main aim of the plan, the following objectives are particularly relevant to tourism; A1 A2 A4 82 to encourage the provision of more and higher quality job opportunities to ensure that sites are available for the full range of industrial and commercial activities so as to enable the diversification of employment opportunities to promote the growth of tourism HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 A6 A7 B3 B4 C1 C3 C5 C8 C9 C10 D2 D3 to improve the viability and environment of older housing, commercial and industrial areas to promote development on previously used sites where appropriate, and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings to encourage in accessible locations the provision of sport, recreational, leisure and cultural developments to cater for the whole community to protect and encourage the development of local shopping, leisure sporting and recreational and other community facilities at locations convenient to main neighbourhoods to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest to seek to create a green network within the main urban area to direct the future protection, management and improvement of open space for people and wildlife to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas, and to make them more accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings to promote developments in locations which support existing transport infrastructure, which minimise the need to travel, and which are accessible by all modes of transport to ensure that developments attracting large numbers of people locate in existing centres which are highly accessible by means other than the private car. POLICIES AND PROPOSALS THE TOWN CENTRE AND THE MARINA 6.13 This local plan will seek to pursue the development of the town centre as the main shopping, commercial and social centre of Hartlepool (see policy Com1 above). With the continued improvements to Middleton Grange Shopping Centre and the attractive open spaces of Victory, Wesley and Church Squares now completed, much of the town centre creates a positive impression on visitors to the town. The West Central New Deal for Communities (NDC) area may provide opportunities to encourage further improvement and development in the town centre that will be to the well being of residents of the area and its increased attractiveness to visitors. 6.14 The marina area has also developed significantly over the last ten years, with various developers on site, complementing the major improvements achieved in the town centre under the City Challenge programme. The Marina is identified as an area for mixed uses including leisure facilities and residential accommodation (see Policy Com4/10 above) and will continue to be a major focus for tourism activity and be further enhanced to increase its attractiveness to potential investors and tourists. In this respect, the protection of waters within the marina complex is important for the continued attractiveness of the area for recreation in the form of water sports and coastal wildlife conservation. It is therefore important to retain and enhance access to the water and Marina. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 83 POLICY To1 TOURISM DEVELOPMENT IN THE MARINA THE MARINA WILL CONTINUE TO BE DEVELOPED AS A MAJOR TOURIST ATTRACTION. TOURIST RELATED FACILITIES WILL BE ENCOURAGED TO COMPLEMENT THOSE ATTRACTIONS ALREADY IN PLACE. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROTECT THE AREAS OF WATER WITHIN THE MARINA FROM DEVELOPMENT, RETAINING THE AMBIENCE AND ATTRACTION OF THE MARINA DEVELOPMENT AS A WHOLE. THE HEADLAND 6.15 The Headland area is of great interest in view of its long history, as shown by its archaeological sites, its architecture and its cultural resources. Much of the area is included in the Headland Conservation Area. The setting of the Headland, with views across Hartlepool Bay and features such as the Fish Quay, gives rise to visitor potential. Moreover, archaeological and historical sites on the Headland offer opportunities for appropriate visitor attractions. For example, the wealth of archaeological artifacts known to be on the Headland has attracted interest from the television series ‘Time Team’ who uncovered parts of the ancient Anglo-Saxon burial ground in September 1999. 6.16 The Headland Regeneration Study (referred to in paragraph 5.62 above) concluded that tourism development should provide the catalyst to turn the Headland around and kick start the process of comprehensive regeneration. It proposes major environmental improvements, new visitor attractions and mixed use developments on key infill sites and buildings in the urban core and along the quayside. The Fish Restaurant project that is being developed as part of the Victoria Harbour scheme will be based at Kafiga Landing on the Headland. It is envisaged that the restaurant will help to kick-start the tourism sector on the Headland, linking in with other key initiatives within Hartlepool, whilst competing on a sub-regional/regional level within the restaurant market. 6.17 Proposals for improving parts of the area through general conservation and enhancement of the environment are likely to be developed through regeneration projects within the North Hartlepool Partnership SRB programme. These projects will help to create further visitor-related facilities as well as community based, economic and housing improvements on the Headland (see also paragraph 5.63 above). POLICY To2 TOURISM AT THE HEADLAND PROPOSALS FOR VISITOR-RELATED DEVELOPMENTS WITHIN THE HEADLAND WILL BE APPROVED WHERE THEY ARE SENSITIVE TO THE SETTING, CHARACTER AND MARITIME AND CHRISTIAN HERITAGE OF THE AREA. SEATON CAREW 6.18 84 Seaton Carew, in contrast to the Headland, is recognised as an area for more commercial forms of family entertainment and special interests related to the sea and HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 beaches. The Borough Council considers that the main commercial and leisure activities in Seaton Carew should be situated in a core area along both sides of The Front between Station Lane and South End. Public consultation on a Draft Tourism Strategy for Seaton Carew took place in May 2003. The Strategy was adopted in September 2003. The Strategy has been drawn up in an attempt to rejuvenate Seaton Carew as a visitor destination. Through the Strategy funding will be drawn into the area to carry out key work/improvements to objectives highlighted within the Strategy. Development proposals affecting properties within the Conservation Area will be required to preserve or enhance the character or appearance of the area (see policy HE1 below). Parts of the core area are also included in the Seaton Carew commercial improvement area, and at present certain areas can benefit from Heritage Economic Regeneration Scheme (HERS) grant assistance to improve businesses and properties in the area (see also paragraph 5.35 and policy Com6 above). POLICY To3 CORE AREA OF SEATON CAREW PROPOSALS FOR COMMERCIAL AND LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS WITHIN THE CORE AREA OF SEATON CAREW, AS DEFINED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, WILL BE PERMITTED WHERE THEY ARE SYMPATHETIC TO THE CHARACTER OF THE AREA AND ARE IN KEEPING WITH THE DEVELOPMENT OF SEATON CAREW AS A SEASIDE RESORT. 6.19 Key development sites and other potential sites for leisure development at Seaton Carew have been identified such as under-used areas along the seaward side of The Front. The site behind the bus station on The Front, the former amusement park and the coach park, all located within the core area of Seaton Carew, are considered suitable for more intensive leisure and commercial facilities. Replacement parking will be sought should these sites be developed. Should some of the activities along The Front, such as the putting green, or paddling pool be displaced as a result of new development, then they should be relocated in Seaton Park (see paragraph 6.23 below). 6.20 Planning permission has recently lapsed for a pub/restaurant development at the former baths site. The site is considered appropriate for similar development of a less intensive nature. 6.21 Two other areas of Seaton Carew at Coronation Drive and south of the Seaton Carew Cricket Club have potential for less intensive recreational/sporting uses. These are referred to in paragraph 11.28 and policy Rec7. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 85 POLICY To4 COMMERCIAL DEVELOPMENT SITES AT SEATON CAREW THE FOLLOWING SITES ARE IDENTIFIED FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF COMMERCIAL AND RECREATIONAL FACILITIES WHICH WILL ENHANCE THE ATTRACTION OF SEATON CAREW FOR BOTH RESIDENTS AND VISITORS: a. LAND TO REAR OF THE BUS STATION PROVIDED THE DEVELOPMENT IS APPROPRIATE TO THE CHARACTER AND SETTING OF THE LISTED BUILDING (0.7HA), b. LAND AT THE FORMER AMUSEMENT PARK AND AT THE CURRENT COACH PARK SOUTH OF THE CENTRE OF SEATON CAREW (1.1HA), c. LAND TO THE NORTH OF LONGSCAR CENTRE (0.5HA), AND d. FORMER BATHS SITE (0.6HA) SITES a, b and c ARE CONSIDERED SUITABLE FOR MORE INTENSIVE COMMERCIAL AND RECREATIONAL DEVELOPMENT AS THEY ARE LOCATED WITHIN THE CORE AREA WHILST SITE d IS CONSIDERED SUITABLE FOR A LESS INTENSIVE USE. WHERE EXISTING ACTIVITIES ARE DISPLACED BY NEW DEVELOPMENT, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL REQUIRE THAT REPLACEMENT FACILITIES ARE PROVIDED IN SEATON PARK (SEE ALSO POLICIES GEP9 AND To6). North Shelter 6.22 POLICY To5 It may be that the structure of the underused North Shelter, which lies within the Seaton Carew Conservation Area, could be adapted to enable its use for activities associated with the beach. Possible uses could be for kiosks and/or as a base for windsurfing or other beach activities. Care will have to be taken that development will preserve or enhance the character or appearance of the Conservation Area (see policy HE1) and that the amenities of the area are safeguarded. NORTH SHELTER THE NORTH SHELTER IS IDENTIFIED FOR SMALL SCALE COMMERCIAL/LEISURE PURPOSES ASSOCIATED WITH THE BEACH. ANY SUCH USE SHOULD RESPECT THE QUIET NATURE OF THE GREEN AND THE SURROUNDING ESPLANADE GARDENS (SEE ALSO POLICIES GEP1, HE1, AND HE4). Seaton Park 6.23 86 There is potential for developing the northern end of Seaton Park for recreational and play related attractions, possibly of a commercial nature. Any activities which may require relocation as a result of development along The Front could also be accommodated within the park area (see policies GEP9 and To4 above). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY To6 SEATON PARK SEATON PARK WILL BE DEVELOPED WITH ADDITIONAL RECREATIONAL FACILITIES IN ORDER TO INCREASE ITS ATTRACTIVENESS TO USERS. GREEN TOURISM 6.24 POLICY To7 Green Tourism is tourism relating to the natural world. The Borough Council is committed to promoting Green Tourism. Hartlepool has many assets, which can contribute to green tourism such as the ecological interest of the area (particularly bird watching, seals and wildlife). Green tourism can also incorporate the inclusion of the improved cleanliness of the coast and the tourism potential of the rural area through the community forest scheme (see paras 6.26 and 15.42 to 15.44 below). Summerhill will also be able to contribute to the provision of green tourism within the Borough (see policy Rec10). GREEN TOURISM THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL PROMOTE AND ENCOURAGE THE PROMOTION OF GREEN TOURISM THROUGH THE PROVISION OF FACILITIES FOR THE OBSERVATION AND INTERPRETATION OF WILDLIFE, HABITATS AND THE NATURAL ENVIRONMENT. Teesmouth National Nature Reserve 6.25 The Borough Council acknowledges that the international importance of the Teesmouth area for nature conservation should receive active promotion within the context of a sustainable and strategic approach. This must stress the integration of leisure, business and wildlife. Established partnerships between industry and nature conservation have secured the reputation of the area as a national leader in this respect. 6.26 Therefore, the Borough Council will seek to encourage the sustainable development of the Teesmouth area as an internationally important nature conservation site. Green tourism will be encouraged through the provision of interpretive facilities such as information boards and other facilities such as hides and car parking. POLICY To8 TEESMOUTH NATIONAL NATURE RESERVE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROMOTE THE TEESMOUTH NATIONAL NATURE RESERVE AS A TOURIST ATTRACTION BY ACTIVELY ENCOURAGING ITS ENHANCEMENT AND ENCOURAGING SUSTAINABLE GREEN TOURISM. RURAL TOURISM 6.27 The Tees Forest (formerly the Cleveland Community Forest) extends over most of the rural area of Hartlepool and into the green wedges within the town. The forest initiative seeks to achieve a range of environmental and community benefits, HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 87 including landscape improvement, wildlife conservation, agricultural diversification, recreation provision and employment generation. There are also the benefits, which the initiative will bring in terms of tourism. 6.28 A number of gateway sites for the community forest have been identified in Hartlepool. These will help to lead those visiting the Headland, Marina/town centre and Seaton Carew into the rural area. Summerhill has been established as a primary gateway site (see policy Rec10). Hart Moor Farm, Hart Station (at the southern end of the Hart–Haswell route) and Middle Warren have potential as secondary gateway sites (see policy Rur15). 6.29 The Borough Council considers that tourism-related developments in the countryside beyond the fringes of the urban area and in the undeveloped coastal areas should be linked to create a tourist network. The activities undertaken in these areas should be limited to quiet informal outdoor recreation so as not to induce damaging effects on the environment (see policy Rur16). TOURIST ACCOMMODATION 6.30 Accommodation for tourists and other visitors can be provided in several forms including hotels, guesthouses, self-catering facilities and touring/static caravan sites. As part of the strategy to promote the growth of tourism, the Borough Council will encourage the establishment of further tourist accommodation within, primarily, the town centre and Marina. This will help to encourage the continued viability and vitality of these areas. 6.31 Tourist accommodation at Seaton Carew will continue to cater for demand at the resort, primarily business tourism from Teesside, and will also complement town-wide demand. The Headland is a suitable location for accommodation such as guest houses and small hotels. This level of provision will be in keeping with the character of the Headland. Care will need to be taken to ensure that hotel uses do not have an adverse effect on the surrounding neighbourhood. The criteria set out in Policy GEP1 will be applied to new proposals for tourist accommodation. 6.32 Touring caravan sites, unless carefully sited and landscaped, can have a detrimental impact, particularly on the visual environment. Care will need to be taken to ensure that adequate access can be provided. The Borough Council has not been able to identify any suitable areas within the town, which would be appropriate for the location of touring caravans. However, there may be opportunities for a site, in the longer term, within the area of the Tees Forest. Smaller scale caravan sites may be acceptable as part of farm diversification schemes. POLICY To9 TOURIST ACCOMMODATION THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CONTINUE TO ENCOURAGE THE ENHANCEMENT OF EXISTING TOURIST ACCOMMODATION AND ALSO THE DEVELOPMENT OF FURTHER TOURIST ACCOMMODATION WITHIN THE KEY TOURIST AREAS OF THE BOROUGH (THE TOWN CENTRE AND MARINA, VICTORIA HARBOUR, THE HEADLAND, AND SEATON CAREW). PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT PROVISIONS OF POLICY GEP1. 88 SHOULD ACCORD WITH THE HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY To10 TOURING CARAVAN SITES PROPOSALS FOR TOURING CARAVAN SITES WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE THEY ARE EXCEPTIONALLY WELL SCREENED SO AS NOT TO INTRUDE VISUALLY INTO THE LANDSCAPE, AND PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. THE SURROUNDING ROAD NETWORK IS CAPABLE OF ACCOMMODATING THE DEVELOPMENT, AND SUBSTANTIAL LANDSCAPING IS PROVIDED, AND ADEQUATE SEWAGE DISPOSAL FACILITIES ARE AVAILABLE. BUSINESS TOURISM AND CONFERENCING 6.33 POLICY To11 Hartlepool has established a reputation for having good conferencing facilities for business and the Borough Council will encourage further developments which cater for such events. More conference facilities and suitable accommodation within Hartlepool can contribute to the whole tourism package on offer in Hartlepool. The Historic Quay is currently the primary location for business tourism. However, the Borough Council believes that additional, alternative facilities would offer a greater choice and increased attractiveness to potential conference clients. In addition to the Historic Quay, the Business Development Centre within Hartlepool College of Further Education also offers training and business tourism facilities. Therefore, the Borough Council will look to encourage further developments which will create new facilities for and improve the business tourism and the conference offer of Hartlepool. Potential sites for such development may include the Queen’s Meadow site (see Policy Ind3) and also the Headland (Policy To2) may offer facilities for business tourism and conferencing. BUSINESS TOURISM AND CONFERENCING THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE AND PROMOTE IMPROVEMENTS TO EXISTING FACILITIES AND NEW DEVELOPMENTS WHICH COMPLEMENT THE NEEDS OF BUSINESS, IN TERMS OF CONFERENCING FACILITIES AND TOURISM. PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT PROVISIONS OF POLICY GEP1. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 SHOULD ACCORD WITH THE 89 90 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 7 HOUSING CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 7.1 The Hartlepool Local Plan, as an essentially land-use based document, is primarily concerned with ensuring that adequate land is allocated to meet future housing needs of the whole community. These needs are, in the main, estimated from an assessment of the likely levels and characteristics of the future population of Hartlepool. The aim is to provide in a sustainable manner wider opportunity and choice and a better mix in the size, type and location of housing than is currently available. As well as identifying land for new housing, the local plan will also address the issues surrounding the existing housing stock, including improvement and/or clearance. Hartlepool Community Strategy 7.2 The local plan policies and proposals take into account, in particular, the following Environment and Housing objectives of the Community Strategy: to re-balance the supply and demand for housing; to make improvements to the quality, energy-efficiency and attractiveness of existing housing; to ensure that there is access to a choice of good quality housing to buy or to rent, to meet the aspirations of residents and encourage investment; and to secure adequate provision of new housing and maximise the proportion that is built on previously developed land, while seeking to secure the development of an appropriate provision of larger, higher value dwellings. Housing in Hartlepool 7.3 Hartlepool has a very high proportion of terraced housing (over 41% in 2001 compared to a national average of about 26% and a regional average of about 32%) and a correspondingly low proportion of detached dwellings (14% compared to a national average of 23%). There is a very high proportion of low cost housing and relatively small proportion of higher cost housing as reflected in the Council Tax valuations of properties in Hartlepool (in 2002, over 62% of dwellings fell within Band A, but less than 11% were classed at Band D and above). Overall, Hartlepool has the highest proportion of Band AB properties in the Tees Valley and one of the highest in the region, and the lowest proportion of Bands C-D, E-F and G-H properties in the Tees Valley and one of the lowest in the region. Figure 7.1(A) Housing Types - 2001 Census 45 40 35 Percentage 30 25 Detached Semi-detached Terraced 20 15 10 5 0 Hartlepool HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 North East England & Wales 91 7.4 Figure 7.1 demonstrates the imbalance of the existing housing stock in Hartlepool. The housing supply does not match demand in terms of what is desired by (and affordable to) residents. This is confirmed by recent housing related studies undertaken by consultants on behalf of the Borough Council (see paragraphs 7.8 to 7.15 below). 7.5 Over the last few years, house-building rates have been relatively high – the highest rate in relation to population in the Tees Valley area. Much of the new housing which has been and is being provided is attractive to families requiring modern facilities, more private space, off-street parking and a safe environment for young children to play, and it is readily accessible to those with average or just below average incomes. Consequently there has been a falling demand both for older terraced housing in the town and for social housing. However, the high building rates have helped to stem population outflows from the Borough such that Hartlepool is one of few authorities in the region where there has recently been a positive net migration, albeit a very modest one. 7.6 There is a strong correlation between the areas of older terraced and social housing and the areas of highest deprivation in the town. Regeneration efforts and resources through City Challenge, several rounds of the Single Regeneration Budget Programme, the West Central Hartlepool New Deal for Communities Programme and the Neighbourhood Renewal Fund have been directed at such areas and will continue to be concentrated in them. 7.7 At the other end of the housing market, the overall shortage of larger, high quality detached homes may result in middle and upper income households being attracted to areas outside the Borough. The Housing Market Dynamics and Low Density Housing Studies highlight that there is negligible in-migration even from those taking new jobs in Hartlepool (see paragraphs 7.10 and 7.15 below). This is confirmed by the more recent Hartlepool Low Density Housing Study 1 (see paragraph 7.15 below) which demonstrates the consequences for the economic and social life of the Hartlepool community of failing to provide appropriate levels of low density housing. The Hartlepool Community Strategy and the Hartlepool Housing Aspirations Study both point to the need to provide additional larger higher value dwellings. Hartlepool Housing Market Dynamics Study 7.8 In 1999, the Borough Council commissioned a study 2 to examine the dynamics of the housing market in Hartlepool to better assess the needs and requirements of the Hartlepool community. The study involved a questionnaire survey of 1000 households in the Borough and structured interviews with key players in the housing market. It also examined the existing housing situation in Hartlepool, analysed migration patterns, and assessed the relationship between incomes and house prices. 7.9 The study produced a number of positive and encouraging findings including • a high resident satisfaction with their house, their street and their local area; • low out-migration; and • no denial of market access to housing for households earning average or below average incomes. 7.10 However, a range of more worrying findings and trends also emerged from the study including: • negligible in-migration even from those taking new jobs in Hartlepool; • out-migration concentrated in the economically active groups; • collapse of the market for older terraced housing in some areas – well below national and regional rates; and • imbalance in the existing housing stock. 1 2 Hartlepool Low Density Housing Study – Nathaniel Lichfield & Partners/NLP (Final Report – July 2005) Housing Market Dynamics Study – Nathaniel Lichfield & Partners / NEMS Market Research, (Final report - April 2000). 92 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 7.11 The study concluded that the Borough Council should: ♦ consider the provision of a. smaller dwellings in the light of the increasing numbers of smaller households, b. larger 4-5 bedroom units to broaden the range and choice of housing stock, to encourage in-migration and discourage out-migration, ♦ consider the potential for significant clearances in some areas to prevent the further deterioration and then abandonment of those areas, ♦ recognise that the problems emerging in certain areas may require a holistic approach and that housing policy, planning policy and environmental initiatives may need to be backed-up with integrated economic and social programmes, and ♦ consider continuing with the current local plan approach of not securing affordable housing in association with new development. Hartlepool Housing Aspirations Study 7.12 The Hartlepool Housing Aspirations Study 3 was commissioned by the Hartlepool Local Strategic Partnership to take forward the broad conclusions of the Hartlepool Housing Dynamics Study to: • make detailed conclusions about the need for, and extent of, rented housing and low cost ownership in different parts of the town; • generate options for addressing the mismatch between reasonable aspirations and the quality and mix of housing currently available; • appraise the various options, including the consideration and recommendation of strategic goals and mechanisms for delivering them. 7.13 The findings of the study re-emphasised the following key trends: • fall in demand for social housing, particularly in respect of unpopular house types, older un-modernised housing and unpopular locations; • an overall growth in the private rented sector; • an increase in the number of owner occupied dwellings but with a movement away from smaller terraced properties and growing aspirations to live in larger properties and in bungalows. 7.14 The study sets out a strategy with the following key focuses for action • balancing the quantitative and qualitative supply and demand for housing in the social sector; • intervention in the private sector; and • integrating planning, regeneration and housing strategies. Hartlepool Low Density Housing Study 7.15 3 The Hartlepool Low Density Housing Study undertaken by consultants Nathaniel Lichfield & Partners in 2005 found that the shortage of larger low density housing in Hartlepool compared to other local authorities in the North East contributed to Hartlepool being unable to attract its proportionate share of highly skilled in-migrants, whilst it has continued to lose higher socio-economic groups to neighbouring authorities such as Stockton that have provided significant amounts of new aspirational housing in recent years. This has contributed to having some of the lowest proportions of the higher socioeconomic groups and some of the highest proportions of the lower socio-economic groups in the region and sub-region. The study concluded that increasing the quantity of low density housing in the Borough, in conjunction with its regeneration initiatives already underway, would help the town to attract its proportionate share of the highly skilled inmigrants to the region. This would also help the town to retain the higher socioeconomic groups that may otherwise migrate to achieve their housing aspirations. Hartlepool Housing Aspirations Study – Nathaniel Lichfield & Partners (2003) HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 93 Hartlepool Urban Capacity Study 7.16 At the end of 2001, the Borough Council commissioned consultants to undertake an urban capacity study 4 expanding and updating the methodology in line with the guidance set out in the government guidance ‘Tapping the Potential’. The Council identified nearly 300 sites within the urban area and the villages based on the potential capacity sources set out in the guidance, including many sites not previously covered in the earlier capacity assessments (such as small sites, car parks, and intensification in existing housing areas). The consultants then examined each site and considered that only 61 had potential for development over the plan period and concluded that there was an estimated capacity of 1558 dwellings made up of 758 dwellings from identified sites and 800 dwellings from unidentified windfalls including conversions. Issues identified by the consultants in their work on the study included the following: ♦ a ‘failing’ housing market in some parts of the town; ♦ a strong market in peripheral parts of the town, particularly for new or modern properties with gardens, off-road parking and modern amenities; ♦ negative equity in some locations; ♦ a continuing programme of clearance of public sector stock, much of which may not be replaced; ♦ the possibility of clearance of private sector stock, particularly in the New Deal for Communities area, with very limited replacement to allow for significant improvements to the environment; ♦ low house prices relative to average incomes providing ease of access to new housing for first time buyers (exacerbating the problem in the older areas of terraced stock); ♦ an absence of demand for ‘affordable’ housing provision by RSLs (Registered Social Landlords) except for some types of specialist housing; ♦ a shortage of larger ‘executive’ 4/5 bedroom houses; and ♦ a shortage of bungalow properties. Planning Policy Guidance Note 3: Housing 7.17 A new planning policy guidance note (PPG3) on housing was issued in March 2000. This represented a fundamental change in planning for housing. The main key policy objectives of the new guidance are that: ♦ a sequential approach be applied to housing proposals (giving priority to the reuse of land and buildings before developing greenfields); ♦ land to be used more efficiently (greater housing densities, reduced parking standards etc), and ♦ higher quality development promoted. 7.18 The PPG sets a national target for 60% of new housing to be provided on previously developed land and through conversions of buildings by 2008, each local planning authority to set its own ‘recycling target’ to contribute to this national goal. 7.19 Housing allocations in development plans should be reviewed as quickly as possible and any permissions for housing development which come forward for renewal should be thoroughly assessed to reflect the new guidance in the PPG. 7.20 Updates to PPG3 in January 2005 provided for planning for sustainable communities in rural areas and gave further guidance on the consideration of planning applications for housing or mixed use developments on land allocated for industrial or commercial use. 4 Hartlepool Urban Housing Capacity Study – Chesterton (in association with Ron Grieg) - May 2002 94 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Regional Planning Guidance (RPG1) 7.21 Regional Planning Guidance strategy recognises the contribution to regeneration that is made from new housing and the improvement or demolition of unsatisfactory dwellings. Thus the Guidance seeks a more integrated approach to housing so that the problems of older housing are tackled in conjunction with planning for new housing development. The RPG’s objectives seek to ensure that everyone has the opportunity of a decent home, that there is a greater choice of housing in sustainable locations and that the best use is made of existing stock, and suitable previously developed land and buildings in urban areas. They also seek to ensure that the provision of additional housing does not result in, or exacerbate, problems of low demand and abandonment and that housing should not reinforce social exclusion. 7.22 The annual rate of housing provision for sub areas of the region including the Tees Valley is set out in the RPG. Other housing policies in the RPG require that development plans should: • support improvements to the existing housing stock, consider the needs of regeneration in terms of either improvement and/or demolition, and minimise new housing development on greenfield sites; • ensure the managed release of sites giving priority to the re-use of previously developed land and buildings; • set challenging targets for the re-use of previously developed land to contribute to meeting the regional targets of 60% and 65% by 2008 and 2016 respectively; • include criteria based policies to assess the suitability of windfall sites, with no allowance being given for greenfield windfall sites; • include policies on densities in order to make more efficient use of land having regard to local character and market considerations as well as encouraging good and safe design, layout and amenity; • address the need for affordable housing based on up-to-date local housing needs surveys. Structure Plan Policies 7.23 The Tees Valley Structure Plan requires that provision be made for 3000 dwellings in Hartlepool between 2002 and 2016 excluding those required to replace dwellings to be cleared (policy H1). A search sequence is to be followed in allocating sites for development (policy H1A) with support to be given to measures complementing the restructuring of the housing market (policy H1B). Increased residential densities are to be sought on appropriate sites (policy H4). Where there is a local need, the provision of affordable housing should be facilitated (policy H5) and a range of house types, including those for smaller households and disadvantaged groups and also small scale, high quality, low density housing, provided (policy H6). Local plans are to guide the location and provision of gypsy sites (policy H7). Support will be given to measures which make better use of the existing housing stock (policy H8). 7.24 However, since the above strategic policy (RPG1 and the Tees Valley Structure Plan) was approved, national, regional and sub-regional strategy has highlighted more fully the linkages between economic and housing development. The North East Regional Housing Strategy (June 2003) had recognised that the quality of the region’s housing is a critical element in retaining and attracting highly skilled, creative and entrepreneurial people and that a major restructuring of the housing markets is required to offer good housing choices. Submitted Regional Spatial Strategy (RSS) - June 2005 7.25 The Regional Spatial Strategy will provide the long-term framework for the region for developing a stronger economy and improving the quality of life of communities as places to live and work. Its key objectives include: • to stabilise and then increase the region’s population; HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 95 • • • 7.26 to focus housing development on previously developed land and buildings in sustainable locations within the conurbations and main towns; housing market restructuring areas, towns in regeneration areas and rural service centres; to provide a more appropriate mix of type, size, tenure and affordability of decent high quality homes by housing market restructuring and through additions to the region’s housing stock; and to reduce the amount of vacant and obsolete housing in the region to 3% by 2010. The submitted RSS sets out a new housing strategic housing requirement which when approved will supersede that of the structure plan. In addition it proposes in policy 29 that the housing stock be improved where there is sufficient demand and that there be an increase in the level of demolitions. Policy 32 of the submitted strategy requires that provision is made for a range of dwelling type, size and tenure. Local Plan Objectives 7.27 In line with the overall strategy of the local plan, the following objectives are of relevance in terms of housing provision and improvements: A6 to improve the viability and environment of older housing, commercial and industrial areas; A7 to promote development on previously used sites and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings; A8 to promote mixed use developments where appropriate; A9 to encourage the provision of high quality housing; B1 to ensure that there is available throughout the plan period an adequate supply of suitable housing land which is capable of offering a range of house types to meet all needs; C1 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool C2 to retain the compact form of the main urban area by preventing urban development extending into the countryside; C3 to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest; C4 to encourage a high standard of design and the provision of a high quality environment in all developments and particularly those on prominent sites, along main road and rail corridors, and along the coast; C6 to protect as far as possible existing open space, and to encourage further landscaping and tree planting where appropriate; C9 to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources; C10 to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings; D2 to promote development in locations which support existing transport infrastructure, which minimise the need to travel, and which are accessible by all modes of transport; D4 to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport. POLICIES AND PROPOSALS 7.28 96 The Hartlepool Community Strategy’s Environment and Housing aim is to secure ‘a more attractive and sustainable environment that is safe, clean and tidy; a good infrastructure; and access to good quality, affordable housing’. One of its key objectives from the land use point of view is to rebalance the supply and demand for housing. Balancing both the quantitative and qualitative supply and demand is an important element of the Hartlepool Housing Strategy in terms of its objective of securing a choice of housing in sustainable communities that meets the needs and aspirations of residents. This means that the HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 problems of the existing housing stock need to be considered in association with planning for new housing. IMPROVEMENTS TO EXISTING HOUSING AREAS 7.29 The Hartlepool Housing Market Dynamics Study and the Hartlepool Housing Aspirations Study revealed a high level of satisfaction among residents with their house, their street and their local area. Improvements to the environment and condition of both public and private housing have taken place over the last few years particularly in the former City Challenge area, and the Single Regeneration Budget Partnership areas of Owton / Rossmere and North Hartlepool. 7.30 In line with the Community Strategy objective to ‘make improvements to the quality, energy-efficiency and attractiveness of existing housing’, the Borough Council considers there should be further improvements to the housing stock and the environment as part of wider regeneration initiatives aimed at addressing social and economic deprivation in many areas of the town. Just under half of the Council’s former housing stock (now owned by Housing Hartlepool following stock transfer in 2004) falls below the ‘Decent Homes Standard’ (a total of over 3,500 properties as at 31 March 2005). The Borough Council aims to ensure that all social housing meets the new ‘Decent Homes Standard’ by April 2010. In the private sector, the Council has been concentrating on supporting initiatives in the North Hartlepool Single Regeneration Budget Partnership area, the New Deal for Communities West Central area around Belle Vue and the central area and the North Central Hartlepool area where it is proposed to target resources over the next ten years. In the future the Council will target private sector renewal assistance towards the support of further broader-based area initiatives, including the wards showing indications of high levels of deprivation. POLICY Hsg1 HOUSING IMPROVEMENTS A HIGH PRIORITY WILL BE GIVEN TO THE IMPROVEMENT OF THE EXISTING HOUSING STOCK IN HARTLEPOOL AND TO THE ENHANCEMENT OF THE LOCAL ENVIRONMENT AS PART OF OVERALL ENVIRONMENTAL, SOCIAL AND ECONOMIC INITIATIVES SUBJECT TO THE AVAILABILITY OF RESOURCES. AREAS TO BE TARGETED INCLUDE: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ NORTH HARTLEPOOL PARTNERSHIP AREA, NEW DEAL FOR COMMUNITIES WEST CENTRAL AREA, NORTH CENTRAL HARTLEPOOL, AND OTHER AREAS OF HIGH DEPRIVATION. HOUSING CLEARANCE 7.31 The improvement of the existing housing stock and its environment forms part of a package of measures seeking to ensure that housing meets the need and aspirations of the community. However, much of the existing stock is in areas where there is an imbalance between housing supply and demand. 7.32 There has been some selective clearance of primarily public sector housing over the last few years in areas where there are particular social problems. However, in view of the falling demand for public sector housing in the areas cleared and their unsuitability for other than low-cost private housing, these sites have not been identified for redevelopment and are being improved and landscaped in consultation with the local communities. This trend of selective clearance in areas of obsolete social housing and subsequent use of the site for redevelopment and/or open space uses is likely to continue over most of the plan period. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 97 7.33 POLICY Hsg2 There have been no large-scale clearances of private sector housing since the early 1980s, and most of the private houses cleared in the 1990s have been individual dwellings for which a replacement has been provided on site. The Hartlepool Housing Market Dynamics Study, West Central Hartlepool NDC Housing Study and the Hartlepool Housing Aspirations Study however, have highlighted the symptoms of an ‘urban flight’ of existing and emerging owner-occupiers from older terraced housing areas to new housing estates. It was found that in some areas the market for older terraced properties has collapsed in the face of changing housing aspirations and the rising levels of crime and anti-social behaviour. SELECTIVE HOUSING CLEARANCE SELECTIVE DEMOLITION OF HOUSING WILL BE CARRIED OUT TO CONTRIBUTE TO RESTORING THE BALANCE BETWEEN DEMAND AND SUPPLY AND TO ACHIEVE BETTER LOCAL AMENITIES AND AN IMPROVED ENVIRONMENT. THE DECISION ON SELECTIVE DEMOLITION AND ON THE RE-USE OF CLEARED SITES WILL BE CONSIDERED IN CONSULTATION WITH THE LOCAL COMMUNITY. PROPOSALS FOR REDEVELOPMENT SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE NEED TO REHOUSE LOCAL RESIDENTS, PROVIDE LOCAL SERVICES AND CREATE NEW OPEN SPACES TO IMPROVE THE OVERALL ENVIRONMENT OF THE AREA. WHERE THE CLEARANCE SITES ARE NOT REQUIRED FOR HOUSING OR OTHER REDEVELOPMENT THEY WILL BE RETAINED FOR PRIMARILY OPEN SPACE PURPOSES AND TREATED IN CONSULTATION WITH LOCAL RESIDENTS. WHERE HOUSING HAS BEEN CLEARED AND THE SITE IS NOT REQUIRED FOR RE-DEVELOPMENT IN THE SHORT TERM, IT SHOULD BE LANDSCAPED TO AN APPROPRIATE STANDARD. HOUSING MARKET RESTRUCTURING 7.34 In some parts of the town there are concentrations of housing where there is an imbalance between supply and demand. A holistic approach will be required to tackle the problems of low demand and abandonment and redress the imbalance. A combination of clearance, improvement, environmental enhancement and redevelopment will be required to restore confidence and encourage investment in order to attract a more varied population providing greater spending power and leading to the creation of sustainable communities. 7.35 The need for such action was first recognised in the older terraced housing areas to the west of the town centre and in consultation with the residents, a Community Housing Plan was prepared for the West Central Hartlepool New Deal for Communities area. This examined the options for demolition, the provision of new homes and more open spaces (private gardens, pocket parks and open green spaces), the modernisation of properties and street improvements over the whole area. 7.36 The West Central Hartlepool NDC Housing Options Report identified as Priority Action Areas (PAAs), some housing areas where the problems of imbalance between supply and demand seemed to be concentrated. Area assessments were subsequently undertaken within some parts of the PAAs where significant clearance was proposed or where housing was seen to be at particular risk. The Area Assessment exercise undertaken by consultants Halcrow Associates identifies appropriate clearance areas of sufficient size for redevelopment which will contribute to the ultimate aim of housing market re-structuring to reduce obsolete housing stock and improve the balance between demand and supply in the interests of the proper planning of the area. The approved 98 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Community Housing Plan and associated area assessments provided the basis for the preparation of Supplementary Planning Guidance for the redevelopment of three general areas in West Central Hartlepool. It is important in this respect that, where private investment through redevelopment is to be attracted, appropriately sized sites are assembled. 7.37 The problems associated with the imbalance between supply and demand are not confined to the west central part of the town, but are becoming evident elsewhere, particularly in other parts of Stranton and Grange Wards and in Dyke House. The Hartlepool Housing Regeneration Strategy has been prepared to ensure that the town’s housing need, supply and demand issues will be addressed through ‘joined up’ housing, regeneration and planning strategies and policies so that spending is focussed in the right locations and in an informed and sustainable manner. The strategy advocates a ‘plan, monitor, manage’ approach that will initially focus on the North Central and West Central areas and the programmes currently being moved forward in those neighbourhoods, and may in future identify additional areas of the town where intervention (which could potentially include housing clearance and replacement as part of a range of activity) is required. 7.38 The problem of low demand housing and the potential risk to communities and neighbourhoods arising from changing patterns of demand for housing has been welldocumented in Tees Valley. Tees Valley Living (TVL), the sub-regional housing market restructuring partnership, was established during 2003 to develop a housing market renewal strategy for Tees Valley and to lobby government for resources for its implementation. The TVL Board designated a Housing Market Renewal (HMR) area boundary in January 2005. This contains the more challenging areas of housing market weakness and failure in the urban core of Tees Valley, including a large section of central Hartlepool. 7.39 Research carried out in connection with the Regional Spatial Strategy (RSS) identified a need for in the order of 17,500 dwellings to be demolished in the Tees Valley sub-region between 2004-21, roughly two-thirds of which are anticipated to be in the private sector. Experience suggests that this figure will need to be treated with some caution, in view of increasing costs associated with property purchase and the need to deal with household relocation in a sensitive and inclusive manner. Notwithstanding, the Housing Regeneration Strategy for Hartlepool concludes that there is a clear need to consider further potentially significant stock clearance and replacement in the town aimed at creating a housing stock which, in qualitative terms, better matches aspirations of existing and future residents. Some of the stock reduction required will sit broadly with the current clearance programmes underway in West Central and North Central Hartlepool. However, outside of these areas, there will also likely be a need for further, potentially significant, stock clearance, replacement and investment. Future plans addressing these issues will be worked up with local residents. POLICY Hsg3 HOUSING MARKET RENEWAL THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO TACKLE THE PROBLEM OF THE IMBALANCE OF SUPPLY AND DEMAND IN THE EXISTING HOUSING STOCK THROUGH CO-ORDINATED PROGRAMMES TO INCLUDE DEMOLITION, REDEVELOPMENT, PROPERTY IMPROVEMENT AND ENVIRONMENTAL AND STREET ENHANCEMENT WORKS. PRIORITY WILL BE GIVEN TO THE HOUSING REGENERATION OF THE WEST CENTRAL, AND NORTH CENTRAL AREAS OF THE TOWN (AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP). SUPPLEMENTARY PLANNING DOCUMENTS WILL BE PREPARED, AS APPROPRIATE, FOR THOSE PARTS OF HOUSING REGENERATION AREAS WHERE THERE IS TO BE COMPREHENSIVE TREATMENT INVOLVING THE DEMOLITION OF DWELLINGS. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 99 7.40 As part of the holistic approach to tackling the housing imbalance it will be necessary to relate new housing development to the level of clearance of surplus housing to the extent that housing developers may be required to contribute towards demolitions and improvements in the housing market renewal areas in order to be granted permission for new housing in other areas of the town (see policy GEP9 and Supplementary Note 8 on Developer Contributions and also paragraphs 7.86, and 7.90 and policies Hsg5 and Hsg6 on housing developments). CENTRAL AREA HOUSING 7.41 POLICY Hsg4 There is a considerable amount of land adjoining the town centre and edge of centre mixed use areas in predominantly residential use comprising older terraced streets as well as newer housing provided on former clearance sites. Where housing directly abuts such commercial areas there may be pressures for changes of use to offices or other uses associated with the function of the town centre. As much of the town centre and adjoining edge of centre areas are identified for a wide range of uses, the Borough Council considers that it is important that the predominantly housing areas retain their specific community identity and that non-residential or non-community uses are restricted. CENTRAL AREA HOUSING THE SPREAD OF COMMERCIAL USES TO THE RESIDENTIAL AREAS AROUND, BUT OUTSIDE THE DEFINED TOWN CENTRE WILL BE RESISTED EXCEPT WHERE THEY INVOLVE THE PROVISION OF LOCAL SERVICES OR COMMUNITY-BASED USES (AS INCLUDED IN CLASS D1 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 AS AMENDED). HOUSING REQUIREMENT 7.42 The Tees Valley Structure Plan states in policy H1 that about 3000 dwellings will be required in Hartlepool between 2002 and 2016 comprising about 750 between 2002 and 2006 (190 dwellings pa) and 2250 post 2006 (225 dwellings pa). It is stated that the provision after 2006 is only indicative and will be subject to confirmation through the early review of RPG (now the Regional Spatial Strategy). 7.43 Policy 30 of the emerging (submitted) Regional Spatial Strategy (RSS) requires that provision should be made for the average annual net additions to the dwelling stock for Hartlepool as follows: 2004-11 – 390 dwellings pa 2011-16 – 350 dwellings pa. This housing provision “recognises the current level of commitments, the need to diversify the existing dwelling stock and the need to ensure that the successful delivery of housing market restructuring initiatives are not compromised”. It also “recognises the need for ‘front-loading’ to accommodate the large number of extant planning permissions that will be taken up in the first period”. 7.44 The net housing provision set out in the structure plan (and in policy 30 of the submitted RSS) does not however include any allowance for the replacement of cleared dwellings, although policy 29 of the submitted RSS identifies that about 17,500 dwellings will be demolished in the Tees Valley area as a whole. It is currently estimated that about 2100 dwellings will be cleared in Hartlepool over the period 2002 to 2016. This is the figure suggested by Tees Valley Living in its submission to the ODPM on housing market renewal and is in accord with the findings of the Hartlepool Housing Regeneration Strategy. Initially over 600 dwellings are to be cleared in the first two priority areas within the West Central Hartlepool New Deal for Communities area and the first phase within the North Central Hartlepool area. 100 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 7.45 Not all dwellings which are to be cleared, however, will require to be replaced as a proportion of them will be classed as vacant. This proportion will vary from site to site but for the purposes of estimating total housing requirements over the plan period it is assumed that this will be, at most, about 30% of the dwellings cleared. However, for the first three clearance areas referred to above, the proportion of vacant properties amounted to 22% overall, established from surveys carried out in 2003. Taking this into account and assuming an estimated 30% void figure in areas to be cleared in the future, it is therefore estimated that about 1580 of the 2100 dwellings likely to be cleared under the housing market renewal programme could be classed as ‘occupied’ and will need to be replaced. The total housing requirement over the plan period set out in current strategic guidance (Tees Valley Structure Plan) is therefore estimated to be about 4630 dwellings comprising 3010 dwellings required in policy H1 of the structure plan and an additional 5 1620 or so to replace occupied dwellings cleared. TABLE H1: CURRENT STRATEGIC HOUSING REQUIREMENT 2002/03 2003/04 2004/05 2005/11 2011/16 2002/16 Net Requirement (TVSP) (190 dwellings pa 2002-06 & 225 dwellings pa post 2006 Clearances to be replaced (22% of the first 612 dwellings cleared and 70% of future clearances) Gross requirement 7.46 190 190 190 1315 1125 3010 2 7 35 1055 525 1624 192 197 225 2370 1650 4634 Committed housing development in Hartlepool at April 2005 comprises about 3400 dwellings as follows: • 993 dwellings completed between 2002 and 2005 (including conversions), • about 2250 remaining to be developed on the main development sites at Middle Warren, the Marina and Wynyard, and • 167 dwellings remaining to be completed on other sites under construction. It is possible, however, that only about 450 of the dwellings with planning permission in the Marina area will be completed during the plan period even if the main developer’s current completion rates are substantially increased, thus the committed housing likely to be completed during the plan period amounts to about 2850 dwellings as shown in Table H2 below. TABLE H2: COMMITTED HOUSING PROVISION Committed sites (including conversions) Middle Warren Marina Wynyard Other sites completed or under construction Total committed 7.47 Estimated Total completions 2002/03 2003/04 2004/05 2005/11 2011/16 2002/16 Completions 71 2 0 96 96 18 83 23 23 710 240 73 465 200 0 1425 561 114 322 150 109 167 0 748 395 360 238 1190 665 2848 Table H2 above highlights that the number of committed dwellings is only about 160 dwellings short of the net housing requirement set out in the current strategic document (Tees Valley Structure Plan). Once replacement of cleared housing is taken into 5 This figure is made up of the 1580 ‘occupied’ dwellings cleared under housing market renewal programmes together with individual dwellings cleared between 2002 and 2005 – see Table H1. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 101 account, however, the number of dwellings for which provision is required amounts to about 1800 as shown in Table H3 below. TABLE H3: ADDITIONAL DWELLINGS REQUIRED 2002-2016 2002/03 2003/04 2004/05 2005/11 2011/16 2002/16 Gross requirement (TVSP) (from Table H1) Less total committed (from Table H2) Additional Provision Required 192 197 225 2370 1650 4634 395 360 238 1190 665 2848 -203 -163 -13 1180 985 1786 7.48 Since the current strategic housing requirement was approved in the Tees Valley Structure Plan, the major regeneration site at the North Docks (Victoria Harbour) has been brought forward by Tees Valley Regeneration and the owners of the land. The Master Plan which has been prepared for Victoria Harbour and accompanying planning application proposes some 3450 apartments and town houses as part of the mixed use redevelopment of the area. Clearly, in the context of the current strategic housing requirements, it is possible to accommodate only a small proportion of the proposed housing at Victoria Harbour even if there are no new areas allocated in the plan and no windfall developments are allowed. 7.49 The regeneration of the Victoria Harbour area is strategically important not only for Hartlepool, but also the Tees Valley and the Northern Region as a whole. It has therefore been highlighted in the emerging Regional Spatial Strategy (RSS) and, as noted in paragraph 7.43 above, the strategic housing requirement for Hartlepool set out in the submitted RSS has been substantially increased in part to allow the Victoria Harbour housing development to attain sufficient critical mass for it to be viable. The currently proposed housing requirement set out in the submitted RSS is set out in table H4 below. TABLE H4: PROPOSED STRATEGIC HOUSING REQUIREMENT (Submitted Regional Spatial Strategy) Net Requirement (RSS) (390 dwellings pa 2004-11 & 350 dwellings pa 2011-16) Clearances to be replaced (70% of actual clearances 2005 onwards) Gross requirement 7.50 2004/05 2005/11 2011/16 2004/16 390 2340 1750 4480 35 1055 525 1615 425 3395 2275 6095 When current commitments (set out in Table H2) are taken into account, the additional provision required in Hartlepool up to 2016 in terms of the strategic requirement in the submitted RSS would be about 4100 dwellings between 2004 and 2016 (see Table H5 below) rather than the current requirement of 1800 between 2002 and 2016 arising from the Tees Valley Structure Plan. TABLE H5: ADDITIONAL DWELLINGS REQUIRED 2004-2016 (Submitted Regional Spatial Strategy) Gross requirement (RSS) (from Table H4) Less total committed (from Table H2) Additional Provision Required 102 2004/05 2005/11 2011/16 2004/16 425 3395 2275 6095 238 1190 665 2093 187 2205 1610 4002 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 7.51 However, the proposed strategic housing requirements of the submitted RSS are not yet finalised. 7.52 For the purposes of this local plan therefore, and in order to enable a realistic and viable account to be taken of the Victoria Harbour development and of future windfall developments (including replacement on areas of cleared housing) it is assumed that the strategic housing requirements, currently set out in the structure plan, will be substantially increased in the RSS, particularly in the early part of the RSS plan period to properly take account of “current level of commitments, the need to diversify the existing dwelling stock and the need to ensure that the successful delivery of housing market restructuring initiatives are not compromised” 6 . This also reflects the statement in the structure plan that the provision after 2006 is only indicative and will be subject to confirmation through the early review of RPG/RSS (see paragraph 7.42 above). 7.53 Nevertheless, pending approval of the RSS it is not proposed to make any new allocations in the plan beyond identifying the potential for housing within the important regeneration areas at Victoria Harbour and the Headland (see policy Hsg6). HOUSING SUPPLY 7.54 New housing provision is made up of the following three elements: commitments (see Table H2) windfall development (including current approvals not yet started), and allocations of land. 7.55 Windfall housing comprises conversions, replacement housing on cleared sites, and developments permitted on other unallocated or as yet unidentified sites. As at 1st April 2005, approval existed for 190 dwellings (including conversions). 7.56 Urban capacity studies are a means of estimating the potential number of dwellings likely to be developed on windfall sites. As noted in paragraph 7.16 above, the 2002 Hartlepool Urban Capacity Study concluded that there was capacity for 1558 dwellings from 2001, comprising 758 7 from 61 ‘identified’ sites and 800 from unidentified windfall sites. The estimated capacity of 800 dwellings from unidentified windfalls was based on the last 10 years’ rates for all ‘brownfield’ windfalls including redevelopment on cleared sites and conversions. 7.57 However, since the study was carried out in 2002: • many of the ‘identified’ sites have been committed (44% equating to 430 dwellings have been developed, are under construction or have planning permission); and • in relation to unidentified sites, there has been progress in identifying the amount of future housing clearance, and thus housing replacement can be more accurately estimated; and • new areas, not foreseen in 2002, have or are likely to become available for development. 7.58 An average of about 73 dwellings per annum has been provided on brownfield sites over the 10 year period 1995 to 2005. Of these an average of 33 dwellings pa were on cleared housing sites, 17 were provided by the conversions (including the sub-division of dwellings) and the remaining 23 comprised other windfall developments (see Figure 7.2 below). 6 Submitted Regional Spatial Strategy – June 2005 (paragraph 3.67) When totalled individually, the actual discounted capacity of the 61 identified sites amounts to 768, and not 758 as set out in the study. 7 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 103 Figure 7.2: BROWNFIELD WINDFALL DEVELOPMENT 1995 – 2005 160 140 120 Cleared sites Gross conversions Windfalls - small sites Windfalls 10+ 100 80 60 40 20 0 95/96 96/97 97/98 98/99 99/00 00/01 01/02 02/03 03/04 04/05 7.59 At present it is estimated that about 745 dwellings will be provided on cleared housing sites over the rest of the plan period to 2016, of which about 300 will be in the first three areas identified for redevelopment in the NDC and North Central Hartlepool areas. (This equates to a replacement rate of about 48%, although overall it is expected that on average about 40% of houses cleared will be replaced on site as not all cleared areas will be redeveloped for housing purposes). 7.60 In addition an average of about 50 dwellings per annum could be provided by conversions (about 15pa) and on other windfall sites (about 35pa). This is estimated from past rates of such developments on brownfield sites and takes account of new sites coming forward for development including some which were not assessed in the urban capacity study. 7.61 National guidance states that the local plan should identify sites sufficient to meet strategic requirements after making an allowance for windfalls. Taken together, commitments (2850 - Table H2), redevelopment on cleared sites (745 - paragraph 7.59) and other potential windfall development (at about 50 dwellings per annum excluding commitments) could account for the provision of almost 4000 dwellings between 2002 and 2016 – about 670 dwellings short of the current overall strategic requirement set out in the structure plan. 7.62 There would therefore appear to be little scope for making new allocations in the plan. However, it is considered essential to make appropriate provision for housing development at Victoria Harbour, a major mixed use regeneration area in a sustainable urban location and highlighted in the submitted RSS as a regional flagship scheme which will provide the catalyst for wider regeneration. In this respect it is considered that 100 dwellings per annum should initially be provided rising to 150 - 200 dwellings pa as the development proceeds. This would result in a provision of about 1450 dwellings by 2011. It is also necessary to make an allowance for housing which may be provided in the other mixed use regeneration areas in the Headland. 7.63 Potential housing supply could therefore be almost 4800 dwellings between 2004 and 2016. This provision is considerably in excess of the current strategic housing requirement set out in the structure plan, but well within the proposed housing requirement proposed in the submitted RSS up to 2016 (see Table H6 below). 104 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 TABLE H6: POTENTIAL HOUSING SUPPLY Completions and commitments (Table H2) Redevelopment of cleared housing sites Conversions (at 15pa) Other windfalls (at 35pa) Victoria Harbour policy Hsg5(A) Other Mixed Use Areas – policy Hsg5(A) TOTAL SUPPLY Current housing requirement (Table H1) Proposed housing requirement – submitted RSS (Table H4) * ** 2002/04 2004/05 2005/11 2011/16 TOTAL 2002/16 TOTAL 2004/16 755 238 1190 665 2848 2093 445 300 745 745 81* 75 156 156 200** 175 375 375 550 900 1450 1450 50 0 50 50 755 238 2516 2115 5624 4869 389 225 2370 1650 4634 NA NA 425 3395 2275 NA 6095 Excludes 9 conversions under construction (ie. committed) Excludes ‘windfalls’ under construction MANAGEMENT OF HOUSING LAND SUPPLY 7.64 The Borough Council in identifying options for the provision of housing to meet future requirements has had regard to the needs to: • maximise the amount of development from previously developed land and buildings, • provide variety in terms of the choice and location of new housing, and most importantly • reduce the imbalance of the housing stock so that it better meets the needs and aspirations of the community. 7.65 However, the high level of commitments in relation to the current strategic housing requirement means that provision to be made for new housing is limited. The priorities in this respect are related to those developments having the greatest impact in terms of the regeneration of the town. Land is thus identified for housing within mixed use regeneration areas at Victoria Harbour and the Headland (policy Hsg6). In terms of windfall development, priority will be given to the redevelopment of housing sites cleared under the housing market renewal programme. In addition encouragement is given to the conversion of properties (including the use of upper floors of commercial premises) for residential purposes (policies Hsg7 and Hsg8). As much of the existing housing stock is affordable, and also because it is probable that lower cost housing will be provided on redevelopment sites and other sites coming forward from ‘windfall’ developments, it is not considered necessary to make specific provision for new affordable housing (see paragraphs 7.87 and 7.88 below). 7.66 As shown in Table H6, if the proposed housing development forming a critical element of the major regeneration scheme at Victoria Harbour is to be accommodated in a viable way, it is not possible to keep within the current strategic requirement set in the structure HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 105 plan once commitments and estimated windfalls (including redevelopment on cleared housing sites) are taken into account. 7.67 However, it is likely that the new strategic housing requirement to be set in the Regional Spatial Strategy will be higher than that of the structure plan, and that it will be set at a level, at least for the first part of the plan period (2004-2011), which will take account of the “current level of commitments, the need to diversify the existing dwelling stock and the need to ensure that the successful delivery of housing market restructuring initiatives are not compromised” 8 7.68 The Local Plan strategy for housing is to reduce the imbalance between housing supply and demand by providing in a sustainable manner wider opportunity and choice and a better mix in the size, type and location of housing than is currently available. This strategy accords with the Hartlepool Community Strategy and the Hartlepool Housing Strategy. 7.69 The regular monitoring of a range of factors relating to the amount and type of housing provision and housing clearance will enable the Borough Council to manage the release of housing land in line with the local plan housing strategy in a way which will provide the greatest benefit to the town. By managing the release of sites, the Borough Council can influence the type and location of new housing development and when it is provided. 7.70 The development of windfall sites can increase the choice available to residents in terms of housing type and location but it is important that they do not exacerbate the problems of the imbalance between housing supply and demand. However, in order not to significantly exceed the current strategic housing requirement it will be necessary to strictly control the amount of windfall development coming forward in the immediate future. 7.71 In determining proposals for windfall housing developments, the following considerations will be taken into account: • the effect on the overall strategic housing requirement; • the sequential approach and effect on the recycling targets; • the positive regeneration benefits; • the need to ensure the provision of a range and choice of housing and to encourage the provision of dwelling types currently under-represented in the Hartlepool; • the balance between housing supply and demand; • the level of accessibility to facilities by all modes of transport; and • the contribution to the viability of villages. Proposals should meet the sustainability criteria set out in the general environmental principles policy GEP1 and the principles of layout and design set out in policy Hsg9. 7.72 The above factors are to a certain extent inter-related but the matters which the Council will take into consideration in relation to these are set out below. 7.73 Strategic requirement: The approval of proposals will be dependent upon their cumulative effect on the overall strategic housing requirement. This overall requirement equates to the housing requirement to meet the estimated growth in households set out in strategic policy together with dwellings which will be needed to replace those which have been cleared. In this respect, not all dwellings cleared will need to be replaced as some will be classed as vacant. The Borough Council will therefore closely monitor the rates of housing development, the numbers of dwellings with planning permission and the clearance of ‘occupied’ dwellings to establish actual and proposed housing provision against the overall strategic requirement. 7.74 The Borough Council will seek to manage the release of all new housing sites to support the strategy for housing market renewal (policy Hsg3) and where proposals for new 8 Submitted Regional Spatial Strategy – June 2005 (paragraph 3.67) 106 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 housing will lead to the strategic housing requirement rates being significantly exceeded, permission may be refused (see also paragraph 7.86 below). 7.75 Sequential Approach: This approach established in national and regional policy means that preference will be given to recycling previously developed sites and empty properties. The Borough Council, as set out in the Environment and Housing objectives of the Community Strategy, seeks to maximise the proportion of new housing that is built on previously developed land. 7.76 Recycling targets: The national target for the proportion of housing to be provided on previously developed land and through conversions of buildings is 60% by 2008 and 65% by 2016. This is also the current regional target set out in policy H4 of RPG1. The Borough Council in setting a local target will seek to keep within the national and regional target for 2008 and to achieve a higher target of 75% by 2016. However, it will be particularly difficult to meet the 2008 target as it is expected that there will be a higher level of completions on greenfield land during 2008 due to the proposed additional development at Middle Warren of the extra care village for which funding has been secured from the Department of Health. 7.77 Proposals for windfall housing should therefore relate to the development of previously developed land or the re-use of vacant buildings. The Borough Council will monitor the proportion of new and proposed housing development that is provided on previously developed land and through conversions of buildings. In considering development proposals the Borough Council will, subject to any adverse impact on the achievement of the recycling targets, regard previously developed land as including ‘vacant land not previously developed’ identified in government guidance 9 as a main source of housing capacity which should be assessed by urban capacity studies. This is vacant / undeveloped land often shown within built-up areas on Ordnance Survey maps as a ‘white’ area without annotation. 7.78 Positive regeneration benefits: In assessing proposals for housing development, the Borough Council will consider developments involving the following as providing the greatest benefits for the regeneration of the town: 1. redevelopment of cleared housing areas; 2. conversion of individual vacant industrial or commercial buildings, particularly those situated in prominent locations; 3. demolition and redevelopment of sites of vacant, unused and derelict commercial and community buildings located in residential areas; 4. development of untidy and unused land located within and causing problems in residential areas; 5. developments for special needs housing; and 6. developments providing housing which is under-represented in the town. Although offering important regeneration benefits, major housing-led developments incurring significant clearance and infrastructure costs to enable them to go ahead will be regarded as of lesser priority, particularly where these are not closely related to existing housing areas. 10 Similarly, redevelopment of existing occupied commercial buildings and sites will be regarded as having a lesser positive regeneration benefit. 7.79 Further in the context of the submitted RSS policy 31 11 on managing housing supply, developments involving the loss of employment land identified in this local plan will not be seen as having positive regeneration benefits. 7.80 Range and choice of housing: - National policy highlights the government’s objective that local planning authorities should provide wider housing opportunity and choice and a better mix in the size, type and location of housing than is currently available and seek to 9 Tapping the Potential - Assessing urban housing capacity: towards better practice (December 2000) Physical and environmental constraints on development of land and capacity of existing and potential infrastructure are included in the criteria listed in para. 31 of PPG3 to be assessed in relation to housing developments 11 Policy 31 of the submitted Regional Spatial Strategy states that in considering planning proposals, local planning authorities should consider the re-use of employment sites for housing only where they are not required for long-term employment use. 10 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 107 create mixed communities 12 . The emerging (submitted) RSS recognises that the provision of a better mix of dwelling types and sizes, particularly in urban areas, has important social and economic implications for the future and is essential if the region is to have a sustainable pattern of development. 7.81 The local plan strategy is to provide variety in terms of the choice and location of new housing. The Borough Council will therefore monitor on a regular basis the amount and type of new and proposed housing and the amount and type of dwellings demolished in relation to the existing housing stock. In considering proposals for housing the Borough Council will seek to encourage the development of housing types currently underrepresented in the town. 7.82 In this respect it is considered that detached housing is currently under-represented in the town. Conversely, in view of the high number of high density apartments which are currently being provided in the Marina area and are proposed for Victoria Harbour the Borough Council is unlikely to consider proposals for such types of dwelling as of high priority unless they form a minor part of a larger mixed housing development or it can be demonstrated that there are specific locational or other factors by which the need can be demonstrated such as the need to accommodate households displaced by housing clearance. Similarly terraced housing will not usually be considered appropriate other than as a part of a wider housing renewal scheme. 7.83 Balance between housing supply and demand: This factor is related to both the quantitative and qualitative balance between housing supply and demand and needs to be tackled on a holistic basis. It is necessary to reduce the overall vacancy rate in the town and to ensure that the development of new housing does not result in increased numbers of vacant and abandoned dwellings. At the same time it will be necessary to ensure that a suitable range of housing better meeting the needs and aspirations of the community is available within the town to discourage out-migration to areas where such housing is available. There was considerable out-migration from the town during the early 1970s when drainage restrictions limited the amount of new housing being developed and as highlighted in both the Regional Aspirations Report and the Hartlepool Low Density Housing Study there is still some net-out-migration to neighbouring Stockton, despite the relatively high level of vacant dwellings in some parts of the town. 7.84 Level of accessibility: New housing development should be provided in locations which enable convenient access to employment opportunities, shops, leisure and other facilities by all means of transport. 7.85 Contribution to the viability of villages: New housing development in villages can help to support local services and facilities. However proposals for development must relate to land or buildings within the defined village limits (see policies Rur1 and Rur2) but should not involve the change of use of buildings used as shops, public houses or other community facilities (see policy Rur6). Developer Contributions 7.86 12 As part of its approach to the management of housing land supply, the Borough Council will consider the need to seek contributions from developers towards the clearance and improvement of housing in the Housing Market Renewal Area (see paragraph 7.40, policy GEP9 and Supplementary Note 8). Planning Policy Guidance (PPG) 3 – Housing (para. 2) 108 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Hsg5 MANAGEMENT OF HOUSING LAND SUPPLY THE REGIONAL TARGETS FOR THE PROPORTION OF HOUSING DEVELOPMENT TO BE PROVIDED ON PREVIOUSLY DEVELOPED LAND AND THROUGH CONVERSIONS OF EXISTING BUILDINGS ARE 60% BY 2008 AND 65% BY 2016. THE COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO REACH THE 2008 TARGET OF 60% AND TO EXCEED THE 2016 REGIONAL TARGET BY SETTING A LOCAL TARGET OF 75% BY 2016, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ADOPT A ‘PLAN, MONITOR AND MANAGE’ APPROACH TO HOUSING SUPPLY AND IN THIS RESPECT WILL REGULARLY MONITOR THE NUMBERS OF DWELLINGS DEMOLISHED AND THOSE GRANTED PLANNING PERMISSION, (INCLUDING SCHEMES WHICH THE COUNCIL HAS RESOLVED TO APPROVE SUBJECT TO THE SATISFACTORY COMPLETION OF A S106 AGREEMENT). PLANNING PERMISSION WILL NOT BE GRANTED FOR PROPOSALS THAT WOULD LEAD TO THE STRATEGIC HOUSING REQUIREMENT (WITH AN ALLOWANCE FOR CLEARANCE REPLACEMENT) BEING SIGNIFICANTLY EXCEEDED OR THE RECYCLING TARGETS NOT BEING MET. IN CONSIDERING APPLICATIONS FOR HOUSING DEVELOPMENT, PARTICULAR REGARD WILL BE GIVEN TO: • THE AVAILABILITY, SUITABILITY AND LOCATION OF PREVIOUSLY DEVELOPED LAND AND BUILDINGS; • THE POSITIVE REGENERATION BENEFITS OF A HOUSING PROPOSAL; • THE PROVISION OF A VARIETY OF TYPES OF HOUSING TO MEET THE NEEDS OF ALL SECTORS OF THE LOCAL COMMUNITY; • THE BALANCE BETWEEN HOUSING SUPPLY AND DEMAND; • THE ACCESSIBILITY OF THE DEVELOPMENT TO EMPLOYMENT OPPORTUNITIES, SHOPS, LEISURE AND OTHER FACILITIES, PARTICULARLY BY MODES OTHER THAN THE CAR; • ITS CONTRIBUTION TO THE MAINTENANCE OF LOCAL SERVICES AND FACILITIES IN VILLAGES; AND • THE GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINCIPLES SET OUT IN POLICY GEP1. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS SHOULD ACCORD WITH THE DESIGN CRITERIA AND OTHER REQUIREMENTS SET OUT IN POLICY Hsg9. DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS TOWARDS HOUSING CLEARANCE AND IMPROVEMENTS WITHIN THE HOUSING MARKET RENEWAL AREA MAY BE SOUGHT (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). AFFORDABLE HOUSING 7.87 The 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan did not include specific policies requiring the provision of new affordable housing as it was considered that demand for low-cost housing could be met by the existing housing stock. There is provision in the Section 106 Agreement 13 relating to the development of Middle Warren for ‘social housing land’ to be developed by a housing association or by any other appropriate organisation. The site identified in phase 1 of the Middle Warren development was not taken up until 2002 – it is to be developed for elderly people’s bungalows. The Hartlepool Housing Market Dynamics 13 A Section 106 Agreement is a legal agreement attached to the approval of a planning permission through which the applicant and others with a legal interest in the land agrees to undertake or pay for additional works or adhere to restrictions which could not be dealt with by planning condition alone. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 109 Study, referred to in paragraph 7.8 to 7.11 above, confirms that there is no denial of market access to housing for households earning average or below average incomes. It suggests that if the price of new housing is further reduced, through the provision of subsidised market housing units via an affordable housing policy, this would further encourage “urban flight’ from the older housing areas to new housing. 7.88 A number of privately developed low-cost housing schemes have been completed over the last few years which may have contributed to the ‘urban flight’ of existing and emerging owner-occupiers from older terraced housing areas to new housing areas. In addition, it is likely that some new low-cost housing will be provided on existing committed sites and on some of the sites allocated on mixed use sites (policy Hsg6) and through conversions (policies Hsg7 and Hsg8). It is therefore not considered appropriate to require housing developers to make provision for affordable housing on their schemes. A policy on affordable housing is therefore not included in this plan. HOUSING IN MIXED USE AREAS 7.89 Victoria Harbour and parts of the Headland are identified in this plan for mixed-uses. The development of these sites will make an important contribution to regeneration initiatives. In this context, it is considered that housing development could be an appropriate element of these multiple use areas. It is not proposed to specify the amount of housing that should be provided on each site within these general areas which will be considered in the context of overall proposals for their regeneration. 7.90 However, it will be important to ensure that new housing in these regeneration areas does not exacerbate the problems associated with the overall imbalance of housing supply and demand. In this respect due consideration will be given to the potential for new development to contribute towards the clearance of surplus housing and improvements in low demand housing areas (see also paragraphs 7.40 and 7.86 above). 7.91 It is expected that housing development within the Headland will come forward during the early part of the plan period complementing the impact of the North Hartlepool Partnership SRB programme. Housing development on the Victoria Harbour regeneration area will, however, need to be phased in order to ensure that the strategic housing requirement is not significantly exceeded. In phasing the development, it will be necessary also to ensure that sufficient provision is made to enable it to achieve a viable critical mass. 7.92 As part of the Headland and Victoria Harbour areas lie within the indicative tidal flood plain, a flood risk assessment will be required to enable the Environment Agency to fully assess flood risk to any proposed development (see policy Dco2). 110 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Hsg6 MIXED USE AREAS HOUSING DEVELOPMENT WILL BE APPROVED AS PART OF MIXED USE DEVELOPMENTS IN THE HEADLAND AND VICTORIA HARBOUR REGENERATION AREAS SUBJECT TO THERE BEING NO DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE OVERALL HOUSING STRATEGY FOR REDUCING THE IMBALANCE OF HOUSING SUPPLY AND DEMAND. DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS TOWARDS CLEARANCES AND IMPROVEMENTS IN AREAS OF LOW HOUSING DEMAND MAY BE SOUGHT (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8 ON DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS). THE HOUSING PROVISION IN THESE AREAS WILL BE PHASED AS FOLLOWS: 2005-2011: HEADLAND (50 DWELLINGS) VICTORIA HARBOUR (550 DWELLINGS) 2011-2016: VICTORIA HARBOUR (900 DWELLINGS) IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE PLAN, MONITOR AND MANAGE APPROACH, ADDITIONAL DWELLINGS MAY BE PERMITTED AT VICTORIA HARBOUR SHOULD MONITORING ESTABLISH THAT THEY CAN BE ACCOMMODATED WITHOUT DETRIMENT TO THE STRATEGIC HOUSING REQUIREMENT. PROPOSALS FOR HOUSING DEVELOPMENT IN THESE AREAS SHOULD ACCORD AS APPROPRIATE WITH THE DESIGN CRITERIA AND OTHER REQUIREMENTS SET OUT IN POLICY Hsg9 AND THE REQUIREMENT FOR FLOOD RISK ASSESSMENTS IN POLICY Dco2. CONVERSIONS 7.93 The variety of dwelling types in the town can be increased through the conversion of buildings formerly in other uses, the division of larger dwellings into smaller units, and the residential use of vacant or underused space on the upper floors of commercial properties. Such conversions can provide appropriate accommodation for smaller households and for the increasing number of young people living on their own. 7.94 Non-residential properties and larger dwellings can be converted into self-contained flats or bedsits (houses in multiple occupation). In residential areas, the sub-division of properties into self-contained flats does not, in general, have such an impact as the use of dwellings for bedsits, where there can be a direct effect on neighbours, particularly in terms of noise and traffic congestion. Planning permission is not required for the use of a dwellinghouse by not more than six residents living together as a household. Where planning permission is required, it is important that there are sensitive planning controls to ensure that such conversions do not damage the existing character and amenity of established residential areas. 7.95 Parking requirements may be relaxed where appropriate, for example where the accommodation provided is for single persons or where there is adequate public car parking in the area. In this respect, the premises to be converted should be located close to local facilities and well served by public transport. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 111 POLICY Hsg7 CONVERSIONS FOR RESIDENTIAL USES PROPOSALS FOR THE CONVERSION OF DWELLINGS OR OTHER BUILDINGS TO SELF CONTAINED FLATS OR HOUSES IN MULTIPLE OCCUPATION, WILL BE APPROVED WHERE THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL IMPACT ON THE AMENITIES OF OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES OR ON THE CHARACTER OF THE SURROUNDING AREA. THE PARKING REQUIREMENTS SET OUT IN SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2 MAY BE RELAXED WHERE THERE IS PUBLIC PARKING AVAILABLE NEARBY, OR IN AREAS WELL SERVED BY PUBLIC TRANSPORT. 7.96 POLICY Hsg8 New residential accommodation can be provided in parts of buildings used for other purposes, particularly in vacant or underused space above shops. The 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan encouraged the residential use of upper floors of properties in the town centre and its fringes where it would not act as a major constraint to commercial activities in the area. The occupation of upper floors will prevent the deterioration of underused buildings and can lead to increased activity and vitality in a commercial area at night and also provide an increased element of security. The Borough Council considers that the residential use of upper floors should also be encouraged in appropriate areas outside the town centre including local shopping parades and areas where there are concentrations of local shops. Account will have to be taken, however, of the potential impact of noise and fumes which may arise from the commercial activities. RESIDENTIAL USE OF UPPER FLOORS PROPOSALS FOR THE RESIDENTIAL USE OF UPPER FLOORS OF PROPERTIES IN MIXED USE OR COMMERCIAL AREAS WILL BE APPROVED PROVIDED THAT THE FURTHER DEVELOPMENT OF COMMERCIAL ACTIVITIES IS NOT PREJUDICED AND SUBJECT, WHERE APPROPRIATE, TO THE INSTALLATION OF NOISE INSULATION AND FUME CONTROL EQUIPMENT. THE PARKING REQUIREMENTS SET OUT IN SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2 MAY BE RELAXED WHERE EXISTING PUBLIC PROVISION IS CONSIDERED ADEQUATE OR IN AREAS WELL SERVED BY PUBLIC TRANSPORT. LOW DENSITY HOUSING 7.97 As stated in paragraphs 7.3 to 7.7 above, and illustrated in Figure 7.1, there is an imbalance of the housing stock in Hartlepool. An important aspect of this is the relative shortage of detached houses, particularly at the highest end of the housing market. The Hartlepool Housing Market Dynamics Study concluded that the Borough Council should consider the provision of “larger 4-5 bedroom units to broaden the range and choice of housing stock, to encourage in-migration and discourage out-migration” (see paragraph 7.11 above) and the subsequent Housing Aspirations Study considers that it is necessary to provide good quality housing at the upper end of the market. The ‘shortage of larger executive 4/5 bedroom houses’ was also identified in the urban capacity study (see paragraph. 7.16 above). 7.98 The ODPM (Office of the Deputy Prime Minister) strategy for the North ‘Moving Forward: The Northern Way’ highlights that in the North East there is a shortage of ‘executive’ housing to attract people from higher socio-economic groups and these groups are critical to future economic success. If housing is not provided to meet the aspirations of these groups it is likely that the unsustainable out-migration patterns from the region will continue and the region will lose highly skilled workers to other regions. Linking housing 112 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 markets with economic growth is viewed as being critical, as will the provision of housing that meets the aspirations of highly skilled more economically prosperous workforce. 7.99 Further, the draft Regional Housing Strategy (RHS) (2005) outlines that key to the region’s future economic growth will be the retention and attraction of highly skilled workers. To do this a range of housing needs to be provided for these groups. It notes that the geographical areas of low demand closely reflect the distribution of disadvantage. These two factors can be mutually reinforcing, where large parts of the existing dwelling stock are not meeting current or future aspirations, and demand for all types and tenures of property has collapsed or is close to doing so. This is not conducive to delivering sustainable communities. 7.100 Delivering sustainable communities requires high quality housing and living environments in sustainable locations to facilitate and support accelerated economic growth. Both the RHS and emerging (submitted) Regional Spatial Strategy (RSS) recognise that this requires an approach that simultaneously tackles housing market failure and increases the region’s dwelling stock resulting in increased build rates and demolition rates. 7.101 The Regional Housing Aspiration Study commissioned by One North East and the Regional Housing Board found that the success of three authorities in North East (including Stockton and Darlington) in attracting and retaining a balanced population was linked to providing sufficient build rates of types of housing sought by those within the intermediate and higher socio-economic groups. The study found that these authorities had benefited at the expense of neighbouring authorities that had not provided an appropriate scale and range of new housing. 7.102 The Hartlepool Low Density Housing Study (July 2005) points out that the high build rates in Hartlepool have helped to stem population outflows from the Borough, (although there is a large net outflow to Stockton arising from the quantity of aspirational housing stock available which is attracting economically active higher socio-economic groups to that area) but have failed to attract new people into the town. It states that unless Hartlepool begins to offer housing of choice to attract in-migrants this will constrain economic growth in Hartlepool and the sub-region in the future. Failure to provide housing of choice will result in continued out migration to areas that supply housing of choice. 7.103 The submitted RSS highlights in paragraph 3.71 that the provision and location of socalled ‘executive’ housing defined as the upper end of the market, and dwelling types under-represented in the current stock, like detached housing, will have an important part to play in attracting and retaining population. 7.104 ‘Executive’ housing at the upper end of the market can take the form of high density apartments and town houses or low density detached housing. The Victoria Harbour regeneration will incorporate the provision of a large number of high value, high quality apartments and town houses. 7.105 The Borough Council considers that there is a need for the provision of high quality housing of all types in order to secure the long term prosperity of the town and to achieve a balanced and sustainable community in the main urban area of Hartlepool. Provision of housing of an appropriate quality should encourage higher income households to remain in the town where they will contribute to its economic and social life. A good choice of quality housing will also be a factor in attracting, and keeping, job-creating investment. 7.106 A very large supply of high quality housing in the form of high density apartments and town houses will be provided in Victoria Harbour. In addition some high quality housing comprising larger 4-5 bedroom dwellings will be provided on various sites in the town, including parts of Middle Warren. 7.107 In terms of provision for low density and high quality housing as required by policy H6 of the Tees Valley Structure Plan, 7 sites were allocated in the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 113 for small scale and high quality executive housing to be developed at a density not normally exceeding 10 dwellings per hectare. Only one of these sites (Briarfields – paddock area) remains uncommitted as the Council has sought to phase its release after the Furness Field and Tunstall Court developments. 7.108 However, it is not proposed to allocate any land for low density housing at this time owing to the need to ensure that the overall strategic housing requirement is not significantly exceeded. Nevertheless, should monitoring indicate a shortfall in housing land supply, the Briarfields site, comprising the Paddock area as formerly allocated in the 1994 Local Plan, together with Briarfields House and the ambulance station, could be brought forward for development, subject to the provisions of policy Hsg5 on the management of housing land supply. Although the Paddock area has not been previously developed, it falls within the definition of vacant land considered in government guidance on urban capacity studies to be a main source of housing capacity. The site is thus sequentially preferable to greenfield sites. Further the development of this area should enable the future of Briarfields House to be secured. NEW RESIDENTIAL REQUIREMENTS DEVELOPMENT: DESIGN, LAYOUT AND OTHER 7.109 New residential development should provide living environments that are attractive, create a ‘sense of place’ and make a positive contribution to the quality of Hartlepool. It is essential to ensure that new housing is not detrimental to the amenities of the surrounding area, and that the scale and character is appropriate to the locality. In Conservation Areas, new housing should preserve or enhance the character or appearance of the area (see policy HE1). 7.110 PPG3 seeks to ensure the best use of land and states that local planning authorities should avoid housing developments of less than 30 dwellings per hectare net and encourage those at higher densities. Higher densities may be appropriate in areas close to the town centre and its facilities or in areas which are highly accessible to public transport. However due regard should be had in this respect to the scale and character of the site and its surroundings. 7.111 Tandem development, where one house is located behind the other sharing the same access or having an access very close to the frontage house, is unlikely to achieve appropriate standards of design, privacy and access. 114 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Hsg9 NEW RESIDENTIAL LAYOUT – DESIGN AND OTHER REQUIREMENTS PROPOSALS FOR RESIDENTIAL DEVELOPMENT WILL BE PERMITTED IN LOCATIONS WHICH ACCORD WITH POLICIES Hsg5 AND Hsg6 ABOVE PROVIDED THAT: i. THE SCALE OF THE PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT IS APPROPRIATE TO THE LOCALITY, AND WHERE PERTINENT, THE OPEN CHARACTER OF THE AREA IS RETAINED, ii. THERE IS SUFFICIENT PROVISION OF PRIVATE AMENITY SPACE WITHIN EACH CURTILAGE COMMENSUATE WITH THE SIZE OF EACH DWELLING AND THE CHARACTER OF THE AREA, iii. THERE IS AN ADEQUATE PROVISION OF CASUAL AND FORMAL PLAY AREAS (SEE POLICY Rec2), iv. ADEQUATE AREAS OF SAFE, ACCESSIBLE AND ATTRACTIVE OPEN SPACE ARE PROVIDED AS APPROPRIATE, v. THE LOCATION OF THE NEW DEVELOPMENT IS SUCH THAT THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE OCCUPIERS OF BOTH THE NEW AND EXISTING DEVELOPMENT - TANDEM DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED, vi. THE SITE IS NEITHER SUBJECT TO UNACCEPTABLE POLLUTION BY REASON OF NOISE, DUST, FUMES OR SMELL, NOR TO POTENTIAL NUISANCE OR HAZARD CREATED BY EXISTING OR APPROVED COMMERCIAL OR INDUSTRIAL ACTIVITIES, vii. EXISTING FEATURES OF INTEREST, INCLUDING TREES AND HEDGEROWS, WATERCOURSES AND WETLANDS ARE RETAINED, viii. APPROPRIATE PROVISION IS MADE FOR SAFE AND CONVENIENT PEDESTRIAN AND CYCLE ROUTES (SEE POLICIES Tra5 AND Tra8), viiia. THERE IS ADEQUATE ACCESS TO PUBLIC TRANSPORT (SEE POLICY Tra19), AND ix. TRAFFIC CALMING MEASURES ARE PROVIDED. IN GENERAL, THE NET DENSITY OF DEVELOPMENTS SHOULD BE AT LEAST 30 DWELLINGS PER HECTARE, BUT HIGHER DENSITIES WILL BE SOUGHT, ON SITES CLOSE TO THE TOWN CENTRE OR READILY ACCESSIBLE TO PUBLIC TRANSPORT. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK FINANCIAL CONTRIBUTIONS FROM DEVELOPERS FOR THE PROVISION OF ADDITIONAL WORKS DEEMED TO BE REQUIRED AS A RESULT OF THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICIES GEP9, Rec2, Rec3 AND Tra19). HOUSE EXTENSIONS 7.112 Many householders in seeking to acquire more living space and additional facilities choose to extend their existing homes rather than move to a new house. If, however, extensions are inappropriately designed, they can cause problems for immediate neighbours in terms of loss of privacy and overlooking. They can also affect the amenities of the wider area, particularly where they may be a proliferation of extensions concentrated in small areas, or where a terracing effect is being created by the erection of side extensions to semi-detached or detached dwellings. The Borough Council has therefore reviewed its guidelines on residential extensions for development control purposes and these are included as Supplementary Note 4. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 115 POLICY Hsg10 RESIDENTIAL EXTENSIONS PROPOSALS FOR ALTERATIONS AND EXTENSIONS TO RESIDENTIAL PROPERTIES SHOULD: i. ii. iii. iv. v. BE OF A SIZE, DESIGN, MATERIALS AND EXTERNAL APPEARANCE THAT HARMONIZES WITH THE EXISTING DWELLING, BE UNOBTRUSIVE AND NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE CHARACTER OF THE STREET, NOT SIGNIFICANTLY AFFECT THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJACENT OR NEARBY PROPERTIES THROUGH OVERLOOKING, OVERSHADOWING OR BY CREATING POOR OUTLOOK, NOT DENY THE EXISTING AND FUTURE OCCUPIERS OF THE DWELLING TO BE EXTENDED, REASONABLE OUTDOOR SPACE FOR NORMAL DOMESTIC NEEDS OR ADEQUATE PARKING SPACE WITHIN THE CURTILAGE, AND NOT OBSTRUCT VISIBILITY FOR PEDESTRIANS OR DRIVERS OF MOTOR VEHICLES OR OTHERWISE PREJUDICE ROAD SAFETY. PROPOSALS WHICH ARE NOT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE GUIDANCE SET OUT IN SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 4 WILL NOT BE APPROVED. RESIDENTIAL ANNEXES FOR RELATIVES 7.113 POLICY Hsg11 The accommodation needs of families can change and there is often a desire for accommodation for relatives to be provided adjoining the main family home. Usually this is in the form of an extension to the property, but sometimes a separate structure within the curtilage of the property can be converted, or very rarely, a new building erected in the grounds of the property. It is important to ensure that where such separate accommodation is provided, that it is not of a form that would encourage its occupation as a separate dwelling. RESIDENTIAL ANNEXES PROPOSALS FOR EXTENSIONS TO PROVIDE ACCOMMODATION FOR RELATIVES OF THE OCCUPIER OF THE DWELLING WILL BE APPROVED PROVIDED THEY ACCORD WITH POLICY Hsg10 AND THEY ARE DESIGNED TO ENABLE INCORPORATION INTO THE EXISTING DWELLING WHEN NO LONGER REQUIRED. WHERE AN EXTENSION IS NOT APPROPRIATE FOR DESIGN REASONS, CONVERSION OF AN OUTBUILDING (OR EXCEPTIONALLY A NEW BUILDING) MAY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. ii. IT IS OF A SATISFACTORY SCALE, LOCATION AND DESIGN IN RELATION TO THE EXISTING DWELLING, ITS CURTILAGE AND SURROUNDING DWELLINGS, AND IT IS DESIGNED SO THAT IT WILL SERVE AN ANCILLARY FUNCTION TO THE MAIN HOUSE AND IS NOT OF A FORM THAT WOULD ENCOURAGE ITS OCCUPATION AS A SEPARATE DWELLING WHEN NO LONGER REQUIRED. PLANNING CONDITIONS WILL BE APPLIED BINDING THE OCCUPATION OF THE ACCOMMODATION PROVIDED TO THE OCCUPATION OF THE MAIN DWELLING. 116 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HOMES AND HOSTELS 7.114 Residential institutions including nursing homes and residential care homes are appropriately located in residential areas convenient for access to public transport and local facilities. They can be provided as new buildings or conversions of larger detached or semi-detached dwellings. There has been an increase in the number of such developments over the last few years, primarily as a result of the ‘Care in the Community’ policies. It is important to ensure that the concentration of such uses does not lead to a deterioration in the character of particular areas or of the amenity of adjoining householders in terms of additional traffic generation, noise, visual intrusion, loss of privacy and overshadowing. 7.115 Temporary or permanent housing (hostels) providing accommodation for the homeless should also be located in areas well served by public transport and close to community facilities. Care needs to be taken in the location of some hostels as these can give rise to concerns in occupants of neighbouring properties relating to the fear of crime. Appropriate account will have to be taken of such concerns. POLICY Hsg12 HOMES AND HOSTELS PROPOSALS FOR RESIDENTIAL INSTITUTIONS FALLING WITHIN CLASS C2 OF THE TOWN AND COUNTRY PLANNING (USE CLASSES) ORDER 1987 (AS AMENDED) AND FOR HOSTELS WILL BE APPROVED PROVIDED THAT THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL IMPACT ON THE AMENITY OF OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING AND NEIGHBOURING PROPERTIES OR ON THE CHARACTER OF THE SURROUNDING AREA, AND SUBJECT TO: i. ii. iii. THE DEVELOPMENT BEING CONVENIENTLY LOCATED FOR ACCESS TO PUBLIC TRANSPORT, SHOPPING AND OTHER COMMUNITY FACILITIES, AN APPROPRIATE AMOUNT OF CAR PARKING (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2) BEING PROVIDED WITHIN THE CURTILAGE OF THE DEVELOPMENT WITHOUT CAUSING UNDUE DISTURBANCE ON THE SITE, WITHIN THE BUILDING OR TO ADJOINING RESIDENTIAL PROPERTIES, AND THE PROVISION OF AMENITY SPACE TO MEET THE NEEDS OF RESIDENTS COMMENSUATE WITH THE SIZE AND CAPACITY OF THE BUILDING. MOBILE HOMES 7.116 Residential mobile homes can provide a form of affordable housing accommodation. However, the Hartlepool Housing Dynamics Study found that a shortage of affordable housing was not an issue in the town. There is already a large residential mobile home park on the fringe of the town at Ash Vale, off Easington Road and further mobile homes at Seaton Carew, and therefore the Borough Council does not consider it appropriate to allocate any additional areas for the development of mobile homes. 7.117 Where proposals are brought forward, residential mobile homes should be located where they are not visually intrusive, and in general, in areas well served by public transport and close to existing residential areas where appropriate community facilities are available. For these reasons, therefore, they should normally be located within the urban area, although they should not occupy land that would be more appropriately developed for permanent uses. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 117 POLICY Hsg13 RESIDENTIAL MOBILE HOMES PROPOSALS FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADDITIONAL LAND RESIDENTIAL MOBILE HOMES WILL ONLY BE APPROVED IF THE SITE: i. ii. iii. iv. FOR IS LOCATED WITHIN THE DEFINED URBAN FENCE AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, DOES NOT OCCUPY LAND ALLOCATED FOR PERMANENT DEVELOPMENT, IS NOT LOCATED IN A GREEN WEDGE OR ON LAND PROTECTED BY POLICIES GN3 AND GN6, AND IS CONVENIENTLY LOCATED FOR ACCESS TO PUBLIC TRANSPORT, SCHOOLS AND OTHER LOCAL FACILITIES. WHERE DEVELOPMENT IS TO BE APPROVED, SUBSTANTIAL LANDSCAPING WILL BE REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN VISUAL AMENITY. DEVELOPMENT SHOULD ALSO MEET THE RELEVANT CRITERIA SET OUT IN POLICY Hsg9. 7.118 Proposals for individual temporary mobile homes will be considered on their merits when needed, for example whilst permanent accommodation is being erected or in relation to the establishment of new agricultural enterprises. ACCOMMODATION FOR GYPSIES/TRAVELLERS 7.119 The Department of the Environment Circular 1/94 ‘Gypsy Sites and Planning’ asks local planning authorities to assess the need for gypsy accommodation in their areas and, wherever possible, to identify locations suitable for gypsy sites in their development plans. Although on occasions, gypsies have set up in unofficial encampments in Hartlepool, in general the town is not considered to be on a main travellers’ route. The biannual counts since 1993 have not revealed any significant numbers of gypsy caravans. There is thus little evidence to support the need for a gypsy site and the Borough Council therefore does not consider it appropriate to identify a specific site at this time. 7.120 In the event of it being envisaged by the gypsies that a site is required, the site would need to be located where it would not give rise to nuisance to neighbouring residences and workplaces, yet be convenient for access to certain community facilities, particularly shops, schools and medical services. The amenities to be provided on a site will vary according to whether the site is required for long-term use or as a temporary stopping place, or is a transit site only. POLICY Hsg14 GYPSY SITE PROPOSALS FOR THE PROVISION OF GYPSY SITES WILL BE APPROVED WHERE THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITY OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES AND PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. v. 118 THERE IS ADEQUATE ACCESS TO THE SITE AND PROVISION FOR PARKING, TURNING AND SERVICING WITHIN THE SITE, THE SITE IS ACCESSIBLE TO FACILITIES INCLUDING SCHOOLS, MEDICAL FACILITIES AND SHOPS, THE SITE IS NEITHER SUBJECT TO UNACCEPTABLE POLLUTION BY REASON OF NOISE, DUST, FUMES OR SMELL, NOR TO POTENTIAL NUISANCE OR HAZARD CREATED BY EXISTING OR APPROVED COMMERCIAL OR INDUSTRIAL ACTIVITIES, THE SITE IS ADEQUATELY SCREENED AND LANDSCAPED, IF REQUIRED, THE SIZE OF THE SITE IS LARGE ENOUGH TO ACCOMMODATE SEPARATE RESIDENTIAL AND BUSINESS USES AND ADDITIONAL PARKING SPACE FOR EXTRA CARAVANS, CARS AND LORRIES. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 8. TRANSPORT CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 8.1 The development and implementation of transport policies for roads and public transport greatly influences development proposals relating to other major land uses such as industry, retail, housing and recreation. The need for an efficient and effective network of highways and public transport both locally and regionally is a key factor in the overall economy and environment of the town. These aspects are reflected in the Borough Council’s Local Transport Plan (LTP) which sets out the local transport vision for the year 2021: “Hartlepool will have a high quality, integrated and safe transport system that supports continued economic growth and regeneration. It will provide access to key services and facilities for all members of society…” 8.2 It is important to realise that both the Hartlepool Local Plan and the Local Transport Plan are very strongly linked and complement each other with regard to transport policies and proposals in Hartlepool. The strategies identified in the LTP are reflected, where appropriate, in the local plan and vice versa. 8.3 The Borough Council has sought, through its powers, to promote rail and road links within the Borough by:♦ ♦ ♦ 8.4 campaigning for direct improvements in the rail service in order to maintain and strengthen the communication links to and from the town, supporting improvements in the highway network, and promoting and co-ordinating a safe and effective traffic system within the town through good traffic management in order to enhance the physical environment of the town. Since local government reorganisation in 1996, Hartlepool Borough Council has the main responsibility for most transport matters in the Borough, previously the responsibility of Cleveland County Council. Hartlepool Community Strategy 8.5 The Hartlepool Partnership’s Community Strategy seeks to provide a safe and effective integrated transport system that enables equal accessibility and maximum choice. It aims to: • • • improve transport facilities and encourage other forms of transport, develop wider transport choices in order to address the problems of road traffic congestion and reduce dependence on the car. to promote accessibility for all, especially those without a car. to promote integration of all forms of transport and land use planning. Hartlepool Local Transport Plan 8.6 Hartlepool Borough Council has taken the principles of the Government’s Transport White Paper “A New Deal for Transport: Better for Everyone” as the central theme of its Local Transport Plan (LTP). The LTP, in tandem with the Hartlepool Local Plan, will help shape transport policy in the Borough. The lifetime of the LTP is 5 years (2006 – 2011) and it will thus be reviewed during this local plan period (2001 – 2016). It is therefore vital that these documents complement each other in terms of transport strategy and policy. The LTP should be used alongside the local plan in reference to transport strategy and policies. The local plan will, through its written statement and policies, seek to reflect the strategies set out in the LTP. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 119 Structure Plan Policies 8.7 With respect to the general transport system, policies T1 and T2 in the Tees Valley Structure Plan state that proposals and policies for new infrastructure in the Tees Valley will be evaluated against given criteria to deal with identified transport problems. The formation of public and private partnerships will help to develop a sustainable integrated transport system. The need to improve and maintain facilities for those with disabilities and mobility difficulties will be fully incorporated into all transport systems (policy T3). 8.8 The structure plan seeks to ensure that improved facilities for pedestrians and cyclists will be continued and improved (policies T4, T5 and T6). 8.9 In terms of the rail network, the structure plan will seek to secure improved rail services and facilities. Land is reserved for an extension of the railway line from Seal Sands to Graythorp to provide links to the proposed Tees Crossing and to ensure the routes of disused railways are safeguarded (policy T8). The provision of new rail halts will be encouraged along with the reopening of former stations (policy T9). 8.10 In terms of freight, the plan seeks to control routes taken by heavy goods vehicles where there are problems of safety and environmental intrusion (policy T20). It also encourages proposals for the provision of alternative freight and freight transfer facilities related to rail and water transport (policies T10, T11 and T16) where it may reduce the number of heavy goods vehicles on the road. 8.11 Improved infrastructure for use by bus will continue to be provided including a network of busways and green routes (policies T13 and T14). Alignments for improvements to the primary and trunk route network are to be protected from development (policy T18). 8.12 The structure plan also seeks to ensure that there is sufficient off-street car parking (policies T23 and T24) and proposes that traffic management and calming schemes will be continued (policy T22). Local Plan Objectives 8.13 In conjunction with the main aim of the local plan and the strategy for the maximisation of accessibility, the following objectives are particularly relevant in drawing up the policies and proposals relating to transport: A5 B2 C1 C3 D1 D3 D4 120 to ensure that there is an adequate infrastructure to serve new and existing development to ensure that Hartlepool Town Centre continues to fulfil its role as a compact attractive, competitive and viable facility providing a wide range of attractions and amenities with convenient access for the whole community to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of conservation areas, listed buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest to ensure the provision of a safe, efficient and economic transport network to ensure that developments attracting large numbers of people locate in existing centres which are highly accessible by means other than the private car to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS 8.14 In 2001 there were 39.3% of households in Hartlepool with no car. This figure is well above the national average of 26.8% (England & Wales, 2001 Census). Therefore, it is important that appropriate and accessible provision is made for modes of transport other than the private car. This includes public transport (bus and rail services) and personal transport (for cyclists and walkers). PUBLIC TRANSPORT Bus Services 8.15 In terms of bus transport and provision, personal mobility can be increased and improved through measures such as bus-only lanes, the removal of traffic congestion on bus priority routes, the introduction of low-floor buses and supporting infrastructure as well as by financial measures such as supporting unprofitable bus services. Electronic signalling for buses may be possible in the future, giving priority to buses at junctions and along particular stretches of road. 8.16 One bus priority route (the North-South Priority Route) has been identified and some traffic management measures have been introduced particularly along the central section of the route through the town centre. The central section of York Road, between Victoria Road and Park Road, has been made a bus priority link. This has helped to divert traffic from a main shopping street in Hartlepool to the A689/A179 route to the east of the town centre shopping area. These works incorporated improvements to pedestrian and bus stop facilities and have improved the environment around the town centre. 8.17 The Borough Council will continue to seek new priority routes during the local plan period. Possibilities include the bus route from the South Fens to the Headland via the town centre linking to the North-South route. POLICY Tra1 BUS PRIORITY ROUTES (a) Tra1 MEASURES WILL BE TAKEN TO IMPROVE THE PASSAGE OF BUSES AND THE COMFORT OF PASSENGERS ALONG THE NORTH-SOUTH BUS PRIORITY ROUTE (AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP) INCLUDING: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ IMPROVEMENT TO JUNCTIONS TO GIVE PRIORITY TO BUSES (SEE ALSO POLICY Tra10), PROVISION OF IMPROVED INFRASTRUCTURE, SUCH AS LAY-BYS AND BUS SHELTERS, IMPOSITION OF TRAFFIC REGULATION ORDERS WHERE APPROPRIATE, AND PROVISION OF LOW FLOOR BUSES. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO IDENTIFY FURTHER BUS PRIORITY ROUTES WITHIN THE TOWN. 8.18 The bus network can be extended into new development areas where road layouts are designed to cater for public transport. It is therefore important that early discussions take place regarding the need to cater for bus routes in the design of new residential and industrial areas (see policy Tra19 below). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 121 Rail Services 8.19 It is important that existing rail services are maintained and improved at Hartlepool and Seaton Carew stations ensuring adequate links to the regional and national networks. Rail will be one of the modes of transport which is likely to increase in popularity over the coming years, and as such will play a significant role in the future of public transport. Therefore, it is vital that frequency and reliability of services is of a high standard for Hartlepool. The Borough Council will work to improve and provide facilities to cater for this increased popularity. In 2006 Grand Central secured an option to operate trains between Sunderland and London, with Hartlepool being one of the main stations on the route. This will mean a number of direct trains to London each day which will improve accessibility into and out of the town. 8.20 The strategy for rail-based infrastructure in Tees Valley includes proposals for rail loops north and south of the Tees. These loops will be linked by the proposed Tees crossing provisionally at Port Clarence – South Bank (forming a figure of eight system). Routes feeding into the system will provide connections to Durham/Tyneside (via the East Coast main line), Darlington, Northallerton and Tyneside/Wearside (via Hartlepool). 8.21 In developing such a rail network for the Tees Valley, accessibility between urban areas in the region and beyond would be improved. Hartlepool will play an important part in these proposals in order to gain the benefits that the system will bring. Benefits will include an increase in access and mobility to other urban areas in the Tees Valley, particularly areas such as Redcar and Cleveland and beyond (ie. the North Yorkshire Heritage Coast). A further benefit will be an increase in the choice of transport, reducing the need to use the car and providing better links to the regional and national rail networks. This route will convey both passengers and freight to the Tees crossing, reducing journey times to south Teesside dramatically. 8.22 Policy T8 of the Tees Valley Structure Plan protects railway alignments which will provide links to the Tees crossing, from development, including the ‘Seals Sands railway alignment between Graythorp and the proposed Tees crossing north approach’. A safeguarding route for this rail connection was identified in the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan and it will therefore continue to be identified in this plan. POLICY Tra2 RAILWAY LINE EXTENSION LAND IS RESERVED FOR AN EXTENSION OF THE RAILWAY LINE FROM THE SEATON SNOOK BRANCH LINE TO SEAL SANDS. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS WHICH AFFECT THE SAFEGUARDED ROUTE MAY HOWEVER BE APPROVED PROVIDED THAT A FEASIBLE ALTERNATIVE THROUGH ROUTE IS RETAINED. Rail Halts 8.23 122 The Borough Council is investigating the feasibility of identifying locations in the town for new rail halts and has identified a site at Hart Station. This would provide better access for the people who live in this northern part of the town. It is also considered to be appropriate as a secondary gateway for the Tees Forest via the Hart–Haswell Walkway (see paragraph 15.39 below). The site will need some minor development work in order that it may be able to perform a dual role. Parking may be provided for those using the proposed rail halt and also for use in conjunction with the development of a gateway site. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 8.24 A further rail halt may be developed at North Hartlepool, although the findings of the feasibility study suggest that development of a rail halt in this area would be less viable. There may also be options for the re-opening of Greatham Station. POLICY Tra3 RAIL HALTS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CONTINUE TO SUPPORT IMPROVEMENTS TO THE LOCAL RAILWAY NETWORK BY ACTIVELY ENCOURAGING THE PROVISION OF NEW RAIL HALTS ALONG THE RAIL CORRIDOR. INITIALLY A NEW HALT WILL BE PROVIDED AT HART STATION. Durham Tees Valley Airport 8.25 The Tees Valley Structure Plan highlights the expansion of Durham Tees Valley Airport both in terms of its passenger and freight handling facilities. Teesside Airport is an important economic generator within the Tees Valley. As a rapidly growing and increasingly important element of the Tees Valley transport network, providing benefits for residents and businesses in all local authorities in the Tees Valley, it is important that links are developed between Hartlepool and the airport to maximise these benefits. Public transport links (both bus and rail) will help to increase personal mobility for airport passengers and enhance the transport network for Tees Valley residents nationally and internationally. The Borough Council will seek to encourage improved passenger transport links between Hartlepool and Durham Tees Valley Airport in relation to the Tees Valley transport network. Integrated Public Transport 8.26 Proposals have been put forward in the structure plan for enhanced rail and bus facilities to form an integrated system for the Tees Valley sub-region into which the Hartlepool area should be linked. 8.27 Since the removal of the United/Tees Bus Station and Depot at Church Square in 1993, there has been no central hub facility for public transport in Hartlepool. Alternative facilities will need to be provided if the town is to benefit from inward investment through business, tourism and leisure visitors. 8.28 As part of an overall strategy to aid transport integration, Hartlepool Borough Council is proposing to undertake an audit of the signing of walking routes to stations. In addition, it is proposed to investigate links with local bus routes. 8.29 However, to fully recoup the maximum benefit of integrated public transport for residents of the town and visitors, feasibility studies have recently been undertaken to identify the level of need for interchange facilities for Hartlepool. A site at Church Square (east of Gateway Bridge) was identified and public consultation has been carried out on a preliminary scheme design. A central interchange facility, providing appropriate services, will improve the accessibility and personal mobility of Hartlepool residents to other areas of the Tees Valley and beyond. It will also create a positive first impression to visitors to the town. 8.30 The area of land on the eastern side of Gateway Bridge at Church Square, close to the railway station, is therefore protected from permanent development in policy Tra4 below. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 123 POLICY Tra4 PUBLIC TRANSPORT INTERCHANGE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL HAS EXAMINED THE POTENTIAL FOR PROVIDING A PUBLIC TRANSPORT INTERCHANGE FACILITY IN CENTRAL HARTLEPOOL. A SITE AT CHURCH SQUARE (EAST OF GATEWAY BRIDGE) WAS GRANTED PLANNING PERMISSION IN NOVEMBER 2004. PERMANENT DEVELOPMENT WHICH WOULD IMPEDE THE PROVISION OF AN INTERCHANGE FACILITY ON THIS SITE WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. THE CYCLE NETWORK 8.31 The Tees Valley Cycling Strategy (1998) sets out an overall strategic guide for the individual Borough Councils to work towards and achieve the Tees Valley targets in terms of cycle provision. The document presents a strategy for promoting, encouraging and integrating the use of cycling as a sustainable means of transport in the Tees Valley. The Borough Council takes this strategy into account in its cycle provision policies. 8.32 Cycleways and greenways offer opportunities for improved conditions for journeys to work and for leisure by increasing road safety and creating more environmentally attractive routes. Local and sub-regional networks should link into the national Sustrans network which runs north – south along the coast within the Borough. Other routes have also been identified through the Tees Valley Cycling Strategy, such as Greatham–Seaton Carew and Greatham– Summerhill. Work has been carried out on defining other routes through the Local Transport Plan (see Diagram 8.1). Several individual schemes began during the lifetime of the previous local plan and are already in place. 8.33 A comprehensive network of cycle routes and greenways is desirable to link the town centre with communities and other residential areas within the Borough and improve traffic safety. In particular, the Marina, Seaton Carew and the Headland could be integrated into the current network of routes. It is proposed that a new pedestrian and cycle bridge across the entrance of the Harbour will be provided as part of the major regeneration scheme at Victoria Harbour. 8.34 Links to the main network should be provided in new developments. The charging of commuted sums to those who wish to develop residential, commercial or recreational development will enable the cycle network to take shape much more quickly (see policy Tra19 below). 124 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 125 POLICY Tra5 CYCLEWAYS NETWORK PROVISION WILL BE MADE FOR THE CONTINUED DEVELOPMENT OF A COMPREHENSIVE NETWORK OF CYCLE ROUTES LINKING MAIN AREAS OF THE BOROUGH. THESE INCLUDE THE FOLLOWING: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ TOWN CENTRE - NORTH WEST HARTLEPOOL, TOWN CENTRE - SOUTH EAST HARTLEPOOL, MARINA – HEADLAND, MARINA - SEATON CAREW – GREATHAM, GREATHAM – SUMMERHILL, SAPPERS CORNER – WYNYARD, AND GRAYTHORP – GREATHAM. PROPOSALS FOR NEW HOUSING AND INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENT, FOR HIGHWAY IMPROVEMENTS AND TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT SCHEMES SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE NEED TO PROVIDE LINKS TO THE CYCLE NETWORK (SEE ALSO POLICY Tra19). 8.35 POLICY Tra6 Secure cycle parking at destinations is also essential if people are to be persuaded to cycle. The level of provision sought will take account of the number of people likely to be attracted to the development, the distance travelled to reach it and the existence of any cycle parking provisions in the immediate area. Generally, cycle parking and storage facilities should be provided in well-lit areas, capable of being overlooked from nearby buildings or by passing pedestrians. Developers should consult the local planning authority, so that such facilities can be incorporated into the scheme at the design stage; otherwise, cycle parking may be secured through the imposition of a condition on a planning consent. CYCLE FACILITIES DEVELOPMENTS WHICH ATTRACT OR ARE LIKELY TO ATTRACT SIGNIFICANT NUMBERS OF PEOPLE, WHETHER AS VISITORS OR EMPLOYEES, WILL BE REQUIRED TO PROVIDE ON SITE, SECURE AND CONVENIENT CYCLE PARKING PROVISION, THE LEVEL OF SUCH PROVISION TO BE AGREED WITH THE LOCAL PLANNING AUTHORITY. PROVISION FOR PEDESTRIANS Improvements to the Pedestrian Environment 8.36 Environmental conditions for pedestrians can be considerably improved by traffic management schemes designed to relieve road congestion and improve road safety. In the town centre, the York Road bus priority link will provide improved pedestrian facilities complementing those already completed in Victoria Road. The pedestrian environment will be enhanced further by the junction improvements identified in policy Tra10 below. Improvements to Pedestrian Linkages 8.37 Improvements will need to be made to the linkages for pedestrians as well as cyclists between the town centre and other parts of the town, in particular the tourism areas of the Marina, Headland and Seaton Carew. 8.38 The proposed cycle network has a role to play in providing a link between the two areas. However, alternative routes for pedestrians should be considered in 126 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 addition to the Gateway Bridge route. Possibilities for additional links between the town centre and Marina could include a pedestrian footbridge over the railway line and also access through the underpass adjacent to the railway station. Linkages could be incorporated into the possible public transport interchange located at Church Square. 8.39 Links between the town centre and the Headland could be improved further by regeneration work taking place on the Headland under the Single Regeneration Budget. There may be opportunities to create links via a ferry across the harbour between the Marina and the Headland for example. POLICY Tra7 PEDESTRIAN LINKAGES: TOWN CENTRE / HEADLAND / SEATON CAREW IMPROVEMENTS WILL CONTINUE TO BE MADE TO THE PEDESTRIAN ENVIRONMENT IN THE CENTRAL AREA. IN PARTICULAR, IMPROVED PEDESTRIAN LINKS WILL BE PROVIDED BETWEEN THE PRIMARY SHOPPING AREA AND OTHER PARTS OF THE TOWN CENTRE INCLUDING THE MILL HOUSE, CHURCH STREET (INCLUDING THE PROPOSED INTERCHANGE) AND MARINA AREAS. IMPROVED PEDESTRIAN LINKS WILL ALSO BE PROVIDED WITHIN AND BETWEEN THE MARINA, SEATON CAREW AND THE HEADLAND, INCLUDING A PROPOSED NEW PEDESTRIAN BRIDGE AT VICTORIA HARBOUR. Pedestrian Routes Within Housing Areas 8.40 Safe and convenient pedestrian routes linking local shops, schools, community centres, play areas etc. can be provided in new housing developments. Such routes should be of sufficient width to allow for the provision of landscaping. POLICY Tra8 PEDESTRIAN ROUTES – RESIDENTIAL AREAS PROPOSALS FOR RESIDENTIAL DEVELOPMENT SHOULD PROVIDE FOR SAFE AND CONVENIENT PEDESTRIAN ROUTES TO LINK NEW HOUSING TO LOCAL FACILITIES AND AMENITIES. 8.41 The proposed recreational routes will also provide improved pedestrian routes across the Borough. These will link the urban area to rural and remote coastal locations (see policy Rec9 below). TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT 8.42 Traffic management has a large impact on land use issues relating to transport and vice versa. This is particularly the case in the town centre. The implementation of traffic management schemes can have a very important effect in easing traffic flows, assisting road safety, giving priority to public transport and improving the environment for pedestrians and cyclists. Traffic management methods will be used to improve the road network for the benefit of all road users by implementing measures that maximise the efficiency of existing transport systems rather than relying on new road construction. The Hartlepool Local Transport Plan considers these issues further. With Government policy moving away from new road building, traffic management needs to be more effective than ever before. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 127 Traffic Management in the Town Centre 8.43 POLICY Tra9 In association with the remodelling of the central section of York Road to a bus priority link, it will be necessary to introduce and maintain traffic management measures. In particular, the road network in the areas north of Victoria Road and west of York Road will need to be remodelled to discourage through traffic and divert vehicles onto the A689/A179 route. TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT IN THE TOWN CENTRE TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT MEASURES INVOLVING THE CLOSING OFF OF SECTIONS OF ROADS, ALTERATIONS TO PRIORITIES AT JUNCTIONS, AND THE ALTERATIONS OR INTRODUCTION OF ONEWAY AND BUS-PRIORITY SYSTEMS, WILL CONTINUE TO BE CARRIED OUT IN THE TOWN CENTRE BETWEEN YORK ROAD, VICTORIA ROAD, CLARENCE ROAD AND MIDDLETON ROAD. FURTHER MEASURES TO MINIMISE TRAFFIC FLOWS AND IMPROVE THE ENVIRONMENT FOR RESIDENTIAL PROPERTIES TO THE WEST OF YORK ROAD WILL BE INVESTIGATED AND IMPLEMENTED WHERE APPROPRIATE. Improvements to Road Junctions 8.44 POLICY Tra10 Problems of congestion and safety can be eased by relatively minor improvement works to road junctions such as signing, changes in priorities and the installation of traffic lights. The Hart Lane / Raby Road junction has recently been improved to facilitate passage by buses as part of the North-South bus priority route. In addition most of the major junctions along the main roads through the town will also be improved to ease the flow of traffic and improve the environment for pedestrians and cyclists. ROAD JUNCTION IMPROVEMENTS AN IMPROVEMENT SCHEME WILL BE CARRIED OUT AT THE VICTORIA ROAD/A689 JUNCTION. FURTHER JUNCTIONS ALONG THE A689/A179 CORRIDOR WILL BE IMPROVED WHEN RESOURCES PERMIT. 8.45 Traffic measures are currently being implemented through the North Hartlepool SRB initiative within the town. More may come forward in future as part of the successful SRB funding bid for the Headland area. PERSONAL MOBILITY 8.46 128 The above proposals for new and improved road junctions, improvements to public transport, and to facilities for pedestrians and cyclists, will all help to improve personal mobility. The Borough Council places great importance on ensuring that the mobility impaired, have greater opportunities for personal mobility in transport terms (see policy GEP2). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 THE HIGHWAY NETWORK Strategic Road Schemes 8.47 The Tees Valley Structure Plan, in policy T18, identifies the following two primary and major road improvement schemes in Hartlepool which are to be protected from other development: ♦ ♦ A19 Wolviston Samsung Second Access, and B1277/A178 Brenda Road / Tees Road In addition the Borough Council considers it appropriate to continue to safeguard a corridor for the upgrading of the Powlett Road section of the A179. 8.48 A19 Wolviston Second Samsung Access: The corridor for a second access to the Samsung development from the A19 Wolviston slip road (southbound) will be safeguarded. This will enable access to land for Phase 3 of the North Burn electronic components park. Planning approval is in place for the scheme; however, this will expire in 2006. 8.49 B1277/A178 Brenda Road/Tees Road: A corridor of land continues to be identified along the B1277 Brenda Road and the section of the A178 between Brenda Road and Greatham Creek to allow for the future upgrading of this route in connection with the Tees crossing proposal put forward in the structure plan. The development of the scheme will take close consideration of the internationally important wildlife sites within the surrounding environment. Safe parking for birdwatching and nature conservation groups will be incorporated into the scheme at the Greatham Creek road bridge. 8.50 A179 (Powlett Road) Improvement: The improvement of this section of the A179 to dual-carriageway would complete the upgrading of the whole stretch of the A179 in the inner urban area of Hartlepool out to the A19. Investigations into the feasibility and requirement of this scheme will be undertaken by the Borough Council prior to any improvement to the road being considered. POLICY Tra11 STRATEGIC ROAD SCHEMES NO PERMANANT DEVELOPMENT WILL BE PERMITTED WITHIN CORRIDORS OF LAND SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP WHICH ARE RESERVED FOR FUTURE SCHEMES TO IMPROVE OR CONSTRUCT THE FOLLOWING ROADS: a. b. c. A19 WOLVISTON SECOND SAMSUNG ACCESS, B1277/A178 BRENDA ROAD/TEES ROAD, AND A179 (POWLETT ROAD) IMPROVEMENT. Other Road Improvements 8.51 A number of other improvement schemes, not included in the structure plan, and affecting secondary and local access roads, are proposed in the local plan. Safeguarding routes for these are also defined on the Proposals Map. 8.52 North Graythorp Link Road: The provision of a new road linking Graythorp Road with Tofts Road West will provide an additional access to the North Graythorp industrial area which is likely to be necessary both on highway and safety grounds and will assist in the effective promotion of undeveloped land at North Graythorp. The safeguarding corridor for this proposal is identified on the Proposals Map. However, consideration may be given to a variation in the alignment of the link road in exceptional circumstances such as the development HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 129 of North Graythorp for a single plant. be retained. In any event, a through route will need to 8.53 Middleton Beach Road: This new road is intended to provide access to Middleton Beach and a viewing area from the Marina development, together with access to the lifeboat and coastwatch stations. It will generally run along the edge of Middleton Beach and enable public access to this area to be separate from the port activities of Hartlepool Docks. Developers of land adjacent to this route will make a contribution to the provision of the access road for which a corridor is reserved. 8.54 Middle Warren Spine Road (Merlin Way): This scheme will complete the main distributor road through the major Middle Warren housing development between Hart Lane and the roundabout on West View Road. It will cross the green wedge to link the northern and southern parts of the development and will be provided in stages by the developers in association with the residential development of the area. POLICY Tra12 ROAD SCHEME: NORTH GRAYTHORP A CORRIDOR OF LAND AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP IS SAFEGUARDED FOR THE CONSTRUCTION OF A LINK ROAD TO BE PROVIDED BY THE DEVELOPERS IN THE NORTH GRAYTHORP INDUSTRIAL AREA. SOME VARIATION MAY HOWEVER BE PERMITTED TO THIS CORRIDOR PROVIDED THAT AN ADEQUATE THROUGH ROUTE IS MAINTAINED. POLICY Tra13 ROAD SCHEMES: DEVELOPMENT SITES NO PERMANANT DEVELOPMENT WILL BE PERMITTED WITHIN THE CORRIDORS OF LAND SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP RESERVED FOR THE CONSTRUCTION OF THE FOLLOWING ROADS WHICH ARE TO BE PROVIDED BY DEVELOPERS: a. b. MERLIN WAY, AND MIDDLETON BEACH ROAD. Road Schemes No Longer Required 8.55 130 Two further road improvement corridors were safeguarded in the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan, but these are no longer required: ♦ A689/Brenda Road link: It is unlikely that this road will be developed within the period of this plan. Nevertheless there is a need to retain access points from the A689 and from Brenda Road to enable access to the high quality industrial land at Golden Flatts (see policy Tra14 below). If it is felt that a through-link is required, its development will be sought through developer contributions. ♦ Stephenson / Hunter House Industrial Estates link road: The former Stephenson industrial estate is currently being used for clay extraction and subsequent tipping and it is proposed in the longer term to develop the site as a nature reserve. It is therefore unlikely that the level of traffic generated in the area will necessitate the provision of a new link road. A turning circle will be required within Hunter House Industrial Estate, however, to cater for public transport access and other large vehicles. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Access to Development Sites 8.56 POLICY Tra14 In addition to identifying and safeguarding corridors for proposed road schemes, there is a need to identify proposed future access points for development sites where the details of internal road layouts will await firm proposals for development. These include various sites for housing and industrial uses. Access points to the Golden Flatts high quality industrial site are identified from both the A689 and from Brenda Road. However, it may be that the site will be accessed via the Queens Meadow business park instead of directly from the A689. ACCESS TO DEVELOPMENT SITES THE PRIMARY ACCESS POINTS TO THE FOLLOWING DEVELOPMENT SITES SHOULD, AS FAR AS PRACTICABLE, BE AS IDENTIFIED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP: ♦ ♦ VICTORIA HARBOUR, AND GOLDEN FLATTS. Restriction on Access to Major Roads 8.57 POLICY Tra15 Any increase in new main access points along the primary road network is likely to give rise to problems of highway safety (Circular 4/2001 highlights the Highways Agencies policy regarding such developments) and should therefore be resisted. The main routes where there are to be restrictions in access points are listed in policy Tra15 below. In addition to this it is also important to ensure that new access points onto other roads meet recognised standards (see policy GEP1). RESTRICTION ON ACCESS TO MAJOR ROADS PROPOSALS TO FORM NEW ACCESS POINTS OR THE INTENSIFICATION OF EXISTING ACCESSES TO THE FOLLOWING ROADS, WITH THE EXCEPTION OF THOSE IDENTIFIED IN POLICY Tra14 ABOVE, WILL NOT BE APPROVED: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ A19, A689, A179, AND A178 SOUTH OF SEATON CAREW TO BRENDA ROAD/TEES ROAD ROUNDABOUT. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CONSULT THE HIGHWAY AGENCY ON PROPOSALS WHICH WOULD BE LIKELY TO GENERATE A MATERIAL INCREASE IN TRAFFIC (AS DEFINED BY PPG13 TRANSPORT) ON THE A19 TRUNK ROAD. PROPOSALS FOR ACCESS ON OTHER ROADS SHOULD COMPLY WITH POLICY GEP1. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 131 CAR PARKING 8.58 On-street parking and the servicing of premises can cause problems of pedestrian/vehicular conflict, road congestion and visual intrusion. Therefore, it is necessary to ensure that, as far as practicable, off-street parking is provided in new developments. Maximum parking provision for particular developments are set out in Supplementary Note 2. For major developments or other developments likely to lead to an increase in travel, the Borough Council will require a Travel Plan (see Policy Tra20) as part of a legally binding agreement. 8.59 Some public parking is available serving part of the Town Centre. In the areas served by such car parks, it is therefore not generally appropriate for individual private car parks to be provided for customers and staff. This could disrupt the flow of traffic in the central area, increase congestion and also reduce the effectiveness of traffic management schemes designed to rationalise and improve vehicular and pedestrian circulation. The extent of these areas is shown on Diagram 8.2. In these areas, however, new developments should normally provide for operational requirements as far as possible (see Supplementary Note 2). 8.60 In terms of public parking in the vicinity of the primary shopping area, the Borough Council seeks to ensure sufficient provision to meet the demand for offstreet parking facilities. In doing so, regard will be made to environmental, physical and financial constraints. The Borough Council will require legally binding agreements to ensure that replacement car parking facilities are provided prior to any development at Park Road (see Policy Com3). 8.61 Currently, there is sufficient public car parking at Seaton Carew. Any new developments would be expected to provide parking and also use public parking. Public car parking will also cater for visitors. This will therefore remove the need for each commercial scheme to provide its own car parking. The current extent of the area of Seaton Carew served by public car parks is shown in Diagram 8.3. POLICY Tra16 CAR PARKING STANDARDS THE COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE A LEVEL OF PARKING WITH ALL NEW DEVELOPMENTS THAT SUPPORTS SUSTAINABLE TRANSPORT CHOICES. PARKING PROVISION SHOULD NOT EXCEED THE MAXIMUM FOR DEVELOPMENTS SET OUT IN SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2. PROPOSALS FOR MAJOR DEVELOPMENTS OR OTHER DEVELOPMENTS LIKELY TO LEAD TO AN INCREASE IN TRAVEL WILL BE EXPECTED TO SHOW IN A TRAVEL PLAN THE MEASURES TAKEN TO MINIMISE THE NEED FOR PARKING AND TO PROMOTE LINKED TRIPS AND ALTERNATIVE MEANS OF TRANSPORT. NON-OPERATIONAL PARKING WILL NOT BE REQUIRED WITHIN: ♦ ♦ AREAS OF THE TOWN CENTRE SERVED BY CAR PARKS, AND PARTS OF SEATON CAREW SERVED BY EXISTING CAR PARKS. IF IT IS CONSIDERED THAT SUCH PROVISION IS LIKELY TO HAVE A DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE STRATEGIC OPERATION OF CENTRAL AREA TRAFFIC POLICY, IT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED IN THE TOWN CENTRE. 132 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 133 134 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 FREIGHT Road Haulage: 8.62 The movement of freight by heavy goods vehicles can have a detrimental effect on the environment particularly in residential areas, and can cause damage to buildings and roadways through the use of inappropriate routes. Problems with HGVs are experienced in the villages within the Borough such as Elwick and Greatham. Weight restrictions can be imposed on certain lengths of roads in order to encourage heavy traffic to use the primary road network, improve environmental conditions and road safety in residential areas. Secure parking for HGVs has recently been made available at Longhill Industrial Estate. Rail Freight: 8.63 The Tees Valley Structure Plan, in policies T10 and T11, seeks to encourage the carriage of freight by rail where it will reduce the number of heavy road vehicles and achieves environmental benefits, and also to encourage users of rail for freight transport to locate at suitable sites. 8.64 In line with advice contained within PPG13 (Transport) and the Hartlepool Local Transport Plan (2006-11) the Borough Council will seek to improve the viability and attractiveness of rail freight as an alternative to road haulage and encourage its increase in the haulage market of Hartlepool. The pursuit of rail haulage will have benefits for Hartlepool. It will reduce the level of road haulage in Hartlepool, improving the environment and decrease congestion on the main routes. Freight sidings currently serve the Docks, Corus South Works and the Nuclear Power Station. Opportunities for rail haulage will be increased with the extension of the Seaton Snook branch line (see policy Tra2 above). 8.65 Grants contributing towards the cost of rail freight facilities are available under Section 56 of the Railways Act 1993. POLICY Tra17 RAILWAY SIDINGS IN ORDER TO FACILITATE THE TRANSPORT OF GOODS BY RAIL, ACCESS FROM INDUSTRIAL LAND TO THE RAILWAY SHOULD, WHERE POSSIBLE, BE PRESERVED. PROPOSALS INVOLVING THE PROVISION OF NEW RAIL SIDINGS TO SERVE INDUSTRIAL DEVELOPMENTS WILL, WHERE APPROPRIATE, BE SUPPORTED. POLICY Tra18 RAIL FREIGHT FACILITIES PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT OF EXISTING OR NEW SIDINGS TO FORM FREIGHT HANDLING FACILITIES WILL BE PERMITTED PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. THE PROPOSAL WILL NOT HAVE A DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE SURROUNDING AREA IN TERMS OF NOISE, TRAFFIC, HAZARD, VISUAL IMPACT AND ENVIRONMENTAL QUALITY, THE NATURE OF THE DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT UNDULY CONSTRAIN THE DEVELOPMENT OF ADJOINING LAND, THE CHOSEN LOCATION IS NOT ADJACENT TO RESIDENTIAL AREAS, AND THERE IS ADEQUATE ACCESS TO THE SITE FOR FREIGHT TRANSFER. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 135 TRANSPORT IN THE COUNTRYSIDE 8.66 Rural communities have particular transport needs and present particular problems in terms of accessibility. The transport provision for rural areas is, by nature, different to urban areas and should be sympathetic to the needs of both the local community and the character of the countryside. 8.67 Conventional public transport cannot always meet the diverse accessibility needs of those who live in rural areas. Therefore alternatives to conventional public transport may need to be provided. The Green Bus is one such example. This subsidised service is funded from landfill tax credits and serves countryside visitor centres and facilities. Voluntary car sharing and assisted ride schemes are currently operating in the rural areas of Hartlepool, principally relating to church-based activities. The introduction of such schemes is supported by Hartlepool Borough Council and opportunities for their development will be investigated. 8.68 The Hartlepool Local Transport Plan (LTP) addresses the issues relating to transport in the local countryside through its Rural Transport Strategy. The two main objectives for rural transport in Hartlepool are to improve accessibility of services and facilities and to improve road safety in rural areas. Where appropriate, the Hartlepool Local Plan complements the aims and objectives of the Rural Transport Strategy through its policies and proposals. In particular, the local plan seeks to improve access to the countryside (see Chapter 15 - The Rural Area). 8.69 Traffic management in villages and other rural areas of Hartlepool is to be developed to address environmental concerns of heavy goods traffic. The LTP will look at these issues in more detail than the local plan. PROVISION FOR TRANSPORT IN NEW DEVELOPMENTS 8.70 POLICY Tra19 It is important that provision is made for all modes of transport at the design stage of new developments. This will enable the provision of appropriate links to the bus, cycle and pedestrian networks. Proposals for major developments will be required to submit a travel plan 1 (see policy Tra20 below). Improvements in the bus, pedestrian and cycle networks will be sought through developers’ contributions towards improved accessibility to new and existing developments (see also policy GEP9). PROVISION FOR ALTERNATIVE TRANSPORT IN ORDER TO ALLOW FOR IMPROVEMENTS TO THE BUS, CYCLE AND PEDESTRIAN NETWORKS, RESIDENTIAL AND INDUSTRIAL ESTATE LAYOUTS SHOULD BE DESIGNED TO ENSURE ADEQUATE ACCESS BY ALTERNATIVE MODES OF TRANSPORT TO THE PRIVATE CAR FROM THE INITIAL PHASE OF DEVELOPMENT. WHERE REQUIRED AS A RESULT OF THE DEVELOPMENT, DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS WILL BE SOUGHT TOWARDS IMPROVED PUBLIC TRANSPORT AND ALTERNATIVE TRANSPORT ACCESSIBILITY (SEE ALSO POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). 1 A travel plan is a strategy for managing multi-modal access to a site or development, focusing on promoting access by sustainable modes. They can assist in reducing traffic congestion, widening accessibility, and reducing air pollution. 136 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 TRAVEL PLANS 8.71 The Borough Council has an obligation to assess the transportation impact of all development proposals to ensure that they can satisfactorily be integrated into the transport network. Planning Policy Guidance Note 13 requires the submission of Travel Plans alongside planning applications that will have significant transport implications. 8.72 A Travel Plan is a package of measures to assist in managing the transport needs of an organisation. A Travel Plan should contain a package of measures to encourage alternative and more sustainable modes of transport to be used for commuting, schools journeys and business trips. These may include travel by bus, rail, bicycle, motorcycle, walking or car sharing. 8.73 The promotion and implementation of Travel Plans is a policy objective within the Local Transport Plan (LTP), as Travel Plan’s assist the delivery of strategies to reduce the need to travel by car. The LTP includes local targets to reduce the number of car journeys, promote public transport, and increase levels of walking and cycling. 8.74 Developers have an important role to play in encouraging sustainable travel and will be required to submit a travel plan with all applications likely to generate significant amounts of travel. Development proposals for all major developments within the boundaries of Hartlepool will require a travel plan, for the purposes of policy Tra20, when the following thresholds are exceeded: LAND USE CLASS THRESHOLD A1, A2, A3, A4 - Food Retail and Non Food Retail D2 – Assembly and Leisure 1000m 2 B1 - Business 2500m 2 B2 General Industry 2500m 2 B8 Storage or Distribution Education All schools and higher / further education establishments All new developments Residential – Dwelling Houses 50 units 8.75 In appropriate circumstances the Borough Council will require developers to contribute towards improvements to public transport, walking and cycling facilities. This could incorporate both measures within the development site (such as the provision of bus shelters and cycle storage facilities, improved pedestrian access and providing turning spaces) and the provision of links to existing transport routes nearby (see also paragraph 21 of Supplementary Note 2). POLICY Tra20 TRAVEL PLANS TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR MAJOR DEVELOPMENTS AND OTHER DEVELOPMENTS LIKELY TO LEAD TO AN INCREASE IN TRAVEL. CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY WITHIN AND TO THE DEVELOPMENT. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 137 138 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 9 PUBLIC UTILITY AND COMMUNITY FACILITIES CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 9.1 The development and implementation of public utility and community facilities greatly influences a wide range of development proposals. PPS12: Local Development Frameworks stresses the importance development plans have for co-ordinating development with the infrastructure it demands. Structure Plan Policies 9.2 The Tees Valley Structure Plan within its overall strategy and policy SUS1 aims to ensure that proposals make a positive contribution towards achieving sustainable development, with the impact upon environmental quality, social well being and economic prosperity being central considerations. Best use should be made of existing infrastructure, services and amenities (policy SUS2). 9.3 Policy ENV23 points to the importance of protecting the quality of underground, surface and coastal water. Further policies ensure the protection of water sources, waterside areas, areas at risk from flooding and ensure that areas allocated for development have water resources available. Major renewable and non-renewable energy developments are to be assessed on a range of criteria to ensure that all environmental concerns are balanced. Local Plan Objectives 9.4 The following objectives are relevant in the formation of developing the local plan policies for public utilities and community facilities: A2 A5 B3 B4 C1 C3 C9 C11 to ensure that sites are available for the full range of industrial and commercial activities so as to enable the diversification of employment opportunities to ensure that there is adequate infrastructure to serve new and existing development to encourage in accessible locations the provision of sport, recreational, leisure and cultural developments to cater for the whole community to protect and encourage the development of local shopping, leisure, sporting and recreational and other community facilities at locations convenient to main neighbourhoods to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest. to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting or hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a damaging effect on the environment. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 139 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS DRAINAGE 9.5 Both the Burn Valley/West Park system and the Southern Drainage system have experienced flooding in the past. Even though no improvements have taken place to these networks other than an overflow into the Stell watercourse, there have been no flooding events, which meet the criteria for resources to be made available from the Capital Investment Strategy of Northumbrian Water. However studies have been carried out to the Southern Drainage area which should, when localised improvement schemes have been implemented, assist in reducing the possibility of any flooding in the Southern Drainage area. At the south end and the downstream reaches of the Southern Drainage network, improvements by Northumbrian Water to the headworks at the outlet are now complete. 9.6 The Borough Council is concerned that the possibility of flooding, however infrequent, in parts of the town remains a problem and acts as a constraint to development. It will therefore continue to emphasise to Northumbrian Water the need for further improvement works to be undertaken. 9.7 Hartlepool Borough Council has permissive land drainage powers under the Land Drainage Act 1991. This provides powers to maintain and improve watercourses to provide flood prevention measures. 9.8 All new developments will be expected to incorporate adequate means of foul and surface water disposal. They should be designed so as not to add to the risk of flooding or other environmental damage. In particular adequate provision should be made for run off for roofs and paved areas. Where possible developers should explore the feasibility of sustainable drainage systems. Sustainable Drainage Systems include the use of filter strips and swales to create landscape features with amenity and wildlife value and mimic the natural pattern of drainage. POLICY PU1 DRAINAGE SYSTEMS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL REQUIRE DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS TO BE DESIGNED TO ENSURE THAT THERE IS NO ADDITIONAL FLOOD RISK AS A RESULT OF SURFACE RUN OFF. THE USE OF SUSTAINABLE DRAINAGE TECHNIQUES TO CONTROL SURFACE RUN OFF WILL BE ENCOURAGED. 9.9 Surface water drainage at Graythorp is via a watercourse and the industrial estate’s system, both of which may need improvements and new connections in the event of the whole of North Graythorp being developed. 9.10 For certain industrial, commercial and agricultural operations special measures may be necessary. Development of Queens Meadow Business Park will increase the flow of surface water run-off to The Stell. The capacity of this watercourse is inadequate where it passes under Brenda Road and work will need to be carried out to improve it before significant industrial redevelopment takes place. 9.11 As part of the Environment Agency’s Standing Advice on Flood Risk, assessment will be required to include consideration of surface water run off impacts where development proposals are over 1 hectare in size. (see paragraph 10.9). 140 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY PU2 INDUSTRIAL SITES DRAINAGE PROPOSALS FOR INDUSTRIAL AND RELATED DEVELOPMENT AT NORTH GRAYTHORP, SOUTH WORKS AND QUEENS MEADOW WILL BE APPROVED WHERE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL CONSIDERS THAT DRAINAGE IS ADEQUATE. DEVELOPERS WILL NEED TO ENSURE THAT WHERE NECESSARY THE DRAINAGE SYSTEM IS UPGRADED TO CATER FOR INCREASED FLOW RESULTING FROM THE PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT. DEVELOPERS WILL BE ENCOURAGED TO USE SUSTAINABLE DRAINAGE SYSTEMS. SEWAGE TREATMENT 9.12 POLICY PU3 Northumbria Water has developed a full sewage treatment works at Brenda Road with a connection to the Seaton Carew headworks. Other sewage treatment facilities within the Borough include small works at Greatham and Graythorp. It is possible that further expansion of these facilities may be required in the future in order to permit Northumbria Water’s statutory obligations. SEWAGE TREATMENT WORKS LAND AT TEES ROAD/BRENDA ROAD IS ALLOCATED FOR A FULL SEWAGE TREATMENT WORKS. PROPOSALS FOR EXTENSIONS TO EXISTING SEWAGE TREATMENT WORKS WILL BE PERMITTED AT:a) SEATON CAREW PUMPING STATION b) GREATHAM SEWAGE TREATMENT WORKS c) GRAYTHORP SEWAGE TREATMENT WORKS PROVIDED THAT: ♦ THERE IS NO MATERIAL ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF NEIGHBOURING OCCUPIERS, ♦ THE APPEARANCE DOES NOT MATERIALLY AFFECT THE CHARACTER OF THE AREA, AND ♦ THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT EFFECT ON NATURE CONSERVATION. WATER SUPPLIES 9.13 POLICY PU4 The Borough Council, together with the Environment Agency, Hartlepool Water Company and Northumbrian Water is committed to protecting the water environment. Water supplies are provided by the Hartlepool Water Company from local sources at Throston, Naisberry and Crookfoot reservoirs. It is of the utmost importance that the aquifer, which provides the Borough’s drinking water, and watercourses are protected from contamination from pollutants, hence applications which do not provide adequate protection to ground and surface watercourses will not be permitted. Planning obligations may be sought with developers to secure measures to protect water quality. PROTECTION OF THE AQUIFER PROPOSALS WHICH HAVE THE POTENTIAL TO HAVE A DETRIMENTAL EFFECT UPON THE QUALITY OF GROUNDWATER RESERVES WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS MEASURES ARE IN PLACE WHICH REMOVE RISK OF GROUNDWATER POLLUTION. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 141 9.14 Although some of the higher parts in Hartlepool, including Naisberry, Springwell, Dalton Piercy and Elwick areas, suffer from reduced water pressure, generally there is adequate capacity to accommodate new developments which do not exceed 50 metres above sea level. In the case of Middle Warren, new development in excess of 50 metres may require developers to contribute to the cost of reinforcing the supply system from Naisberry Reservoir. ELECTRICITY SUPPLIES 9.15 The existing electricity supply network at a local level is adequate to meet the demands for residential and most types of industrial uses provided that the network is reinforced by additional substations where necessary. The National Grid Company is responsible for the national distribution network. Several important 400kV and 275kV overhead lines traverse areas of the Borough and care is needed to protect them from building activities in their vicinity. 9.16 High voltage overhead power lines can have adverse effects on the amenity of an area. These impacts can be minimised by careful line routing, landscaping, designing and screening. The Council will monitor advice and research on best practice to ascertain up to date information on the health risk concerns associated with high voltage lines and equipment. POLICY PU5 ELECTRICITY TRANSMISSION, DISTRIBUTION AND SUPPLY IN CONSIDERING PROPOSALS AND PLANNING APPLICATIONS FOR HIGH VOLTAGE LINES AND EQUIPMENT IN OR NEAR BUILT UP AREAS, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CONSIDER AMENITY CONCERNS AND WILL TAKE A PRECAUTIONARY APPROACH TAKING ACCOUNT OF THE ADVICE OF THE NATIONAL RADIOLOGICAL PROTECTION BOARD. 9.17 POLICY PU6 Hartlepool Nuclear Power Station is operated by British Energy. The effect of the power station on development proposals is referred to in Chapter 10 on Development Constraints. Within the power station site some land is being held for future operational uses. NUCLEAR POWER STATION SITE ABOUT 57 HECTARES OF LAND ARE HELD BY BRITISH ENERGY FOR OPERATIONAL PURPOSES. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS REQUIRING PLANNING PERMISSION WILL BE APPROVED WHERE THEY DO NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE SURROUNDING AREA BY VIRTUE OF VISUAL IMPACT OR INCREASED TRAFFIC FLOWS, AND WHERE THEY DO NOT HAVE A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON ADJACENT INTERNATIONAL AND NATIONAL SITES OF NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST (SEE ALSO POLICIES WL1 AND WL2). THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL, IN CONSIDERING THE PROPOSALS, HAVE REGARD TO THE ADVICE OF THE HEALTH AND SAFETY EXECUTIVE (INCLUDING THE NUCLEAR INSTALLATIONS INSPECTORATE), ENGLISH NATURE AND THE ENVIRONMENT AGENCY. LARGE SCALE DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS MAY REQUIRE THE CARRYING OUT OF AN ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT STUDY (SEE POLICY GEP5). 142 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 RENEWABLE ENERGY 9.18 Renewable energy covers energy flows that occur naturally and repeatedly in the environment. In industrialised countries energy has historically been supplied from fossil and nuclear sources. The burning of fossil fuels results in CO2 emissions which in turn cause global warming. In order to protect our environment and build a sustainable lifestyle for future generations it is necessary to reduce CO2 emissions. Alternative sources of renewable energy are fundamental in order to achieve this goal. The Hartlepool Community Strategy supports the increasing use of renewable energy resources. 9.19 National land use policy for renewable energy is now contained in Planning Policy Statement 22: Renewable Energy (PPS22). At the regional level a North East Regional Renewable Energy Strategy has been produced which supports the emerging Regional Spatial Strategy for the North East. A key principle of both national and regional policy is that development plan policies should promote and encourage rather than restrict the development of such resources. The Government has set out a target to increase renewable energy generation by 10% of the UK’s requirements by 2010, with an aspiration of increasing this to 20% by 2020. 9.20 Whilst recognising the importance of renewable energy sources, developments may be intrusive in the landscape, and adversely affect neighbouring residents and wildlife. Any applications for such installations should include details of associated developments so that their likely impact upon the environment can be assessed. Some applications may need to be accompanied by an Environmental Assessment indicating their likely effect on human beings, flora, fauna, soil, water, air, climate, the landscape, material assets and the cultural heritage (see Appendix 4 and policy GEP5). Wind Energy 9.21 Within the Borough there are some locations where the climate may be conducive for the commercial generation of electricity from wind farms. 9.22 Whilst the Council supports the concept of renewable energy and its important role in achieving sustainable development, wind turbines may be visually prominent, a source of noise, shadow flicker, electromagnetic interference and can have significant impacts on the ecology of the area. The planning system has sought to balance the environmental benefits with the need to protect the visual amenity of the countryside. In order to minimise the potential impacts, applications will be judged against the criteria outlined in policy PU7 below. In applying the policy, criteria account will be given of any proposed mitigation measures to reduce adverse impacts. 9.23 Applications for some wind farms may need to be accompanied by an Environmental Statement. Proposals for wind farms in or in the proximity of international and national designated nature sites will be considered against policies WL1 and WL2. The Durham Tees Valley International Airport will be consulted on all wind farm proposals within the Borough of Hartlepool. 9.24 In determining proposals for wind turbines the Borough Council will take particular account of the Hartlepool Landscape Assessment published in 2000. The assessment identifies the visual quality and amenity resource value of the area. 9.25 The development of single turbines to provide energy for a particular development may be acceptable and a more feasible option for wind power HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 143 development in the built up areas. There may also be occasions whereby single wind turbines can be installed to harness wind energy to support rural developments. 9.26 144 The development of offshore wind facilities to generate electricity is expected to gather pace over the plan period, negotiations having already taken place for the development of turbines off Teesmouth. The local planning authority has considerably less control over the siting and location of offshore facilities, although the provision of essential onshore plant to service the turbines will require planning permission. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Other Renewable Energy Sources 9.27 For a viable hydropower, a reliable supply of running water is an essential requirement, but within the Borough the opportunities for this type of development are limited. In the UK, tidal barrage schemes are all located along the west coast, where the tidal regime is most favourable. The wave energy levels along the north east coast are generally modest compared to the more exposed north and west coasts and for this reason it is unlikely that schemes of this nature would be economically viable. 9.28 Short rotation coppicing can be used as a source of biomass as fuel for the generation of combined heat and power in wood burning facilities particularly in the countryside. 9.29 Active solar systems are a renewable resource which can be implemented on a smaller scale. Energy efficiency considerations, particularly in the design, layout and orientation of buildings may well be given relaxed planning controls to stimulate innovative development (see policy GEP6). In addition, investigations into the exploitation of landfill gas on landfill sites in the Borough have concluded that proposals would be uneconomical. POLICY PU7 RENEWABLE ENERGY DEVELOPMENTS RENEWABLE ENERGY PROJECTS WILL GENERALLY BE SUPPORTRED IN ORDER TO FACILITATE THE ACHIEVEMENT OF NATIONAL TARGETS FOR NEW ELECTRICITY GENERATING CAPACITY. IN DETERMINING APPLICATIONS FOR SUCH PROJECTS SIGNIFICANT WEIGHT WILL BE GIVEN TO THE ACHIEVEMENT OF WIDER ENVIRONMENTAL AND ECONOMIC BENEFITS. ACCOUNT WILL ALSO BE TAKEN OF THE POTENTIAL EFFECTS UPON ON:♦ THE VISUAL APPEARANCE AND CHARACTER OF THE AREA, OR ♦ THE AMENITY OF LOCAL RESIDENTS, OR ♦ THE ECOLOGY OF THE AREA, IN PARTICULAR IMPORTANT INTERNATIONAL, NATIONAL AND LOCAL WILDLIFE SITES (SEE ALSO POLICIES WL1, WL2, WL5, WL6 AND WL8), OR ♦ AIRPORT RADAR AND TELECOMMUNICATIONS, PROPOSALS SHOULD INCLUDE DETAILS OF ASSOCIATED DEVELOPMENTS INCLUDING ACCESS ROADS, TRANSMISSION LINES, PYLONS AND OTHER ANCILLARY BUILDINGS. FOR WIND TURBINE PROPOSALS THE TOPOGRAPHY OF THE SITE AND THE LAYOUT OF THE TURBINES WILL NEED TO BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT AND ALL REASONABLE MEASURES TAKEN TO REDUCE THE IMPACT OF THE DEVELOPMENT. PLANNING APPLICATIONS WILL NEED TO INCLUDE A SATISFACTORY SCHEME TO RESTORE THE SITE TO A QUALITY OF AT LEAST ITS ORIGINAL CONDITION ONCE OPERATIONS HAVE CEASED. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 145 TELECOMMUNICATIONS 9.30 The UK telecommunications network has developed rapidly over the last 10 years and is likely to continue to do so in future years. The modern telecommunications network is seen as an essential component of the UK’s economic infrastructure. Government policy on telecommunications is outlined in PPG 8 (August 2001) and aims to cater for the growth of telecommunications in harmony with the protection of the environment and amenity. 9.31 It is the Government’s opinion that planning authorities should not seek to prevent competition between operators nor should they question the need for a particular telecommunications installation. Local planning authorities should instead aim to control the siting and design of telecommunications equipment. 9.32 Mobile phones and their base stations (masts) transmit and receive radio signals via electromagnetic waves (EMFs). These EMFs are all around us, occurring naturally within the earth’s magnetic field and from a wide range of man-made sources, e.g. domestic appliances and power lines. Health considerations and public concern over radiological exposure can in principle be material considerations in determining applications for planning permission and prior approval. The Borough Council will determine what weight to attach to such considerations on a case by case basis. However, whether such matters are material to a particular case will ultimately be decided by the courts. Government policy underlines that if a proposed base stations meets the ICNIRP (International Commission on Non-Ionizing Radiation Protection) guidelines for public exposure the planning authority should not need to consider further health aspects and concerns. 9.33 The Borough Council will encourage operators to engage in pre-application discussions. Such an approach can help avoid abortive effort on the part of telecommunications developers and help the Borough Council direct development to the most suitable sites. 9.34 To minimise the proliferation of telecommunications installations operators are required to consider the options for the sharing of existing installations. In submitting any application (for prior approval or planning permission) for a telecommunications installation the applicant should provide evidence which shows that the possibility of erecting telecommunications equipment on existing installations or of sharing an existing site has been fully explored. The applicant should also show they have considered the siting of equipment on existing 146 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 buildings or structures. 9.35 POLICY PU8 In seeking to achieve the best environmental solution operators should consider the use of sympathetic materials and colours, landscaping and screening to reduce the visual impact of telecommunications installations on the landscape or townscape. TELECOMMUNICATIONS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO WORK WITH OPERATORS TO FIND THE OPTIMUM ENVIRONMENTAL SOLUTION ON A CASE-BYCASE BASIS. HAVING REGARD TO TECHNICAL AND OPERATIONAL CONSTRAINTS AND THE SIGNIFICANCE OF THE PROPOSAL AS PART OF THE NATIONAL NETWORK, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROTECT AREAS OF ENVIRONMENTAL IMPORTANCE, INCLUDING CONSERVATION AREAS, AND AREAS OF HIGH LANDSCAPE VALUE. WHERE THE OPERATOR CAN DEMONSTRATE THAT THERE ARE NO SUITABLE ALTERNATIVE LOCATIONS, PROPOSALS WITHIN AREAS OF PARTICULAR ENVIRONMENTAL IMPORTANCE SHOULD BE SENSITIVELY DESIGNED AND SITED MAKING USE OF MODERN TECHNIQUES TO MINIMISE VISUAL IMPACT. PROPOSALS FOR TELECOMMUNICATIONS DEVELOPMENT SHOULD: i. INCLUDE A STATEMENT STIPULATING THAT THE PROPOSED FACILITY WHEN OPERATIONAL WILL NOT EXCEED THE ICNIRP GUIDELINES FOR PUBLIC EXPOSURE; ii. INCLUDE DESIGN AND SITING TECHNIQUES, INCLUDING SCREENING AND LANDSCAPING, TO MINIMISE THE IMPACT OF EQUIPMENT; iii. HIGHLIGHT THE RELATIONSHIP OF EQUIPMENT TO EXISTING BUILDINGS AND TOWNSCAPES / LANDSCAPES, TOPOGRAPHY, VIEWS AND VISTAS; iv. PROVIDE EVIDENCE THAT THE OPERATOR HAS EXPLORED THE POSSIBILITY OF SHARING EXISTING MASTS OR REPLACING A MAST SO THAT IT IS SUITABLE FOR JOINT USE; AND v. PROVIDE EVIDENCE THAT THE OPERATOR HAS EXPLORED THE POSSIBILITY OF ERECTING EQUIPMENT ON OR WITHIN EXISTING BUILDINGS OR STRUCTURES. COMMUNITY FACILITIES 9.36 Local facilities, including places of worship, surgeries, schools, libraries, meeting halls and community centres should be located where they are accessible by all modes of transport to the community they serve. Where possible they should be located within or close to local centres (see policy Com5), but may also be appropriately within residential areas provided that they do not have an adverse effect on their surroundings and that adequate parking and servicing can be provided. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 147 POLICY PU9 LOCAL FACILITIES SERVING RESIDENTIAL AREAS COMMUNITY-BASED USES WILL BE PERMITTED IN RESIDENTIAL AREAS PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING AND NEARBY PROPERTIES, THE SITE IS ACCESSIBLE BY ALL MODES OF TRANSPORT, AND SUFFICIENT CAR PARKING AND ADEQUATE SERVICING ARRANGEMENTS CAN BE PROVIDED (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES 1 AND 2). Health Services 9.37 Health services are presently concentrated at the University Hospital of Hartlepool at Holdforth Road. Additional health facilities include the Caroline Street, Seaton Carew and Miers Avenue clinics and a number of doctors’ and dentists’ surgeries. The Ambulance Service is currently operated from a site at Elwick Road. Education 9.38 There may be further opportunities to make fuller use of school buildings and playing fields so that they are more widely available to the community. The Borough Council will discuss possible dual use arrangements of education premises with individual schools involved (see policy Rec6). 9.39 Rationalisation of the St Hilds Comprehensive School onto a single site has taken place and will result in the site north of King Oswy Drive becoming available for development. The local education authority’s requirements, and the wider needs of the community, in respect of sporting and recreational provision, will be examined and any development proposal will be considered against policy Rec4. 9.40 Generally there is adequate capacity in existing nursery, primary, secondary and further education to cater for the expected level of growth. The projected numbers at the Warrior Park development at Seaton Carew do not justify the construction of a primary school. 9.41 A site has been identified for a primary school at Middle Warren, part of which lies within the How Beck green wedge. However, the Section 106 agreement attached to the planning permission for this area enables that part of the school site lying outside the green wedge to be developed for housing purposes should it be evident that the school is not required by the time Middle Warren is 80% developed. POLICY PU10 PRIMARY SCHOOL LOCATION LAND IS RESERVED AT MIDDLE WARREN FOR THE PROVISION OF A PRIMARY SCHOOL. IF BY THE TIME 80% OF MIDDLE WARREN IS DEVELOPED AND IT IS DETERMINED THAT THERE IS NO REQUIREMENT FOR A SCHOOL, THEN THE AREA IDENTIFIED FOR THE SCHOOL WHICH LIES OUTSIDE THE GREEN WEDGE AREA WILL BE MADE AVAILABLE FOR HOUSING DEVELOPMENT. 9.42 148 Land at Chester Road was allocated in the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan for the HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 replacement Jesmond Road Primary School. The local education authority is currently considering both replacement and refurbishment options in respect of this school. It is therefore proposed to continue to reserve the Chester Road site for the possible replacement school. Should the school not be replaced on this site, there will still be a need to retain the land to provide appropriate outdoor playing space for the school. POLICY PU11 PRIMARY SCHOOL SITE A SITE OF 1.9 HECTARES IS ALLOCATED AT CHESTER ROAD FOR THE REPLACEMENT OF JESMOND ROAD PRIMARY SCHOOL. IN THE EVENT OF THE SITE NOT BEING REQUIRED THE SITE WILL BE RETAINED FOR OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL USE. Community Centres 9.43 There are presently several community centres strategically located in the outer estates of the town providing a range of community facilities and meeting rooms. A new community centre has been provided at Central Estate and the Borough Council will continue to encourage the provision of further facilities elsewhere. There is potential for a community centre to be provided within the area of the Middle Warren local centre. Outside the urban area, the role of community owned and run village halls is recognised as being important to the life of rural areas. Libraries 9.44 Hartlepool Central Library is located at York Road, and in addition there are six branch libraries in the Borough together with a mobile library to serve outlying areas and the villages. If a new branch library is required to serve the Middle Warren and Clavering areas it would be appropriately situated in the local centre to be provided at Middle Warren. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 149 150 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 10 DEVELOPMENT CONSTRAINTS CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 10.1 On most types of development proposals there are, to varying degrees, constraints. This section relates to issues concerned with some of the constraints or other considerations that need to be taken into account in respect of development. There are other factors, such as the existence of important nature conservation sites near a development site, which can constrain or otherwise influence the form of development permitted. These are considered, as appropriate, elsewhere in the local plan. Local Plan Objectives 10.2 The following objectives are relevant in the drawing up of the development constraints policies: C1 C8 C10 C11 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas, and to make them more accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and underused land and buildings to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting or hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a damaging effect on the environment. POLICIES AND PROPOSALS NOTIFIABLE INSTALLATIONS 10.3 Certain sites are designated as Notifiable Installations by virtue of the quantities of hazardous materials held on the site. From a safety viewpoint, planning controls will be exercised to prevent incompatible and sensitive land uses such as housing from being within a predetermined distance from such installations. There are several notifiable installations in Hartlepool and the Health and Safety Executive requires that development proposals within these zones are referred to them for comment (see Diagram 4.1 and policy Ind11). THE NUCLEAR POWER STATION 10.4 Two consultation zones have been set up around the Nuclear Power station, as indicated in Diagram 10.1. The outer zone has a radius of about two miles covering the area south of Seaton Lane, Seaton Carew, Golden Flatts, South Works and Graythorp, whilst the inner zone is approximately one mile in radius, the boundaries being based on recognisable features. H.M. Nuclear Installations Inspectorate is consulted on all applications within the inner zone for industrial development, and those for residential development or likely to cause an influx of non-residential population. Applications for development for the outer zone HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 151 152 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 providing permanent or temporary residential accommodation for more than fifty people, or likely to cause an influx of non-residential population of more than fifty people, must also be referred to the H.M.Nuclear Installations Inspectorate (see Policy GEP1). AIRPORTS 10.5 Durham Tees Valley Airport is situated about 15 kilometres from the boundary of the Borough of Hartlepool. The Borough Council is required to consult the Durham Tees Valley International Airport on any applications for planning permission within the south east area of Hartlepool for buildings and structures over 90 metres in height (see Diagram 10.2). The existence of the airport is not considered a problem, although consultations may be needed regarding the location of structures such as chimneys, telecommunication masts and large wind turbines (see Policy PU8). LANDFILL SITES 10.6 Where land has previously been used as a landfill site, there is the possibility that contaminants may be present and that gases may be emitted from the site for some years following reinstatement of the land. Redevelopment of these sites and proposals in the surrounding areas will need to be carefully considered, to ensure that there is no undue risk arising from contamination and from the possibility of gas emissions. In the case of gas emissions, methods are available to vent such sites to reduce as far as possible any risk. The Council in 1989 commissioned a report on landfill gas investigation at six restored landfill sites, which established that the levels of emissions were not generally significant. The report recommended that despite their low risk the Throston Carr and Coronation Drive sites should continue to be monitored and any development will need to take account of the presence of the former tip. All sites with the exception of the northern mounded area of Coronation Drive can be developed with precautionary measures. The principal landfill areas are shown in Diagram 10.3. 10.7 The Borough Council takes precautionary measures when approving development on landfill sites. These measures include attaching conditions to planning permissions relating to investigation and remediation, removing permitted development rights and where applicable entering into legal agreements. POLICY Dco1 LANDFILL SITES DEVELOPMENT ON NOTIFIED LANDFILL SITES AND ON ADJOINING AREAS AFFECTED BY THEM WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE THERE WILL BE NO DEMONSTRABLE HARM TO OCCUPIERS. PROTECTION MEASURES, INCLUDING VENTING OF LAND AND SPECIFYING PARTICULAR BUILDING CONSTRUCTION DESIGN WILL BE REQUIRED TO CONTROL EMISSIONS OF LANDFILL GAS AND THE PRESENCE OF OTHER CONTAMINANTS. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL IMPOSE MEASURES SUCH AS ATTACHING CONDITIONS TO PLANNING PERMISSIONS, REMOVAL OF PERMITTED DEVELOPMENT RIGHTS AND SEEK TO SECURE LEGAL AGREEMENTS. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 153 154 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 155 FLOOD RISK 10.8 Government advice seeks to encourage a search sequence when selecting sites for development proposals to minimise flood risk. Priority in permitting development of sites will be given to those sites where no or little flood risk is evident. The least favoured sites are those at more frequent risk from flooding. 10.9 Development which threatens the stability and continuity of coastal and tidal flood defences can place large areas at risk of inundation. Parts of Hartlepool can be affected by tidal flooding. The highest tidal flood recorded in this area was 4.01 metres AOD in 1953. The Environment Agency has published flood maps (as shown on Diagram 10.4) which identify three flood zones for the Hartlepool area: Flood Zone 1 (little to no risk area) Flood Zone 2 (medium to low risk area) Flood Zone 3 (high risk area) Tidal flood zone 3 refers to land where the indicative annual probability of flooding is 1 in 200 years or less from tidal / coastal sources. Tidal flood zone 3 levels are estimated at 4.19m AOD at Teesmouth. Tidal flood zone 2 refers to land where the indicative annual probability of flooding is between 1 in 200 years and 1 in 1000 years from tidal / coastal sources. Tidal flood zone 2 levels are estimated at 4.39 AOD at Teesmouth. 10.10 All development proposals within the flood risk areas identified in the Environment Agency’s Standing Advice must be accompanied by a flood risk assessment, and may need to be referred to the Environment Agency. 10.11 The Environment Agency also requires Flood Risk Assessment to include consideration of surface water run off impacts where development proposals are over 1 hectare in size. (see paragraph 9.11) and where a proposal is within the vicinity of a Main River as designated by the Agency. 10.12 A Shoreline Management Plan has been prepared by the North East Coastal Local Authorities. This sets out a strategy for coastal defence for the section of coast between Seaham Harbour and Saltburn taking account of natural coastal processes and the effect on land uses. It identifies those areas where coastal defence measures need to be addressed. The Management Plan will be kept under review and used in assessing coastal flood risk. 10.13 Some inland areas are also identified as being at risk from fluvial flooding. 10.14 The Borough Council, in consultation with the Environment Agency, aims to ensure that new development does not significantly increase the risk of flooding to a level where life is endangered or natural and built assets damaged, whether by direct development in the flood plain or where the new development would increase the risk of flooding elsewhere by accelerating surface water run-off. The onus is on the developer to show that a development site is not at flood risk by carrying out a Flood Risk Assessment. This will include technical investigations to establish the risk of flooding, and where necessary provide mitigation measures to remove potential flooding risks. 156 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 157 POLICY Dco2 FLOOD RISK THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL PAY REGARD TO THE ADVICE OF THE ENVIRONMENT AGENCY IN CONSIDERING PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT WITHIN FLOOD RISK AREAS. DEVELOPERS WILL BE REQUIRED TO UNDERTAKE A FLOOD RISK ASSESSMENT FOR PROPOSALS IN THE ENVIRONMENT AGENCY’S FLOOD RISK ZONES 2 AND 3 AND IN THE VICINITY OF DESIGNATED MAIN RIVERS. WHERE DEVELOPMENT IS APPROVED, THE DEVELOPER MAY BE REQUIRED TO UNDERTAKE FLOOD MITIGATION MEASURES AS APPROPRIATE, WHICH MAY INCLUDE THE CONSTRUCTION OF FLOOR LEVELS AT A SAFE HEIGHT ABOVE PREDICTED TIDAL OR FLUVIAL FLOODING LEVELS. DEVELOPMENT WHICH WOULD BE AT DIRECT RISK FROM FLOODING OR LIKELY TO SIGNIFICANTLY INCREASE THE RISK OF FLOODING ELSEWHERE TO A LEVEL WHERE LIFE OR PROPERTY IS ENDANGERED AND WHERE FLOOD MITIGATION MEASURES ARE IMPRACTICABLE WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. MAJOR PIPELINES 10.15 In general the town and the villages are well supplied by gas mains with most development sites being served without undue difficulty. A few isolated sites to the south of the Borough and at Graythorp continue to experience difficulty due to the additional high cost of extending feeder mains. 10.16 Several high pressure gas, ethylene and other pipelines pass north-south throughout the Borough mainly within the rural area, although important spurs run from Naisberry to Britmag and from Greatham to Huntsman Tioxide (see diagram 10.4). These mains present some constraint to development within specified distances from them, which will, in particular, affect proposed industrial sites at Brenda Road West, North Burn and a small part of Middle Warren. 10.17 Developers should have regard to infrastructure when submitting proposals close to pipelines. Early consultation with the Borough Council is advisable in determining the location of essential underground infrastructure. 158 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 159 160 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 11 RECREATION AND LEISURE CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 11.1 This chapter looks at the need and demand for a wide variety of leisure facilities for residents in the Borough. As people have more leisure time due to more holidays, earlier retirement and unemployment, the need for various leisure facilities and activities is becoming more apparent. The value of sport and leisure in today’s society cannot be underestimated. Sport and leisure plays an important role in health, the economy, social inclusion and in generating confidence in people. The provision of such facilities benefits residents and makes the area more attractive to visitors and investors. 11.2 Leisure activity can take many forms (eg. active participation in sport, walking, cultural and learning activities). This chapter primarily concentrates on recreation and leisure opportunities in the urban area of the Borough. Related issues such as tourism and rural recreation are also considered in Chapter 6: Tourism and Chapter 15: The Rural Area. Hartlepool Community Strategy 11.3 The Culture and Leisure section of the Hartlepool Community Strategy aims to “ensure a wide range of good quality, affordable and accessible leisure and cultural opportunities”. Objective 5 seeks to “enhance and develop a range of high quality local and borough wide recreation, leisure, culture and tourism facilities and events”. Hartlepool Sports Pitch Strategy 11.4 The Hartlepool Playing Pitch Strategy 2004 has been produced by Hartlepool Borough Council and Sport England and takes account of the current and future needs for pitch facilities in the Borough up to 2007. The strategy has been prompted by the Borough Council’s need to assess the provision and quality of playing pitches in the area, as a basis for adopting policies on protection and provision of recreational open space in the local plan. 11.5 The assessment within the strategy provides useful information on trends in participation in pitch sports (football, rugby, cricket and hockey) which can be used to evaluate provision needs in the future. The strategy also considers the quality of that provision. 11.6 The findings of the 2004 study have been considered in the development of the recreation policies within the local plan. The local plan has also taken account of the advice given in PPG17 Sport and Recreation in developing relevant policies on open space. The local authority will carry out open space assessments as required within the revised PPG17 which was published in 2002. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 161 Hartlepool Sport and Recreation Strategy 11.7 The Hartlepool Sport and Recreation Strategy has recently been produced and assesses the role and provision of sport in the Borough and guides future services and action. The central theme of the Strategy is to “ensure, through effective partnerships, access to a wide range of affordable, high quality sporting and recreational opportunities which satisfy the needs of Hartlepool’s community”. It also contains an action plan which aims to address the key issues such as social inclusion and public health. Structure Plan Policies 11.8 The Tees Valley Structure Plan proposes that priority be given to recreation developments which have a suitable location, are easily accessible to communities and have a positive impact on the environment (policy L1). 11.9 With regard to leisure developments requiring large areas of open land, policy L1 further states that preference will be given to the use of derelict land, sites within green wedges and on the edge of the urban area. In the latter case, the Tees Forest should provide opportunities for sport and recreation. 11.10 In Policy L3, the structure plan identifies the development of a network of greenways, footpaths, cycleways and bridleways to provide access to the countryside and links to the villages and open spaces within the town. Policy L7 states that measures to make the maximum use of existing facilities, such as dual use of educational facilities for leisure purposes will be supported. Policy L8 seeks to protect existing playing fields by only permitting development on them if equivalent, alternative provision is provided and there is sufficient provision of playing fields and pitches. 11.11 These structure plan policies for recreation and leisure have been considered in developing the policies in this local plan. Local Plan Objectives 11.12 In conjunction with the overall aim of the local plan the following objectives are particularly relevant to this chapter. A4 A7 B3 B4 C1 C6 C8 C9 C10 162 to promote the growth of tourism to promote development on previously used sites where appropriate, and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings to encourage, in accessible locations, the provision of sport, recreation, leisure and cultural developments to cater for the whole community to protect and encourage the development of local shopping, leisure, sporting and recreational and other community facilities at locations convenient to main neighbourhoods to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to protect as far as possible existing open space and to encourage further landscaping and tree planting where appropriate to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas and to make them more accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to protect and enhance biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and areas of archaeological importance to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 D2 to promote developments in locations which support existing transport infrastructure, which minimise the need to travel, and which are accessible by all modes of transport to ensure that developments attracting large numbers of people locate in existing centres which are highly accessible by means other than the private car to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport D3 D4 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS COASTAL RECREATION 11.13 POLICY Rec1 Hartlepool has developed primarily because of its coastal location. Much of the coastline is important for its wildlife interest, but it is also an important asset in terms of providing opportunities for recreation and tourism. These opportunities include more active outdoor pastimes associated with the coast (sailing, windsurfing and land based pursuits such as fun parks and rides) and more passive outdoor pursuits including the quiet enjoyment of the natural environment. It is important that the recreational use of different parts of the coastal area is appropriate to its character. In this respect developments associated with more active pastimes should be located in the key coastal tourist areas at the marina, Victoria Harbour and Seaton Carew, the latter being particularly appropriate for fun parks etc. and activities associated with the beach and with its role as a seaside resort. COASTAL RECREATION PROPOSALS FOR OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL DEVELOPMENTS IN COASTAL AREAS WITHIN THE LIMITS TO DEVELOPMENT WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE: i. ii. iii. THE DEVELOPMENT DOES NOT SIGNIFICANTLY DETRACT FROM THE NATURE OF THE SURROUNDING COASTAL LANDSCAPE, THE NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST AND HERITAGE OF THE SURROUNDING AREA IS NOT SIGNIFICANTLY ADVERSELY AFFECTED, AND THE DEVELOPMENT ENHANCES THE QUIET ENJOYMENT OF THE COAST AND SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF POLICIES WL1 AND WL2. PROPOSALS FOR UNDEVELOPED COASTAL CONSIDERED IN RELATION TO POLICY Rur1. AREAS WILL BE ACTIVE PURSUITS, SUCH AS WATER SPORTS, SHOULD BE LOCATED WITHIN THE MAIN WATER-BASED RECREATIONAL AREAS AT THE MARINA, VICTORIA HARBOUR AND SEATON CAREW (SEE ALSO POLICIES To1 AND To5). 11.14 It is not considered appropriate to define a specific coastal zone in the local plan as it is generally covered by other specific policies in the plan. In the Borough of Hartlepool there are only two types of coastal areas. These are the undeveloped coast and that part of the coast within the urban fence. Most of the undeveloped HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 163 part of the coast comprises designated wildlife sites which are protected and/or to be enhanced in policies WL1 to WL3 and WL5 to WL7 below. The Tees Estuary Management Plan (TEMP) 1 gives guidance to the appropriate types of recreation and levels of protection to be given in the estuary area. The rest of the undeveloped coastal margins are protected from inappropriate development in policy GN3 below. Within the built-up area, visitor-related developments are promoted at the Marina, Headland and Seaton Carew in policies To1 to To6. PLAY FACILITIES FOR CHILDREN 11.15 Play is very important to the development of children in many different ways. It offers social, behavioural, educational and creative benefits, enhances physical development and exercise and develops characteristics that will equip individuals for life. Play facilities, in land use terms, are of basically two types – open areas appropriate for casual informal play, and equipped playgrounds or adventure play areas. 11.16 It is important that an adequate and appropriate area of space is available in new housing developments for informal play use by children. Often, casual play areas have been identified as an after-thought on ‘left-over’ land not suitable for housing, and they are therefore, environmentally and functionally poor. Casual play space should be within safe and easy access of homes, yet it must be designed and located so as to minimise nuisance to the occupiers of nearby homes. Where adequate private garden space is available within developments or there are opportunities for safe play in cul-de-sac road space, this may, in exceptional circumstances, be acceptable as an alternative provision. 11.17 There are a number of equipped play areas in the town. However, this play provision falls far short of the standards set by the Playing Fields Association. Particular shortage is apparent in the inner areas of the town. At present there are only 14 sites catering for almost 11,000 children between the ages of 4 – 12 years. These facilities are spread throughout the town and include stand alone play areas and playgrounds within parks and recreation grounds. These are protected from development in policies Rec4 and GN3 as appropriate. 11.18 Whilst provision of safe and convenient play space should be considered a priority, particularly in the inner area, there are difficulties in both allocating land for this use and in ensuring that any play facilities provided are not misused. The most successful equipped play areas in Hartlepool, in terms of use and relative freedom from vandalism, are those located in parks which are secured at night, or on larger areas of land where they are highly visible. Those established on small backland sites, in particular, are prone to vandalism, and those close to housing frequently give rise to complaints from adjoining occupiers. 11.19 Many local authorities require housing developers to provide equipped play areas within all new residential schemes comprising family housing, and to make commuted payments towards the maintenance of such areas. However, because of the problems of vandalism and of nuisance caused to nearby householders, the Borough Council considers that in most instances this would not provide a practical solution to the shortage of children’s playgrounds particularly in respect of smaller housing developments. 1 The Tees Estuary Management Plan (1997), prepared by a cross agency working party seeks to develop a framework to enhance the natural, cultural and economic resources of the Tees estuary and to minimise potential conflict between users. 164 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 11.20 POLICY Rec2 The Borough Council therefore considers that rather than require developers to provide small, equipped playgrounds on every new housing scheme, several larger sites of up to approximately five acres should continue to be identified for the creation of managed neighbourhood parks. The development and maintenance of these neighbourhood parks would be in part funded by developers through contributions derived from agreements on proposed schemes in the vicinity (see policies GEP9 and Rec3). In addition to neighbourhood parks, plays areas could also be developed within school grounds to provide safe and secure equipped areas for children to use. Developer contributions could also help to fund, maintain and manage these schemes (see policy Rec6). PROVISION FOR PLAY IN NEW HOUSING AREAS NEW HOUSING DEVELOPMENTS COMPRISING TWENTY OR MORE FAMILY DWELLINGS WILL BE REQUIRED TO PROVIDE SAFE AND CONVENIENT AREAS FOR CASUAL PLAY AND ALSO, IF PRACTICABLE, FOR FORMAL PLAY. WHERE SUCH PLAY PROVISION CANNOT BE APPROPRIATELY PROVIDED WITHIN THE SITE, OR WHERE DEVELOPMENTS COMPRISE LESS THAN TWENTY FAMILY DWELLINGS, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK A CONTRIBUTION TOWARDS THE PROVISION AND MAINTENANCE OF PLAY FACILITIES NEARBY (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). NEIGHBOURHOOD PARKS 11.21 POLICY Rec3 Neighbourhood parks will comprise sitting areas and children’s play areas in a parklike environment, and may, where appropriate, be able to accommodate facilities for more formal activities such as bowling and putting greens. The Borough Council would, in most instances, provide the land for the development of the neighbourhood parks, and develop them as resources allow. It is proposed to provide at least four neighbourhood parks and a further location may be identified in the West Central Area and developed under the New Deal for Communities programme to address the lack of equipped play provision in the inner area of the town. NEIGHBOURHOOD PARKS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO DEVELOP NEIGHBOURHOOD PARKS INCORPORATING EQUIPPED PLAY AREAS AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS AS DEFINED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP: a. b. c. d. CLAVERING, MIDDLE WARREN, CENTRAL PARK, AND CATCOTE ROAD. CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE POSSIBLE DEVELOPMENT OF A FURTHER NEIGHBOURHOOD PARK WITHIN THE WEST CENTRAL AREA. DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS WILL BE SOUGHT TO ASSIST IN THE DEVELOPMENT AND MAINTENANCE OF THE NEIGHBOURHOOD PARKS (SEE POLICIES GEP9 AND Rec2). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 165 11.22 The Borough Council is looking at the possibility of creating a number of homezones (also known as ‘playstreets’) within the urban area. These would create an environment in residential areas where children could play in safety with road vehicles being restricted at certain times of the day. Possible locations for this scheme would be most likely in terraced street areas of the town, on a trial basis initially. OUTDOOR PLAYING SPACE 11.23 It is important that sufficient land is made available in appropriate locations to enable all age groups to participate in games and activities. There are at present approximately 68 hectares of outdoor recreational land in Hartlepool, excluding parks, public open space and children’s playgrounds. This includes about 19 hectares provided by the private sector. The facilities currently provided on this land include playing pitches, tennis courts, putting greens, bowling greens and an athletics track. In addition, there is however almost 120 hectares of primary playing field land attached to the existing schools in Hartlepool, although to date, only a limited area is available for public use. 11.24 The shortage of good quality public playing pitches, in particular, is evident, as many of those currently provided by the Council are heavily overplayed and provide an inferior surface for any game to be played upon. The problem of the quality of pitches through overuse has been alleviated to a certain extent by the provision of artificial surfaces. Several small all-weather pitches have been provided at various locations in the town. However, whilst there are sporting benefits in the provision of artificial surfaces, they are not always considered to be a replacement for a grass playing field. 11.25 The Hartlepool Sports Pitch Strategy (2004) confirmed the problems with the quality of local authority pitches, specifically football pitches. Some of the pitches are overused with potentially five games per weekend. The situation could be improved through the reallocation of pitches. 11.26 In view of the overuse of existing playing pitches the Borough Council considers that unless specific circumstances apply, they should be protected from development. In the event of development being allowed, the Council may seek a legal agreement to be attached to the planning permission to provide for appropriate replacement facilities in a location accessible to the general public and capable of being served by the public transport network. 166 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Rec4 PROTECTION OF OUTDOOR PLAYING SPACE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROTECT EXISTING AREAS OF OUTDOOR PLAYING SPACE (INCLUDING CHILDREN’S PLAY AREAS, PLAYING FIELDS, TENNIS COURTS AND BOWLING GREENS). THEIR LOSS WILL BE ACCEPTABLE ONLY IN THE FOLLOWING CIRCUMSTANCES: i. WHERE THEY ARE REPLACED BY NEW PROVISION WHICH IS AT LEAST COMPARABLE IN TERMS OF FACILITIES, AMENITY AND LOCATION, OR WHERE THEY CAN BEST BE RETAINED AND ENHANCED THROUGH THE REDEVELOPMENT OF A SMALL PART OF THE SITE, OR WHERE THE LOCAL PLAN / SPORTS PITCH STRATEGY SHOWS AN EXCESS OF PROVISION OF PLAYING FIELDS OR THEIR RELOCATION ACHIEVES A BETTER DISPERSAL OF PITCHES, OR WHERE SCHOOL EXPANSION OR RE-BUILDING TAKES PLACE AND THE LOSS OF SOME PLAYING FIELD LAND DOES NOT PREJUDICE ITS OVERALL INTEGRITY THROUGH ADVERSELY AFFECTING THE QUANTITY, QUALITY OR USE OF THE PITCHES. ii. iii. iv. WHERE OUTDOOR PLAYING SPACE IS LOST TO DEVELOPMENT, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK A PLANNING OBLIGATION TO SECURE ITS REPLACEMENT OR THE ENHANCEMENT OF SUCH LAND REMAINING (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). 11.27 Several sites have been identified for the development of further pitches, subject to demand and funding, initially through modifying the maintenance regime, then with a view to securing funding to develop at National Governing Body specification. Development of this sort will help to improve the overall quality of pitches. The stock of facilities will be increased with a consequent reduction in the wear of pitches. 11.28 Development of facilities such as changing rooms and toilet facilities will be accommodated, where appropriate, adjacent to the sports pitches and outdoor playing space where a need has been identified in the Hartlepool Playing Pitch Strategy. POLICY Rec5 DEVELOPMENT OF SPORTS PITCHES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE THE DEVELOPMENT AND IMPROVEMENT OF SPORTS PITCHES AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS: a. b. c. d. e. f. g. MIDDLE WARREN, CENTRAL PARK, MASEFIELD ROAD, CARR HOUSE/NEWBURN SIDINGS, TEES ROAD,SEATON CAREW, GREATHAM, AND ADDITIONAL PROVISION AT GRAYFIELDS HOUSE. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 AND RIFT 167 DUAL USE OF SCHOOL FACILITIES 11.29 POLICY Rec6 Sports facilities provided at school sites are an important resource, not just for the school through the delivery of the national curriculum and extra-curricular sport but potentially for the wider community. Many schools are already well located in terms of access on foot or by public transport to the local community, and so greater use of the sports facilities outside normal school hours should not add significantly to the number of trips generated by private car. By providing school facilities for use by the wider community, existing playing pitches would not be subject to the overuse currently experienced and identified in the Hartlepool Sports Pitch Strategy (2004) and the quality of pitches thereby improved. However, issues surrounding security, management and maintenance of school facilities will need to be addressed before such a strategy could be taken forward. The Borough Council will, nevertheless, look to encourage and work towards dual use of school facilities for sports and recreation activities for the wider community. Developer contributions again could play a role in the funding and maintenance of these proposals. DUAL-USE OF SCHOOL FACILITIES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK, WHERE APPROPRIATE, TO MAKE SPORTS FACILITIES WITHIN EDUCATIONAL ESTABLISHMENTS AVAILABLE TO THE PUBLIC OUT OF SCHOOL HOURS. THE WIDER USE OF SCHOOL PLAYING FIELDS WILL ALSO BE ENCOURAGED, ESPECIALLY IN AREAS WHERE THERE ARE DEFICIENCIES OF PUBLIC PLAYING FIELDS. DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS MAY BE SOUGHT TO ASSIST IN THE FUNDING OF SUCH PROPOSALS (SEE POLICIES GEP9 AND Rec2). OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL SITES 11.30 POLICY Rec7 There are three areas in the vicinity of Seaton Carew which could be developed for outdoor recreational purposes in order to increase the range of attractions available in the area. These are the reclamation site to the west of Coronation Drive, land to the south of Elizabeth Way and Seaton Carew Cricket Club, and the former slag bank area around the Tees Bay Retail Park which is a site with significant wildlife value. These areas are appropriate for less intensive recreational uses that require few built facilities. In particular, the mounded Coronation Drive site could be suitable for a ‘pitch and putt’ course or similar development provided that the underlying tip material is not disturbed. The more level site at Tees Road (south of Elizabeth Way) is suitable for playing pitches and other outdoor sports and leisure facilities activities whilst the Tees Bay site could be developed as a golf course. OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL SITES THE FOLLOWING SITES ARE IDENTIFIED FOR OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL AND SPORTING DEVELOPMENT REQUIRING FEW BUILT FACILITIES: a. b. c. 168 LAND WEST OF CORONATION DRIVE (14HA), TEES ROAD, SEATON CAREW (12HA), AND TEES BAY, BRENDA ROAD (42HA). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 INFORMAL RECREATION AREAS 11.31 Ideally, parks and other areas for informal recreation should be provided for each residential neighbourhood providing easily accessible areas for informal recreation and leisure activities for people of all ages but especially the young and old. Currently, there are almost 50 hectares of parkland in Hartlepool comprising formal parks, ornamental gardens and the sea front at Seaton Carew. 11.32 The local plan proposes the development of a network of multi-functional green space within the town (see policy GN1). Within this green network are a number of larger areas that will be protected and enhanced as areas for quiet recreational activities. 11.33 How Beck forms the western part of the green wedge at Middle Warren and will be developed as an area for informal recreational purposes as the housing development in the area progresses. The Central Estate linear park provides a spur from Central Park and has been developed as informal open space through which there are recreational routes for cyclists and walkers. The Greatham Beck has recently been declared a local nature reserve (see policy WL5) and Seaton Meadows (Stephenson’s tip site) is to be developed as a nature reserve when its existing use for clay extraction and tipping has ceased. 11.34 The attraction of these areas can be enhanced as appropriate by the provision of interpretive facilities and nature trails. By ensuring that any landscaping carried out uses native species, important for wildlife, the network of corridors and links identified in policy GN1 can also be enhanced. POLICY Rec8 AREAS OF QUIET RECREATION THE FOLLOWING AREAS, AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, WILL BE DEVELOPED FOR QUIET RECREATIONAL PURPOSES: a. b. c. d. e. HOW BECK, MIDDLE WARREN (20HA), CENTRAL PARK (8HA), CENTRAL ESTATE LINEAR PARK (3HA), GREATHAM BECK (3HA), AND SEATON MEADOWS (24.4HA). THESE AREAS WILL BE LANDSCAPED AND PLANTED AND, WHERE APPROPRIATE, FACILITIES SUCH AS CROSS COUNTRY RUNNING TRACKS, NATURE TRAILS AND INTERPRETIVE INFORMATION WILL BE PROVIDED. RECREATIONAL ROUTES 11.35 Opportunities for informal recreation can be enhanced by the provision of footpath and cycle links. These links will connect existing and proposed areas of open space, parks and other areas of interest within the urban area, and also, via green wedges to link with the greenway/right of way network in the countryside (see policies Rur17 to Rur19 below). There may be opportunities to create new bridleways or convert existing routes into facilities which cater for the needs of horse riders. The Coastal Walkway links the Hart–Haswell Walkway in the north, via Central Park, the Headland, and from the Marina to Seaton Carew and beyond to the important wildlife areas of the North Tees area. Two routes are shown on the proposals map at the Marina – one running in front of Navigation Point and one to the seaward side of HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 169 Navigation Point. The former route is available now and the second route represents the preferred route to be sought to provide a continuation as close to the sea as possible. This route will be ultimately linked with others to be provided elsewhere in both the urban and countryside areas of Hartlepool. Initially these will include a route from the Marina to Greatham (comprising north and south extensions to the existing Seaton Lane walkway) and the Golden Flatts link from Stockton Road to Seaton Carew. POLICY Rec9 RECREATIONAL ROUTES A NETWORK OF RECREATIONAL ROUTES LINKING AREAS OF INTEREST WITHIN THE URBAN AREA OF HARTLEPOOL WILL BE DEVELOPED. INITIALLY, THE FOLLOWING ROUTES WILL BE PROVIDED: a. b. c. d. e. COASTAL ROUTE, MIDDLE WARREN, EAST – WEST ROUTE (GOLDEN FLATTS LINK), GREATHAM TO BELLE VUE WAY AND MARINA, AND SUMMERHILL TO BURN VALLEY. PROPOSALS WHICH WOULD IMPEDE THE DEVELOPMENT OF THE ABOVE ROUTES WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. SUMMERHILL 11.36 POLICY Rec10 With proposals coming forward as part of the development of the Tees Forest, there is the potential for increased recreational activities in the rural area. Summerhill is being developed as a primary gateway site to the Tees Forest. It is an important recreational resource linking the town with the open countryside. The site provides a visitor centre, climbing facilities, cycling, horseriding, walking and other general countryside activities in a location readily accessible to the Hartlepool community. There may be opportunities to extend the range of facilities provided. Such development would exclude motor sports and other noisy activities. SUMMERHILL SUMMERHILL WILL CONTINUE TO BE DEVELOPED AS A FOCUS FOR ACCESS TO THE COUNTRYSIDE, NATURE CONSERVATION AND INFORMAL RECREATIONAL AND SPORTING ACTIVITIES. 11.37 The Tees Forest and its implications for the rural part of Hartlepool beyond the limits to development are addressed in paragraphs 15.42 to 15.44 below. NOISY OUTDOOR SPORTS AND LEISURE ACTIVITIES 11.38 Noisy activities, including off-road motorised sports and clay pigeon shooting, are becoming increasingly popular. However, motor cyclists and similar users tend to use the beach and dunes and other large areas of open space within the town, which causes problems of disturbance and of damage to fragile areas, particularly the important wildlife areas along the coast. 170 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 11.39 POLICY Rec11 In order to lessen these problems, it would be appropriate to continue to identify an area where noisy outdoor activities could be accommodated to minimise conflict with other uses. New proposals for potentially disturbing outdoor activities will need to be carefully considered in the context of their potential impact on adjacent land uses and occupiers of nearby properties. NOISY OUTDOOR SPORTS AND LEISURE ACTIVITIES THE DEVELOPMENT OF LAND FOR NOISY OUTDOOR SPORTS AND LEISURE ACTIVITIES WITHIN THE URBAN AREA WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE THE REQUIREMENTS OF POLICY GEP1 ARE GENERALLY MET AND PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. iii. 11.40 POLICY Rec12 THE SITE IS NOT IN CLOSE PROXIMITY TO HOUSING, THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF OCCUPIERS OR USERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY LAND OR ON THE FLORA OR FAUNA OF DESIGNATED WILDLIFE SITES, AND MEASURES ARE TAKEN TO MINIMISE POTENTIAL NOISE NUISANCE BEYOND THE SITE BOUNDARIES. Development was started on an auto-leisure park on land west of Brenda Road. Should this development not proceed the land would continue to be suitable for noisy sports activities (subject to policy Rec11 above). It could alternatively be appropriately developed for other types of recreational use such as a golf driving range, sports pitches or for quieter recreational activities related to the adjoining land which forms part of the green network and recreational route link. LAND WEST OF BRENDA ROAD LAND WEST OF BRENDA ROAD IS IDENTIFIED FOR OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL PURPOSES. INDOOR SPORTS AND LEISURE ACTIVITIES 11.41 Indoor sports and leisure facilities include a wide variety of sporting, leisure, social, cultural and educational centres including sports halls, museum, cinemas and theatres. 11.42 Sports Halls: existing provision in the public sector is concentrated at Mill House (swimming baths and multi-purpose leisure centre) in the central area of the town and at Belle Vue Sports Centre. Policy Com4/9 above seeks to ensure that the Mill House area continues to be retained for recreational and leisure uses. 11.43 Museums: the Museum of Hartlepool is ideally located adjacent to the Historic Quay in the Marina and attracts large numbers of visitors. Christ Church has been converted in to the town’s Art Gallery and Exhibition Centre and also houses the Tourist Information Centre. A small museum may be developed at St Hilda’s Church on the Headland as part of the tourism-related regeneration of this area. 11.44 Cinemas and Theatres: a six-screen, state of the art multiplex cinema has been developed at the marina which is considered adequate for the town’s needs. Some HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 171 former cinema buildings remain in Hartlepool, but these are not suitable to cater for today’s cinema-going requirements and have been converted to other uses. 11.45 The Borough Council does not consider it could provide a purpose-built theatre as a viable proposition. The Town Hall has been upgraded in recent years to provide a theatre which attracts national and local productions. The Town Hall also has a cinema licence. LATE NIGHT USES 11.46 Some leisure activities can have a detrimental effect on the amenities of the surrounding area. Amusement arcades and bingo halls, for example, generate a certain amount of noise and their proliferation in an area can have an inhibiting effect on other businesses. Similarly, take-away food establishments, wine bars and other licensed premises can also give rise to different types of ‘nuisance’ and should generally be located away from residential areas (see policy Com12 above). 11.47 Changes in the licensing laws enables such uses, as well as night clubs and premises selling alcohol, to open up to twenty four hours a day, every day. This could exacerbate the potential for disturbance during the time when most residents would normally expect peace and quiet. Most disturbance in this respect is caused by users once outside the premises. The local planning authority will generally attach planning conditions to permissions restricting hours of opening in order to protect the amenities of nearby residents (see policy Com12). However, there are parts of the town centre away from residential areas where longer opening hours may be acceptable. Policy Rec13 below identifies the Church Street mixed use area and the south western part of the Marina for uses which operate at times throughout the night and early morning. However, it is important that these areas do not lose their respective character and function as mixed use areas. 172 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 11.48 Developer contributions may be sought to mitigate potential nuisance resulting from establishments operating flexible opening hours (see policy GEP9 and Supplementary Note 8). POLICY Rec13 LATE NIGHT USES PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENTS WHICH WILL OPERATE BETWEEN MIDNIGHT AND 7 A.M. WILL BE PERMITTED ONLY WITHIN THE CHURCH STREET AREA, OR WITHIN THE SOUTHWEST AREA OF THE MARINA PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF NEARBY PROPERTIES BY REASON OF NOISE AND DISTURBANCE; AND THE OVERALL APPEARANCE, FUNCTION AND CHARACTER OF THESE AREAS IS NOT PREJUDICED. WHERE NECESSARY DEVELOPER CONTRIBUTIONS WILL BE NEGOTIATED TO MITIGATE THE EFFECTS OF DEVELOPMENTS AND LEGAL AGREEMENTS WILL BE SOUGHT (SEE POLICY GEP9 AND SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 8). MAJOR LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS 11.49 Government advice proposes that a sequential approach be adopted in the consideration of major traffic generating proposals including entertainment and leisure developments. This approach means that first preference should be for town centre sites, followed by edge-of-centre sites and only then by out of centre sites that are accessible by a choice of means of transport. In addition proposals must illustrate that there is an identified need for the development. 11.50 Most of the existing major entertainment and leisure facilities serving the whole community are located within the town centre – these include the multiplex cinema, a major bingo hall, the Hartlepool United football ground, and the Town Hall Theatre. New leisure developments attracting large numbers of visitors should also, as far as appropriate and practicable, be located within the town centre then in edge of centre sites such as the mixed-use Marina area. 11.51 In Hartlepool, there are no defined district centres and the local centres are too small to satisfactorily accommodate major leisure developments. However, there are three other areas in the town where such developments could be located depending upon their scale and nature: ♦ Headland: appropriate for tourism-related projects related to its historic and cultural heritage (see policy To2); ♦ Seaton Carew: appropriate for sea-side based recreational and leisure facilities (see policies To3 to To4); and Victoria Harbour: development sites are identified in the Master Plan which has been produced. The site is capable of housing various types of major leisure developments in the future. ♦ The sequential approach to the consideration of major leisure developments set out in policy Rec14 below, therefore takes account of these three areas. After the above HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 173 sites have been considered there may be potential at Tees Bay Retail Park where leisure uses are permitted in the legal agreement accompanying the planning permission for this development. 11.52 Developments requiring a large area of land for outdoor activities as an integral part of an overall scheme should be subject to the sequential approach only in as far it can be demonstrated that the location lies within the urban area and it is readily accessible by all modes of transport. 11.53 Larger developments comprising 1000 sq.m or more of floorspace will be required to submit a travel plan aimed at delivering sustainable transport objectives. 174 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICY Rec14 MAJOR LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS MAJOR LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS LIKELY TO ATTRACT LARGE NUMBERS OF VISITORS SHOULD BE LOCATED WITHIN THE TOWN CENTRE AS DEFINED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP. WHERE THERE ARE NO SUITABLE SITES IN THE TOWN CENTRE, DEVELOPMENTS MUST ACCORD WITH THE FOLLOWING SEQUENTIAL APPROACH WHICH IDENTIFIES MAJOR REGENERATION AREAS ACCESSIBLE BY A CHOICE OF MEANS OF TRANSPORT AFTER EDGE OF CENTRE AREAS AS PREFERABLE TO OTHER OUT OF CENTRE LOCATIONS: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ EDGE OF CENTRE SITES INCLUDING THE MARINA, THEN VICTORIA HARBOUR, OR AT THE HEADLAND, OR AT SEATON CAREW PROVIDED THAT THE VITALITY AND VIABILITY OF THE TOWN CENTRE IS NOT PREJUDICED AND THAT THE SCALE AND NATURE OF THE DEVELOPMENT IS APPROPRIATE TO THE ROLE AND CHARACTER OF THESE LOCATIONS (SEE POLICIES To1–To4, Com7 AND Com15). PROPOSALS FOR MAJOR LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS ON SITES ELSEWHERE WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE IT HAS BEEN DEMONSTRATED THAT ALL OR PART OF THE DEVELOPMENT CANNOT BE ACCOMODATED ON EXISTING OR POTENTIAL SITES IN THE ABOVE AREAS AND PROVIDED THAT: i. ii. THE SITE LIES WITHIN THE URBAN FENCE (SEE POLICY Rur1), AND THE SITE IS ACCESSIBLE BY A CHOICE OF MEANS OF TRANSPORT. ALL LARGE SCALE PROPOSALS SHOULD BE ACCOMPANIED BY A STATEMENT JUSTIFYING THE NEED FOR THE DEVELOPMENT. TRAVEL PLANS SHOULD BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS FOR LARGE SCALE LEISURE DEVELOPMENTS AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN, WHERE APPROPRIATE, TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE IMPROVEMENT OF PUBLIC TRANSPORT, CYCLING AND PEDESTRIAN ACCESSIBILITY TO THE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Tra20). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 175 176 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 12 THE GREEN NETWORK CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 12.1 Open space forms an integral and important part of the urban fabric and has great value in contributing to the quality of life. Its importance in the urban context has been recognised by the Council of Europe: “Open space is an essential part of the urban heritage, a strong element in the architectural and aesthetic form of a town, plays an important education role, is ecologically significant, is important for social interaction and in fostering community development and is supportive of economic objectives and activities… in particular, it helps reduce the inherent tension and conflict in deprived parts of urban area; it has an important role in providing the recreational and leisure needs of a community and has, finally, an economic value in that environmental enhancement, in which the improvement of open space plays a major part, assists the economic revival of cities, not just through creating jobs but in increasing the attractiveness of a town as a place for business investment and sought-after residential areas.” 1 12.2 Hartlepool Borough Council recognises the key role that open space plays in encouraging biodiversity and in the economic and social well being of the town and in particular the increased benefits accruing from the development of linked and linear open spaces. The successful Hartlepool Urban Greening (HUG) programme 2 sought to create a network of green spaces throughout the town linked together and to the wider countryside by green routes for cyclists, walkers and wildlife. Substantial improvements have been made to the landscape of the town and environmental works continue to comprise a major part of regeneration initiatives. 12.3 The Green Network in Hartlepool is made up of wildlife sites, land for recreational and leisure use and other ‘green’ areas including amenity open space, cemeteries and churchyards, the coastal margins etc. together with the links between them. This chapter is primarily concerned with the Green Network in the town – its overall protection, management and enhancement - and with the protection of key open spaces and other areas within it which are not specifically identified for recreational purposes or as wildlife sites. Policies for the provision of, and protection of, recreational land are included in Chapter 11 (Recreation and Leisure), and for the protection and enhancement of wildlife sites in Chapter 13 (Wildlife and Natural Features). Regional Planning Guidance 12.4 1 The Regional Planning Guidance for the North East states that planning authorities should seek to maintain and enhance the quality, diversity and local distinctiveness of landscape character throughout the North East. Open space has an important role in contributing to the quality of life and accessible greenspace within settlements should be encouraged. Council of Europe Committee of Ministers of member states recommendation no.R(86)11 on Urban Open Space – 1986 2 Hartlepool Urban Greening was the Borough Council’s successful bid for capital resources for 1997 to 2000 under the Government’s Capital Challenge Fund initiative. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 177 Structure Plan Policies 12.5 At the strategic level the Tees Valley Structure Plan requires that green wedges be retained for open land uses or to maintain the local distinctiveness of individual areas – their precise boundaries to be reviewed in local plans (policy ENV14). Hartlepool Community Strategy 12.6 The Environment and Housing section of the Community Strategy aims to “protect and enhance the amenity and nature conservation value of Borough’s open spaces including brownfield sites.” Local Plan Objectives 12.7 In line with the overall aim of the plan to regenerate Hartlepool securing a better future for its people to meet economic, environmental and social needs in a sustainable manner, the following objectives of the local plan are particularly relevant in drawing up the policies and general proposals relating to the Green Network. C3 C5 C6 C8 C9 C10 D4 to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of conservation areas, listed buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest to seek to create a green network to direct the future protection, management and improvement of open space for people and wildlife to protect as far as possible existing open space and to encourage further landscaping and tree planting where appropriate to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas, and to make them more accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport POLICIES AND PROPOSALS THE GREEN NETWORK 12.8 Through the policies in this local plan, the Borough Council will seek to promote and enhance the development of a multi-functional network of green spaces for both people and wildlife in the urban area of Hartlepool and linking to the countryside and the proposed greenway along the western fringe of the town. The basis of this network already exists and comprises eight main corridors as follows: i. ii. 178 north coastal – including part of the internationally important Teesmouth and Cleveland Coast Special Protection Area and Ramsar site and other areas of the coastal margin, Hartlepool Golf Club, the Old Cemetery and Central Park; How Beck green wedge which is being created and enhanced through the provision of playing fields, a neighbourhood park and other amenity areas together with footpaths and cycleways, as part of the overall development of the Middle Warren area for housing; HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 iii. Burn Valley green wedge – an existing corridor of green space running from the centre of the town along the Burn Valley Gardens; iv. Brierton – this corridor which includes Stranton cemetery, allotments and the Brierton School playing fields is generally less accessible to the wider public, but it nevertheless represents an important green space in people’s perception and it provides a link for wildlife; v. Owton Manor green wedge – an existing corridor of green spaces running through a major area of housing and including Rossmere Park, sports pitches and landscaped amenity open space; vi. Stockton Road/Golden Flatts to Seaton Carew – a corridor of land consisting primarily of mounding screening the industrial development at the Corus (formerly British Steel) South Works and generally open land between the housing development in Seaton Carew and the Tofts Farm East / Hunter House industrial area. It has the potential to be enhanced to provide an important link via an existing right of way from the residential areas of south west Hartlepool to Seaton Carew and the coast; vii. Seaton coast and common which includes nature conservation sites of local, national and international importance; and viii. Marina to Greatham – a green corridor within which it is proposed to create an extension to the Seaton Lane walkway along the western side of the railway line to Greatham and beyond. 12.9 These corridors are made up of many different types of open and green space, including parks, playing fields, cemeteries, allotments, amenity spaces and wildlife sites, the individual elements of which are covered by other policies in the plan (see policies Rec3 to Rec5, Rec7 to Rec10, GN2 to GN5, and WL1 to WL7). 12.10 The Borough Council wishes to ensure that the integrity of the Green Network will be protected and enhanced by ensuring that key open spaces are protected from inappropriate development and managed and improved for people and wildlife. To make the network more accessible, public rights of way will be protected and improved and other footpath links created and improved including the coastal walkway and the Marina to Geatham walkway (see policy Rec9). Where possible, cycle routes will also be provided to link key spaces (see policy Tra5). The Tees Forest will play a key role in the promotion and implementation of the Green Network. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 179 POLICY GN1 ENHANCEMENT OF THE GREEN NETWORK THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO DEVELOP, PROTECT AND ENHANCE A NETWORK OF GREEN SPACES IN THE URBAN AREA OF HARTLEPOOL AND LINKING TO THE OPEN COUNTRYSIDE ALONG THE FOLLOWING CORRIDORS: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ NORTH COASTAL, HOW BECK GREEN WEDGE, BURN VALLEY GREEN WEDGE, BRIERTON, OWTON MANOR GREEN WEDGE, STOCKTON ROAD/GOLDEN FLATTS TO SEATON CAREW, SEATON COAST AND COMMON, AND MARINA TO GREATHAM. ACCESSIBILITY WITHIN AND TO THE CORRIDORS WILL BE IMPROVED AND PEDESTRIAN AND CYCLEWAY LINKS PROVIDED (SEE ALSO POLICIES Tra5 AND Rec9). THE VISUAL AND AMENITY VALUE OF THE GREEN SPACES WITHIN THE NETWORK WILL BE ENHANCED BY LANDSCAPING AND TREE PLANTING, WILDLIFE VALUE WILL BE MAINTAINED AND INCREASED AND INTERPRETATION FACILITIES PROVIDED. GREEN WEDGES 12.11 A key component of the Green Network are the green wedges at How Beck, Summerhill/Burn Valley and Owton Manor which extend from the open countryside to the heart of the town. They provide (or in the case of How Beck will provide) convenient and extensive amenity open space and easy access to the countryside. They offer major opportunities for improving the general environment, providing recreational uses, creating valuable links for wildlife and increasing biodiversity. The precise boundaries of these green wedges are shown on the Proposals Map. 12.12 The extent of the Owton Manor green wedge is well-established and stretches from the countryside through housing development to Catcote Road and beyond to Rossmere Park. The amenity value of parts of this green wedge has recently been enhanced in consultation with the residents of the area and a cycle route and footpath have been provided through the area. 12.13 Burn Valley green wedge is also well-established and comprises a tapering green corridor into the heart of the town. A family wood is being developed at the western end of Burn Valley Gardens and it is proposed that further woodland planting is carried out in this area (see policy GN5 below). 12.14 As noted in paragraph 12.8 above, the How Beck green wedge is being developed as an integral part of the Middle Warren housing development. It divides the extensive Middle Warren area into two distinct entities, and will provide a high quality environment. Footpaths, cycleways and greenway routes are being provided through the area linking into the adjacent housing (see also policy Rec9). 12.15 The green wedges offer major opportunities for improving the overall environment of Hartlepool, for providing recreational, sporting and leisure uses and also for creating valuable links for wildlife. They are to be retained as tracts of predominantly open land and enhanced as part of the Green Network (see policy GN1 above). New 180 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 development involving the erection of buildings or structures, therefore, will not generally be permitted within the delineated green wedge areas. However, because of their multi-functional role, there may be a need to provide ancillary buildings in connection with the existing or proposed uses within the area. These could include, for example, built extensions to school premises or the provision of buildings or facilities in connection with formal or quiet recreational uses. POLICY GN2 PROTECTION OF GREEN WEDGES DEVELOPMENT WITHIN DELINEATED ON THE CONTROLLED: a. b. c. THE FOLLOWING GREEN PROPOSALS MAP, WILL WEDGES, AS BE STRICTLY HOW BECK, MIDDLE WARREN, BURN VALLEY, AND OWTON MANOR. PLANNING APPROVAL WILL ONLY BE GIVEN FOR THE ERECTION OF BUILDINGS OR STRUCTURES WHICH: ♦ ♦ ♦ COMPRISE EXTENSIONS TO EXISTING PREMISES LOCATED WITHIN A GREEN WEDGE, OR PROVIDE FACILITIES ANCILLARY TO EXISTING OR PROPOSED RECREATIONAL, LEISURE, OR SPORTING USES OR RELATE TO THE PROVISION OF WILDLIFE SITES, AND PROVIDED THAT THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE OVERALL INTEGRITY OF THE GREEN WEDGE. KEY GREEN SPACE AREAS 12.16 It is important to retain all important areas of green space, whether or not they lie within the green wedges or other identified corridors in the Green Network. Such areas not covered by other policies in this plan are identified below and included in policy GN3 as areas to be protected from inappropriate development. 12.17 The main parks in the town are well used and two of them - Ward Jackson Park, (a park included in the Register of Parks and Gardens of Special Historic Interest) and Rossmere Park - have recently been refurbished in consultation with users. A new linear park has been provided at Central Estate. It provides an important green space for the local community with whom it has been developed and also forms a southward spur from the north coast corridor towards the town centre. There are also other smaller areas of formalised open space which provide an important leisure or amenity resource in their localities. These include Victory Square, Park Square, Serpentine Gardens, Redheugh Gardens, Vicarage Gardens and the Piazza in the Marina. At a more informal level the Town Moor on the Headland and the village greens are equally important as amenity open spaces. 12.18 Some of the churches in the town and surrounding villages have ancient graveyards that have remained relatively undisturbed making them important wildlife refuges. Hartlepool’s cemeteries also form important havens for wildlife. The peaceful environment of these areas are particularly valued by people seeking solitude. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 181 12.19 Allotments, whilst not accessible to the wider public, do form an integral part of the green space provision in Hartlepool. They are well used by local communities and are host to a variety of urban wildlife. 12.20 Highway and railway corridors are valuable wildlife corridors often rich in wild flora. Additional features such as ditches increase their biodiversity value. Landscaped frontages along the major transport corridors help to extend green spaces into the town centre providing both visual and biodiversity benefits. 12.21 Much of the coastal area of Hartlepool comprises designated wildlife sites of local, national and international importance. Other parts of the coastal margin, comprising beaches, promenades, golf courses and other open or green spaces, are important for their recreational and amenity value and also have value for wildlife in enabling migration between areas. 12.22 Two areas have for many years been retained to provide a buffer to major industrial development. These are the mounded area to the south of Golden Flatts and generally open land to the north of the Tofts Farm East and Hunter House industrial areas. They comprise a major part of the Stockton Road to Seaton Carew corridor (see paragraph 12.8 above). 12.23 Many areas of amenity open space have been provided within housing areas in the town. Two of the more significant areas are the linear strip of open land through Clavering and the area around the pond at Warrior Park. These have great amenity value for the local communities and also have value for wildlife. POLICY GN3 PROTECTION OF KEY GREEN SPACE AREAS DEVELOPMENT ON THE FOLLOWING KEY GREEN SPACE AREAS LISTED BELOW AND SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP WILL BE STRICTLY CONTROLLED: a. b. c. d. e. f. g. PARKS AND OTHER FORMAL PUBLIC OPEN SPACE, THE TOWN MOOR AND VILLAGE GREENS, CHURCHYARDS AND CEMETERIES, ALLOTMENTS, THE VERGES OF HIGHWAYS AND THE RAILWAY CORRIDOR, THE COASTAL MARGINS, BUFFER AREAS AT GOLDEN FLATTS AND SOUTH OF SEATON CAREW, h. OPEN SPACE AT CLAVERING, BRIARFIELDS, WARRIOR PARK, HILL VIEW, GREATHAM, ALONG THE WESTERN FRINGES OF THE TOWN AND AT WYNYARD WOODS, AND i. PONDS, WATERCOURSES AND THEIR RESPECTIVE MARGINS. PLANNING PERMISSION WILL ONLY BE GIVEN FOR DEVELOPMENTS WHICH RELATE TO THE USE OF LAND WITHIN THESE KEY GREEN SPACES AS PARKLAND OR OTHER AMENITY, RECREATIONAL OR LANDSCAPED OPEN SPACE, FOR CHURCHYARDS, CEMETERIES OR ALLOTMENTS, OR FOR WILDLIFE PURPOSES, SUBJECT TO THERE BEING NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE IMPACT ON: i. ii. iii. iv. v. 182 THE VISUAL AND AMENITY VALUE OF THE AREA, OR THE CHARACTER OF THE LOCALITY, OR FACILITIES FOR SPORT OR OTHER FORMAL OR INFORMAL RECREATION, OR THE CONTINUITY OF THE GREEN NETWORK AND ITS LINKS TO THE COUNTRYSIDE, OR AREAS OF WILDLIFE INTEREST. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 LANDSCAPING OF MAIN APPROACHES 12.24 POLICY GN4 The first impression of Hartlepool for potential investors and visitors is gained along the major roads into the town or from the railway. Considerable landscaping has been carried out along these corridors and the Borough Council wishes to ensure a continuation of such improvements. Policy GEP7 seeks to ensure that developments adjoining the main approaches are of a particularly high standard of design and landscaping. In addition the Borough Council will continue to undertake landscaping schemes on both its own and on privately owned land where practical to improve the visual environment along the main transport corridors. LANDSCAPING OF MAIN APPROACHES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL UNDERTAKE STRATEGIC LANDSCAPING SCHEMES AND WOODLAND PLANTING ALONG THE: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ A689 AND A179 ROAD CORRIDORS TO THE TOWN CENTRE, MAIN APPROACHES TO THE HEADLAND, MAIN APPROACHES TO SEATON CAREW, AND MIDDLESBROUGH TO NEWCASTLE RAILWAY LINE. TREE PLANTING 12.25 POLICY GN5 The Borough Council recognises the visual and environmental benefits of improving tree cover in Hartlepool and is a partner in the Tees Forest initiative which is primarily concerned with improving tree cover in the rural areas and providing better quality and accessible countryside on the urban fringe. The Council has where appropriate made Tree Preservation Orders to protect individually important trees and areas of woodland, and in policy GEP12 seeks the retention and planting of additional trees on development sites. It has also developed a family wood in the Burn Valley area and planted over 65,000 trees at the Summerhill gateway site. The Council will continue to seek major areas of woodland planting in these and other key locations in the town, both on its own land and as a requirement of major developments. TREE PLANTING THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROVIDE ADDITIONAL TREE AND WOODLAND PLANTING IN HARTLEPOOL AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS: a. b. c. d. e. f. g. HOW BECK GREEN WEDGE, BURN VALLEY FAMILY WOOD, SUMMERHILL AND MASEFIELD ROAD, WEST OF OWTON MANOR, TEES BAY RECREATIONAL AREA, WEST OF BRENDA ROAD, AND SOUTH OF ELIZABETH WAY. THE COUNCIL WILL IMPOSE PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR SEEK OBLIGATIONS TO ENSURE THAT TREE PLANTING IS PROVIDED AS PART OF DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS WITHIN AND ADJOINING THESE AREAS. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 183 INCIDENTAL OPEN SPACE 12.26 There are many small areas of amenity open space in Hartlepool, often provided as part of housing developments, which contribute both to the integrity of the greenspace network and to the amenity of residents of the immediate area. They often add character and identity to a local area. The Borough Council considers that such incidental open space should generally be safeguarded from development. There may, however, be circumstances where a proposed development (such as special needs housing) has special locational requirements and can only be located on open space in an area. In such circumstances there should be appropriate compensation for the ensuing loss of open space through the provision of alternative areas or by enhancement of remaining open space on the site. 12.27 The Borough Council will not generally permit small parts of open space areas to be incorporated into private gardens except in exceptional circumstances where the area concerned proves to be detrimental to the amenity of residents in the area and is either very small or is difficult to maintain. POLICY GN6 PROTECTION OF INCIDENTAL OPEN SPACE THE LOSS OF AREAS OF INCIDENTAL OPEN SPACE WILL BE RESISTED EXCEPT WHERE: i. ii. IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THE AREA OF OPEN SPACE IS DETIMENTAL TO THE AMENITIES OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES, AND IT IS TOO SMALL OR DIFFICULT TO MAINTAIN TO A SATISFACTORY STANDARD, OR A PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT HAS SPECIAL LOCATIONAL REQUIREMENTS AND THERE IS NO OTHER APPROPRIATE SITE IN THE VICINITY. WHERE AN AREA OF OPEN SPACE IS LOST TO DEVELOPMENT, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL IMPOSE PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR SEEK OBLIGATIONS TO ENSURE COMPENSATORY PROVISION OF AN ALTERNATIVE SITE OR ENHANCEMENT OF ADJOINING OPEN SPACE. 184 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 13 WILDLIFE AND NATURAL FEATURES CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 13.1 This chapter is concerned with protecting and enhancing the rich wildlife heritage of the Borough. It sets out policies to protect sites of wildlife importance ranging from international to locally important designations. 13.2 Britain has a number of significant international obligations as regards protection of wildlife sites. European obligations are set out in the Conservation (Natural Habitats &c) Regulations 1994. The nature conservation sites comprise European designations within the Natura 2000 series of sites together with other recognised international conventions. Natura 2000 is the title for a network of areas designated to conserve natural habitats and special species of wildlife which are rare, endangered or vulnerable in the European Community. The term comes from the 1992 EC Habitats Directive and symbolises the conservation of precious natural resources for the year 2000 and beyond. There are two types of designated areas: ♦ a Special Protection Area (SPA) to protect birds that are considered rare or vulnerable within the European Union; ♦ a Special Area of Conservation (SAC) may be designated where an area supports certain rare, endangered or vulnerable species of plant or animals other than birds, or if it supports outstanding examples of habitats. Some sites may have both designations although in the case of the Borough of Hartlepool, only a Special Protection Area has been designated. 13.3 In addition a SPA or SAC may be designated as a European Marine Site for those sites extending out below the mean low water mark. Some Special Protection Areas are also designated under the Ramsar Convention of 1971 as being Wetlands of International Importance. 13.4 The statutory framework in Britain under which wildlife sites of national importance are protected and enhanced is based on the Wildlife and Countryside Act 1981 (as amended). The legislation places a duty on local authorities to take reasonable steps to further conservation and enhancement of flora, fauna and geological/physiological sites. A code of practice will be issued in due course by the Secretary of State to guide local authorities to assess proposals which might have an effect on protected sites. 13.5 Sites of Special Scientific Interest form a national network of the country’s best sites for wildlife and geology. English Nature (Natural England) is responsible for the identification and protection of SSSIs in England. SSSIs which were identified in the Nature Conservation Review of 1977 and the Geological Conservation Review (1977-89) are recognised as being of national importance to which planning authorities are required to pay particular regard. The Secretary of State may make a Nature Conservation Order to protect an international or a Nature Conservation Review site. All National Nature Reserves are also SSSI Nature Conservation Review sites. National Planning Guidance 13.6 Current Government guidance on nature conservation is given in Planning Policy Statement (PPS) 9. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 185 13.7 PPS9 embodies the Government’s commitment to sustainable development and to conserving the diversity of Britain’s wildlife. The guidance sets out the framework for safeguarding our natural heritage under domestic and international law. It describes the role of the local planning authorities and English Nature (Natural England) and emphasises the importance of both designated and undesignated areas for nature conservation. PPS9 gives development control criteria, particularly for Sites of Special Scientific Interest (SSSIs) and other national and international sites and also for protected species. It elaborates on minerals development and nature conservation including sites of nature conservation importance. Regional Planning Guidance. 13.8 The Regional Planning Guidance for the North East states that internationally or nationally designated sites should continue to be protected in line with the Government’s tiered approach to nature conservation. Designated sites should not, however, be considered in isolation but rather as an integral part of the biodiversity of the region. A comprehensive approach to nature conservation should be adopted. The aim of development plans should be to maintain and increase the biodiversity of the region and to recognise the nature conservation value of non-designated habitats. Structure Plan Policies. 13.9 Environmental principles are embodied throughout the Tees Valley Structure Plan, which is committed to working towards achieving sustainable development. The policies in the plan seek to conserve and enhance areas and sites given special protection under various designations and to maintain and improve biodiversity by protecting and enhancing habitats (policies ENV4 to ENV7 and ENV9). Hartlepool Community Strategy 13.10 The Community Strategy seeks to protect and enhance the natural environment of the Borough, including open spaces and the countryside, and to ensure that the biodiversity of local wildlife and plants is valued and protected and their habitats are maintained and enhanced. Local Plan Objectives 13.11 In line with the overall aim of the local plan to regenerate Hartlepool securing a better future of its people to meet economic, environmental and social needs in a sustainable manner, the following plan objectives are particularly relevant in drawing up the policies relating to wildlife: C1 C5 C8 C9 C10 186 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to seek to create a green network within the main urban area to direct the future protection, management and improvement of open space for people and wildlife to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas, and to make them more accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and under-used land and buildings HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS 13.12 In urban and rural areas it is vital to maintain a balance between areas where development may normally take place and areas which are protected for the purpose of nature conservation in its own right. The local plan therefore contains policies providing for the protection and enhancement of nature conservation areas, which aim to maintain biodiversity - the diversity of habitats where species of flora and fauna may flourish. In addition it is desirable to accommodate public access to, and interpretation of, nature conservation sites in order that they may serve as an educational and recreational resource, as well as being protected for their own sake. Many species occur in the wider countryside outside protected sites as recognised by the Tees Valley Local Biodiversity Action Plan (see paragraph 13.37 below). 13.13 The Tees estuary is recognised as being ecologically important, particularly for internationally important populations of migratory waterbirds. The Tees estuary supports over 20,000 waterbirds each winter. This importance is recognised in Hartlepool with a series of protected wildlife sites in the estuary and along the coast. The Tees Estuary Management Plan (TEMP) was prepared by a cross agency working party to develop a framework to enhance the natural, cultural and economic resources of the Tees estuary and to minimise potential conflict between users. INTERNATIONAL SITES INCLUDING SPECIAL PROTECTION AREAS AND RAMSAR SITES 13.14 The most important wildlife sites are Special Protection Areas (SPA), Special Areas of Conservation (SAC) and Ramsar sites, which are sites of international significance. For planning purposes, the Government has chosen to base these sites on existing Sites of Special Scientific Interest. 13.15 As the competent planning authority, Hartlepool Borough Council is required by Regulation 48 of the Habitats Regulations 1994 to undertake “appropriate assessment” 1 on any plan or project which would be likely to have a significant effect on a European site. 13.16 Natura 2000 sites require the most rigorous examination in planning cases. The UK Government has indicated that new development which adversely affects Natura 2000 sites will only be permitted if there is an imperative reason of over-riding public interest. English Nature 2 must be consulted on all development proposals which may affect an SPA, SAC or Ramsar sites. 13.17 Parts of the Tees estuary which fall within Hartlepool were designated as the Teesmouth and Cleveland Coast Special Protection Area and Ramsar site in 1995. Much of the remaining coastline of Hartlepool was designated as an extension to this SPA and Ramsar site in March 2000. The Borough Council will comply with the UK’s international obligation in respect of this site. This SPA has a tidal component which is also classed under the Habitat Regulations as a European Marine Site. Relevant 1 In October 2005 the European Court of Justice ruled that the United Kingdom had failed to transpose the provisions of EU Directive 92/43/EEC on the Conservation of Natural Habitats and of Wild Fauna and Flora (Habitats Directive) and as a result there had been a failure to make land use plans (including Local Plans) subject to Appropriate Assessment. At the time of the ruling the preparation of the Hartlepool Local Plan was at an advanced stage. As relevant policies on Wildlife and Natural Features had already been drawn up in consultation with English Nature consideration is being given as to whether it is reasonably practicable to apply formal Appropriate Assessment to the Local Plan. 2 As from October 2006 English Nature becomes part of Natural England HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 187 authorities are required to exercise their functions so as to secure compliance with the Habitats Directive. A management scheme for the Teesmouth and Cleveland Coast European Marine site is being prepared. 13.18 POLICY WL1 Under Regulation 50 of the Conservation (Natural Habitats etc,) Regulations 1994, the Borough Council is required to review all extant planning permissions which are likely to have a significant effect on the Teesmouth and Cleveland Coast Special Protection Area. If the integrity of the Special Protection Area is found to be adversely affected, the Borough Council will need to consider any action to remove the harm. PROTECTION OF INTERNATIONAL NATURE CONSERVATION SITES. PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT NOT DIRECTLY CONNECTED WITH OR NECESSARY TO THE MANAGEMENT OF AN INTERNATIONALLY PROTECTED SITE (INCLUDING A SPECIAL PROTECTION AREA AND/OR A RAMSAR SITE) AND WHICH IS LIKELY TO HAVE A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE SITE (EITHER INDIVIDUALLY OR IN COMBINATION WITH OTHER PLANS OR PROJECTS) WILL BE SUBJECT TO THE MOST RIGOROUS EXAMINATION. WHERE IT CANNOT BE ASCERTAINED THAT THE DEVELOPMENT WOULD NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE INTEGRITY OF THE SITE IT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS: i. ii. THERE IS NO ALTERNATIVE SOLUTION; AND THERE ARE IMPERATIVE REASONS OF OVER-RIDING PUBLIC INTEREST FOR THE DEVELOPMENT. WHERE THE SITE CONCERNED HOSTS A PRIORITY NATURAL HABITAT AND/OR PRIORITY SPECIES, DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS IT IS NECESSARY FOR IMPERATIVE REASONS OF HUMAN HEALTH OR PUBLIC SAFETY OR FOR BENEFITS OF PRIMARY IMPORTANCE FOR THE ENVIRONMENT. WHERE DEVELOPMENT IS PERMITTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE HABITATS REGULATIONS, THE USE OF CONDITIONS OR PLANNING OBLIGATIONS WILL BE CONSIDERED IN ORDER TO AVOID AND MINIMISE HARM TO THE SITE, TO ENHANCE THE SITE’S NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST AND TO SECURE ANY COMPENSATORY MEASURES AND APPROPRIATE MANAGEMENT THAT MAY BE REQUIRED. IN THE BOROUGH, AS AT MARCH 2006 AND AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, THERE IS ONE INTERNATIONAL SITE (THE TEESMOUTH AND CLEVELAND COAST SPECIAL PROTECTION AREA / RAMSAR SITE). NATIONALLY IMPORTANT SITES Sites Of Special Scientific Interest. 13.19 188 Sites of Special Scientific Interest (SSSIs) are designated by English Nature (Natural England), as representative examples of semi-natural habitats forming a nationally important set of sites, under section 28 of the Wildlife and HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Countryside Act 1981 (as amended) as incorporated by the Countryside and Rights of Way Act 2000. They are of special interest by reason of their flora, fauna, geological or physiographical features. The following SSSIs which lie wholly or partially within Hartlepool are included in the Teesmouth Flats and Marshes Nature Conservation Review (NCR) site and are of national importance: • Seaton Dunes and Common • Seal Sands • Cowpen Marsh In addition, and also of national importance, the Hartlepool Submerged Forest SSSI is a Geological Review Site (GCR). 13.20 Planning permission is required for any temporary recreational uses of land within SSSIs, including for example war games or clay pigeon shooting. This is to enable nature conservation and other considerations to be taken into account before the change in land use. Sometimes such uses will be permissible on a seasonal basis without risks to the features of special interest. Conditions may be imposed to regulate the proposed use in order to mitigate potential damage to the SSSI. 13.21 Development proposals within an SSSI may have an adverse effect on the scientific interest of the site. In addition development outside the site may have an impact on the features of interest within the SSSI. For this reason the Borough Council will consult English Nature (Natural England) before deciding planning applications likely to affect land in an SSSI (see Policy GEP1). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 189 National Nature Reserves 13.22 POLICY WL2 A number of the most important SSSIs are managed as National Nature Reserves (NNR). English Nature (Natural England) owns, leases or manages NNRs by agreement, in order to conserve the best examples of the spectrum of wildlife habitats and geological features and provide opportunities for the study of their flora and fauna. National Nature Reserves are declared under Section 19 of the National Parks and Access to the Countryside Act 1949, or section 35 of the Wildlife and Countryside Act 1981/85. Where the site concerned is a NNR particular regard will be paid to its nature conservation interest. The Teesmouth NNR was declared in March 1995. PROTECTION OF NATIONALLY IMPORTANT NATURE CONSERVATION SITES PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT IN OR LIKELY TO HAVE AN EFFECT ON A SITE OF SPECIAL SCIENTIFIC INTEREST WILL BE SUBJECT TO SPECIAL SCRUTINY. WHERE DEVELOPMENT IS LIKELY DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, TO DAMAGE THE SPECIAL INTEREST OF THE SITE, IT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS THE REASONS FOR THE DEVELOPMENT CLEARLY OUTWEIGH THE HARM TO THE SPECIAL NATURE CONSERVATION VALUE OF THE SITE. WHERE DEVELOPMENT IS PERMITTED, THE USE OF CONDITIONS OR PLANNING OBLIGATIONS WILL BE CONSIDERED IN ORDER TO AVOID AND MINIMISE HARM TO THE SITE, TO ENHANCE THE SITE’S NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST AND TO SECURE ANY COMPENSATORY MEASURES AND APPROPRIATE MANAGEMENT THAT MAY BE REQUIRED. AS AT MARCH 2006 AND AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, THERE ARE 4 SSSIs WHICH LIE WHOLLY WITHIN THE BOROUGH: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ HART WARREN SSSI, HART BOG SSSI, HARTLEPOOL SUBMERGED FOREST SSSI, AND SEATON DUNES AND COMMON SSSI; AND 4 SSSIs WHICH LIE PARTLY WITHIN THE BOROUGH: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ DURHAM COAST SSSI, SEAL SANDS SSSI, COWPEN MARSH SSSI, AND TEES AND HARTLEPOOL FORESHORE AND WETLANDS SSSI. IN ADDITION PART OF ONE NATIONAL NATURE RESERVE AT TEESMOUTH LIES WITHIN THE BOROUGH. ENHANCEMENT OF SITES OF SPECIAL SCIENTIFIC INTEREST 13.23 The Borough Council has carried out some protection and enhancement works in two SSSIs. Dune stabilisation works has been carried out at Hart Warren SSSI and Seaton Dunes and Common SSSI. In addition sea buckthorn control has been 190 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 implemented at the latter site. The Borough Council has undertaken a hydrological survey of Seaton Dunes and Common SSSI and many of the recommendations are being implemented. A sluice has been installed to give control of the surface water. The Borough Council will continue to encourage, support and implement further enhancement works. These may also include prevention of unauthorised access by vehicles and animals to sensitive areas, whilst encouraging legitimate access by means of footpaths and designated parking and observation areas. Interpretation of sites may be achieved by provision of interpretive material such as information plaques, sign posting and by establishing nature trails. SSSIs may also be enhanced by the protection of native species and habitats from damage or destruction by unsympathetic management practices. The Borough Council has obligations under the Countryside and Rights of Way Act 2000 to conserve and enhance SSSIs. It may, in conjunction with English Nature (Natural England), seek nature conservation management agreements with owners or occupiers of SSSIs. POLICY WL3 ENHANCEMENT OF SITES OF SPECIAL SCIENTIFIC INTEREST THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENHANCE THE QUALITY OF THE SITES OF SPECIAL SCIENTIFIC INTEREST IN A SUSTAINABLE MANNER, BY THE FOLLOWING MEANS AS APPROPRIATE, AND AS FINANCES PERMIT: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ CARRYING OUT FURTHER DUNE STABILISATION WORKS AND WORKS TO PREVENT SURFACE EROSION, CARRYING OUT WATER MANAGEMENT, PREVENTION OF UNAUTHORISED VEHICULAR AND ANIMAL ACCESS, PROVISION AND MAINTENANCE OF FOOTPATHS AND FORMAL CAR PARKING AND OBSERVATION AREAS, PROVISION OF INTERPRATIVE MATERIALS, AND ESTABLISHMENT OF NATURE TRAILS. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK MANAGEMENT AGREEMENTS WITH OWNERS OR OCCUPIERS OF SSSIs INTENDED TO PROTECT NATIVE SPECIES AND HABITATS FROM DAMAGE OR DESTRUCTION. SPECIES PROTECTED BY LAW 13.24 Certain species of plant and animal, and in some cases their habitat, are given special protection through legislation (chiefly the Wildlife & Countryside Act 1981 (as amended), the Protection of Badgers Act 1992 and the Conservation (Natural Habitats etc) Regulations 1994). Nationally rare species are listed in red data books. The presence of a protected species on a site is a material consideration HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 191 where the local planning authority is considering a development proposal, which, if carried out, would be likely to result in harm to a protected species or habitat. The suspected occurrence of a protected species must therefore be thoroughly investigated (Supplementary Note 9). Where development is permitted, appropriate conditions may be imposed and where possible an equivalent alternative habitat will be required. Certain activities affecting protected species require licensing by English Nature or the Department for Environment, Food and Rural Affairs. 13.25 All bats and their roosts are protected by British and European Law. Where their presence is known or suspected, a survey should be carried out by a suitably qualified person. The key factors for bat conservation are age and size of buildings and their proximity to woodland and water. 13.26 In recent years the Tees Bay population of breeding little terns, a protected bird species, has formed a summer breeding colony on the Hartlepool/Easington boundary at Crimdon Dene. The Borough Council will work in partnership with other organisations to protect any nationally important little tern breeding colony on the Hartlepool coast. 13.27 The habitat of the water vole has been given protection due to the general decline of this animal throughout Great Britain. This species could be found on any development site which has a water course or body of water within it. It is possible that the water vole itself may become a protected species in the future. 13.28 It is likely that great crested newts may be found in suitable habitats in Hartlepool. This species has declined significantly over recent decades, largely due to habitat loss. Apart from the breeding pond, great crested newts need a suitable habitat for shelter, foraging and hibernation and because of this translocation to a replacement pond may not be appropriate. POLICY WL4 PROTECTED SPECIES DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT BE PERMITTED WHICH WOULD HAVE A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT, DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, ON SPECIES PROTECTED BY LAW AND THEIR HABITATS EXCEPT WHERE THE DEVELOPER HAS TAKEN EFFECTIVE STEPS TO SECURE THE PROTECTION OF SUCH SPECIES AND THEIR HABITATS (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 9). LOCAL NATURE RESERVES 13.29 The Borough Council has the power to acquire, declare and manage Local Nature Reserves (LNRs). This is to enable promotion of and positive management for nature conservation to be made. Local Nature Reserves also provide protection against competing uses and are recreational and educational resources of value to the whole community. 192 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 PROTECTION OF LOCAL NATURE RESERVES POLICY WL5 DEVELOPMENT LIKELY TO HAVE A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON A LOCAL NATURE RESERVE WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS THE REASONS FOR DEVELOPMENT CLEARLY OUTWEIGH THE HARM TO THE SUBSTANTIVE NATURE CONSERVATION VALUE OF THE SITE. AS AT MARCH 2006, AND AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL HAS DESIGNATED SIX LOCAL NATURE RESERVES IN HARTLEPOOL ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ 13.30 POLICY WL6 SEATON DUNES AND COMMON, HART TO HASWELL WALKWAY, GREATHAM BECK (WEST OF THE A689), HART WARREN DUNES, SUMMERHILL, AND SPION KOP CEMETERY The Borough Council may identify further areas in due course. NEW LOCAL NATURE RESERVES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL DECLARE FURTHER LOCAL NATURE RESERVES AS APPROPRIATE. SITES OF NATURE CONSERVATION IMPORTANCE AND REGIONALLY IMPORTANT GEOLOGICAL / GEOMORPHOLOGICAL SITES 13.31 As at March 2006, 38 Sites of Nature Conservation Importance (SNCIs) had been identified for their importance locally in nature conservation terms – these are listed in Appendix 7. SNCIs are important refuges, ‘stepping stones’ and corridors for wildlife. 13.32 In the Tees Valley, SNCIs are put forward by the Tees Valley Biodiversity Steering Group. This group is made up of representatives of the Tees Valley Boroughs, DEFRA, English Nature, the Environment Agency and a number of other bodies, including the Tees Forest, the Industry and Nature Conservation Association and the Tees Valley Wildlife Trust. A review of sites has been undertaken by the steering group using an agreed set of criteria on the value of each potential site. The designation of those sites currently meriting SNCI status has been ratified by the Borough Council. Any additional sites to be brought forward in the future will be considered as part of the agreed ratification process. 13.33 Unlike SSSIs, SNCIs are not covered by legislation for their protection and some of them are affected by existing planning permissions for development or by long-term designations for industrial and other uses. However, it is important that, as far as possible land use and management of SNCIs should be sympathetic towards nature conservation. The Borough Council will seek to enter into management agreements with owners or occupiers of SNCIs. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 193 13.34 The Borough Council recognises that where there is an overriding need to carry out coastal protection works, development on SNCIs may be necessary, subject to there being no net loss of local biodiversity plan habitats. In order to maintain a balance between developed land and natural habitats, it is desirable to compensate for SNCIs lost to development by provision of new sites whenever possible. Where development will not result in the complete destruction of an SNCI, the Borough Council will recommend that measures be adopted to mitigate the damage caused by the development. 13.35 Regionally Important Geological/Geomorphological Sites (RIGSs) are identified for their scientific and aesthetic value. These might include rock outcrops, waterfalls, caverns, ox-bow lakes and wave-cut platforms. They should be publicly accessible. As at March 2006 there is one RIGS currently identified in the borough, at Long Scar and Little Scar Rocks, Seaton Carew. It is likely that further RIGSs will be declared in due course. Ancient Woodlands 13.36 POLICY WL7 Woodland is considered to be ancient if it existed before 1600 AD or is shown on the earliest available maps of the area. Ancient semi-natural woodlands are irreplaceable and so any identified within the Borough are generally granted SNCI status. PROTECTION WOODLAND OF SNCIs, RIGSs AND ANCIENT SEMI-NATURAL DEVELOPMENT LIKELY TO HAVE A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON A SITE OF NATURE CONSERVATION IMPORTANCE OR A REGIONALLY IMPORTANT GEOLOGICAL/GEOMORPHOLOGICAL SITE OR ANCIENT SEMI-NATURAL WOODLAND, WHICH IS NOT OTHERWISE ALLOCATED IN THE LOCAL PLAN, WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS THE REASONS FOR THE DEVELOPMENT CLEARLY OUTWEIGH THE HARM TO THE SUBSTANTIVE NATURE CONSERVATION OR GEOLOGICAL OR GEOMORPHOLOGICAL VALUE OF THE SITE. WHERE DEVELOPMENT ON A DESIGNATED SITE IS APPROVED, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL MAY IMPOSE PLANNING CONDITIONS AND / OR SEEK LEGAL AGREEMENTS TO MINIMISE THE HARM TO THE SITE, ENHANCE THE REMAINING NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST AND SECURE ANY COMPENSATORY MEASURES AND SITE MANAGEMENT THAT MAY BE REQUIRED. 194 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 BIODIVERSITY 13.37 The Convention on Biological Diversity (termed biodiversity) was one of several sustainability initiatives stemming from the Earth Summit in Rio de Janeiro in 1992. It is a commitment by 150 nations, including the United Kingdom, to conserve and sustain the variety of life on Earth. Biodiversity encompasses the whole variety of life on Earth. It includes all species of fauna and flora, their genetic variations and the complex ecosystems of which they are a part. The UK is well advanced in developing and implementing a national Biodiversity Action Plan. The Government’s response to the Biodiversity Convention was to publish a strategy for conserving and enhancing wild species and wildlife habitats in the UK for the next 20 years – titled Biodiversity: the UK Action Plan (1994). Since 1994 the Government has produced 391 species and 45 habitat action plans. In 2002 the Government produced a biodiversity strategy for England ‘Working with the Grain of Nature’ which aims to ensure that biodiversity considerations become embedded in all the main sectors of the economic activity, public and private and sets out a work programme for the next five years. The Government fully supports the production of Regional and Local Biodiversity Action Plans. In 2001 the North East Regional Biodiversity Forum produced ‘A Biodiversity Audit of the North East’. The Tees Valley Local Biodiversity Action Plan was launched in 1999 and is endorsed by the Borough Council as providing the future basis for decisions on nature conservation in the Borough. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 195 POLICY WL8 PROTECTION OF BIODIVERSITY THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO HELP TO MEET TARGETS SET OUT IN THE NATIONAL AND TEES VALLEY BIODIVERSITY ACTION PLANS. IN ANY SITUATION WHERE DEVELOPMENT IS PERMITTED, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO MINIMISE OR AVOID ANY SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE IMPACT TO THE NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST OF THE SITE. THE USE OF CONDITIONS OR PLANNING OBLIGATIONS WILL BE CONSIDERED IN APPROPRIATE CASES, IN ORDER TO PROTECT AND ENHANCE THE SITE’S NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST AND TO PROVIDE APPROPRIATE COMPENSATORY MEASURES AND SITE MANAGEMENT. 196 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 14 CONSERVATION OF THE HISTORIC ENVIRONMENT CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 14.1 The Borough of Hartlepool has benefited from a variety of measures to conserve its rural and urban environment. These include grants for repairing buildings in Conservation Areas and contributions towards the repair and maintenance of listed and historic buildings. It is essential to continue to protect and enhance the built environment of the town. This part of the local plan considers the many and diverse aspects of the historic environment. It identifies how and where areas of special or historic interest may be improved and enhanced. 14.2 Development plans are required to include policies for the conservation of the built environment, based on advice given in Planning Policy Guidance Note 15 issued in September 1994 for the protection of historic buildings, conservation areas and other elements of the historic environment. Planning Policy Guidance Note 16 issued in 1990 encourages the protection of archaeologically important sites. Structure Plan Policies 14.3 The Tees Valley Structure Plan aims to improve the area’s environment by protecting and enhancing Listed Buildings and Conservation Areas and their settings and by protecting its heritage and sites of archaeological importance. Policies ENV10 and ENV11 relate to the investigation and evaluation of sites of archaeological interest. Policy ENV12 seeks to protect the character and appearance of Conservation Areas and Listed Buildings. Hartlepool Community Strategy 14.4 The Community Strategy seeks to protect the built environment including areas of townscape and the coast together with areas of archaeological or architectural importance. The strategy also emphasises the need to promote good design and to record, protect and provide information about the historic environment. Local Plan Objectives 14.5 In line with the main aims of the Local Plan and the need to improve the image of the town, the following objectives are relevant to the formulation of policies and proposals for the protection and conservation of the built environment: C1 A4 A7 C3 C7 C10 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to promote the growth of tourism to promote development on previously used sites and to encourage the full use of empty or underused buildings to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest to protect and enhance the character of the existing villages to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and underused land and buildings HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 197 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS CONSERVATION AREAS 14.6 Conservation Areas are designated because of their special architectural or historic interest, the character and appearance of which it is desirable to preserve and enhance. 14.7 At 2006 eight Conservation Areas have been designated within the Borough. Six of these lie within the main urban area, at Seaton Carew, Church Street, the Headland, Stranton, the Grange and in the Park area. The other two are in the villages of Elwick and Greatham (see Diagram 14.1). Protection and Enhancement of Conservation Areas 14.8 Conservation Areas contribute to the quality of the built environment and help promote Hartlepool as an attractive place in which to live and to visit. It is important that standards of design for new buildings and extensions are maintained in Conservation Areas, and that all developments should preserve or enhance the particular character of the individual Conservation Area in terms of appearance and impact of use. 14.9 As the characteristics of each of the eight Conservation Areas vary considerably, policies have been formulated to reflect theses differences and guidance on special design requirements included. Proposals for development in Conservation Areas should adhere to policies HE1, HE2 and HE4 and reference should be made to Supplementary Note 5 and, where appropriate, to any Village Design Statement in interpreting these policies. Supplementary Note 5 refers to the character of the Conservation Areas, to the scale, type, use and nature of development and to materials and designs which are considered appropriate to the setting. 14.10 The Borough Council expects a high standard of design to be demonstrated for development proposals in Conservation Areas and will seek provision of full details of design at the planning application stage. This aims to avoid unnecessary delays pending further information being sought from applicants. 14.11 Conservation Areas are examples of special built environments which the Council seeks to preserve and enhance. This, however, does not mean that no changes are to be permitted in a Conservation Area, but it does indicate that great care will be taken to ensure that unsympathetic design and incompatible changes of use should not occur. 14.12 The Park, Grange, Elwick and Greatham Conservation Areas are predominantly residential. Some buildings in the two village Conservation Areas remain in agricultural use. The Borough Council wishes to retain the special residential character of the Park, Grange, Elwick and Greatham Conservation Areas by ensuring that development is of a residential nature (including houses, flats, residential homes, hotels and guest houses) or appropriate to a residential area (including small shops and community uses). 14.13 In the Headland Conservation Area development should respect the area’s special historic heritage. 14.14 In the Church Street, Stranton and Seaton Carew Conservation Areas, commercial and retail developments should be in character and particular care is needed to ensure that designs normally associated with modern commercial and retail practices remain sensitive to the quality of the built environment. 198 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 199 14.15 Development within the Greatham Conservation Area should have regard to the Greatham Village Design Statement published in September 1999 (see policy Rur4). 14.16 For works to buildings within Conservation Areas attention should be paid to the rear of properties where these are visible or where public investment is to be requested. POLICY HE1 PROTECTION AND ENHANCEMENT OF CONSERVATION AREAS PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT WITHIN A CONSERVATION AREA WILL BE APPROVED ONLY WHERE IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THE DEVELOPMENT WILL PRESERVE OR ENHANCE THE CHARACTER OR APPEARANCE OF THE AREA AND WHERE THE DEVELOPMENT DOES NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE AMENITIES OF OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES. ANY APPLICATIONS FOR PLANNING PERMISSION WITHIN CONSERVATION AREAS SHOULD BE SUBMITTED WITH FULL DETAILS. IN DETERMINING APPLICATIONS, PARTICULAR REGARD WILL BE HAD TO THE NEED FOR THE FOLLOWING: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. THE SCALE AND NATURE OF THE DEVELOPMENT TO BE APPROPRIATE TO THE CHARACTER OF THE PARTICULAR CONSERVATION AREA, THE DESIGN, HEIGHT, ORIENTATION, MASSING, MEANS OF ENCLOSURE, MATERIALS, FINISHES, AND DECORATION PROPOSED TO BE SYMPATHETIC WITH THOSE OF THE SURROUNDING PROPERTIES, ASSOCIATED LANDSCAPE IMPROVEMENTS TO BE INCORPORATED, EXISTING TREES, HEDGEROWS AND LANDSCAPE FEATURES ON THE SITE TO BE RETAINED, ALL SUBSTANTIAL AND WORTHWHILE ORIGINAL FEATURES SUCH AS WALLS, GATEWAY ENTRANCES TO BE RETAINED, AND CAR PARKING, WHERE PROVIDED, TO BE LOCATED, DESIGNED AND LANDSCAPED IN SUCH A WAY AS TO PRESERVE THE CHARACTER OR APPEARANCE OF THE AREA. DEVELOPMENT IN THE PARK, ELWICK & GREATHAM CONSERVATION AREAS AND IN THE MAIN PART OF THE GRANGE CONSERVATION AREA SHOULD BE APPROPRIATE TO A RESIDENTIAL AREA. REFERENCE SHOULD BE MADE TO SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 5 AND TO ADOPTED VILLAGE DESIGN STATEMENTS IN ORDER TO REFLECT LOCAL DISTINCTIVENESS. 14.17 200 It is important to ensure that advertisements do not detract from the visual amenity in Conservation Areas. Whilst in suitable locations in Church Street and Seaton Carew advertisements may be an appropriate addition to the streetscape, care should be taken to ensure that the advertisements are of an appropriate design which will enhance the street scene (see paragraph 80 of Supplementary Note 5 relating to advertisements in Conservation Areas). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 Environmental Improvements in Conservation Areas 14.18 POLICY HE2 The Borough Council recognises the need to improve the general environment of Conservation Areas, for the benefit of local residents as well as to enhance their attractiveness for tourism. The Borough Council will, subject to the availability of finance, assist private sector involvement in environmental improvement schemes by means of grant aid. ENVIRONMENTAL IMPROVEMENTS IN CONSERVATION AREAS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE ENVIRONMENTAL IMPROVEMENTS TO ENHANCE CONSERVATION AREAS (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 5). Developments in the Vicinity of Conservation Areas 14.19 POLICY HE3 It is important that developments in areas immediately adjacent to Conservation Areas should take proper account of their effects on the setting and character of Conservation Areas. DEVELOPMENTS IN VICINITY OF CONSERVATION AREAS THE DESIGN AND MATERIALS USED IN NEW DEVELOPMENTS WHICH WOULD AFFECT THE SETTING OF CONSERVATION AREAS SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE CHARACTER OF THOSE NEIGHBOURING CONSERVATION AREAS (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 5). WHERE THERE ARE IMPORTANT VIEWS INTO AND OUT OF THE CONSERVATION AREA THESE SHOULD BE PRESERVED OR ENHANCED. Control of Demolition in Conservation Areas 14.20 POLICY HE4 The designation of a Conservation Area gives the local authority powers, by virtue of the need for Conservation Area consent or planning permission, to control the demolition of buildings and certain other features within Conservation Areas. The Borough Council will use these powers to allow, in exceptional circumstances, proposals involving the demolition of buildings in Conservation Areas, in order to maintain the historic character of the built environment. Proposals for demolition to remove a later unsympathetic addition, such as a porch or extension to a building in a Conservation Area will be favourably received provided that, a suitable alternative use is agreed where appropriate. The Borough Council will, where necessary, impose conditions to preclude demolition in Conservation Areas until a satisfactory after use is committed, in order to prevent gap sites occurring. CONTROL OF DEMOLITION IN CONSERVATION AREAS WHERE THERE ARE CONTROLS ON DEMOLITION IN CONSERVATION AREAS, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ONLY PERMIT THE DEMOLITION OF THOSE BUILDINGS AND OTHER FEATURES AND STRUCTURES IF IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT: i. ii. THE REMOVAL WOULD HELP TO PRESERVE OR ENHANCE THE CHARACTER OR APPEARANCE OF THE CONSERVATION AREA, OR ITS STRUCTURAL CONDITION IS SUCH THAT IT IS BEYOND REASONABLE ECONOMIC REPAIR. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL REQUIRE, BY CONDITION OR BY SEEKING A LEGAL AGREEMENT, PROPOSALS FOR THE SATISFACTORY AFTER-USE OF THE SITE TO BE APPROVED AND HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 201 COMMITTED BEFORE DEMOLITION IS ALLOWED TO TAKE PLACE (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 5). Additional Measures to Improve Design in Conservation Areas 14.21 The Borough Council seeks to protect Conservation Areas from potentially unsympathetic developments such as replacement windows and reroofing, which are generally permitted development without the need for planning permission. Such protection can be given by making a Direction under Article 4 of the Town & Country Planning (General Development Order) 1995 which makes planning permission necessary for a wider range of works especially on prominent frontages within a Conservation Area. There are currently Article 4 Directions covering parts of Seaton Carew, Elwick, Grange, Greatham and Headland Conservation Areas. Whilst Article 4 Directions are useful tools in protecting a Conservation Area they are also applicable elsewhere throughout the Borough (see policy GEP 11 above). 14.22 Village Design Statements prepared by the local community are a means to identify the special distinctiveness of local areas. To date one Village Design Statement has been adopted (for Greatham) and it is possible that others may be encouraged in due course (see policy Rur4). Review of Conservation Areas 14.23 POLICY HE5 The existing Conservation Area boundaries are to be kept under review. There are areas that might also benefit from designation in order to protect their special qualities and to ensure that new developments preserve and enhance the quality of the environment in those areas. During 2002 the Seaton Carew Conservation Area was reviewed and as a consequence the boundary of the designated area was extended. In 2004 further areas were considered in the Grange area to the west of the town centre and at Stranton Gardens. These two areas have subsequently been designated as Conservation Areas. REVIEW OF CONSERVATION AREAS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL EXAMINE THE POTENTIAL FOR THE DESIGNATION OF NEW CONSERVATION AREAS AND WILL KEEP UNDER REVIEW THE LIMITS OF EXISTING CONSERVATION AREAS IN PARTICULAR WHERE: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ THERE IS NEW EVIDENCE OR AWARENESS OF ARCHITECTURAL OR HISTORIC INTEREST, WHERE KNOWN FACTORS ARE LIKELY TO POSE A RISK TO THE SPECIAL CHARACTER OF AN AREA, WHERE THERE IS GROUP VALUE OF BUILDINGS AND OPEN SPACES, WHERE AN ARTICLE 4 DIRECTION MIGHT NOT BE APPROPRIATE, AND WHERE SPECIFIC ENHANCEMENT SCHEMES ARE BROUGHT FORWARD. HISTORIC PARKS AND GARDENS 14.24 202 English Heritage in 1998 included Ward Jackson Park in a non-statutory register of Parks and Gardens of Special Historic Interest in England as a good example of a Victorian park which has retained much of it original character. The inclusion on the register has assisted the Borough to obtain financial assistance towards the restoration of the park and its Listed Buildings and structures within the Park Conservation Area. It is possible that other parks or gardens may be identified for inclusion on the list either within or outside Conservation Areas. The HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 character, appearance and setting of registered parks and gardens should be protected from inappropriate development. POLICY HE6 PROTECTION AND ENHANCEMENT OF REGISTERED PARKS AND GARDENS DEVELOPMENTS WITHIN OR IN THE IMMEDIATE VICINITY OF THOSE AREAS INCLUDED IN THE REGISTER OF PARKS AND GARDENS OF SPECIAL HISTORIC INTEREST SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE CHARACTER OF THOSE PARKS AND GARDENS. SUCH DEVELOPMENTS SHOULD NOT INVOLVE THE LOSS OF FEATURES CONSIDERED TO FORM AN INTEGRAL PART OF THE SPECIAL CHARACTER OR APPEARANCE OF THE AREA. PROPOSALS SHOULD NOT DETRACT FROM THE ENJOYMENT, LAYOUT, DESIGN, CHARACTER APPEARANCE OR SETTING OF THE PARK OR GARDEN. AS AT MARCH 2006 THERE IS ONE HISTORIC PARK – WARD JACKSON PARK. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE ENVIRONMENTAL IMPROVEMENTS TO ENHANCE REGISTERED PARKS AND GARDENS. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 203 LISTED BUILDINGS Control of Demolition of Listed Buildings 14.25 There are about 200 buildings and structures which are listed as being of architectural or historic interest (see Appendix 8). These “Listed Buildings” are protected by legislation and consent is usually needed for their alteration (internal as well as external) or for their complete or substantial demolition. Advice can be given by the Borough Council on what constitutes proposals which are less than substantial demolition as this is a matter of fact and degree (and may constitute works or alterations). Listed Buildings are an important part of Hartlepool’s heritage which should as far as practicable, be preserved. Where demolition is the only option the Council will usually require proposals for the satisfactory redevelopment of the site to be committed before demolition takes place. The Borough Council will consider favourably proposals involving the demolition of a later extension which detracts from the character of a Listed Building. 14.26 The presence of bats and bat roosts in Listed Buildings may constrain the timing of demolition and will require mitigation measures to protect the species (see policy WL4 and Supplementary Note 9). POLICY HE7 CONTROL OF DEMOLITION OF LISTED BUILDINGS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ONLY CONSENT TO THE DEMOLITION OF A LISTED BUILDING IN EXCEPTIONAL CIRCUMSTANCES WHERE IT HAS BEEN CLEARLY DEMONSTRATED THAT: A) IN THE CASE OF TOTAL DEMOLITION : i. ii. iii. iv. B) THERE IS NO APPROPRIATE USE FOR THE BUILDING, THE FABRIC OF THE BUILDING IS BEYOND REASONABLE ECONOMIC REPAIR, PRESERVATION IN SOME FORM OF CHARITABLE OR COMMUNITY OWNERSHIP IS NOT POSSIBLE OR SUITABLE, AND REDEVELOPMENT WOULD PRODUCE SUBSTANTIAL BENEFITS FOR THE COMMUNITY. IN THE CASE OF SUBSTANTIAL DEMOLITION: 14.27 i. toTHE FABRIC OF THE FEATURES ARE BEYOND ECONOMIC Works Listed Buildings REPAIR, AND ii. THE and LOSS OF THE STRUCTURE OR FABRIC WILL skill NOT Development alteration involving historic buildings requires great and MATERIALLY DETRACT FROM THEadditions SPECIAL OFthe care to avoid damage and to ensure that any areCHARACTER in keeping with THE BUILDING. 204 THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL REQUIRE THAT DETAILED PROPOSALS HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 FOR THE SATISFACTORY REDEVELOPMENT OF THE SITE ARE COMMITTED BEFORE DEMOLITION TAKES PLACE. remainder of the building, and that new features harmonise with their surroundings. It is most important to avoid the use of incongruous designs and materials which adversely affect the character and appearance of historic buildings and their setting. Supplementary Note 5 provides general design guidance relating to works to Listed Buildings. In addition the presence of bats and bat roosts in Listed Buildings may require mitigation measures (see Policy WL4 and Supplementary Note 9). POLICY HE8 WORKS TO LISTED BUILDINGS (INCLUDING PARTIAL DEMOLITION) TRADITIONAL MATERIALS AND SYMPATHETIC DESIGNS SHOULD BE USED IN WORKS TO LISTED BUILDINGS, TO BUILDINGS ADJACENT TO LISTED BUILDINGS AND TO THOSE BUILDINGS WHICH AFFECT THE SETTING OF A LISTED BUILDING (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 5). THESE SHOULD BE IN KEEPING WITH THE CHARACTER AND SPECIAL INTEREST OF THE BUILDING AND SHOULD THEREBY PRESERVE THE INTEGRITY OF THE SETTING AND THAT OF THE SURROUNDING AREA. INTERNAL FEATURES AND FITTINGS WHICH COMPRISE AN INTEGRAL PART OF THE CHARACTER AND SPECIAL INTEREST OF THE BUILDING SHOULD BE RETAINED WHERE PRACTICAL. ALTERATIONS TO PART OF A LISTED BUILDING WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT THE MAIN PART OF THE BUILDING WILL BE PRESERVED AND ENHANCED AND WHERE Changes of Use of Listed BuildingsOF SPECIAL ARCHITECTURAL OR NO SIGNIFICANT FEATURES HISTORIC INTEREST ARE LOST. 14.28 L isted Buildings which are no longer used for the purpose for which they were HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 205 originally designed may be at risk of deterioration and may even become derelict when left empty. Where this is the case, it is important that new acceptable uses are found which bring disused Listed Buildings back into use. It may be appropriate to allow uses which are widely different from the original provided that this does not adversely affect the character or setting of the Listed Building, nor adversely affect the occupiers of nearby or adjacent properties. POLICY HE9 CHANGES OF USE OF LISTED BUILDINGS THE CHANGE OF USE OF A LISTED BUILDING WHICH PRESERVES ITS CHARACTER OR SPECIAL INTEREST AND ITS SETTING, WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES. Development in the Vicinity of Listed Buildings 14.29 POLICY HE10 It is important that development adjacent and visually prominent to the setting of a Listed Building should take proper account of the effect on the integrity of that building. DEVELOPMENTS IN THE VICINITY OF LISTED BUILDINGS THE SITING, DESIGN AND MATERIALS OF NEW DEVELOPMENTS IN THE VICINITY OF LISTED BUILDINGS SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE LISTED BUILDING AND ITS SETTING. NEW DEVELOPMENT WHICH ADVERSELY AFFECTS A LISTED BUILDING AND ITS SETTING WILL NOT BE APPROVED. Review of Listed Buildings 14.30 POLICY HE11 Within the Borough of Hartlepool there are many high quality and attractive historic buildings which should be preserved but which are currently unlisted. Many contribute to the character of the local environment. The Borough Council seeks to avoid problems of delays in listing procedures. The Borough Council will therefore keep Listed Buildings under review. It will recommend the Secretary of State for Culture, Media and Sport include on the list those unlisted historic buildings which appear threatened by development and which merit statutory protection, and similarly will recommend those Listed Buildings which no longer merit protection be deleted from the list. REVIEW OF LISTED BUILDINGS THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL KEEP UNDER REVIEW THOSE HISTORIC BUILDINGS IT RECOMMENDS FOR INCLUSION ON THE LIST OF BUILDINGS OF SPECIAL ARCHITECTURAL OR HISTORIC INTEREST. Buildings of Local Interest 206 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 14.31 Whilst buildings on the local list do not have statutory protection their inclusion on the list will be a material consideration when planning applications are determined. Generally the considerations will be similar to those applied to unlisted buildings in Conservation Areas. In particular the council will seek to prevent the demolition of those buildings included on the local list and the removal of their important features. 14.32 There is a need to protect many other buildings within the Borough which are not included on the statutory list. Sometimes these have been omitted from the list by the Secretary of State because the view of central government is that there are better examples elsewhere within in the country. Some characteristics of buildings may however be rare within Hartlepool or may have important group value or may display important local distinctiveness which make up the town’s heritage. The Borough Council will therefore, subject to resources, prepare a non-statutory list identifying Buildings of Local Interest which would be desirable to preserve as a means of emphasising local character and a sense of place. POLICY HE12 PROTECTION OF LOCALLY IMPORTANT BUILDINGS IN DETERMINING APPLICATIONS FOR PLANNING PERMISSION THAT AFFECT ENTRIES ON THE LIST OF LOCALLY IMPORTANT BUILDINGS, PARTICULAR REGARD WILL BE HAD TO THE FOLLOWING: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ THE HISTORIC OR ARCHITECTURAL IMPORTANCE OF THE BUILDING; FEATURES WHICH CONTRIBUTE SIGNIFICANTLY TO THE CHARACTER OF THE BUILDING; ITS GROUP VALUE; ITS CONTRIBUTION TO THE APPEARANCE OF THE LOCALITY; ITS SCARCITY VALUE TO THE REGION; THE SCALE, NATURE AND IMPORTANCE OF THE PROPOSED REDEVELOPMENT; AND THE DESIGN AND MEANS OF ENCLOSURE OF THE PROPOSAL. THE COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PREVENT THE DEMOLITION OF THOSE BUILDINGS INCLUDED ON THE LIST OF LOCALLY IMPORTANT BUILDINGS AND THE REMOVAL OF THEIR IMPORTANT FEATURES, AND WILL SUPPORT THEIR REMOVAL OR ALTERATION ONLY IF IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT IT WOULD HELP PRESERVE OR ENHANCE THE CHARACTER OF THE SITE AND THE SETTING OF OTHER BUILDINGS NEARBY. 14.33 Conservation involves giving old buildings a new lease of life through restoration, sensitive development, adaptation and good management. The Borough Council is prepared, subject to the availability of resources, to give grants to assist in meeting the cost of repairing and enhancing Listed Buildings, buildings within Conservation Areas and for those on the Local List. ARCHAEOLOGICAL SITES HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 207 Introduction 14.34 Hartlepool has a rich archaeological heritage. Over 1000 archaeological remains are detailed on the Sites and Monuments Record (SMR) for the area of the Borough held by Tees Archaeology. The SMR is constantly updated and revised as new information is received. It includes such diverse sites as prehistoric settlements, medieval villages, Victorian shipwrecks and World War defences. Developers are encouraged to make early contact with Tees Archaeology to highlight archaeological issues at an early stage. Scheduled Monuments and Protected Wreck Sites 14.35 Scheduled Monuments are of national importance and their physical preservation will be required. They are protected under the Ancient Monuments and Archaeological Areas Act 1979. In addition historic shipwrecks may be designated as Protected Wrecks under the Protection of Wrecks Act 1973. 14.36 Within the Borough there are currently eight Scheduled Monuments. These are:♦ Claxton Medieval Moated Site, ♦ Hartlepool Town Wall and Sandwell Gate, ♦ Hartlepool Heugh Battery ♦ Hart Great House, ♦ Hart Fishponds, ♦ Low Throston Deserted Medieval Village, ♦ High Burntoft Medieval Farmstead and Open Field System, and ♦ Elwick Hall Fishpond. 14.37 There is currently one Protected Wreck within the Borough. This is the Seaton Carew Collier Brig. 14.38 An ongoing scheme of work by English Heritage known as the Monuments Protection Programme is re-assessing all archaeological sites for inclusion in the Schedule of Ancient Monuments. This makes it likely that the number of designations will increase during the plan period. 14.39 The Borough Council will protect these sites and their settings from adverse effects of development. POLICY HE 13 SCHEDULED MONUMENTS DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS WHICH ADVERSELY AFFECT THE SITE AND SETTING OF A SCHEDULED MONUMENT OR PROTECTED WRECK WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. Areas of Archaeological Interest 14.40 208 The rich archaeological heritage of the Borough is not fully represented by its few sites with statutory designations. As it is not possible to show all archaeological sites on the proposal map, developers should consult Tees Archaeology for details of sites in any particular area. Developers should however note the following areas are of particular importance: ♦ The Headland - it is known that important archaeological remains of national importance exist on the Headland. ♦ The villages - other archaeological sites exist in the villages at:Hart, HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 Elwick, Dalton Piercy, Greatham, and Newton Bewley. ♦ Other Important sites - archaeological sites in more open locations exist at:Summerhill (Catcote Village), Seaton Common, and Greenabella Marsh. 14.41 This list is not exhaustive and developers will need to be aware of the possibility of archaeological interest in other areas around the town. The Borough Council and Tees Archaeology will offer advice to developers at the pre-application stage where archaeological remains are likely to be affected by development. These consultations and any subsequent assessments by qualified archaeologists commissioned by the developer may reveal that important archaeological remains exist. 14.42 On receipt of proposals for development likely to affect sites of archaeological interest an assessment will be made to determine possible impact on the site. The developer will be requested to arrange for an archaeological field evaluation to be carried out before any decision is taken on the planning application. This will allow the Borough Council to assess the weight which ought to be attached to the preservation of the remains in situ whether the site is scheduled or not. It will assist the Borough Council in determining whether the application will be refused, required to be preserved in situ or whether archaeological recording is required. 14.43 In rare situations it may not be feasible to preserve archaeological remains in-situ. Each case will be assessed on its merits and an acceptable alternative may be for an investigation by excavation and recording to be carried out. The Borough Council may secure this by imposing a condition to planning permission or through a legal agreement. Developers will be required to show, before development commences, that proper provision has been made for excavation and recording of the archaeological remains. POLICY HE14 PROTECTION OF ARCHAEOLOGICAL SITES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROTECT ARCHAEOLOGICAL SITES AND, WHERE APPROPRIATE, THEIR SETTING. WHERE DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS AFFECT SITES OF KNOWN OR POSSIBLE ARCHAEOLOGICAL INTEREST THE BOROUGH COUNCIL MAY REQUIRE THAT AN ARCHAEOLOGICAL ASSESSMENT / EVALUATION IS CARRIED OUT PRIOR TO ANY PLANNING APPLICATION BEING DETERMINED. THIS IS INTENDED TO INDICATE WHETHER THE DEVELOPMENT IS LIKELY: ♦ ♦ ♦ TO BE SUBJECT TO ARCHEAOLOGICAL RECORDING, TO BE SUBJECT TO A REQUIREMENT TO PRESERVE REMAINS IN SITU, OR TO BE REFUSED. WHERE NATIONALLY IMPORTANT REMAINS ARE FOUND TO EXIST THEN THEIR PRESERVATION IN SITU WILL BE REQUIRED. WHERE THIS CANNOT BE ACHIEVED BY SENSITIVE DESIGN THEN PLANNING PERMISSION MAY ULTIMATELY BE REFUSED. WHEN PHYSICAL PRESERVATION IS NOT REQUIRED, AND WHERE APPROPRIATE, THE COUNCIL WILL, BY MEANS OF CONDITIONS, REQUIRE THE APPLICANT TO MAKE PROPER PROVISION FOR THE INVESTIGATION OF THE SITE BEFORE AND DURING DEVELOPMENT. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 209 AREAS OF HISTORIC LANDSCAPE 14.44 English Heritage encourages the protection of landscapes which represent important past human activity. One such area is Seaton Common where relics of the important medieval salt industry are evident. The area is currently protected under policies WL1 and WL2 as a Special Protection Area and Ramsar site and as a Site of Special Scientific Interest but additional designation as an area of Historic Landscape is considered appropriate because of its importance to the archaeological heritage of Hartlepool. POLICY HE15 AREAS OF HISTORIC LANDSCAPE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SEEK TO PROTECT AND ENHANCE THE HISTORIC LANDSCAPE OF THE SALT MOUND AREA AT SEATON COMMON WHICH IS OF ARCHAEOLOGICAL SIGNIFICANCE. ANY DEVELOPMENT WILL REQUIRE AN ARCHAEOLOGICAL EVALUATION OF THE SITE (SEE POLICY HE14). FURTHER SITES WILL BE ASSESSED AND NEW HISTORIC LANDSCAPES MAY BE DESIGNATED WHERE APPROPRIATE. 210 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN –April 2006 15 THE RURAL AREA CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 15.1 The countryside in Hartlepool comprises about 65% of the area of the Borough, although only a small proportion of the population lives or works in the rural areas. Current changes in the agricultural economy have resulted in increased pressure on the rural areas to accommodate among others, new recreation and leisure facilities. These changes are likely to continue over the next few years as the European Union’s Common Agricultural Policy is redefined and as the admission of new member states to an enlarged European Union affects established markets. The reduction of agricultural land in food production will result in pressure for alternative economic use of rural land. Such new activities need to be carefully controlled, for whilst development is necessary to sustain the rural economy, it must be compatible with the protection of the countryside in terms of its beauty, landscape, wildlife and natural features, agriculture, natural resources and recreational value. An objective of the Hartlepool Community Strategy is to protect and enhance the natural environment and the countryside, and ensure that the biodiversity of local wildlife and plants is valued and protected and their habitats are maintained. 15.2 The planning system is playing an increasingly important role in rural areas to ensure that a balance exists between economic development and the protection of rural landscapes. It is particularly important that urban development such as new housing and industry is not allowed to spread into the countryside. Conservation of the Borough’s rural environment is important for the benefit of those who live and work in the countryside and also for visitors. The countryside should be conserved for its own sake in order to avoid spoiling the very features which make it attractive in the first place. Structure Plan Policies 15.3 The Tees Valley Structure Plan within its overall strategy of sustainable development states that continuous urban development extending into the countryside and new development within the countryside will be strictly controlled (policies ENV13, STRAT1 and STRAT2). Specifically it requires that open areas between settlements are protected to retain their physical identity (ENV14). 15.4 The best and most versatile agricultural land and the amenity of the countryside are to be safeguarded (ENV20). The plan proposes the development of the countryside for quiet recreation pursuits (L3) and the improvement of the urban fringe areas adjoining the main built up area. Local Plan Objectives 15.5 The following objectives which accord with those of the Hartlepool Community Strategy to protect and enhance the countryside are relevant in the drawing up of the local plan’s policies and policies for the countryside: A4 A5 B3 B4 to promote the growth of tourism to ensure that there is an adequate infrastructure to serve new and existing development to encourage in accessible locations the provision of sport, recreational, leisure and cultural developments to cater for the whole community to protect and encourage the development of local shopping, leisure, sporting and recreational and other community facilities at locations convenient to main neighbourhoods HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 211 C1 C2 C3 C4 C7 C8 C9 C10 C11 D4 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool to retain the compact form of the main urban area by preventing urban development extending into the countryside to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest to encourage a high standard of design and the provision of high quality environment in all developments and particularly those on prominent sites, along the main roads and rail corridors and along the coast. to protect and enhance the character of the existing villages to protect and enhance the countryside and coastal areas, and to make them accessible for the benefit of the residents of, and visitors to, the Borough to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure the appropriate enhancement of derelict, unused and underused land and buildings to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting or hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a damaging effect on the environment. to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport Landscape Assessment 15.6 During 1999, the Borough Council commissioned a landscape assessment to evaluate the quality of the countryside taking into account amenity value, visual quality, landscape value and the potential for enhancement of the landscape 1 . In all, six types of rural landscape have been evaluated. These are : ♦ the coastal area, ♦ the Tees Estuary area, ♦ undulating farmland, ♦ woodland, ♦ the rural fringe, and ♦ the transport corridors. An additional type was assessed within the urban area as urban green space. 15.7 The landscape assessment has been used in the preparation of the local plan for the following issues:♦ to evaluate the landscape quality of the countryside, ♦ to assist the evaluation of the limits to development at the urban edge and around the villages, ♦ to help define green wedges, ♦ to redefine where necessary the extent of the Special Landscape Areas, ♦ to assess landscape from a visual and community value, and ♦ to identify areas which would benefit from improved management and conservation. 1 Hartlepool Landscape Assessment – The Landmark Partnership (February 2000). 212 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS LIMITS TO DEVELOPMENT 15.8 In order to control the spread of urban development and to protect the countryside, it is necessary to define precisely limits to development around the main urban area of Hartlepool and the villages of the Borough. Policies and proposals in this chapter of the local plan primarily refer to the area outside the limits to development including both the rural hinterland of the town and the undeveloped areas of the coast. (For open areas extending from the urban area out to the countryside see Chapter 12: The Green Network). The Urban Fence 15.9 POLICY Rur1 The limit to development of the main built up area is defined by the “urban fence”. The line of this urban fence reflects the requirements of the Tees Valley Structure Plan to retain open areas between Hartlepool and Billingham, and in the areas between Hartlepool and the villages of Greatham, Hart, Elwick and Dalton Piercy. The limit to development has been drawn up to take account of proposed developments within and on the edge of the existing urban area and the future development needs of the town as a whole, up to and beyond 2016, the period covered by this local plan. URBAN FENCE THE SPREAD OF THE URBAN AREA INTO THE SURROUNDING COUNTRYSIDE AND UNDEVELOPED AREAS OF THE COAST BEYOND THE URBAN FENCE SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP WILL BE STRICTLY CONTROLLED. PROPOSALS FOR DEVELOPMENT IN THE COUNTRYSIDE WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE THEY MEET THE CRITERIA SET OUT IN POLICIES Rur7, Rur11, Rur12 AND Rur13, OR WHERE THEY ARE REQUIRED IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE DEVELOPMENT OF NATURAL RESOURCES OR TRANSPORT LINKS. Development at Wynyard 15.10 Beyond the urban fence line, areas of land have planning permission at Wynyard for industrial and business uses. Development has commenced at Wynyard Business Park and a further area of land is allocated for industrial development at North Burn (see policies Ind1 and Ind2). The areas for industrial development are defined within limits to development shown on the Proposals Map. 15.11 Wynyard Woods comprises a new housing area set in the countryside which extends across the boundary between the Boroughs of Hartlepool and Stockton on Tees. Approximately 130 houses built or with planning permission are within the Hartlepool area and the limit to development shown on the Proposals Map reflects this development. POLICY Rur2 WYNYARD LIMITS TO DEVELOPMENT LAND AT WYNYARD WITHIN THE LIMIT TO DEVELOPMENT SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP IS IDENTIFIED FOR HOUSING AND FOR EMPLOYMENT PURPOSES (SEE ALSO POLICIES Ind1 AND Ind2). EXPANSION BEYOND THE DEFINED LIMITS AROUND WYNYARD WILL NOT BE PERMITTED HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 TO DEVELOPMENT 213 Village Envelopes 15.12 There are five villages in the Borough - Hart, Greatham, Elwick, Dalton Piercy, and Newton Bewley. The location of these villages between Hartlepool and the main A19 Trunk Road make them attractive to commuters seeking a home in a rural setting. It is important to ensure that the essentially rural characteristics of these villages are retained, by restricting the limits beyond which they can expand, in order to maintain their attractiveness as small communities. 15.13 Village envelopes have been defined around the villages taking into account the following factors:a. the adequacy of land available within the main urban area of Hartlepool to meet the overall need for all types of housing during the plan period up to 2016 and beyond. b. physical constraints to development including the capacity of public utility services, educational facilities and the road network to accommodate further growth c. environmental constraints, including the protection of the character and heritage of the village and of the physical setting and also the conservation of sites of archaeological interest d. the need to safeguard the best and most versatile agricultural land. POLICY Rur3 VILLAGE ENVELOPES EXPANSION BEYOND THE DEFINED VILLAGE ENVELOPES AROUND THE VILLAGES OF HART, GREATHAM, ELWICK, DALTON PIERCY AND NEWTON BEWLEY WILL NOT BE PERMITTED. DEVELOPMENT IN THE VILLAGES Affordable Housing in the Rural Area 15.14 Generally there is no adequate justification for low cost housing for local needs within the villages within the Borough particularly as they lie close to the main urban area where there is an adequate supply of affordable housing. However requirements for affordable housing in the rural area will be kept under review. Village Design Statements 15.15 POLICY Rur4 The design of new development within villages will need to take account of any Village Design Statements prepared by the community under the Countryside Agency’s Parish Plans initiative 2 . A Village Design Statement, which identifies special local distinctiveness, was prepared for Greatham in August 1999 and adopted by the Borough Council as Supplementary Planning Guidance (see Supplementary Note 6). Further Village Design Statements will be prepared for other villages. VILLAGE DESIGN STATEMENTS THE DESIGN OF NEW DEVELOPMENTS WITHIN VILLAGES WILL NEED TO TAKE ACCOUNT OF ANY RELEVANT VILLAGE DESIGN STATEMENTS WHICH HAVE BEEN ADOPTED BY THE LOCAL Development at Newton Bewley PLANNING AUTHORITY AS SUPPLEMENTARY PLANNING GUIDANCE. 2 Parish Plans are part of the Countryside Agency’s ‘Vital Villages’ initiative. They are prepared by a village community and are intended to be a framework for the future of the settlement. Parish Plans can include any social, environmental or economic issues. Village Design Statements may be a key section of the Parish Plan and can be adopted as Supplementary Planning Guidance separately from the Parish Plan itself. 214 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 15.16 POLICY Rur5 Whilst in most of the villages there are opportunities for limited infill and redevelopment of existing properties, development at Newton Bewley is constrained by the fast A689 which bisects the village. Although a speed limit has been imposed in recent years, new access points are still likely to prejudice highway safety. New access points and intensification of existing accesses will not generally be allowed. Policy Tra15 restricts new access points onto the A689. DEVELOPMENT AT NEWTON BEWLEY MINOR INFILL DEVELOPMENT AND REDEVELOPMENT OF EXISTING SITES WITHIN THE DEFINED VILLAGE LIMIT AROUND NEWTON BEWLEY WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE THERE WILL BE NO MATERIAL INCREASE IN VEHICULAR TRAFFIC AT EXISTING ACCESS POINTS (SEE ALSO POLICIES Tra15 AND Hsg9). Rural Services 15.17 POLICY Rur6 Shops and public houses and other key facilities serving local rural communities offer a valuable service to local residents, particularly those without access to a car. It is difficult to ensure that such facilities are maintained when operators or owners wish to cease operations for economic or family reasons. Changes of use from a community service should however be resisted where it can not be adequately demonstrated that genuine attempts have been made to dispose of the business as a going concern. Supporting evidence will be required therefore that the property has been widely advertised locally on the open market for a reasonable period and that no reasonable offer that would allow retention of the service has been refused. This could involve the facility being advertised at least four times over a twelve-month period at roughly equal intervals over the year at a value reflecting the existing use. RURAL SERVICES WITHIN THE DEFINED VILLAGES AND IN THE COUNTRYSIDE, PROPOSALS FOR THE CHANGE OF USE OF BUILDINGS WHICH ARE USED AS SHOPS, PUBLIC HOUSES OR COMMUNITY FACILITIES WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT: i. ii. iii. THE FACILITY IS NO LONGER VIABLE, THERE IS NO DEMAND FOR THE FACILITY IN THE LOCALITY, AND EQUIVALENT ALTERNATIVE FACILITIES ARE AVAILABLE NEARBY. DEVELOPMENT IN THE COUNTRYSIDE 15.18 The countryside is being increasingly subject to pressure for change. The Borough Council considers that most new development in the wider countryside and along the undeveloped areas of the coast should, in general, be resisted in order to retain the natural beauty and landscape diversity of these rural areas. 15.19 Certain types of development (such as electricity transmission lines, telecommunications masts, wind turbines, mineral workings, roads, service reservoirs, agricultural buildings, sewage treatment works, pumping stations, and other public utilities) not all of which require planning permission, may need to be accommodated in the countryside. They should however, as far as possible, be carefully sited so as to minimise both the intrusive effect on the landscape, the adverse effects on farming and wildlife and on the historic environment. Where HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 215 planning permission is required the principles laid down in local plan policies GEP1 relating to general matters and/or in other more specific policies (such as those relating to telecommunications, wind turbines etc.) will be relevant in determining applications. 15.20 Beyond the urban fence line, the Wynyard limits to development and village envelopes, development should be compatible with its rural surroundings. Appropriate countryside activities include, for example: ♦ essential rural activities in agriculture, horticulture and forestry, ♦ recreation uses characterised by large areas of open space, but with limited requirements for building, extensive car parking or other infrastructure, ♦ certain institutional and similar uses standing in extensive open landscaped grounds, and ♦ certain small scale rural enterprises (including tourism enterprises, small scale commercial and light manufacturing industries) involving the use or redevelopment of land and buildings in a manner which would neither be harmful in effect nor intrusive in appearance. Where such farm diversification is proposed activities should be compatible with existing agricultural activities. In addition, some developments associated with the extraction of minerals will be appropriate in the countryside. 15.21 All development works on or affecting agricultural land need to be carried out in accordance with a code of practice set out by the Department of Environment & Rural Affairs (DEFRA). Prior to any excavation of agricultural land it is the responsibility of the developer to take steps to prevent the spread of soil borne plant or animal diseases. 15.22 Details of foul drainage provision will be required particularly in the case where mains drainage is not available. If non-mains sewerage and sewage disposal is not assessed as being satisfactory this would normally be sufficient to justify refusal of planning permission. POLICY Rur7 DEVELOPMENT IN THE COUNTRYSIDE IN ADDITION TO POLICIES GEP1, Rur11, Rur13, Rur16 AND OTHER RELEVANT LOCAL PLAN POLICIES, THE FOLLOWING FACTORS WILL BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT IN DETERMINING APPLICATIONS FOR PLANNING PERMISSION IN THE OPEN COUNTRYSIDE: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. vii. viii. ix. x. 216 RELATIONSHIP OF THE DEVELOPMENT TO OTHER BUILDINGS IN TERMS OF SITING, SIZE AND COLOUR, VISUAL IMPACT ON THE LANDSCAPE, COMPATIBILITY OF THE DESIGN OF THE DEVELOPMENT WITHIN ITS SETTING AND THE LANDSCAPE GENERALLY, USE OF TRADITIONAL OR SYMPATHETIC MATERIALS, OPERATIONAL REQUIREMENTS OF THE AGRICULTURE AND FORESTRY INDUSTRIES, REQUIREMENT WHERE APPROPRIATE FOR ADDITIONAL TREE AND HEDGE PLANTING AND OTHER RELATED ENVIRONMENTAL IMPROVEMENTS, VIABILITY OF A FARM ENTERPRISE, ADEQUACY OF THE SEWAGE DISPOSAL ARRANGEMENTS, PROXIMITY TO EXISTING INTENSIVE LIVESTOCK UNITS, AND ADEQUACY OF THE ROAD NETWORK. WITHIN THE TEES FOREST AREA THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL IMPOSE PLANNING CONDITIONS AND WILL SEEK LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS, AS APPROPRIATE, TO ENSURE THE PLANTING OF TREES AND HEDGEROWS IN ASSOCIATION WITH NEW DEVELOPMENT. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 AGRICULTURE Permitted Development 15.23 POLICY Rur8 Some development for the purpose of agriculture is “permitted development” not requiring planning permission. However the Borough Council must be notified of certain proposals applying to agricultural units so that it can, if necessary, require “prior approval” to be obtained for specified details. This does not mean that permitted development rights as such have ceased. Rather it gives the Borough Council the opportunity to consider the effect of the development on the landscape in terms of visual amenity, particularly in areas of landscape importance (see paragraph. 15.57 below) as well as the desirability of preserving archaeological and wildlife sites, the character of Conservation Areas, and Listed Buildings and their setting. Where it is considered that the development is likely to have a significant impact on its surroundings, the Borough Council can require the formal submission of details to influence the final siting, design and external appearance of the development and its relationship to its surroundings. PRIOR NOTIFICATION FOR AGRICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT PRIOR NOTIFICATION IS REQUIRED TO DETERMINE WHETHER PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT FOR FARMING OR FORESTRY PURPOSES NEEDS PRIOR APPROVAL. PRIOR APPROVAL WILL BE REQUIRED WHERE THE DEVELOPMENT IS VISUALLY PROMINENT OR INTRUSIVE IN THE RURAL LANDSCAPE OR IS LOCATED: i. ii. iii. iv. v. WITHIN A CONSERVATION AREA OR OTHERWISE AFFECTING ITS CHARACTER, OR WITHIN A SPECIAL LANDSCAPE AREA AS SHOWN ON THE PROPOSALS MAP, OR IN THE VICINITY OF KNOWN ARCHAEOLOGICAL SITES OR SITES OF WILDLIFE OR NATURAL INTEREST, OR WHERE IT MAY ADVERSELY AFFECT A LISTED BUILDING OR ITS SETTING, OR IN CLOSE PROXIMITY TO THE EDGE OF BUILT DEVELOPMENT NEAR HOUSES. WHERE PRIOR APPROVAL IS REQUIRED FOLLOWING FACTORS WILL BE TAKEN DETERMINING THE APPLICATION: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. 15.24 FOR DETAILS, THE INTO ACCOUNT IN THE RELATIONSHIP OF THE DEVELOPMENT TO OTHER BUILDINGS IN TERMS OF SITING, SIZE AND COLOUR, THE VISUAL IMPACT ON THE LANDSCAPE, THE COMPATIBILITY OF THE DESIGN OF THE DEVELOPMENT WITHIN ITS SETTING AND THE LANDSCAPE GENERALLY, THE USE OF TRADITIONAL OR SYMPATHETIC MATERIALS, THE OPERATIONAL REQUIREMENTS OF THE AGRICULTURE AND FORESTRY INDUSTRIES, AND THE EFFECTS ON PUBLIC RIGHTS OF WAY. Where planning permission is required for agricultural and other proposals in the open countryside, the principles laid down in policies Rur6 and GEP1 will apply. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 217 However, because of the sensitive nature of development in the countryside, particular emphasis will be given to visual impact on the landscape and use of traditional or sympathetic materials. Agricultural Land 15.25 Agriculture remains the most important land use in the countryside despite reductions in production and the operation of set aside which are encouraging diversification of agricultural land. Once farmland is used for other purposes, however, it is very difficult to return it to agricultural use. It is therefore important that the areas of highest quality farmland are protected from such irreversible development. Woodland planting however is a reversible process which does not compromise the best and most versatile agricultural land. 15.26 A band of land running from north to south and lying to the west of Hartlepool has been identified as containing a higher proportion of best and most versatile agricultural land. These islands of the higher grade of agricultural land are to be found near Greatham, Dalton Piercy, Naisberry and Hart as shown in Diagram 15.1. POLICY Rur9 PROTECTION OF AGRICULTURAL LAND DEVELOPMENT RESULTING IN THE IRREVERSIBLE LOSS OF THE BEST AND MOST VERSATILE AGRICULTURAL LAND WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS OTHER CONSIDERATIONS APPLY. WHERE DEVELOPMENT ON AGRICULTURAL LAND IS UNAVOIDABLE PREFERENCE SHOULD BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF POORER QUALITY LAND. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL IN DETERMINING PLANNING APPLICATIONS WILL TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE FOLLOWING MATTERS:i) THE EXISTENCE OF ALTERNATIVES SITES WITHIN THE LIMITS TO DEVELOPMENT; ii) POSITIVE SUSTAINABILITY FACTORS (INCLUDING ANY REDUCTION IN THE NEED TO TRAVEL); iii) THE EFFECT ON FARM SIZE, STRUCTURE AND VIABILITY; iv) THE RECOMMENDATIONS OF THE DEPARTMENT OF THE ENVIRONMENT AND RURAL AFFAIRS AND OTHER RELEVANT BODIES; v) THE FEASIBILITY OF RESTORATION TO AN EQUIVALENT GRADE OF AGRICULTURAL LAND. Intensive Livestock Units and Animal Waste Processing 15.27 An intensive livestock unit is used for the permanent indoor housing of pigs, poultry or cattle and also for housing such livestock indoors for only part of the time if a slurry system is to be adopted. Buildings to be used for intensive livestock units, and associated structures such as slurry tanks and lagoons need full planning permission where these are to be built within 400 metres of residential and other populated areas. The Borough Council recognises the need to minimise potential conflict between neighbouring land uses when considering planning applications for houses, schools, hospitals, offices etc. within 400 metres of established livestock units, because of the potential risk of nuisance from smell or noise associated with intensive livestock units. Within the 400 metre cordon, the Borough Council will expect developers to adopt measures to ensure that the operation of intensive livestock units does not have a significant detrimental effect on the amenities of nearby residents or occupiers. 218 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 219 POLICY Rur10 INTENSIVE LIVESTOCK UNITS PROPOSALS FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF INTENSIVE LIVESTOCK UNITS WITHIN 400 METRES OF RESIDENTIAL OR POPULATED AREAS WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. ii. iii. iv. THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING AND NEIGHBOURING PROPERTY BY REASON OF SMELL, NOISE OR GENERAL DISTURBANCE, THE BUILDINGS ARE DESIGNED AND SITED IN SUCH A MANNER AS TO AVOID UNACCEPTABLE VISUAL INTRUSION FROM ANY MAIN ROAD, RAILWAY, FOOTPATH OR BRIDLEWAY (SEE ALSO POLICY Rur6), THE SITE IS ADEQUATELY SCREENED, AND ADEQUATE PROVISIONS ARE MADE FOR STORAGE AND DISPOSAL OF SOLID MANURE AND SLURRY WITHOUT SIGNIFICANT RISK OF POLLUTION OF AIR, SOIL, THE AQUIFER OR OF WATERCOURSES. Changes in Farming Practices 15.28 The Environment Agency is empowered under the Control of Pollution (Silage, Slurry and Agricultural Fuel Oil) Regulations 1991 to serve notice requiring action to improve existing silage, slurry or fuel oil installations if it considers these pose a significant pollution risk. The Borough Council will consider sympathetically such developments which seek to reduce agricultural pollution of water courses. 15.29 The Borough Council will also treat sympathetically those development proposals which aim to comply with new environmental, hygiene and welfare legislation, for example those involving extensions to animal houses which increase space allocations required as alternatives to stall-and-tether systems. Farm Diversification 15.30 The character of the countryside is largely dependent on the nature of farming activity. Structural changes in farming in recent years however have made make it more difficult to maintain satisfactory income from agriculture. Although farming remains vital to the economy of the rural area, the Borough Council recognises that opportunities for diversification into non agricultural activity can make a positive contribution to the continued viability of farm businesses. 15.31 Well conceived farm diversification schemes may be encouraged where the nature and scale of the business is appropriate to a rural location. Such schemes should seek to reuse good quality existing buildings to create new business use rather than the building of new development in the countryside. Where new buildings are required there should be no loss of visual quality of the countryside or erosion of the character of the rural area. 15.32 Within the rural area there may be opportunities for woodland planting and other agri-environmental schemes under the Countryside Agency’s Countryside Stewardship scheme. However forest planting should not be used to justify inappropriate and unsustainable development in the countryside. 15.33 Certain industrial and commercial development may not be appropriate in the countryside particularly where alternative and more accessible and sustainable sites are available in the urban area. Apart from reasons associated with the need to protect the intrinsic value of the countryside, there are the added factors 220 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 that roads in the rural areas may be generally inadequate to cater for any increase in traffic. POLICY Rur11 FARM DIVERSIFICATION FARM DIVERSIFICATION SCHEMES WILL BE PERMITTED WHERE THE PROPOSALS: a) CONFORM TO POLICIES Rur7, Rur13, Rur16, GEP1 AND OTHER RELEVANT POLICIES; b) MINIMISE AS FAR AS POSSIBLE ANY ADVERSE EFFECTS ON THE BEST AND MOST VERSATILE AGRICULTURUAL LAND. (SEE POLICY Rur9); c) REUSE WHERE POSSIBLE EXISTING FARM BUILDINGS (SEE POLICY Rur13); d) DO NOT HAVE SIGNIFICANT DETRIMENTAL EFFECT ON THE AMENITIES OF OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING AND NEIGHBOURING PROPERTY BY REASON OF SMELL, NOISE OR GENERAL DISTURBANCE; e) DO NOT GENERATE SIGNIFICANT ADDITIONAL TRAFFIC ONTO THE RURAL ROAD NETWORK. f) ARE CONSISTENT IN THEIR SCALE WITH THEIR RURAL LOCATION. HOUSING IN THE RURAL AREAS New Housing 15.34 There is sufficient land available within the limits to development defined around the Hartlepool urban area and the villages to accommodate the anticipated housing needs up to and beyond 2016. There is no justification for new housing development in the open countryside other than that required for countryside activities. Occupancy conditions will be imposed where justified on permissions for agricultural dwellings, and will not be removed without realistic assessment of needs. 15.35 There are presently several isolated dwellings scattered throughout the countryside, some of which are unsuitable for continued occupation. The Borough Council considers that where the residential use has been abandoned over many years there is no justification for new dwellings to be erected in its place. However, where a dwelling has continued in residential use, it should be reasonable to allow for its replacement on a one to one basis, provided that the new dwelling does not intrude visually into its surroundings. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 221 POLICY Rur12 NEW HOUSING IN THE OPEN COUNTRYSIDE ISOLATED NEW DWELLINGS WILL NOT BE PERMITTED IN THE OPEN COUNTRYSIDE UNLESS IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT:a) THEY ARE ESSENTIAL FOR THE EFFICIENT FUNCTIONING OF AGRICULTURAL, FORESTRY OR OTHER APPROVED OR ESTABLISHED USES IN THE COUNTRYSIDE, b) THE ENTERPRISE FOR WHICH THEY ARE REQUIRED IS ECONOMICALLY VIABLE, c) THEY ARE OF A SIZE COMMENSURATE WITH THE ESTABLISHED FUNCTIONAL REQUIREMENT, d) THE SITING, DESIGN, SCALE AND MATERIALS WILL NOT BE SIGNIFICANTLY DETRIMENTAL TO THE RURAL ENVIRONMENT. PROPOSALS FOR ONE FOR ONE REPLACEMENT DWELLINGS WILL ONLY BE APPROVED WHERE: i. ii. THE EXISTING ACCOMMODATION NO LONGER MEETS MODERN STANDARDS AND IS INCAPABLE OF ECONOMIC REPAIR OR ADAPTATION, AND THE SCALE OF THE PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT IS BROADLY SIMILAR TO THE ORIGINAL AND THE FORM, SCALE, MASSING AND GENERAL DESIGN IS SUCH TO MINIMISE VISUAL INTRUSION. INFRASTRUCTURE INCLUDING SEWAGE DISPOSAL TO SERVE HOUSING IN THE RURAL AREA MUST BE ADEQUATE TO MEET THE NEEDS OF THE DEVELOPMENT. Residential Extensions 15.36 Proposals for the extension of existing residential properties in the countryside should accord with Policy Hsg10 and the guidelines set out in Supplementary Note 4. RE-USE OF RURAL BUILDINGS 15.37 Some rural buildings which are no longer in use in connection with agricultural or other activities, offer some opportunities for re-use or conversion to alternative uses such as small scale workshops, unobtrusive recreational facilities, tourist accommodation and visitor centres which could all be appropriate to the rural environment (see policy Rur11). 15.38 Farm buildings located within the village envelopes could in addition be appropriate for conversion to residential and certain small scale business uses. Whilst in exceptional circumstances other rural buildings outside village envelopes may be appropriate for residential uses, preference should be given to employment uses. All conversions must, however, remain compatible with the character and amenity of their surroundings. 15.39 A conversion of a rural building to other purposes could result in the construction of additional premises or in extensions to existing buildings to accommodate a displaced farming activity. Where it is considered that this is the case, and where a resultant proliferation of farm buildings could have a serious detrimental effect on the landscape, the Borough Council may attach planning conditions to its approval for the re-use of a building for non agricultural activities removing the 222 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 permitted development rights normally granted in respect of future new farm buildings or extensions on the particular agricultural unit or holding. 15.40 POLICY Rur13 The presence of nesting birds or protected species such as barn owls or bats (and their roosts) in rural buildings may constrain the timing any works and may require mitigation measures to protect the species (see policy WL4). REUSE OF RURAL BUILDINGS PROPOSALS FOR THE RE-USE OF BUILDINGS IN THE OPEN COUNTRYSIDE WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. THEY ARE FOR COMMERCIAL PURPOSES APPROPRIATE TO THE RURAL ENVIRONMENT, ii. THE PROPOSED USE DOES NOT ADVERSELY AFFECT THE SURROUNDING AREA BY REASON OF NOISE, DISTURBANCE, DUST, APPEARANCE OR VISUAL INTRUSION, iii. THE BUILDINGS ARE CAPABLE OF CONVERSION WITHOUT SIGNIFICANT REBUILDING AND / OR ALTERATIONS AND EXTENSIONS WHICH WOULD ADVERSELY CHANGE THEIR FORM AND CHARACTER, iv. THERE IS NO OUTSIDE STORAGE WHICH WOULD INTRUDE INTO THE LANDSCAPE OR AFFECT THE SETTING OF THE BUILDING, v. THE ROAD NETWORK IS CAPABLE OF ACCOMMODATING THE PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT, vi. APPROPRIATE CAR PARKING IS PROVIDED (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2), vii. ADEQUATE SEWAGE DISPOSAL IS PROVIDED, AND viii THERE IS NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON SPECIES PROTECED BY LAW (SEE POLICY WL4). ix THE DEVELOPMENT ACCORDS WITH CRITERIA SET OUT IN POLICIES Rur7, Rur11 and Rur16 AS APPROPRIATE. IN ADDITION, WHERE PROPOSED REUSE OF BUILDINGS INVOLVES A RESIDENTIAL USE, THE APPLICANT WILL NEED TO: a) DEMONSTRATE THAT REASONABLE ATTEMPTS HAVE BEEN MADE TO SECURE SUITABLE BUSINESS REUSE AND SUBMIT A STATEMENT OF THE EFFORTS WHICH HAVE BEEN MADE, OR b) DEMONSTRATE THAT RESIDENTIAL CONVERSION IS A SUBORDINATE PART OF A SCHEME FOR BUSINESS USE. PLANNING CONDITIONS RESTRICTING FUTURE PERMITTED DEVELOPMENT RIGHTS FOR NEW FARM BUILDINGS AND EXTENSIONS AND / OR ALTERATIONS TO CONVERTED BUILDINGS MAY BE IMPOSED, WHERE APPROPRIATE, TO CONTROL THEIR PROLIFERATION WHERE THEY WOULD BE DETRIMENTAL TO THE VISUAL ENVIRONMENT. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 223 RECREATION AND TOURISM Recreation Near the Urban area 15.41 The area of countryside close to the main urban area can suffer from problems such as vandalism, litter dumping, and damage to the landscape. The agricultural viability of such land may be adversely affected by urban pressures. Such areas are vulnerable to change. However these areas can offer great potential in meeting the need for local access to attractive and interesting countryside. They also offer great potential for other recreational and leisure purposes, particularly large users of land such as golf courses, or users requiring access to a wider area, such as riding establishments, which are not usually appropriately located within the urban area. The Tees Forest 15.42 The Tees Forest (formerly the Cleveland Community Forest) extends over most of the rural area of Hartlepool and into the green wedges within the town. The forest initiative is implemented through the Tees Forest Partnership. This comprises the Countryside Agency, the Forestry Commission and the five Borough Councils in the Tees Valley area. The forest initiative seeks to achieve a range of environmental and community benefits, including tree planting, landscape improvement, wildlife conservation, agricultural diversification, recreation provision and employment generation. 15.43 The Cleveland Community Forest Plan, originally published in 1994, has now been replaced by the Tees Forest Plan, published in November 2000. The overall strategy is set out in Appendix 2. The Forest Plan identifies Local Management Zones within which appropriate local strategies will be developed to reflect the individual form and character of each zone. Within the Borough of Hartlepool there are three zones: ♦ the Hartlepool Rural Fringe where an area of significant woodland establishment will permit increased recreation within the green corridor at Middle Warren, the forest gateway site at Summerhill and improved access routes to link to the urban boundary; ♦ the Greatham Corridor within the low-lying countryside between Billingham and Hartlepool, where improvements and rationalisation in rights of way and improvements to the cycle network are envisaged; and ♦ Wynyard which covers an existing wooded area. 15.44 The Tees Forest Countryside Sport and Recreation Strategic Action Plan published in 1999 indicates a number of ways in which countryside recreational facilities can be improved by the development of gateway sites and a network of greenways (see paragraph 15.45 below). POLICY Rur14 THE TEES FOREST DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS CONSIDERED APPROPRIATE IN THE COUNTRYSIDE AND WHICH ARE LOCATED WITHIN THE AREA OF THE TEES FOREST SHOULD SEEK TO INCLUDE TREE PLANTING (USING LOCALLY NATIVE SPECIES), LANDSCAPING AND IMPROVEMENTS TO THE RIGHTS OF WAY NETWORK. IN THIS RESPECT, PLANNING CONDITIONS MAY BE ATTACHED AND LEGAL AGREEMENTS SOUGHT IN RELATION TO PLANNING APPROVALS. 224 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Gateway sites 15.45 A number of gateway sites providing open access for recreation and locations for woodland planting have been identified within Hartlepool. Summerhill, with a visitor centre (opened in 1999) and various outdoor activities, has been established as a primary gateway site. It lies adjoining the Summerhill/Burn Valley green wedge and has direct access to the open countryside. 15.46 Hart Moor Farm has been established as a secondary gateway site and Hart Station (at the southern end of the Hart to Haswell route) and Sunderland Lodge have potential for further secondary sites with appropriate facilities being provided. In the case of the Hart Station gateway it is proposed to link this facility with the proposed rail halt especially with regard to cycle parking. (see Transport paragraph 8.23 and policy Tra3). A site within the Middle Warren green wedge is considered as a tertiary site. The Borough Council will keep under review the potential for identifying further gateway sites. Further potential tertiary sites could be identified in the North Burn area west of the A19 and at Greatham. POLICY Rur15 SMALL GATEWAY SITES SMALL COMMUNITY FOREST GATEWAY SITES ARE IDENTIFIED AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS: a. b. c. d. HART MOOR FARM, HART STATION, MIDDLE WARREN, AND SUNDERLAND LODGE & RED GAP. LOCAL, INFORMAL RECREATIONAL AND APPROPRIATE FACILITIES OF A MODEST NATURE WILL BE DEVELOPED. LEISURE THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL KEEP UNDER REVIEW THE POTENTIAL FOR FURTHER GATEWAY SITES AND WILL IDENTIFY NEW SITES WHERE APPROPRIATE. Recreation and Tourism in the Open Countryside 15.47 The Borough Council considers that recreational developments in the countryside beyond the fringes of the urban area and in the undeveloped coastal areas should be limited to quiet outdoor recreational and sporting activities such as picnicking, walking and nature trails. In this respect the Borough Council seeks to ensure that access to sensitive habitats is carefully managed to avoid damaging such habitats. Other recreational developments involving more active participatory pursuits and developments involving the erection of new tourism accommodation are generally more appropriate in the urban area although the development of the Tees Forest may provide opportunities for certain recreational and sporting developments. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 225 POLICY Rur16 RECREATION IN THE COUNTRYSIDE PROPOSALS FOR OUTDOOR RECREATIONAL DEVELOPMENTS IN RURAL AREAS WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. vii. viii. THE DEVELOPMENT DOES NOT SIGNIFICANTLY DETRACT FROM THE OPEN NATURE OF THE LANDSCAPE, THE BEST AND MOST VERSATILE AGRICULTURAL LAND IS PROTECTED FROM IRREVERSIBLE DEVELOPMENT (SEE POLICY Rur9), THERE ARE NO NEW ACCESS POINTS ONTO THE A19, THE A689 OR THE A179 BETWEEN THE URBAN FENCE AS DEFINED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP AND THE BOROUGH BOUNDARY (SEE POLICY Tra15), THE ROAD NETWORK IS CAPABLE OF ACCOMMODATING THE DEVELOPMENT AND SATISFACTORY ACCESS CAN BE PROVIDED (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 1), NEW BUILDINGS ARE LIMITED TO THOSE ESSENTIAL TO THE MAIN USE OF THE LAND FOR OUTDOOR RECREATION PURPOSES AND ARE DESIGNED, SITED AND LANDSCAPED TO COMPLEMENT THE SURROUNDINGS, THERE IS NO DISTURBANCE TO OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING AND NEARBY PROPERTIES, OR COUNTRYSIDE USERS OR TO NATURE CONSERVATION INTEREST, ADEQUATE CAR PARKING FACILITIES ARE PROVIDED (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 2), AND THE DEVELOPMENT ACCORDS WITH CRITERIA SET OUT IN POLICIES Rur7, Rur11 and Rur13 AS APPROPRIATE. WITHIN THE TEES FOREST AREA THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL IMPOSE PLANNING CONDITIONS AND SEEK LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS, AS APPROPRIATE, TO ENSURE THE PLANTING OF TREES AND HEDGEROWS IN ASSOCIATION WITH NEW DEVELOPMENT. ACCESS TO THE COUNTRYSIDE 15.48 The countryside is a valuable resource for environmental, recreational and ecological activities and it is therefore important that it is made more accessible to the urban population. Recreational Routes 15.49 Walking in the countryside remains the most popular form of rural recreation. There is a very short stretch of the Castle Eden Walkway extending through the Borough from the neighbouring local authority areas of Stockton on Tees and Sedgefield. The Hart to Haswell route extends for about 1 mile within the borough and connects with a route within Easington District in County Durham. Other routes link to the network within neighbouring local authorities including those being developed under the Turning the Tide initiative for the Durham coast. 15.50 The Sustans National Cycle Network Route 14 connects into Hartlepool, via the Hart to Haswell route, into the urban area to Seaton Carew and to Billingham via Cowpen Bewley Woodland Country Park. Opportunities will be taken to link the 226 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 national cycle network with the greenways network and other recreational cycle routes within the countryside (see policy Tra5). POLICY Rur17 STRATEGIC RECREATIONAL ROUTES THE FOLLOWING STRATEGIC ROUTES WILL BE SAFEGUARDED FROM DEVELOPMENT WHICH IS NOT DIRECTLY ASSOCIATED WITH THEIR USE AS MAJOR RECREATIONAL ROUTES: a. b. c. THE CASTLE EDEN WALKWAY, THE HART TO HASWELL ROUTE, AND THE COASTAL WALKWAY OUTSIDE THE LIMIT TO DEVELOPMENT (SEE ALSO POLICY Rec9). Rights of Way 15.51 The existing definitive rights of way network has great potential for providing better access to the countryside. Recent works to reopen routes, create new links and improve waymarking have succeeded in substantially increasing accessibility to the countryside. 15.52 The Borough Council will work with the Tees Forest and landowners to ensure the integrity, definition and upkeep of the legal rights of way network. The development and improvements of key rights of way especially those forming a network of greenways (see paragraph 15.47 below) will link the urban area to other areas of wildlife or historic interest and the coast and the villages (see policy Rec9). 15.53 Accessibility would further be enhanced by the provision of car parks, picnic sites and nature trails where appropriate in association with such leisure walkway links. POLICY Rur18 RIGHTS OF WAY RIGHTS OF WAY WILL BE IMPROVED TO FORM A NETWORK OF LEISURE ROUTES LINKING THE URBAN AREA TO THE FOLLOWING: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ AREAS OF NATURAL, HISTORIC OR RECREATIONAL INTEREST, THE VILLAGES, GATEWAY SITES AT • SUMMERHILL, • HART STATION, • HART MOOR FARM , • MIDDLE WARREN, AND • SUNDERLAND LODGE/RED GAP, THE COAST, THE SUMMERHILL / COWPEN BEWLEY GREENWAY, AND THE SUMMERHILL / HIGH THROSTON RECREATIONAL ROUTE. WHERE APPROPRIATE, CAR PARKS AND PICNIC SITES WILL BE DEVELOPED IN ASSOCIATION WITH THIS NETWORK. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 227 Greenways 15.54 POLICY Rur19 Greenways are a network of car free routes linking gateway sites to the countryside and open spaces. They provide a recreational resource and an opportunity for sustainable transport for multi-user access to the community forest area based on existing public rights of way and routes provided through voluntary agreements with landowners. A major element of the network is the creation of a greenway between Summerhill and Cowpen Bewley with an eventual link to areas within Middlesbrough and Redcar and Cleveland Boroughs. SUMMERHILL TO COWPEN BEWLEY GREENWAY LAND IS RESERVED ON THE WESTERN EDGE OF THE URBAN AREA FOR THE CREATION OF THE SUMMERHILL, BRIERTON TO COWPEN BEWLEY GREENWAY. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS IN THE VICINITY OF THE GREENWAY SHOULD TAKE ACCOUNT OF THE NEED TO MAINTAIN AN ADEQUATE THROUGH ROUTE FOR USE BY PEDESTRIANS, CYCLISTS AND HORSE RIDERS (SEE ALSO POLICY Rec9). Bridleways and Other Multi User Routes 15.55 There are currently very few legally defined bridleways in the Hartlepool countryside and opportunities to create a meaningful network are limited. The multi-user routes at Summerhill provide some additional routes for horse riding and cycling. It is intended that opportunities will be taken, subject to finance, to negotiate additional access arrangements in the countryside particularly to create links to the greenway network. SPECIAL LANDSCAPE AREAS 15.56 The Tees Valley Structure Plan in policy ENV2 has indicated as special landscape areas the Newton Hanzard / Crookfoot Reservoir and the Crimdon Dene and Nesbit Dene areas where the landscape characteristics give the area sufficient importance to warrant special recognition. 15.57 The Landscape Assessment undertaken in 1999 has evaluated the quality of the countryside. The Assessment included a comprehensive analysis highlightling differences in the visual and amenity value of the landscape, setting out seven distinctive character areas. The landscape value scoring was used to determine and redefine the boundaries of Special Landscape Areas. The Thorpe Bulmer Dene and the Newton Hanzard areas are highlighted in the assessment as having a visual importance in the landscape with tree belts along the valleys. 15.58 The structure plan states that particular care needs to be taken in considering whether new development contributes to the special character and minimises the impact on landscape and amenity. Intrusive development should therefore not be located within the defined Special Landscape Areas. Appropriate uses in these areas are for agriculture, woodland management and informal recreation purposes which will not introduce visual intrusion in these areas. POLICY Rur20 SPECIAL LANDSCAPE AREAS DEVELOPMENT IN THE THORPE BULMER DENE, NESBIT DENE AND NEWTON HANZARD /CROOKFOOT RESERVOIR SPECIAL LANDSCAPE AREAS WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS IT IS SYMPATHETIC TO THE LOCAL RURAL CHARACTER IN TERMS OF THE DESIGN, SIZE AND SITING AND BUILDING MATERIALS AND IT INCORPORATES APPROPRIATE PLANTING SCHEMES. 228 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 THE COAST 15.59 Structure plan policy ENV3 identifies the area of the undeveloped coast which should be protected from development. Within Hartlepool almost all of the undeveloped coast is subject to protection under national or international legislation. 15.60 The undeveloped areas of the coast give opportunities for passive recreational pursuits including the quiet enjoyment of the natural environment. It is however important that the recreational use is appropriate to the character of the area and will, where appropriate, enhance the quiet enjoyment of the coast. Where planning permission is required for recreational pursuits on the undeveloped parts of the coast these should accord with the principles set out in Policies GEP1, Rec1, WL1, WL2, Rur1 and Rur16. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 229 230 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 16 MINERALS CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 16.1 It is the duty of all Minerals Planning Authorities to prepare a Minerals Local Plan as laid down by the Town and Country Planning Act 1990, as amended by the Planning and Compensation Act 1991. 16.2 After local government reorganisation in 1996 the responsibility for the preparation of minerals local plan policies was transferred from Cleveland County Council to Hartlepool Borough Council. The Tees Valley Joint Strategy Unit has prepared the new Structure Plan for the Tees Valley, which includes strategic policies and commentary on minerals development encompassing the Boroughs of Hartlepool, Stockton-on-Tees, Redcar and Cleveland, Middlesbrough and Darlington. Land-use matters arising from minerals operations and associated developments are now wholly the responsibility of Hartlepool Borough Council. Current Mineral Operations in Hartlepool 16.3 To the south of the Borough there are gypsum and alluvium deposits, whereas to the north are dolomite (or dolorite) reserves and possible mineralisation associated with the Butterknowle Fault. 16.4 The main mineral extraction operation within the Borough is at Hart Quarry. In 1989 permission for the extension of limestone and magnesian limestone extraction was permitted, and in 1996 the conditions attached to the permission were varied to permit the extraction of clay from the extension area. Currently the conditions attached to the planning permission are under review as part of the mineral review process. 16.5 Combined clay extraction and landfill operations are currently taking place in a phased manner at Seaton Meadows (formerly the Stephenson Industrial Estate) and on land near the Mayfair Centre off Tees Road. 16.6 In addition there is a sand extraction operation from the inter-tidal foreshore at North Gare Sands with existing planning permission allowing extraction to be carried out till 2042. The current licence allows a maximum of 48,000 tonnes of sand per annum to be extracted. 16.7 The only other active mineral working relates to the extraction of salt from the brinefields at Greatham Creek. Minerals Planning Guidance 16.8 Government guidance is set out in Minerals Planning Guidance Notes (MPGs). Minerals local plans should carry forward policies ensuring the supply of minerals and indicate areas where provision is made for mineral working, indicate those areas where mineral resources are to be safeguarded for future working, and set out the development control criteria that will be applied in considering applications for mineral working and requirements for the restoration of such sites. Minerals are finite resources which need to be used effectively so that current needs can be met without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 231 16.9 In drawing up policies, the minerals planning authority should appraise the policy options in terms of social, environmental and economic effects and should be able to demonstrate that all options have been assessed and that those selected represent the best balance of social, environmental and economic costs and benefits, through full consideration of all resources and the principles of sustainable development and the need to maintain an adequate and steady supply of minerals to meet local, regional and national need. Minerals contribute to the economy through direct employment and as essential raw materials for industry and for the construction and maintenance of developments including buildings and roads. 16.10 The local plan provides a guide to mineral operators and the public where mineral extraction is likely in principle to be acceptable and where not acceptable. Acceptability in principle will be subject to meeting development control criteria, as well as safeguarding sensitive environmental features and providing environmental and resource protection policies. Policies which rule out all forms of mineral working within an entire plan area will not be appropriate, unless agreed in the regional context. Regional Planning Guidance 16.11 The policies in the Regional Planning Guidance seek to ensure the prudent use of the region’s indigenous natural resources in line with sustainable development principles. In particular the guidance sets out development control criteria and requires that development plans should make appropriate provision for mineral working in the light of the need for the mineral, the contribution of existing workings/permissions, the location of known deposits and the contribution to be made by secondary or recycled materials. Structure Plan Policies 16.12 The Tees Valley Structure Plan seeks to ensure that the needs of society for minerals are consistent with the protection of the environment. The structure plan has set down criteria for which proposals for mineral extraction must meet (policy MIN1) and safeguard mineral resources from surface development prior to extraction (MIN2). 16.13 In addition, the structure plan seeks to maintain an adequate supply of workable reserves to contribute towards the regional supply (MIN3), providing proposals are environmentally acceptable. Policies also exist in the plan encouraging the concurrent working of additional minerals from existing sites (MIN5), and examining the possibilities of alternatives to extraction (MIN6). 16.14 A comprehensive restoration and after-care programme, monitored regularly, should be a major part of the application with any land taken being restored to the highest standard at the earliest opportunity (MIN7 and MIN8). Local Plan Objectives 16.15 In line with the main aims of the Local Plan and the need to improve the image of the town, the following objectives are relevant in the formulation of policies associated with mineral development: A5 C3 232 to ensure that there is an adequate infrastructure to serve new and existing development. to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 C9 to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting or hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a damaging effect on the environment. to minimise the adverse environmental effects of mineral workings and waste disposal operations and ensure the appropriate restoration and after use of land to increase the attraction of, and to promote, viable alternatives to the private car and road freight transport. C11 C12 D4 16.16 A key objective of the Hartlepool Community Strategy is to make better use of natural resources especially fossil fuels and water. POLICIES AND PROPOSALS MINERAL CONSULTATION AREAS 16.17 POLICY Min1 The Mineral Consultation Areas shown on the Proposals Map are based upon those defined by the former Cleveland County Council in accordance with section 86(2) of the Local Government, Planning and Land Act, 1980. They indicate potential mineral resources, but do not determine locations where the extraction of the mineral resource is a viable economic option, or where planning permission may necessarily be granted. SAFEGUARDING OF POTENTIAL MINERAL RESOURCES MINERAL RESOURCES WILL BE SAFEGUARDED FROM SURFACE DEVELOPMENT. DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS WHICH WILL PREVENT FUTURE MINERAL EXTRACTION WITHIN THE AREAS IDENTIFIED ON THE PROPOSALS MAP AS MINERAL CONSULTATION AREAS WILL NOT BE PERMITTED UNLESS: i. ii. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL IS SATISFIED THAT THE SITE DOES NOT CONTAIN A WORKABLE MINERAL RESOURCE; OR THERE IS AN OVERRIDING NEED FOR THE DEVELOPMENT AND THE DEPOSIT CANNOT BE EXTRACTED IN ADVANCE. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 233 PRIMARY AND SECONDARY AGGREGATES 16.18 Aggregates are granular materials, such as sand, gravel and crushed rock that are used in construction. Current guidance relating to aggregate minerals states that minerals planning authorities in the North East need to make provision for 20 million tonnes of sand and gravel and 119 million tonnes of crushed rock over the 16 year period 2001–2016. The guidance states that each minerals planning authority should make provision for the appropriate local apportionment of the above regional guideline, but because of the limited number of operations in the former Cleveland area as a whole, sub-regional requirements are combined with those for County Durham. 16.19 For developments such as road building, it can be more sustainable to use recycled materials to reduce the requirement for new minerals. The draft RSS sets a regional target of 5.2million tonnes of a secondary and recycled aggregates to be used through the 16 year period (2006-2021). Over the plan period this provides a regional target at 76million tonnes to be met. The Borough Council, in conjunction with the other Tees Valley Boroughs, has initiated the testing of recycled materials, and providing that implementation is a feasible economic option, the Borough Council will endeavour to increase the use of recycled facilities. POLICY Min2 USE OF SECONDARY AGGREGATES IN ORDER TO CONTRIBUTE TO THE REGIONAL TARGETS FOR RECYCLING, THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE THE USE OF SECONDARY AND RECYCLED AGGREGATES IN PREFERENCE TO PRIMARY AGGREGATES WHEREVER ECONOMICALLY AND TECHNICALLY FEASIBLE. PROPOSALS FOR THE WORKING OF SECONDARY AGGREGATES SHOULD MEET THE CRITERIA SET OUT IN POLICIES Min3 TO Min5 BELOW. LANDBANKS 16.20 The Government advises that policies should be included in development plans to provide for the maintenance of landbanks. Landbanks are a stock of mineral reserves with planning permission for their winning and working. Policy MIN3 of the structure plan states that the Tees Valley will contribute to the regional supply of minerals to meet the needs of society by endeavouring to maintain an adequate supply of economically workable reserves if a proposal is environmentally acceptable. The structure plan states that it is inappropriate to maintain a landbank in the Tees Valley due to the limited resources in the area. However, the Tees Valley will contribute to a joint Durham and Tees Valley landbank. Figures for each of these areas cannot be separated because of confidentiality issues. MINERAL EXTRACTION 16.21 The winning and working of minerals can provide economic and social benefits to the local community, but it can also have a significant effect upon the local environment and amenity. As an open form of development, mineral working can give rise to noise, dust and fumes, blast effects including ground and over pressure vibration and visual impacts. Where appropriate, the Borough Council will impose conditions on planning permissions to protect the occupiers of neighbouring land-uses and to reduce any adverse visual impact. 234 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 16.22 Certain land designated or identified for its wildlife, historic, agricultural or landscape importance should be afforded a high degree of protection. In particular, internationally and nationally important wildlife sites should be protected from development except where it is clearly in the public interest or in exceptional circumstances (see policies WL1 to WL3). 16.23 The Borough Council will also seek to protect vulnerable natural resources such as the water environment from the adverse effects of mineral development, which can have a significant negative impact on the quantity and quality of water resources. Groundwater forms part of the natural water cycle that is present within underground strata. Policy PU3 seeks to protect the quality of groundwater reserves. 16.24 Applications for new mineral extraction must meet an established need as part of a contribution to the most recent sub regional apportionment of the national and regional guidelines for aggregate provision in England. An environmental impact assessment at the application stage of proposals will be required where the development is likely to have a significant effect on the environment. Policy GEP5 provides more detailed information on development requiring environmental impact assessment. 16.25 Where it is appropriate for a minerals development to be permitted, it must be to the highest standard of working and restoration (see also policy Min5). Where appropriate, the Borough Council will impose conditions on planning permissions to protect the occupiers of neighbouring land-uses and reduce any adverse visual impact and measures such as screening, wheel cleaning, specifying working hours and the number of lorries will be applied, where appropriate, to protect the environment. The Borough Council will also consider the use of conditions or planning obligations to ensure protection and enhancement of the natural and historic environment of the area. 16.26 There is only one working limestone quarry in Hartlepool – at Hart Quarry. Whilst it is worked primarily for limestone, some clay is also being extracted on the extension site. Given the adverse environmental effects resultant from mineral working (including short and long term visual intrusion, noise and air pollution, vibration, etc.) it may be more appropriate to permit an extension to the current activities rather than allow limestone extraction at a new site. The operational disturbance could thereby be minimised by making best use of existing environmental protection measures. Proposals for the extension of this existing mineral working will however need to be evaluated in the same way as applications for new minerals developments (see policy Min3 below). This would include an assessment of whether any defined need can be met, if economically and technically feasible, by the use of secondary aggregates. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 235 POLICY Min3 MINERAL EXTRACTION THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL CONSIDER FULLY THE IMPACT OF FUTURE MINERAL DEVELOPMENT ON THE LOCAL ENVIRONMENT AND COMMUNITY. AN ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT WILL BE REQUIRED TO ACCOMPANY ANY APPLICATION FOR MINERAL EXTRACTION WHERE THE PROPOSED DEVELOPMENT IS LIKELY TO HAVE A SIGNIFICANT EFFECT ON THE ENVIRONMENT (SEE POLICY GEP5). PLANNING PERMISSION FOR MINERAL EXTRACTION WILL ONLY BE GRANTED WHERE: i. IN THE CASE OF PRIMARY AGGREGATES, WHERE IT HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED THAT A FURTHER PERMISSION IS REQUIRED AS A CONTRIBUTION TO THE MOST RECENT SUB REGION APPORTIONMENT OF THE NATIONAL AND REGIONAL GUIDELINES FOR AGGREGATE PROVISION IN ENGLAND. ii. THE OVERALL PROPOSAL IS ACCEPTABLE IN TERMS OF ITS IMPACTS ON THE ENVIRONMENT AND LOCAL COMMUNITY, iii. ADEQUATE SAFEGUARDS ARE IMPLEMENTED TO PREVENT UNACCEPTABLE LEVELS OF DUST AND NOISE, iv. ANCILLARY BUILDINGS AND PLANT ARE SITED AND SCREENED TO MINIMISE VISUAL IMPACT, v. APPROPRIATE LANDSCAPING (INCLUDING TREE PLANTING WHERE APPROPRIATE) IS UNDERTAKEN AROUND THE SITE TO REDUCE THE VISUAL IMPACT, vi. THE ROAD NETWORK IS CAPABLE OF ACCOMMODATING THE ADDITIONAL TRAFFIC GENERATED (SEE POLICY Min4), vii. DESIGNATED INTERNATIONAL AND NATIONAL NATURE CONSERVATION SITES ARE PROTECTED, UNLESS THE DEVELOPMENT CAN DEMONSTRATE ITS IMPORTANCE IN PROVIDING A NATIONAL RESOURCE (SEE POLICIES WL1 – WL2), viii. BOTH SURFACE AND GROUNDWATER SOURCES, INCLUDING THE AQUIFER, ARE PROTECTED FROM POLLUTION, ix. WHERE APPROPRIATE, A FULL ARCHAEOLOGICAL ASSESSMENT HAS BEEN UNDERTAKEN, x. THE BEST AND MOST VERSATILE AGRICULTURAL LAND IS PROTECTED (SEE POLICY Rur9), xi. ANY WASTE MATERIAL ARISING FROM THE DEVELOPMENT IS DISPOSED OF IN A WAY THAT IS ENVIRONMENTALLY ACCEPTABLE AND MAKES THE FULLEST ECONOMIC USE OF THE MATERIAL, AND xii. IT CAN BE DEMONSTRATED THAT ADEQUATE FINANCIAL PROVISION HAS BEEN MADE FOR EFFECTIVE RECLAMATION OF THE LAND (SEE ALSO POLICY Min5 ). THE BOROUGH COUNCIL, THROUGH THE USE OF CONDITIONS AND PLANNING OBLIGATIONS, WILL SEEK TO ENSURE THE HIGHEST STANDARD OF DEVELOPMENT AND TO MINIMISE ADVERSE ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS. 236 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 TRANSPORTATION 16.27 POLICY Min4 The transportation of minerals can potentially create significant adverse environmental impacts. A range of potential impacts can occur through the transportation of minerals by road. The number and size of vehicles can cause additional congestion, adversely affecting highway safety and convenience. The Borough Council will support the transportation of minerals by either rail or sea where it accords with the best practicable environmental option (BPEO), but where this is not practical will favour the location of mineral sites with good access to the primary road network. TRANSPORTATION OF MINERALS PROPOSALS FOR MINERALS DEVELOPMENT WHICH GENERATE ROAD TRAFFIC WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE THE LOCAL ROAD NETWORK IS CAPABLE OF ACCOMMODATING THE TYPE AND VOLUME OF TRAFFIC WITHOUT HAVING A SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECT ON: ♦ ♦ HIGHWAY SAFETY, AND LOCAL COMMUNITIES, IN TERMS OF VISUAL INTRUSION, FUMES, DUST, NOISE AND VIBRATION. IN ADDITION THE SITE ACCESS ROADS AND JUNCTIONS WILL NEED TO BE OF AN APPROPRIATE STANDARD (SEE SUPPLEMENTARY NOTE 1). THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL, WHERE APPROPRIATE, REQUIRE A TRANSPORT PLAN TO BE PREPARED TO ACCOMPANY PROPOSALS, AND CONSIDERATION WILL BE GIVEN TO THE USE OF PLANNING CONDITIONS AND/OR LEGALLY BINDING AGREEMENTS TO SECURE THE MOVEMENT OF MINERALS OR BY-PRODUCTS BY MEANS OTHER THAN ROAD TRANSPORT. REFERENCE SHOULD BE MADE TO POLICY Tra15 - RESTRICTION ON ACCESS TO MAJOR ROADS. RESTORATION, AFTER-USE AND AFTER-CARE OF WORKED MINERAL SITES 16.28 Planning applications for mineral working should include details of the proposed after-use, after care and restoration. Any after-use will have to be sustainable in the long term and compatible with other development plan policies. The historic use of many extinct sites is for landfill operations, with the speed, compaction, and nature of waste tied to the planning permission. During the plan period, to 2016, however, there is no need for additional landfill sites within Hartlepool to meet the waste disposal needs of the Borough. 16.29 The worked site often provides an opportunity to develop other practical afteruses. Appropriate uses could include agriculture, nature conservation, educational use and possibly certain sports uses. The inclusion of water features may be appropriate and can provide opportunities for after uses for recreational and / or habitat creation purposes. Landscaping may be the only appropriate use for the site, and in this case the form of restoration needs to assimilate with the landscape quality of the surrounding area. Restoration such HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 237 as grassland opportunities. on magnesian limestone could provide for biodiversity 16.30 Most of the areas where mineral reserves are known to exist are within the Tees Forest area and schemes for restoration of worked sites should have regard to the potential for further tree planting (see policy Rur14). 16.31 Operators could be obliged to upgrade poorly restored sites adjacent to mineral reserves that they are working, as a condition of the planning permission, if relevant to development to which the permission relates and under the control of the applicant. The scheme can be tied to phasing to ensure the restoration programme is completed to the desired timetable with conditions to treat problems of landfill gas and leachate. Where old mineral permissions are being reviewed, they must adhere to the Environment Act 1995. These provisions will enable the permissions to reflect changing environmental standards and ensure the conditions do not become outdated. POLICY Min5 RESTORATION OF MINERAL SITES A DETAILED RESTORATION AND AFTERCARE SCHEME WILL BE AGREED WITH THE BOROUGH COUNCIL PRIOR TO THE COMMENCEMENT OF EXTRACTION OPERATIONS, AND THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ATTACH CONDITIONS TO PLANNING APPROVALS TO ENSURE A SATISFACTORY RESTORATION AND AFTERCARE SCHEME IS IMPLEMENTED. 238 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 17 WASTE CONTEXT FOR POLICIES Introduction 17.1 Each year we produce huge quantities of waste, over 100 million tonnes from households, commerce and industry. Most of this waste is landfilled. This chapter sets out policies that provide the land-use framework for sustainable waste management. In the Government document ‘Waste Strategy 2000’, sustainable waste management is the overriding objective, “producing less waste can reduce the use of materials and produce savings in the other inputs that might have gone into processing the materials (for example energy and labour). It also reduces the environmental impacts of waste disposal”. The development plan system is one way in which a sustainable waste strategy for Hartlepool can be facilitated. The joint municipal waste management strategy for the Tees Valley authorities, including Hartlepool Borough Council, was adopted in May 2002. The Strategy period is to June 2020. 17.2 Planning Policy Statement 23 (PPS23) on ‘Planning and Pollution Control’ (2004) provides advice on the relationship between controls over development under planning law and pollution control legislation. PPS23 also introduces the principle of Best Practicable Environmental Option (BPEO), which is defined as; “for a given set of objectives, the option that provides the most benefit or least damage to the environment, as a whole, at acceptable cost in the long term as well as the short term”. Planning Policy Statement 10 (PPS10) on Planning for Sustainable Waste Management’ (2005) brings previous waste guidance up to date with developments in waste policy to protect human health and the environment by producing and by using it as a resource whever possible. The Government’s Waste Strategy 2000 develops further the general policy framework identified in PPS23 and PPS10. It reinforces the Government’s vision based upon the principle of BPEO, supported by the ‘Waste Hierarchy’ and the ‘Proximity Principle’. 17.3 The ‘Proximity Principle’ requires that as far as practicably possible waste should be recovered or disposed of as close to the point where it arises, and proposals for waste management facilities will be considered against the need to achieve regional self sufficiency. 17.4 The ‘Waste Hierarchy’ is detailed in the Government’s White Paper, ‘Making Waste Work’ which states that, in order of preference, waste should be reduced, reused, recovered and as a last resort disposed of safely. It is more sustainable if waste can be dealt with near the top end of the hierarchy, although in reality there will always be some wastes produced which are only suitable for disposal. 17.5 Reduction and re-use both aim to reduce the amount of material requiring final disposal. The impact of both methods relies heavily on the producers of waste altering existing ways of production, and while the emerging Packaging Directive may impact upon this, the land-use planning system can have no real significant impact in achieving the reduction and re-use of waste products. The term recovery includes recycling, composting and recovery of energy from waste. They are grouped together under this heading as each element provides a product or material that has a beneficial after-use. The process of recycling involves the reprocessing of waste materials to usable products. The benefits of reducing and re-using the waste produced are that the environmental and economic costs usually associated with the recovery and disposal of waste are reduced. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 239 17.6 The Landfill Directive 99/31/EC requires a reduction by 2010 of biodegradable municipal waste to 75% of 1995 levels, and by 2013 and 2020 to 50% and 35%. Within its waste strategy, the Government’s target has also set its own target for reducing commercial and industrial waste to 85% of 1998 levels by 2005. In addition, a target of recovering 45% of municipal waste, and recycling or composting 30% of household waste by 2010 has been set. The Government expects that this will need to increase to two thirds of all household waste by 2015. It is therefore important that policies are put in place to enable these targets to be achieved. Structure Plan Policies 17.7 The Tees Valley Structure Plan within its overall strategy of sustainable development states that to minimise the environmental impact of waste there is a need to reduce the amount of waste produced and encourage the reuse and recycling of waste (policy W1) and ensure the appropriate restoration and afteruse of land used for waste treatment or disposal (policy W6). Waste management facilities will be considered against the need to encourage regional self-sufficiency and the proximity principle will be applied to discourage the transfer of waste over long distances (policy W2). In addition waste transfer stations and material recovery facilities should be screened from major transport routes and located away from residential areas (policy W3), and both civic amenity sites and recycling points should be provided in areas accessible to the main centres of population (policy W4). New landfill facilities should only be developed in locations where the environmental impacts are minimised policy W5). Hartlepool Community Strategy 17.8 The Hartlepool Community Strategy aims to minimise the generation of household and commercial waste and maximise all opportunities for recycling waste materials. Local Plan Objectives 17.9 The following objectives are relevant in drawing up the local plan waste policies: C1 C3 C9 C11 C12 240 to ensure that developments do not have an adverse impact on the quality of life of the population of Hartlepool. to preserve and enhance the quality, character and setting of Conservation Areas, Listed Buildings and areas of archaeological and historic interest. to protect and enhance the biodiversity and geodiversity of the natural environment and ensure the careful use of natural resources to ensure that industrial and other potentially polluting or hazardous activities do not have a significant detrimental effect on the adjacent population or workforce and do not have a damaging effect on the environment to minimise the adverse environmental effects of mineral workings and waste disposal operations and ensure the appropriate restoration and after use of land. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 POLICIES AND PROPOSALS PROJECTED LEVELS OF WASTE 17.10 A key consideration in preparing land use policies to facilitate the waste strategy is the analysis of expected projections of the quantities of waste. Hartlepool Borough Council is contracted to dispose of its general domestic and industrial waste to the energy from waste incinerator at Haverton Hill (to 2020). 17.11 During 2005 the local authority was charged with dealing with 49,180 tonnes of municipal waste and 5,500 tonnes of inert waste. Up to 2016 these amounts are expected to rise to approximately 55,000 and 12,000 tonnes respectively. This required level twinned with the expected rise in recycling means that the anticipated levels of waste produced in Hartlepool can be accommodated without the need for increased facilities in the town. 17.12 The “Strategic Waste Management Assessment” for the North East produced by the Environment Agency indicates that the Tees Valley sub-region produces approximately 2.3m tonnes (1999) of Industrial waste and 266,000 tonnes of commercial waste. The agency encourages sub-regional planning for waste and any new landfill developments in the Borough will have to be shown to be justified in terms of sub-regional waste arisings. 17.13 The North East Regional Technical Advisory Body on Waste has produced a consultation summary entitled ‘Towards a Waste Strategy for the North East’ and has requested more information, a financial appraisal and further consultations. It is unlikely that any of the issues raised in the final regional strategy will materially affect the waste policies in the local plan except possibly on incineration or thermal recovery. 17.14 Able UK handles all contaminated special wastes at the landfill site at Brenda Road, and Shanks & McEwan handle liquid wastes. During the plan period it is estimated that the amount of special wastes will increase by 20% from 1999 levels. Consultations with Able UK and other contractors have indicated that there is capacity at the Brenda Road site to cope with expected demand throughout the plan period. AIRPORTS 17.15 Waste management sites, especially landfills, can attract birds. Where birds congregate in large numbers they can create a hazard to aircraft. Durham Tees Valley Airport is situated about 15 kilometres from the boundary of the Borough of Hartlepool. The Borough Council is required to consult the Durham Tees Valley International Airport on any applications for planning permission within the south east area of Hartlepool for landfill developments. In addition the Borough Council will consider the implications for air safety when considering proposals for waste incinerators. LARGE SCALE WASTE PRODUCING DEVELOPMENTS 17.16 The chemical and manufacturing industries are particularly dominant in Hartlepool, resulting in relatively large quantities of industrial waste being produced. It is understood however that the amount of waste arising from industrial and commercial means is likely to fall as the cost of disposal increases and proposed EU waste minimisation programmes are implemented. It is important that the impacts upon the waste stream as a result of a major industrial development are assessed and planned for at the earliest possible stage. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 241 POLICY Was1 MAJOR WASTE PRODUCING DEVELOPMENTS DEVELOPMENTS WHICH WILL PRODUCE WASTE LIKELY TO HAVE A SIGNIFICANT IMPACT ON THE ENVIRONMENT ARE REQUIRED TO SUBMIT A WASTE MINIMISATION PLAN COVERING BOTH CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATIONAL PHASES. THE WASTE MINIMISATION PLAN WILL NEED TO DEMONSTRATE HOW WASTE LEVELS ARE BEING MINIMISED, PAYING PARTICULAR REGARD TO THE BEST PRACTICABLE ENVIRONMENTAL OPTION, THE WASTE HIERARCHY AND THE PROXIMITY PRINCIPLE. WASTE RECOVERY 17.17 The term recovery includes recycling, composting and recovery of energy from waste. They are grouped together under this heading as each element provides a product or material that has a beneficial after-use. Recycling 17.18 The process of recycling involves the reprocessing of waste materials to usable products. The two main methods in which collections are made of separated materials for recycling are through ‘bring’ schemes and ‘collect’ schemes. Bring schemes rely upon householders depositing recyclable waste at regularly visited locations, such as car parks. The greater the number of drop off facilities the greater the amount of waste that can be recycled. 17.19 Presently within Hartlepool there are 33 points where recyclable waste can be deposited. There is a requirement for additional points in areas not currently served such as Dyke House, Jackson, Throston, Grange, Park, Owton and Rossmere wards, and especially in areas of low car ownership. 17.20 On privately owned land one method of ensuring recycling facilities are provided is to design the facilities into commercial developments. Within the plan period it is unlikely that a suitable number of schemes will be developed to provide facilities in all the areas required. It may be the case therefore that small derelict sites are used either permanently or temporarily for the location of ‘bring’ facilities. POLICY Was2 PROVISION OF ‘BRING’ RECYCLING FACILITIES THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ENCOURAGE THE ADDITIONAL PROVISION OF ‘BRING’ POINTS ON NEW DEVELOPMENTS AND SITES IN THE FOLLOWING AREAS: ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ ♦ CENTRAL ESTATE, WEST VIEW, DYKE HOUSE, THROSTON, THE HEADLAND, OWTON MANOR, ROSSMERE, AND AREA WEST OF TOWN CENTRE TOWARDS WEST PARK. PROVIDED THAT THERE ARE NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECTS ON THE OCCUPIERS OF ADJOINING OR NEARBY PROPERTIES AND THAT THE SITE IS READILY AND SAFELY ACCESSIBLE TO RESIDENTS. 242 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 17.21 ‘Collect’ schemes rely upon householders segregating waste that is then collected from the doorstep. Industry and government estimate that potentially up to 30% of household waste can be recovered from this type of scheme. One option to increase the level of domestic waste recycling would be to include purpose built facilities on new housing developments. In order for this to be a feasible option, in terms of collection, a critical mass of over 200 residential units is an essential requirement. There may be the potential, through negotiations with the developer, to design in facilities at the detailed design stage. Composting 17.22 Historically associated with the agricultural sector, composting has the potential to reduce the levels of waste requiring final disposal in the Borough. After trials in 1993 and 1995 the Borough Council, in conjunction with Cleveland Waste Management, is reviewing options for centralised composting. Composting involves the decomposition of organic or biodegradable waste. Wastes suitable for composting include wood, paper, foodstuffs, sewage sludge and garden wastes. Composting operations can vary in scale from home composting to centralised composting. 17.23 Policy Ind6 identifies the Sandgate industrial areas where bad neighbour uses would be most suitably located. Schemes for composting within the urban area should therefore be located in this area. 17.24 Local composting needs can be met by the provision of small-scale sites where household green waste can be composted and re-used in gardens or parks. Smaller scale facilities can be located in the open air, although the provision of a small building for the storage of equipment is likely to be required. Such smallscale facilities would be best located on sites, which are easily accessible, and where the composted material is used on site or close by. POLICY Was3 COMPOSTING THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL SUPPORT THE DEVELOPMENT OF COMPOSTING SCHEMES, SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING CRITERIA: i. ii. iii. iv. THE SITE IS NOT LOCATED IN A RESIDENTIAL AREA, THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECTS ON SURROUNDING LAND USES, MEASURES ARE IMPLEMENTED TO MITIGATE, AS FAR AS PRACTICALLY POSSIBLE, ANY ADVERSE IMPACTS, PARTICULARLY ODOUR, AND THE PROPOSAL WOULD NOT PREJUDICE THE OVERALL DEVELOPMENT OF THE AREA. THE BOROUGH COUNCIL WILL ALSO SUPPORT THE DEVELOPMENT OF SMALL SCALE COMMUNITY COMPOSTING SCHEMES, SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING CRITERIA: i. ii. MEASURES ARE TAKEN TO PREVENT ANY POLLUTION, AND THERE WILL BE NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECTS ON SURROUNDING LAND USES (SEE POLICY GEP4 - CONTROL OF POLLUTION). HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 243 WASTE DISPOSAL 17.25 The disposal of waste lies at the end of the ‘waste hierarchy’. Other means of dealing with waste (reduction, re-use and recovery) should be examined before consideration is given to its disposal (see paragraph 17.4 above). At present there is sufficient capacity for landfill up to 2008, beyond this new sites may need to be developed. However, additional landfill sites may become available during the local plan period, possibly including Hart Quarry, the planning permission for which enables the site to be used for landfill at the cessation of quarrying operations. 17.26 The ‘proximity principle’ places a duty on planning authorities to consider the requirements and locations of waste management to discourage the movement of waste over long distances (see paragraph 17.3 above). For this reason any potential landfill sites within the Borough should be protected primarily for the disposal of waste created in Hartlepool. 17.27 European legislation in the form of the Landfill Directive will increasingly impact upon the way in which landfill can contribute to the disposal of waste. In essence the Directive places restrictions on the type of waste products which can be disposed of directly to landfill. In the lifetime of the local plan this includes materials such as tyres, liquid wastes, infectious clinical waste and certain types of hazardous waste. In addition the Directive bans the co-disposal of hazardous and non-hazardous wastes, therefore requiring separate landfill sites. 17.28 Where planning permission is granted for new landfill sites, the Borough Council will seek to ensure that appropriate measures are put in place to monitor landfill gas. POLICY Was4 LANDFILL DEVELOPMENTS PROPOSALS FOR LANDFILL SITES WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE IT HAS BEEN DEMONSTATED THAT: i. ii. iii. iv. 244 THE PROPOSAL REPRESENTS THE BEST PRACTICABLE ENVIRONMENTAL OPTION (BPEO) AND THAT ALL POSSIBLE MEANS OF TREATING WASTE FURTHER UP THE ‘WASTE HIERARCHY’ (REDUCTION, REUSE AND RECOVERY) HAVE BEEN EXAMINED, THERE IS A NEED FOR A LANDFILL SITE TO SERVICE THE WASTE DISPOSAL REQUIREMENTS OF THE REGION, APPLYING THE ‘PROXIMITY PRINCIPLE’, THERE ARE NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECTS ON SURROUNDING LAND USES, AND SATISFACTORY MEASURES WILL BE TAKEN TO SECURE RESTORATION, AFTERCARE AND AFTERUSE OF THE SITE. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 17.29 POLICY Was 5 Landraising is the deposition of waste, not in man made or natural voids but above the surface of the land. Landraise has some technical advantages over landfill, such as improved leachate control and the potential problem of containment is easier to monitor and remedy. However, landraise should avoid areas of the best and most versatile agricultural land (see policy Rur8). LANDRAISING LANDRAISING WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: ii. iii. iv. THE REQUIREMENTS SET OUT IN POLICY Was4 ARE MET, THE LANDFORM CREATED WOULD REFLECT THE SCALE AND CHARACTER OF THE SURROUNDING TOPOGRAPHY, AFTER RESTORATION WOULD ASSIMILATE NATURALLY INTO THE LANDSCAPE OF THE AREA. PROPOSALS FOR LANDRAISING ON THE BEST AND MOST VERSATILE AGRICULTURAL LAND WILL BE RESISTED (SEE POLICY Rur8). PROTECTION OF WATERCOURSES AND GROUNDWATER SUPPLIES 17.30 Waste developments may pollute watercourses and groundwater, affecting amongst other things natural wildlife habitats and water abstraction, if proper controls are not in place. The aquifer, which runs below much of Hartlepool, is a vitally important resource providing the main source of water for the town. It is therefore essential that the aquifer be protected as far as possible from all forms of pollution caused by waste and other development. Policy PU4 above aims to protect the aquifer from pollution (see also Policy GEP1). CIVIC AMENITY SITES, MATERIAL RECOVERY FACILITIES AND WASTE TRANSFER STATIONS 17.31 Material recovery facilities typically recover materials for subsequent sale or processing. In Hartlepool a number of facilities are located in the Longhill/Sandgate area. Given the expected future waste levels, indicated in paragraph 17.11, there are adequate facilities present to cope with demand, at least until 2016. The Council’s main civic amenity site is currently located on Burn Road. 17.32 The End of Life Vehicle Directive was fully implemented in 2006. This directive increases the requirements for material recovery from vehicles no longer in use. These requirements will create a greater need for facilities capable of dealing with such processes. 17.33 The development of waste transfer stations, civic amenity sites and other bad neighbour uses is covered in Policy Ind6 relating to bad neighbour uses in the Longhill/Sandgate area. The location of these facilities is key as they need to be close to the main concentrations of population for transport reasons, but far enough away to protect the amenity of residential areas. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 245 INCINERATION 17.34 Incineration is the main alternative disposal option to landfill for combustible waste, and as such can significantly reduce the volume of waste requiring final disposal to landfill. The waste to energy plant operated by SITA Tees Valley Limited at Haverton Hill produces a valuable product from the incineration process with the capability of generating 20MW of electricity. Given this facility and the current waste disposal contracts to which the Borough Council is operating there is no scope for additional incineration facilities to treat municipal waste. 17.35 Small incinerators which deal with the waste arising on a particular industrial site may be capable of being located within the same site, which is in accordance with the proximity principle. Environmental impacts, most notably the emissions arising, should be taken into account in determining planning applications. POLICY Was6 INCINERATION PROPOSALS FOR INCINERATORS WILL ONLY BE PERMITTED WHERE: i. ii. iii. iv. v. vi. THE WASTE TO BE TREATED ARISES PRIMARILY FROM WITHIN THE REGION, THE PROPOSAL REPRESENTS THE BEST PRACTICABLE ENVIRONMENTAL OPTION (BPEO), RESIDUES CAN BE DISPOSED OF SAFELY, THE PROPOSED PLANT IS LOCATED ON AN INDUSTRIAL SITE IDENTIFIED IN POLICY Ind9 FOR POTENTIALLY POLLUTING OR HAZARDOUS INDUSTRIES OR ON THE PREMISES WHERE THE WASTE ARISES, THERE ARE NO SIGNIFICANT ADVERSE EFFECTS ON SURROUNDING LAND USES, AND THE DEVELOPMENT WILL NOT PREJUDICE THE OVERALL DEVELOPMENT OF THE AREA. AN ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT ASSESSMENT WILL BE REQUIRED FOR ANY WASTE INCINERATION PROPOSAL (SEE POLICY GEP5). 246 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 18 IMPLEMENTATION AND RESOURCES INTRODUCTION 18.1 The policies and proposals contained in the local plan must be realistic and capable of being implemented within the plan period to 2016. The plan is an enabling document and sets the land use context for developments by the public and private sectors together with local communities and voluntary organisations, often in partnership. It is particularly important in setting the policy context supporting bids for central government regeneration, transport, and housing finance and for European, Countryside Agency and National Lottery assistance. 18.2 The policies in the plan generally fall into one of three categories: i. development control policies, ii. site specific policies, and iii. proposals of intent. 18.3 Table 18.1 lists the policies of the plan and indicates the main agencies for their implementation. DEVELOPMENT CONTROL 18.4 The development control policies which are implemented by the Borough Council in its capacity as the local planning authority generally comprise three main types - those: ♦ setting standards for development, ♦ setting out criteria for specific types of development, and those ♦ seeking the protection and/or enhancement of specific areas of land or structures. 18.5 These policies provide specific guidance to potential developers. The process of development control, by the grant of planning permission (with or without conditions or obligations) or the refusal of permission, will control the location and character of development and its impact on surroundings. 18.6 In considering planning applications, the Borough Council consults a wide variety of individuals and organisations including those who can provide specific guidance and technical advice. Reference is made in some policies of the need to take into account the advice of such organisations as the Environment Agency, English Nature, English Heritage, Sport England, and the Health and Safety Executive, but other bodies such as Tees Archaeology, the Countryside Agency, the Farming and Rural Conservation Agency and Tees Forest are also consulted as appropriate. SITE SPECIFIC POLICIES 18.7 The site specific policies in the plan allocate or otherwise identify areas of land for particular uses and set out the criteria to be met by appropriate developments on these areas of land. Land is thus identified to enable the development of employment, shopping, housing, education, public utilities, leisure and recreational and mixed uses. 18.8 Much of the development likely to result from these enabling policies will be initiated by the private sector, in particular most housing and industrial developments, tourism related and leisure developments in the Marina and at Seaton Carew, as well as further shopping developments in the town centre. Public sector resources, including One North East (English Partnerships) and European funds, will be made available for the provision of infrastructure as well HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 247 as premises on some industrial sites including North Burn, Queens Meadow and Sovereign Park. 18.9 Funding provided under the regeneration initiatives will support development schemes in the Single Regeneration Budget Partnership and New Deal for Communities areas. In particular the mixed use policy for the Headland (policy Com16) will provide the policy context for the implementation of the North Hartlepool Partnership programme for the regeneration of that area. 18.10 The Borough Council is likely to implement very few of these policies solely from its own resources - even some of the non-commercial recreational and leisure developments will be provided and / or funded in part by private developer contributions. PROPOSALS OF INTENT 18.11 Some policies in the plan highlight the Borough Council’s intentions to promote or undertake development. 18.12 An important part of the Council’s economic strategy is the promotion of tourism in the town and several of the plan’s policies relate to the encouragement and development of appropriate tourism-related facilities. Implementation of development resulting from these policies will be primarily by the private sector, although the Borough Council will have an important role in carrying out appropriate promotional activities. 18.13 The Borough Council will implement many of the proposals relating to the enhancement of wildlife areas, including the provision of interpretative facilities, often in partnership with English Nature and other wildlife bodies. The Borough Council will also implement the proposal to establish new local nature reserves. 18.14 The Borough Council will primarily be responsible for implementing environmental improvements in Conservation Areas, along major transport corridors and within the green network. The additional tree and woodland planting proposed in the plan will in part be undertaken by the Borough Council, with grant assistance from the Forestry Authority where appropriate, and in part by private developers. Derelict land will be reclaimed with grant assistance from One North East and other untidy sites having a significant detrimental effect on the surrounding environment will, subject to resources being made available, be compulsorily acquired by the Council. 18.15 Improvements to housing areas and environmental improvements in commercial and industrial improvement areas will be implemented primarily by the respective regeneration partnerships. 18.16 The Borough Council will implement many of the proposals for recreational development, and in this respect will seek funding from appropriate sources such as the national lottery. Some will also be resourced through contributions from developers or as part of regeneration programmes. Proposals for recreational developments in the rural areas, such as the community forest greenways and gateway sites and improvements to the right of ways, will be implemented by the Borough Council with appropriate grant assistance from the Countryside Agency. 18.17 The Borough Council as the highway authority will implement the proposals for improvements to public transport, cycleways, pedestrian routes and traffic management in accordance with the Hartlepool Local Transport Plan. The private sector will also have a part to play in relation the provision of local links to the cycleway network and where appropriate the implementation of proposals in green transport plans. 248 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Table 18.1: ANTICIPATED RESPONSIBILITY FOR IMPLEMENTATION AND RESOURCING OF POLICIES Policy No. and description Principal agencies for implementation & resourcing Type of policy HBC GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PRINCIPLES GEP1 GEP2 GEP3 GEP4 GEP5 GEP6 GEP7 GEP8 GEP9 GEP10 GEP11 GEP12 GEP13 GEP14 GEP15 GEP16 GEP17 GEP18 General Environmental Principles Access for All Crime Prevention by Planning and Design Control of Pollution Environmental Impact Assessment Energy Efficiency Frontages of Main Approaches Advertisements Developers’ Contributions Provision of Public Art Article 4 Directions Trees, Hedgerows and Development Works to Protected Trees Review of Tree Preservation Orders Compulsory Purchase of Potential Dev't Sites Untidy Sites Derelict Land Reclamation Development on Contaminated Land DC(Standards) DC(Standards) DC(Standards) DC(Protection) DC(Standards) DC(Standards) DC(Standards) DC(Criteria) Intent Intent Intent DC(Protection) DC(Protection) Intent Intent Intent Intent DC(Standards) Others DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC LPA DC DC LPA LPA LPA LPA DC all applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants all applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants ONE (grants) relevant applicants INDUSTRIAL AND BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT Ind1 Ind2 Ind3 Ind4 Ind 5 Ind6 Ind7 Ind8 Ind9 Ind10 Ind 11 Wynyard Business Park North Burn Electronics Components Park Queens Meadow Business Park Higher Quality Industrial Estates: Industrial Areas Bad Neighbour Uses Port-related Development Industrial Improvement Areas Potentially Polluting or Hazardous Developments Underground Storage Hazardous Substances Site Specific Site specific Site specific Site specific Site specific DC(Criteria) Site specific Intent Site specific Site specific DC(Criteria) DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC/LPA DC DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants / ONE relevant applicants / ONE relevant applicants / ONE relevant applicants / ONE relevant applicants port authority / relevant applicants relevant applicants / SRB (grants) relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants RETAIL, COMMERCIAL & MIXED USE DEVELOPMENT Com1 Com2 Com3 Com4 Com5 Com6 Com7 Com8 Com9 Com10 Com11 Com12 Com13 Com14 Development of the Town Centre Primary Shopping Area Primary Shopping Area – Opportunity Site Edge of Town Centre Areas Local Centres Commercial Improvement Areas Tees Bay Mixed Use Site Shopping Development Main Town Centre Uses Retailing in Industrial Areas Petrol Filling Stations Food and Drink Commercial Uses in Residential Areas Business Uses in the Home HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Site specific Site specific Site specific Site specific Site specific Intent Site specific DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC DC DC DC DC DC/LPA DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants Relevant applicants / SRB / NDC (grants) relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants 249 Policy No. and description Type of policy Principal agencies for implementation & resourcing HBC Others RETAIL, COMMERCIAL & MIXED USE DEVELOPMENT (continued) Com15 Com16 Com17 Victoria Harbout/North Docks Mixed Use Site Headland – Mixed Uses Land West of A179/North of Middleton Road Site specific Site specific Site specific DC DC/LA DC relevant applicants relevant applicants / SRB partnership relevant applicants DC/LA DC/LA DC DC DC DC/LA LA LPA DC/LA DC LA relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants English Nature / other wildlife groups relevant applicants relevant applicants - LA LA LA DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC SRB and NDC partnerships SRB/NDC partnerships/relevant applicants HBC / NDC / partners relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants LA DC LA LA/DC LA/DC DC LA DC LA LA DC DC DC DC DC DC DC Local Transport Plan funding LTP funding/Railtrack/train companies Local Transport Plan funding LTP funding/relevant applicants relevant applicants Local Transport Plan funding relevant applicants Local Transport Plan funding Local Transport Plan funding relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants TOURISM To1 To2 To3 To4 To5 To6 To7 To8 To9 To10 To11 Tourism Development in the Marina Tourism at the Headland Core Area of Seaton Carew Development Sites at Seaton Carew North Shelter Seaton Park Green Tourism Teesmouth National Nature Reserve Tourist Accommodation Touring Caravan Sites Business Tourism and Conferencing Hsg1 Hsg2 Hsg3 Hsg4 Hsg5 Hsg6 Hsg7 Hsg8 Hsg9 Hsg10 Hsg11 Hsg12 Hsg13 Hsg14 Housing Improvements Selective Housing Clearance Housing Market Renewal Central Area Housing Management of Housing Land Supply Mixed Use Areas Conversions for Residential Uses Residential Uses of Upper Floors New Residential Layout – Design etc. Residential Extensions Residential Annexes Homes and Hostels Residential Mobile Homes Gypsy Site Tra1 Tra2 Tra3 Tra4 Tra5 Tra6 Tra7 Tra8 Tra9 Tra10 Tra11 Tra12 Tra13 Tra14 Tra15 Tra16 Tra17 Bus Priority Routes Railway Line Extension Rail Halts Public Transport Interchange Cycleways Network Cycle Facilities Pedestrian Linkages Pedestrian Routes – Residential Areas Traffic Management in the Town Centre Road Junction Improvements Strategic Road Schemes Road Scheme: North Graythorp Road Schemes – Development Sites Access to Development Sites Restriction on Access to Major Roads Car Parking Standards Railway Sidings Intent Site specific Site specific Site specific Site specific Site specific Intent Intent Intent Site specific Intent HOUSING Intent Intent Intent DC(Protection) DC(Criteria) Site specific DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Standards) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) TRANSPORT 250 Intent Site specific Intent Intent Intent DC(Standards) Intent DC(Standards) Intent Intent DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC(Standards) DC(Protection) DC(Standards) DC(Protection) HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Type of policy Policy No. and description Principal agencies for implementation & resourcing HBC Others TRANSPORT (continued) Tra18 Tra19 Tra20 Rail Freight Facilities Provision for Alternative Transport Travel Plans DC(Criteria) DC(Standards) DC(Standards) DC DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants PUBLIC UTILITY AND COMMUNITY FACILITIES PU1 PU2 PU3 PU4 PU5 PU6 PU7 PU8 PU89 PU10 PU11 Drainage Systems Industrial Sites Drainage Sewage Treatment Works Protection of the Aquifer Electricity Transmission, Distribution and Supply Nuclear Power Station Site Renewable Energy Developments Telecommunications Local Facilities serving Residential Areas Primary School Location (Middle Warren) Primary School Site (Jesmond Road) Dco1 Dco2 Landfill Sites Flood Risk DC(Standards) DC (Standards) Site specific DC(Protection) DC(Criteria) Site specific DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) Site specific Site specific DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC LA/DC LA/DC relevant applicants relevant applicants Nothumbriam Water plc relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants education authority funding education authority funding DEVELOPMENT CONSTRAINTS DC(Standards) DC(Protection) DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants RECREATION AND LEISURE Rec1 Coastal Recreation DC(Criteria) DC relevant applicants DC(Standards) DC relevant applicants Intent LA/DC relevant applicants DC(Protection) DC relevant applicants Rec2 Casual Play in New Housing Areas Rec3 Neighbourhood Parks Rec4 Protection of Outdoor Playing Space Rec5 Development of Sports Pitches Intent LA/DC relevant applicants Rec6 Dual Use of School Facilities Intent LA/DC relevant applicants Rec7 Outdoor Recreational Sites Site Specific DC relevant applicants Rec8 Areas of Quiet Recreation Intent LA SRB partnerships/CA/relevant developers Rec9 Recreational Routes Intent LA LTP / Countryside Agency / lottery Intent LA CA / Tees Forest / Lottery Rec11 Noisy Sports and Leisure Activities DC(Criteria) DC relevant applicants Rec12 Land West of Brenda Road Site specific DC relevant applicants Rec13 Late Night Uses DC(Criteria) DC relevant applicants DC(Criteria) DC relevant applicants LA DC DC LA LA/DC DC SRB partnerships / LTP / developers relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants Rec10 Summerhill Rec14 Major Leisure Developments THE GREEN NETWORK GN1 GN2 GN3 GN4 GN5 GN6 Enhancement of the Green Network Protection of Green Wedges Protection of Key Green Space Areas Landscaping of Main Approaches Tree Planting Protection of Incidental Open Space WL1 Protection of International Conservation sites Protection of Nationally Important Nature Conservation Sites Enhancement of Sites of Special Scientific Interest Protected Species Protection of Local Nature Reserves Intent DC(Protection) DC(Protection) Intent Intent DC(Protection) WILDLIFE AND NATURAL FEATURES WL2 WL3 WL4 WL5 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 DC(Protection) DC relevant applicants DC(Protection) DC relevant applicants Intent DC(Protection) DC(Protection) LA DC DC English Nature / other wildlife groups relevant applicants relevant applicants 251 Policy No. and description Principal agencies for implementation & resourcing Type of policy HBC Others WILDLIFE AND NATURAL FEATURES (continued) WL6 WL7 WL8 New Local Nature Reserves Protection of SNCIs and RIGSs Protection of Biodiversity Intent DC(Protection) DC(Protection) LA DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants CONSERVATION OF THE HISTORIC ENVIRONMENT HE1 HE2 HE3 HE4 HE5 HE6 HE7 HE9 HE10 HE11 HE12 HE13 HE14 HE15 Protection & Enhancement of Conservation Areas Environmental Improvements in Conservation Areas Developments in the Vicinity of Conservation Areas Control of Demolition in Conservation Areas Review of Conservation Areas Protection & Enhancement of Registered Parks etc. Control of Demolition of Listed Buildings Works to Listed Buildings (including partial demolition) Changes of Use of Listed Buildings Developments in the Vicinity of Listed Buildings Review of Listed Buildings Protection of Locally Important Buildings Scheduled Monuments Protection of Archaeological Sites Areas of Historic Landscape Rur1 Rur2 Rur3 Rur4 Rur5 Rur6 Rur7 Rur8 Rur9 Rur10 Rur11 Rur12 Rur13 Rur14 Rur15 Rur16 Urban Fence Wynyard Limits to Development Village Envelopes Village Design Statements Development at Newton Bewley Rural Services Development in the Countryside Prior Notification for Agricultural Development Protection of Agricultural Land Intensive Livestock Units Farm Diversification New Housing in the Open Countryside Re-use of Rural Buildings The Tees Forest Small Gateway Sites Recreation in the Countryside DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC(Standards) DC(Standards) DC(Protection) DC(Standards) DC(Criteria) DC(Protection) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Standards) Intent DC(Criteria) DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC DC LA DC relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants/village communities relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants / Tees Forest / CA relevant applicants Rur17 Rur18 Rur19 Rur20 Strategic Recreational Routes Rights of Way Summerhill – Cowpen Bewley Greenway Special Landscape Areas DC(Protection) Intent Site specific DC(Protection) DC LA DC DC relevant applicants Tees Forest / Countryside Agency relevant applicants /Tees Forest / CA relevant applicants DC LA DC DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants HE8 DC(Protection) Intent DC(Standards) DC(Protection) Intent DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC LPA DC DC LPA DC/LA DC relevant applicants English Heritage relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants/ English Heritage / Lottery relevant applicants DC(Criteria) DC relevant applicants DC(Criteria) DC(Standards) Intent DC(Criteria) DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC(Protection) DC DC LPA LPA DC DC DC/LA relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants / Tees Archaeology THE RURAL AREA MINERALS Min1 Min2 Min3 Min4 Min5 252 Safeguarding of Mineral Reserves Use of Secondary Aggregates Mineral Extraction Transport of Minerals Restoration of Mineral Sites DC(Protection) Intent DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Standards) HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Policy No. and description Type of policy Principal agencies for implementation & resourcing HBC Others DC LA DC DC DC DC relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants relevant applicants WASTE Was1 Was2 Was3 Was4 Was5 Was6 Major Waste Producing Developments Provision of ‘Bring’ Recycling Facilities Composting Landfill Developments Landraising Incineration DC(Criteria) Intent DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) DC(Criteria) Abbreviations: CA Dc HBC LA LPA Countryside Agency Development control powers Hartlepool Borough Council Local authority Local planning authority HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 LTP NDC ONE SRB Hartlepool Local Transport Plan New Deal for Communities One North East Single Regeneration Budget 253 254 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 19 MONITORING AND REVIEW INTRODUCTION 19.1 The Hartlepool Local Plan establishes a framework of planning policies by which to control development and land-use by the Council, private developers, partnerships, individuals and other agencies. These planning policies are a means of attaining the Borough Council’s overall aim to ‘take direct action and work in partnership with others, to continue the revitalisation of Hartlepool life and secure a better future for Hartlepool people’. They are formulated in response to specific circumstances and problems which are apparent at the time the plan is being prepared. Plan preparation is, however, not a once-and-for-all exercise and this plan reviews and supersedes the plan adopted in 1994. 19.2 The local plan is based on the best information available at the time of preparation, and of necessity makes assumptions about likely future trends and events. Changes in the state of the economy, leading to periods of growth or recession, changes in the policies of government at all levels, change in the scheduling of investment (to name but a few examples) will relate to the continued validity of the plan. MONITORING 19.3 There is a need for continuous feedback on the implementation of the local plan policies. Monitoring should be an on-going process which involves regular checking that: ♦ the plan assumptions remain valid, ♦ policies are successful in fulfilling the aims of the plan and the plan’s targets are being met, ♦ policies and proposals remain relevant to current issues, and ♦ proposals are being progressed at the rate anticipated. Such monitoring will not only relate to the collection of data, but also, so far as practicable, will take account of the views of the plan’s clients including developers and the general public. ANNUAL MONITORING REPORT 19.4 The new planning legislation referred to in Chapter 1 1 requires that an Annual Monitoring Report is prepared as part of the Local Development Framework. The Annual Monitoring Report should assess: • the implementation of the Local Development Scheme (LDS) which sets out the Council’s rolling programme for the preparation of documents relating to forward planning; and • the extent to which policies in current planning documents are being achieved. 19.5 In order to properly assess the effectiveness of planning policies, the social, economic and environmental context within which the policies have been formulated, the problems and issues they are intended to tackle, and the opportunities of which advantage can be taken to resolve such problems and issues will be set out in the annual monitoring report. A range of indicators will be established to monitor policies. Certain indicators (referred to as ‘core output indicators’) have been established by central government and must be monitored by all local planning authorities. This includes the preparation of a housing trajectory illustrating past and likely future housing completions against the requirements set out in strategic planning documents (currently the Tees Valley Structure Plan, but ultimately the Regional Spatial Strategy). Other indicators 1 See paragraph 1.20. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 255 (‘local output indicators’) will be developed to ensure robust assessment of policy implementation relevant to the specific circumstances of the Hartlepool area and reflecting the availability of existing data sources. 19.6 In assessing the implementation of policies, the annual monitoring report will o where policies are not being implemented, explain why and set out the steps to be taken to ensure that the policy is implemented, or identify whether the policy is to be amended or replaced; o identify whether policies need adjusting or replacing because they are not working as intended; o identify any policies that need changing to reflect changes in national or regional policy; and o set out whether any policies are to be amended or replaced. 19.7 The Annual Monitoring Report will be published in December each year and relate to the previous financial year. The first two annual monitoring reports (for 2004-2005 and for 2005-2006) must concentrate on the implementation of the policies of the 1994 Hartlepool Local Plan, as this was the plan in force over these two years. Subsequently, annual monitoring reports will consider the extent to which the saved policies included in this plan (adopted in April 2006) are being achieved. REPLACEMENT OF POLICIES 19.8 256 Under the new planning legislation the policies in this plan will be saved for at least three years, unless monitoring indicates that they are no longer working as intended. Ultimately the policies will be replaced in the new local development documents to be prepared under the new planning system. The programme for the preparation of these documents is set out in the Local Development Scheme. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 20 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL OF THE LOCAL PLAN INTRODUCTION 20.1 As part of the preparation of the local plan an environmental appraisal has been carried out on the policies as they have developed. The appraisal has highlighted areas of environmental concern, which in some cases have been able to be addressed by amending and strengthening the environmental emphasis of the policies. 20.2 The method of appraisal followed Government guidance on environmental appraisals of development plans, updated to comply with Hartlepool Borough Council’s method of sustainability appraisal used in line with the Hartlepool Sustainable Development Strategy. 20.3 At the national level Planning Policy Guidance Note 12 (Development Plans and Regional Planning Guidance) states that all plans must undergo an environmental appraisal as part of the plan making process 1 . 20.4 The Environmental Appraisal also incorporates a reasons outlined below. Sustainable Development Commission on Environment and Development (the “development which meets present needs without future generations to meet their own needs.” 20.5 Sustainable Development is now an over riding objective for the European Union. This is stated in the Amsterdam Treaty. It stipulates that environmental protection requirements must be integrated within all community policies, in particular with a view to promoting sustainable development. sustainability appraisal for was defined by the World Brundtland Commission) as compromising the ability of BACKGROUND 20.6 In 1993 the Department of the Environment published “Environmental Appraisal of Development Plans - A Good Practice Guide”. This guidance shows how the Council should assess whether each policy will have a positive, negative or neutral impact on the environment. 20.7 The guidance suggested that local authorities should refine their list according to local circumstances. Since the guidance was published, however, environmental and sustainability issues have moved on considerably. As a consequence Hartlepool Borough Council has sought to bring the environmental appraisal of the local plan in line with the sustainability appraisal used in the preparation of the Local Sustainability Development Strategy. The criteria used have followed quite closely the list in the guidance, but have been defined under the headings of pollution, natural resources, biodiversity and landscape, local distinctiveness, access and crime. These headings fit in with the sustainability appraisal which is based on the thirteen themes of sustainability indicated in bold type in Table 20.1. 20.8 The aims of an environmental appraisal are different to those of a sustainability appraisal. Not all of the criteria in the sustainability appraisal are included in the environmental appraisal and environmental factors are considered in greater detail in the environmental appraisal. Environmental assessment may identify significant negative environmental impacts as for example in out of town greenfield locations such as North Burn (Samsung). In certain circumstances the 1 PPG12 has since been superseded by PPS12 and the provisions of the Planning & Compulsory Purchase Act 2004 whereby Plans and Programmes are subject to Sustainability Appraisal (SA) and Strategic Environmental Assessment (SEA) However this Local Plan was prepared prior to July 2006 and so has been prepared under the previous regulations relating to environmental appraisal. HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 257 benefits of development in economic and social terms may need to be balanced against the negative effects. In such cases the Sustainability Appraisal, which includes social and economic considerations may give a more balanced indication of the effect of major development proposals of national or regional importance. In both environmental and sustainability assessments it is important to identify opportunities to ameliorate or minimise any adverse environmental effects. Table 20.1 Environmental Appraisal Criteria Sustainability Appraisal Criteria Pollution Atmospheric Pollution Warming Local Air Quality Noise Land and Soil Water Quality Light Natural Resources Pollution Atmospheric Pollution & Global Warming Local Air Quality Noise Light Materials Use Natural Resources / Waste Management Transport Energy Efficiency Built Environment Energy Efficiency Renewable Energy Potential Minerals Land, air and water quality Waste Management Biodiversity Local Diversity/ Distinctiveness Cultural and Built Heritage Landscape and Open Land Coast Access Crime and Persecution Diverse Economy Skills, Knowledge and Education Culture, Leisure and Recreation Community Participation Basic Needs Health and Well- Being Local Needs and Global Transport Energy Efficiency Built Environment Energy Efficiency Renewable Energy Potential Minerals Biodiversity Wildlife Local Distinctiveness Cultural and Built Heritage Landscape and Open Land Coast Access Public Access to Open Space Crime Crime Prevention 20.9 The criteria considered when assessing the impact of each policy are set out as follows: ENVIRONMENTAL CRITERIA POLLUTION 1. Atmospheric Pollution and Global Warming Is the policy likely to increase the production of Carbon Dioxide and other Greenhouse Gases? Is it likely to lead to result in other atmospheric pollutants, for example which damage the ozone layer? 258 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Does the policy protect/promote an increase in tree cover (which can fix carbon dioxide)? 2. Local Air Quality Is the policy likely to lead to an increase in local traffic? Is the policy likely to lead to an increase in air pollutants or fumes from other sources? 3. Noise Does the policy safeguard against the effects of pollution by noise? 4. Land and Soil Does the policy safeguard agricultural land or greenspace from loss, contamination or dereliction? Does it promote reclamation? Does it protect greenfield sites or promote the re-use of brownfield sites? 5. Water Quality Does the policy help to protect water resources or promote their effective stewardship? 6. Light Will the policy lead to an increase in light pollution? NATURAL RESOURCES 7. Transport Energy Efficiency Is the policy likely to increase the number and/or length of journeys by car? Does the policy promote alternative forms of transport to the car, e.g. cycling, walking or public transport? 8. Built Environment Energy Efficiency Does the policy encourage/promote energy efficiency in buildings, e.g. design, location, siting, form, layout, density, choice of materials? 9. Renewable Energy Potential Does the policy encourage the use of renewable energy? 10. Minerals Does the policy promote the protection or careful use of non-renewable resources? Does it promote the re-use of buildings or building materials? Does it promote re-use or recycling of materials? BIODIVERSITY AND LANDSCAPE 11. Wildlife Does the policy help to protect or enhance biodiversity/wildlife habitats or might it result in their damage or loss? Does it protect trees, ponds wetlands or other locally important habitats? LOCAL DISTINCTIVENESS 12. Cultural and Built Heritage Does the policy maintain and improve Listed buildings, conservation areas, ancient monuments, archaeological remains or cultural/historic landscapes? HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 259 Does the policy promote the improvement, re-use and/or maintenance of existing buildings? 13. Landscape and Open Land Does the policy promote the protection or enhancement of the landscape, countryside or open urban land? Does it encourage quality planting schemes. Does it protect/encourage links between open space and landscape features? 14. Coast Does the policy protect or improve the coast, e.g. coastal protection, landscape, views, heritage, wildlife habitats, water quality? ACCESS 15. Public Access to Open Space Does the policy maintain or increase the quality and availability of public access to the countryside and open space? CRIME 16. Crime Prevention Does the policy increase safety and security through, for example, designing out crime? THE ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL 20.10 All 178 local plan policies have been appraised using the criteria described above to determine whether they have a positive, negative or neutral effect. The aim has not been to assess in too much detail but rather to raise awareness of the relationship between the policies and environmental factors. The results of the appraisal together with those of the sustainability appraisal are set out in the separately published document “Hartlepool Local Plan - Environmental Appraisal and Sustainability Assessment”. The assessment has been carried out by a small multidisciplinary team representing the council’s various interests in environmental matters including Agenda 21 and ecology. 20.11 Examples include a more comprehensive general environmental improvement policy (GEP1) than had been in the 1994 adopted plan. Other specific areas of concern included the need to minimise light pollution, to encourage the use of secondary aggregates, and to afford increased protection of water resources. Other policy areas where environmental factors have had greater emphasis arising directly from the environmental appraisal include the requirement for Travel Plans, the protection of the green network, additional planting, the need to minimise any adverse impact on biodiversity and a greater emphasis on developer contributions to secure environmental benefits. 20.12 The results of the assessment are given in Table 20.2 below. The framing of policies has been directly influenced by the appraisal in that many of the policies have been strengthened by the identification of opportunities available to minimise adverse environmental effects arising from new development. Where the policies are likely to result in positive enhancement of the environment the relevant issue is identified by a tick in the appropriate box in the table. 260 HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN – April 2006 Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Crime Prevention GEP 4 Control of Pollution GEP 5 Environmental Impact Assessment GEP 6 Energy Efficiency GEP 7 Frontages of Main Approaches GEP 8 Advertisements GEP 9 Developers' Contributions U 12 13 14 15 16 Crime Prevention GEP 3 11 Public Access to Open Space Water Quality Access for All 10 The Coast Land & Soil GEP 2 9 Landscape & Open Land Noise General Environmental Principles 8 Cultural & Built Heritage Local Air Quality GEP 1 7 Biodiversity & Wildlife Policy Subject 6 Minerals 5 Renewable Energy Potential 4 Built Environment Energy Efficiency 3 Transport Energy 2 Light 1 Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Policy No. Criteria U U U U ? ? GEP 10 Public Art ? GEP 11 Article 4 Directions GEP 12 Trees, Hedgerows & Development GEP 13 Works to Protected Trees GEP 14 Review of Tree Preservation Orders GEP 15 Compulsory Purchase GEP 16 Untidy Sites GEP 17 Derelict Land Reclamation GEP 18 Contaminated Land U U ? U U ? ? U U ? 261 Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Ind 8 Industrial Improvement Areas Ind 9 Potentially Polluting or Hazardous Ind 10 Underground Storage Ind 11 Hazardous Substances U U U U U ? U U U U U U U ? U U ? U 16 Crime Prevention Port Related Development ? 15 Public Access to Open Space Bad Neighbour Uses Ind 7 ? U U U U U U U 14 The Coast Ind 6 U U 13 Landscape & Open Land Industrial Areas ? ? U U U U U 11 Cultural & Built Heritage Ind 5 U U U U U U U 10 Biodiversity & Wildlife Higher Quality Industrial Sites ? U 9 Minerals Ind 4 U U U U U 8 Renewable Energy Potential Queens Meadow U U U U U 7 Transport Energy Ind 3 U U U U U U U 6 Light North Burn 5 Water Quality Ind 2 4 Land & Soil Wynyard Business Park 3 Noise Ind 1 2 Local Air Quality Policy Subject Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Policy No. 1 Built Environment Energy Efficiency 262 Criteria 12 U U U U U U ? U U ? U U U U U U ? U ? U ? ? ? U Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Com 9 Major Town Centre Uses U U U ? 16 Crime Prevention Shopping Development U 15 Public Access to Open Space Com 8 U U U 14 The Coast Tees Bay Retail Park 13 Landscape & Open Land Com 7 12 Cultural & Built Heritage Commercial Improvement Areas 11 Biodiversity & Wildlife Com 6 U ? 10 Minerals Local Centres 9 Renewable Energy Potential Edge of Town Centre Areas Com 5 ? U 8 Built Environment Energy Efficiency Com 4 ? U ? U 7 Transport Energy Primary Shopping Area 6 Light Com 2 5 Water Quality Development of the Town Centre 4 Land & Soil Com 1 3 Noise Policy Subject 2 Local Air Quality 1 Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Policy No. Criteria ? U U U Com 10 Retailing in Industrial Areas Com 11 Petrol Filling Stations Com 12 Food & Drink U U U U U U U U 263 Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Core Area of Seaton Carew To 4 Development Sites at Seaton Carew To 5 North Shelter To 6 Seaton Park To 7 Green Tourism To 8 Teesmouth National Nature Reserve To 9 Tourist Accommodation To 10 Touring Caravan Sites To 11 Business Tourism & Conferencing U 15 U U U U U U U U ? ? ? U U U U U U U U ? ? U U U U U U U ? U ? U 16 Crime Prevention To 3 14 Public Access to Open Space Tourism at the Headland 13 The Coast To 2 U 12 Landscape & Open Land Tourism Development in the Marina 11 Cultural & Built Heritage Light Com 17 Land West of A179 To 1 10 Biodiversity & Wildlife Water Quality U Com 16 Headland - Mixed Uses 9 U U U U U ? Victoria Harbour/N.Docks Mixed Use 8 Minerals Land & Soil HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Com 14 Business Uses in the Home 7 Renewable Energy Potential 6 Built Environment Energy Efficiency 5 Transport Energy 4 ? U Com 13 Commercial Uses in Residential Com15 3 Noise Policy Subject Atmospheric Pollution Policy No. 2 Local Air Quality 1 264 Criteria U U Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL 15 16 Crime Prevention U 14 Public Access to Open Space Cultural & Built Heritage U 13 The Coast 12 Biodiversity & Wildlife 10- Landscape & Open Land 11 Minerals U 9 U U Housing Market Renewal Hsg 14 Hsg 4 Central Area Housing Hsg 1 Hsg 5 Management of Housing Land Supply Hsg 3 Hsg 6 Mixed Use Areas Hsg 7 Hsg 7 Conversions for Residentail Uses Hsg 8 Hsg 8 Residential Use of Upper Floors Hsg 6 Hsg 9 New Residential Layout Hsg 15 Hsg10 Residential Extensions Hsg 16 Hsg11 Residential Annexes Hsg 9 Homes & Hostels Hsg12 U 8 Renewable Energy Potential Hsg 3 7 Built Environment Energy Efficiency Selective Housing Clearance 6 Transport Energy Hsg 13 Hsg 2 5 Light Housing Improvements 4 Water Quality Hsg 12 Hsg 1 1 Land & Soil Policy Subject Noise New Policy No. 3 Local Air Quality Former Policy No. 2 Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Criteria Hsg 10 Hsg13 Residential Mobile Homes Hsg 11 Hsg14 Gypsy Site U U U ? ? U U U U U ? U ? ? 265 Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL U U U U ? U U U U U U ? U ? ? U U U U U U ? U ? U ? ? U U U U 13 14 15 16 Crime Prevention Renewable Energy Potential U U U U 12 Public Access to Open Space Built Environment Energy Efficiency ? U U U ? ? 11 The Coast Transport Energy U 10 Landscape & Open Land 9 Cultural & Built Heritage 8 Biodiversity & Wildlife 7 Minerals 6 Light U U 5 Water Quality Bus Priority Routes Railway Line Extension Rail Halts Public Transport Interchange Cycleways Network Cycle Facilities Pedestrian Linkages Pedestrian Routes Traffic Management Road Junction Improvements Strategic Road Schemes Road Scheme: North Graythorp Road Shemes: Development Sites Access to Development Sites Restriction on Access Car Parking Standards Railway Sidings Rail Freight Facilities Provision for Alternative Transport Green Transport Plans 4 Land & Soil Policy Subject 3 Noise 2 Local Air Quality HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Tra 1 Tra 2 Tra 3 Tra 4 Tra 5 Tra 6 Tra 7 Tra 8 Tra 9 Tra 10 Tra 11 Tra 12 Tra 13 Tra 14 Tra 15 Tra 16 Tra 17 Tra 18 Tra 19 Tra 20 1 Atmospheric Pollution 266 Policy No. Criteria U U U U U U U ? ? ? ? ? ? Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Local Facilities PU10 Primary School Location PU11 Primary School Site Dco 1 Landfill Sites Dco 2 Areas at Risk from Flooding 16 Crime Prevention PU 9 15 Public Access to Open Space Telecommunications 14 The Coast PU 8 13 Landscape & Open Land Renewable Energy Developments 12 Cultural & Built Heritage PU 7 11 Biodiversity & Wildlife Electricity Transmission Nuclear Power Station Site 10 Minerals Protection of the Aquifer PU 5 PU 6 9 Renewable Energy Potential PU 4 8 Built Environment Energy Efficiency Sewage Treatment Works 7 Transport Energy PU 3 6 Light Industrial Sites Drainage 5 Water Quality PU 2 4 Land & Soil Drainage Systems 3 Noise PU 1 2 Local Air Quality Policy Policy Subject No. 1 Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Criteria U U ? ? U U U ? ? U U ? U U U U U U U U U U ? ? U ? U U U U U U ? 267 Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Rec 8 Areas of Quiet Recreation Rec 9 Recreational Routes Rec 10 Summerhill Rec 11 Noisy Outdoor Sports & Leisure Rec 12 Land West of Brenda Road Rec 13 Late Night Uses Rec 14 Major Leisure Developments U ? ? ? U U ? ? U U ? U U 16 Crime Prevention Outdoor Recreation Sites at Seaton 15 Public Access to Open Space Rec 7 14 The Coast Dual Use of School Facilities 13 Landscape & Open Land Rec 6 12 Cultural & Built Heritage Development of Sports Pitches 11 Biodiversity & Wildlife Rec 5 10 Minerals Neighbourhood Parks Protection of Outdoor Playing Space 9 Renewable Energy Potential Rec 3 Rec 4 8 Built Environment Energy Efficiency Provision for Play 7 Transport Energy Rec 2 6 Light Coastal Recreation 5 Water Quality Rec 1 4 Land & Soil Policy Subject 3 Noise 2 Local Air Quality HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 1 Atmospheric Pollution 268 Policy No. Criteria U ? U ? ? U ? ? ? U U U U U ? U ? U Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Policy Subject Local Air Quality Noise Land & Soil Water Quality Light Transport Energy Built Environment Energy Efficiency Renewable Energy Potential Minerals Biodiversity & Wildlife Cultural & Built Heritage Landscape & Open Land The Coast Public Access to Open Space 269 GN 1 Enhancement of the Green Network GN 2 Protection of Green Wedges GN 3 Protection of Key Green Space Areas GN 4 Landscaping of Main Approaches GN 5 Tree Planting GN 6 Protection of Incidental Open Space WL1 Protection of International Nature Cons.Sites WL2 Protection of Nationally Important Nature Cons.Sites WL3 Enhancement of SSSIs WL4 Protected Species WL5 Protection of Local Nature Reserves WL6 New Local Nature Reserves WL7 Protection of SNCIs & RIGSs WL8 Protection of Biodiversity 16 Crime Prevention 1 Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Policy No. Criteria ? U ? U ? U U ? U Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Water Quality Light Transport Energy HE 2 Environmental Improvements HE 3 Development in the Vicinity of HE 4 Demolition in Conservation Areas HE 5 Review of Conservation Areas HE 6 Registered Parks & Gardens HE 7 Demolition of Listed Buildings HE 8 Works to LBs (inc Partial Demolition) HE 9 Changes of Use of Listed Buildings HE 10 Developments in the Vicinity of HE 11 Review of Listed Buildings HE 12 List of Locally Important Buildings HE 13 Scheduled Monuments HE 14 Protection of Archaeological Sites HE 15 Areas of Historic Landscape ? ? U ? ? ? ? ? ? ? 11 12 13 14 15 16 Crime Prevention Land & Soil Conservation Areas 10 Public Access to Open Space Noise HE 1 9 The Coast Policy Subject 8 Landscape & Open Land 7 Cultural & Built Heritage 6 Biodiversity & Wildlife 5 Minerals 4 Renewable Energy Potential 3 Built Environment Energy Efficiency 2 Local Air Quality HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 1 Atmospheric Pollution 270 Policy No. Criteria U ? U ? ? ? ? ? ? ? U U ? ? ? ? ? U U U Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL Rural Services Rur 7 Development in the Countryside Rur 8 Approval for Agricultural Development Rur 9 Protection of Agricultural Land Rur 10 Intensive Livestock Units Rur 11 Farm Diversification Rur 12 New Housing Rur 13 Reuse of Rural Buildings Rur 14 The Tees Forest Rur 15 Small Gateway Sites Rur 16 Recreation in the Countryside Rur 17 Stategic Recreational Routes Rur 18 Rights of Way Rur 19 Summerhill Greenway Rur 20 Special Landscape Areas 15 16 Crime Prevention Rur 6 14 Public Access to Open Space Development at Newton Bewley 13 The Coast Rur 5 12 Landscape & Open Land Village Design Statements U U 11 Cultural & Built Heritage Rur 4 U 10 Biodiversity & Wildlife Village Envelopes U 9 Minerals Rur 3 U 8 Renewable Energy Potential Wynyard Limits to Development 7 Built Environment Energy Efficiency Rur 2 6 Transport Energy Urban Fence 3 Light Local Air Quality 271 Rur 1 5 Water Quality Policy Subject 4 Land & Soil 2 Noise 1 Atmospheric Pollution HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 Policy No. Criteria U U U U ? ? ? ? ? ? ? U ? ? ? U U U ? ? U U U U U ? U ? Table 20.2 ENVIRONMENTAL APPRAISAL 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Policy Subject Noise Land & Soil Water Quality Light Transport Energy Built Environment Energy Efficiency Renewable Energy Potential Minerals Biodiversity & Wildlife Cultural & Built Heritage Landscape & Open Land The Coast Public Access to Open Space Min 1 Safeguarding of Mineral Reserves Min 2 Secondary Aggregates Min 3 Mineral Extraction Min 4 Transportation of Minerals Min 5 Restoration of Mineral Sites Was 1 Major Waste Producing Development Was 2 Bring Recycling Facilities Was 3 Composting Was 4 Landfill Developments Was 5 Landraising Was 6 Incineration Facilities ? U U ? ? ? U ? U ? U U U U ? ? U ? ? ? ? ? U U U 16 Crime Prevention 2 Local Air Quality HARTLEPOOL LOCAL PLAN - April 2006 1 Atmospheric Pollution 272 Policy No. Criteria U ? ? U U ? U U ? ? U U